xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-4.7/gcc/doc/invoke.texi (revision 77b0c609)
1@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
2@c 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@ignore
8@c man begin INCLUDE
9@include gcc-vers.texi
10@c man end
11
12@c man begin COPYRIGHT
13Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
141999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011,
152012
16Free Software Foundation, Inc.
17
18Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
19under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
20any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
21Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
22Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
23the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the license is
24included in the gfdl(7) man page.
25
26(a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
27
28     A GNU Manual
29
30(b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
31
32     You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
33     software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
34     funds for GNU development.
35@c man end
36@c Set file name and title for the man page.
37@setfilename gcc
38@settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
39@c man begin SYNOPSIS
40gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
41    [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
42    [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-pedantic}]
43    [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
44    [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
45    [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
46    [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] [@@@var{file}] @var{infile}@dots{}
47
48Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
49remainder.  @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
50@c man end
51@c man begin SEEALSO
52gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
53cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
54and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{as},
55@file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
56@c man end
57@c man begin BUGS
58For instructions on reporting bugs, see
59@w{@value{BUGURL}}.
60@c man end
61@c man begin AUTHOR
62See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
63@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
64for contributors to GCC@.
65@c man end
66@end ignore
67
68@node Invoking GCC
69@chapter GCC Command Options
70@cindex GCC command options
71@cindex command options
72@cindex options, GCC command
73
74@c man begin DESCRIPTION
75When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
76assembly and linking.  The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
77process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the @option{-c} option
78says not to run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files
79output by the assembler.
80
81Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options
82control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself.  Yet other
83options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
84documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
85
86@cindex C compilation options
87Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful
88for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
89(usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
90for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
91that option with all supported languages.
92
93@cindex C++ compilation options
94@xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
95options for compiling C++ programs.
96
97@cindex grouping options
98@cindex options, grouping
99The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many
100options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
101may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dv} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
102-v}}.
103
104@cindex order of options
105@cindex options, order
106You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order
107you use doesn't matter.  Order does matter when you use several
108options of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more
109than once, the directories are searched in the order specified.  Also,
110the placement of the @option{-l} option is significant.
111
112Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
113@samp{-W}---for example,
114@option{-fmove-loop-invariants}, @option{-Wformat} and so on.  Most of
115these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
116@option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  This manual documents
117only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
118
119@c man end
120
121@xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
122
123@menu
124* Option Summary::      Brief list of all options, without explanations.
125* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
126                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
127                        or preprocessed source.
128* Invoking G++::        Compiling C++ programs.
129* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
130* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
131* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
132                        and Objective-C++.
133* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
134                        formatted.
135* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
136* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
137* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
138* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
139                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
140* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
141* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
142* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
143                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
144* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
145* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
146* Submodel Options::    Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
147                        such as 68010 vs 68020.
148* Code Gen Options::    Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
149                        and register usage.
150* Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
151* Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
152@end menu
153
154@c man begin OPTIONS
155
156@node Option Summary
157@section Option Summary
158
159Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are
160in the following sections.
161
162@table @emph
163@item Overall Options
164@xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
165@gccoptlist{-c  -S  -E  -o @var{file}  -no-canonical-prefixes  @gol
166-pipe  -pass-exit-codes  @gol
167-x @var{language}  -v  -###  --help@r{[}=@var{class}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]]}  --target-help  @gol
168--version -wrapper @@@var{file} -fplugin=@var{file} -fplugin-arg-@var{name}=@var{arg}  @gol
169-fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]} -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}}
170
171@item C Language Options
172@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
173@gccoptlist{-ansi  -std=@var{standard}  -fgnu89-inline @gol
174-aux-info @var{filename} -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions @gol
175-fno-asm  -fno-builtin  -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
176-fhosted  -ffreestanding -fopenmp -fms-extensions -fplan9-extensions @gol
177-trigraphs  -no-integrated-cpp  -traditional  -traditional-cpp @gol
178-fallow-single-precision  -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions @gol
179-fsigned-bitfields  -fsigned-char @gol
180-funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char}
181
182@item C++ Language Options
183@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
184@gccoptlist{-fabi-version=@var{n}  -fno-access-control  -fcheck-new @gol
185-fconserve-space  -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}  -ffriend-injection @gol
186-fno-elide-constructors @gol
187-fno-enforce-eh-specs @gol
188-ffor-scope  -fno-for-scope  -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
189-fno-implicit-templates @gol
190-fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
191-fno-implement-inlines  -fms-extensions @gol
192-fno-nonansi-builtins  -fnothrow-opt  -fno-operator-names @gol
193-fno-optional-diags  -fpermissive @gol
194-fno-pretty-templates @gol
195-frepo  -fno-rtti  -fstats  -ftemplate-depth=@var{n} @gol
196-fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit  -fno-weak  -nostdinc++ @gol
197-fno-default-inline  -fvisibility-inlines-hidden @gol
198-fvisibility-ms-compat @gol
199-Wabi  -Wconversion-null  -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
200-Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor -Wnarrowing -Wnoexcept @gol
201-Wnon-virtual-dtor  -Wreorder @gol
202-Weffc++  -Wstrict-null-sentinel @gol
203-Wno-non-template-friend  -Wold-style-cast @gol
204-Woverloaded-virtual  -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
205-Wsign-promo}
206
207@item Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
208@xref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling
209Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects}.
210@gccoptlist{-fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
211-fgnu-runtime  -fnext-runtime @gol
212-fno-nil-receivers @gol
213-fobjc-abi-version=@var{n} @gol
214-fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors @gol
215-fobjc-direct-dispatch @gol
216-fobjc-exceptions @gol
217-fobjc-gc @gol
218-fobjc-nilcheck @gol
219-fobjc-std=objc1 @gol
220-freplace-objc-classes @gol
221-fzero-link @gol
222-gen-decls @gol
223-Wassign-intercept @gol
224-Wno-protocol  -Wselector @gol
225-Wstrict-selector-match @gol
226-Wundeclared-selector}
227
228@item Language Independent Options
229@xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
230@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=@var{n}  @gol
231-fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]}  @gol
232-fno-diagnostics-show-option}
233
234@item Warning Options
235@xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
236@gccoptlist{-fsyntax-only  -fmax-errors=@var{n}  -pedantic @gol
237-pedantic-errors @gol
238-w  -Wextra  -Wall  -Waddress  -Waggregate-return  -Warray-bounds @gol
239-Wno-attributes -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined @gol
240-Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat -Wcast-align  -Wcast-qual  @gol
241-Wchar-subscripts -Wclobbered  -Wcomment @gol
242-Wconversion  -Wcoverage-mismatch  -Wno-cpp  -Wno-deprecated  @gol
243-Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wdisabled-optimization  @gol
244-Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body  -Wenum-compare @gol
245-Wno-endif-labels -Werror  -Werror=* @gol
246-Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2 @gol
247-Wno-format-contains-nul -Wno-format-extra-args -Wformat-nonliteral @gol
248-Wformat-security  -Wformat-y2k @gol
249-Wframe-larger-than=@var{len} -Wno-free-nonheap-object -Wjump-misses-init @gol
250-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
251-Wimplicit  -Wimplicit-function-declaration  -Wimplicit-int @gol
252-Winit-self  -Winline -Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
253-Wno-int-to-pointer-cast -Wno-invalid-offsetof @gol
254-Winvalid-pch -Wlarger-than=@var{len}  -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations @gol
255-Wlogical-op -Wlong-long @gol
256-Wmain -Wmaybe-uninitialized -Wmissing-braces  -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
257-Wmissing-format-attribute  -Wmissing-include-dirs @gol
258-Wno-mudflap @gol
259-Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull  -Wno-overflow @gol
260-Woverlength-strings  -Wpacked  -Wpacked-bitfield-compat  -Wpadded @gol
261-Wparentheses  -Wpedantic-ms-format -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @gol
262-Wpointer-arith  -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @gol
263-Wredundant-decls @gol
264-Wreturn-type  -Wsequence-point  -Wshadow @gol
265-Wsign-compare  -Wsign-conversion  -Wstack-protector @gol
266-Wstack-usage=@var{len} -Wstrict-aliasing -Wstrict-aliasing=n @gol
267-Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n} @gol
268-Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]} @gol
269-Wswitch  -Wswitch-default  -Wswitch-enum -Wsync-nand @gol
270-Wsystem-headers  -Wtrampolines  -Wtrigraphs  -Wtype-limits  -Wundef @gol
271-Wuninitialized  -Wunknown-pragmas  -Wno-pragmas @gol
272-Wunsuffixed-float-constants  -Wunused  -Wunused-function @gol
273-Wunused-label  -Wunused-local-typedefs -Wunused-parameter @gol
274-Wno-unused-result -Wunused-value @gol -Wunused-variable @gol
275-Wunused-but-set-parameter -Wunused-but-set-variable @gol
276-Wvariadic-macros -Wvector-operation-performance -Wvla
277-Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant}
278
279@item C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
280@gccoptlist{-Wbad-function-cast  -Wmissing-declarations @gol
281-Wmissing-parameter-type  -Wmissing-prototypes  -Wnested-externs @gol
282-Wold-style-declaration  -Wold-style-definition @gol
283-Wstrict-prototypes  -Wtraditional  -Wtraditional-conversion @gol
284-Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign}
285
286@item Debugging Options
287@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
288@gccoptlist{-d@var{letters}  -dumpspecs  -dumpmachine  -dumpversion @gol
289-fdbg-cnt-list -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list} @gol
290-fdisable-ipa-@var{pass_name} @gol
291-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass_name} @gol
292-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
293-fdisable-tree-@var{pass_name} @gol
294-fdisable-tree-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
295-fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-unnumbered-links @gol
296-fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
297-fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
298-fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph -fdump-ipa-inline @gol
299-fdump-passes @gol
300-fdump-statistics @gol
301-fdump-tree-all @gol
302-fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]}  @gol
303-fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
304-fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-vcg -fdump-tree-alias @gol
305-fdump-tree-ch @gol
306-fdump-tree-ssa@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-pre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
307-fdump-tree-ccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-dce@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
308-fdump-tree-gimple@r{[}-raw@r{]} -fdump-tree-mudflap@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
309-fdump-tree-dom@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
310-fdump-tree-dse@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
311-fdump-tree-phiprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
312-fdump-tree-phiopt@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
313-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
314-fdump-tree-copyrename@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
315-fdump-tree-nrv -fdump-tree-vect @gol
316-fdump-tree-sink @gol
317-fdump-tree-sra@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
318-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
319-fdump-tree-fre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
320-fdump-tree-vrp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
321-ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n} @gol
322-fdump-tree-storeccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
323-fdump-final-insns=@var{file} @gol
324-fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}  -fcompare-debug-second @gol
325-feliminate-dwarf2-dups -feliminate-unused-debug-types @gol
326-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always @gol
327-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass} @gol
328-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list} @gol
329-fdebug-types-section @gol
330-fmem-report -fpre-ipa-mem-report -fpost-ipa-mem-report -fprofile-arcs @gol
331-frandom-seed=@var{string} -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
332-fsel-sched-verbose -fsel-sched-dump-cfg -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose @gol
333-fstack-usage  -ftest-coverage  -ftime-report -fvar-tracking @gol
334-fvar-tracking-assignments  -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle @gol
335-g  -g@var{level}  -gtoggle  -gcoff  -gdwarf-@var{version} @gol
336-ggdb  -grecord-gcc-switches  -gno-record-gcc-switches @gol
337-gstabs  -gstabs+  -gstrict-dwarf  -gno-strict-dwarf @gol
338-gvms  -gxcoff  -gxcoff+ @gol
339-fno-merge-debug-strings -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm @gol
340-fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new} @gol
341-femit-struct-debug-baseonly -femit-struct-debug-reduced @gol
342-femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]} @gol
343-p  -pg  -print-file-name=@var{library}  -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
344-print-multi-directory  -print-multi-lib  -print-multi-os-directory @gol
345-print-prog-name=@var{program}  -print-search-dirs  -Q @gol
346-print-sysroot -print-sysroot-headers-suffix @gol
347-save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}}
348
349@item Optimization Options
350@xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
351@gccoptlist{-falign-functions[=@var{n}] -falign-jumps[=@var{n}] @gol
352-falign-labels[=@var{n}] -falign-loops[=@var{n}] -fassociative-math @gol
353-fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-probabilities -fbranch-target-load-optimize @gol
354-fbranch-target-load-optimize2 -fbtr-bb-exclusive -fcaller-saves @gol
355-fcheck-data-deps -fcombine-stack-adjustments -fconserve-stack @gol
356-fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fcrossjumping @gol
357-fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fcx-fortran-rules @gol
358-fcx-limited-range @gol
359-fdata-sections -fdce -fdelayed-branch @gol
360-fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize -fdse @gol
361-fearly-inlining -fipa-sra -fexpensive-optimizations -ffat-lto-objects @gol
362-ffast-math -ffinite-math-only -ffloat-store -fexcess-precision=@var{style} @gol
363-fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=@var{style} -ffunction-sections @gol
364-fgcse -fgcse-after-reload -fgcse-las -fgcse-lm -fgraphite-identity @gol
365-fgcse-sm -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 -findirect-inlining @gol
366-finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once -finline-limit=@var{n} @gol
367-finline-small-functions -fipa-cp -fipa-cp-clone -fipa-matrix-reorg @gol
368-fipa-pta -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const -fipa-reference @gol
369-fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm} @gol
370-fira-region=@var{region} @gol
371-fira-loop-pressure -fno-ira-share-save-slots @gol
372-fno-ira-share-spill-slots -fira-verbose=@var{n} @gol
373-fivopts -fkeep-inline-functions -fkeep-static-consts @gol
374-floop-block -floop-flatten -floop-interchange -floop-strip-mine @gol
375-floop-parallelize-all -flto -flto-compression-level @gol
376-flto-partition=@var{alg} -flto-report -fmerge-all-constants @gol
377-fmerge-constants -fmodulo-sched -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves @gol
378-fmove-loop-invariants fmudflap -fmudflapir -fmudflapth -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
379-fno-default-inline @gol
380-fno-defer-pop -fno-function-cse -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
381-fno-inline -fno-math-errno -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 @gol
382-fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fno-signed-zeros @gol
383-fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
384-fomit-frame-pointer -foptimize-register-move -foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
385-fpartial-inlining -fpeel-loops -fpredictive-commoning @gol
386-fprefetch-loop-arrays @gol
387-fprofile-correction -fprofile-dir=@var{path} -fprofile-generate @gol
388-fprofile-generate=@var{path} @gol
389-fprofile-use -fprofile-use=@var{path} -fprofile-values @gol
390-freciprocal-math -free -fregmove -frename-registers -freorder-blocks @gol
391-freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions @gol
392-frerun-cse-after-loop -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops @gol
393-frounding-math -fsched2-use-superblocks -fsched-pressure @gol
394-fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
395-fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=@var{n}] -fsched-stalled-insns[=@var{n}] @gol
396-fsched-group-heuristic -fsched-critical-path-heuristic @gol
397-fsched-spec-insn-heuristic -fsched-rank-heuristic @gol
398-fsched-last-insn-heuristic -fsched-dep-count-heuristic @gol
399-fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 -fsection-anchors @gol
400-fselective-scheduling -fselective-scheduling2 @gol
401-fsel-sched-pipelining -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops @gol
402-fshrink-wrap -fsignaling-nans -fsingle-precision-constant @gol
403-fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -fsplit-wide-types -fstack-protector @gol
404-fstack-protector-all -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
405-fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp @gol
406-ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch -ftree-copy-prop @gol
407-ftree-copyrename -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse @gol
408-ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre -ftree-loop-if-convert @gol
409-ftree-loop-if-convert-stores -ftree-loop-im @gol
410-ftree-phiprop -ftree-loop-distribution -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns @gol
411-ftree-loop-ivcanon -ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-optimize @gol
412-ftree-parallelize-loops=@var{n} -ftree-pre -ftree-pta -ftree-reassoc @gol
413-ftree-sink -ftree-sra -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
414-ftree-ter -ftree-vect-loop-version -ftree-vectorize -ftree-vrp @gol
415-funit-at-a-time -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops @gol
416-funsafe-loop-optimizations -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops @gol
417-fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb @gol
418-fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-linker-plugin @gol
419--param @var{name}=@var{value}
420-O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os -Ofast}
421
422@item Preprocessor Options
423@xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
424@gccoptlist{-A@var{question}=@var{answer} @gol
425-A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
426-C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN @gol
427-D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]}  -E  -H @gol
428-idirafter @var{dir} @gol
429-include @var{file}  -imacros @var{file} @gol
430-iprefix @var{file}  -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
431-iwithprefixbefore @var{dir}  -isystem @var{dir} @gol
432-imultilib @var{dir} -isysroot @var{dir} @gol
433-M  -MM  -MF  -MG  -MP  -MQ  -MT  -nostdinc  @gol
434-P  -fdebug-cpp -ftrack-macro-expansion -fworking-directory @gol
435-remap -trigraphs  -undef  -U@var{macro}  @gol
436-Wp,@var{option} -Xpreprocessor @var{option}}
437
438@item Assembler Option
439@xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
440@gccoptlist{-Wa,@var{option}  -Xassembler @var{option}}
441
442@item Linker Options
443@xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
444@gccoptlist{@var{object-file-name}  -l@var{library} @gol
445-nostartfiles  -nodefaultlibs  -nostdlib -pie -rdynamic @gol
446-s  -static  -static-libgcc  -static-libstdc++ -shared  @gol
447-shared-libgcc  -symbolic @gol
448-T @var{script}  -Wl,@var{option}  -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
449-u @var{symbol}}
450
451@item Directory Options
452@xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
453@gccoptlist{-B@var{prefix} -I@var{dir} -iplugindir=@var{dir} @gol
454-iquote@var{dir} -L@var{dir} -specs=@var{file} -I- @gol
455--sysroot=@var{dir}}
456
457@item Machine Dependent Options
458@xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
459@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
460@c Try and put the significant identifier (CPU or system) first,
461@c so users have a clue at guessing where the ones they want will be.
462
463@emph{Adapteva Epiphany Options}
464@gccoptlist{-mhalf-reg-file -mprefer-short-insn-regs @gol
465-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcmove -mnops=@var{num} -msoft-cmpsf @gol
466-msplit-lohi -mpost-inc -mpost-modify -mstack-offset=@var{num} @gol
467-mround-nearest -mlong-calls -mshort-calls -msmall16 @gol
468-mfp-mode=@var{mode} -mvect-double -max-vect-align=@var{num} @gol
469-msplit-vecmove-early -m1reg-@var{reg}}
470
471@emph{ARM Options}
472@gccoptlist{-mapcs-frame  -mno-apcs-frame @gol
473-mabi=@var{name} @gol
474-mapcs-stack-check  -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
475-mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float @gol
476-mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
477-msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog @gol
478-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -mwords-little-endian @gol
479-mfloat-abi=@var{name}  -mfpe @gol
480-mfp16-format=@var{name}
481-mthumb-interwork  -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
482-mcpu=@var{name}  -march=@var{name}  -mfpu=@var{name}  @gol
483-mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
484-mabort-on-noreturn @gol
485-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
486-msingle-pic-base  -mno-single-pic-base @gol
487-mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
488-mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
489-mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns @gol
490-mpoke-function-name @gol
491-mthumb  -marm @gol
492-mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
493-mcaller-super-interworking  -mcallee-super-interworking @gol
494-mtp=@var{name} -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect} @gol
495-mword-relocations @gol
496-mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd @gol
497-munaligned-access}
498
499@emph{AVR Options}
500@gccoptlist{-mmcu=@var{mcu} -maccumulate-args -mbranch-cost=@var{cost} @gol
501-mcall-prologues -mint8 -mno-interrupts -mrelax -mshort-calls @gol
502-mstrict-X -mtiny-stack}
503
504@emph{Blackfin Options}
505@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]} @gol
506-msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
507-mspecld-anomaly  -mno-specld-anomaly  -mcsync-anomaly  -mno-csync-anomaly @gol
508-mlow-64k -mno-low64k  -mstack-check-l1  -mid-shared-library @gol
509-mno-id-shared-library  -mshared-library-id=@var{n} @gol
510-mleaf-id-shared-library  -mno-leaf-id-shared-library @gol
511-msep-data  -mno-sep-data  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
512-mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore  -mcorea  -mcoreb  -msdram @gol
513-micplb}
514
515@emph{C6X Options}
516@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian -march=@var{cpu} @gol
517-msim -msdata=@var{sdata-type}}
518
519@emph{CRIS Options}
520@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}  -march=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
521-mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}  -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
522-metrax4  -metrax100  -mpdebug  -mcc-init  -mno-side-effects @gol
523-mstack-align  -mdata-align  -mconst-align @gol
524-m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt @gol
525-melf  -maout  -melinux  -mlinux  -sim  -sim2 @gol
526-mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround}
527
528@emph{CR16 Options}
529@gccoptlist{-mmac @gol
530-mcr16cplus -mcr16c @gol
531-msim -mint32 -mbit-ops
532-mdata-model=@var{model}}
533
534@emph{Darwin Options}
535@gccoptlist{-all_load  -allowable_client  -arch  -arch_errors_fatal @gol
536-arch_only  -bind_at_load  -bundle  -bundle_loader @gol
537-client_name  -compatibility_version  -current_version @gol
538-dead_strip @gol
539-dependency-file  -dylib_file  -dylinker_install_name @gol
540-dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list @gol
541-filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
542-force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
543-iframework @gol
544-image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs @gol
545-multi_module  -multiply_defined  -multiply_defined_unused @gol
546-noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms @gol
547-nofixprebinding -nomultidefs  -noprebind  -noseglinkedit @gol
548-pagezero_size  -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
549-private_bundle  -read_only_relocs  -sectalign @gol
550-sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr @gol
551-sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols  -sectorder @gol
552-segaddr -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
553-seg_addr_table  -seg_addr_table_filename  -seglinkedit @gol
554-segprot  -segs_read_only_addr  -segs_read_write_addr @gol
555-single_module  -static  -sub_library  -sub_umbrella @gol
556-twolevel_namespace  -umbrella  -undefined @gol
557-unexported_symbols_list  -weak_reference_mismatches @gol
558-whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version} @gol
559-mkernel -mone-byte-bool}
560
561@emph{DEC Alpha Options}
562@gccoptlist{-mno-fp-regs  -msoft-float  -malpha-as  -mgas @gol
563-mieee  -mieee-with-inexact  -mieee-conformant @gol
564-mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode}  -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
565-mtrap-precision=@var{mode}  -mbuild-constants @gol
566-mcpu=@var{cpu-type}  -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
567-mbwx  -mmax  -mfix  -mcix @gol
568-mfloat-vax  -mfloat-ieee @gol
569-mexplicit-relocs  -msmall-data  -mlarge-data @gol
570-msmall-text  -mlarge-text @gol
571-mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
572
573@emph{DEC Alpha/VMS Options}
574@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
575
576@emph{FR30 Options}
577@gccoptlist{-msmall-model -mno-lsim}
578
579@emph{FRV Options}
580@gccoptlist{-mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 @gol
581-mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
582-malloc-cc  -mfixed-cc  -mdword  -mno-dword @gol
583-mdouble  -mno-double @gol
584-mmedia  -mno-media  -mmuladd  -mno-muladd @gol
585-mfdpic  -minline-plt -mgprel-ro  -multilib-library-pic @gol
586-mlinked-fp  -mlong-calls  -malign-labels @gol
587-mlibrary-pic  -macc-4  -macc-8 @gol
588-mpack  -mno-pack  -mno-eflags  -mcond-move  -mno-cond-move @gol
589-moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar @gol
590-mscc  -mno-scc  -mcond-exec  -mno-cond-exec @gol
591-mvliw-branch  -mno-vliw-branch @gol
592-mmulti-cond-exec  -mno-multi-cond-exec  -mnested-cond-exec @gol
593-mno-nested-cond-exec  -mtomcat-stats @gol
594-mTLS -mtls @gol
595-mcpu=@var{cpu}}
596
597@emph{GNU/Linux Options}
598@gccoptlist{-mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid @gol
599-tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld}
600
601@emph{H8/300 Options}
602@gccoptlist{-mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mint32  -malign-300}
603
604@emph{HPPA Options}
605@gccoptlist{-march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
606-mbig-switch  -mdisable-fpregs  -mdisable-indexing @gol
607-mfast-indirect-calls  -mgas  -mgnu-ld   -mhp-ld @gol
608-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
609-mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
610-mlong-load-store  -mno-big-switch  -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
611-mno-disable-indexing  -mno-fast-indirect-calls  -mno-gas @gol
612-mno-jump-in-delay  -mno-long-load-store @gol
613-mno-portable-runtime  -mno-soft-float @gol
614-mno-space-regs  -msoft-float  -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
615-mpa-risc-1-1  -mpa-risc-2-0  -mportable-runtime @gol
616-mschedule=@var{cpu-type}  -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio @gol
617-munix=@var{unix-std}  -nolibdld  -static  -threads}
618
619@emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
620@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
621-mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
622-masm=@var{dialect}  -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
623-mno-fp-ret-in-387  -msoft-float @gol
624-mno-wide-multiply  -mrtd  -malign-double @gol
625-mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
626-mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
627-mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe -mcrc32 @gol
628-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} @gol
629-mvzeroupper @gol
630-mmmx  -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx @gol
631-mavx2 -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfma @gol
632-msse4a -m3dnow -mpopcnt -mabm -mbmi -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop -mlzcnt @gol
633-mbmi2 -mlwp -mthreads  -mno-align-stringops  -minline-all-stringops @gol
634-minline-stringops-dynamically -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg} @gol
635-mpush-args  -maccumulate-outgoing-args  -m128bit-long-double @gol
636-m96bit-long-double  -mregparm=@var{num}  -msseregparm @gol
637-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mvect8-ret-in-mem @gol
638-mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign @gol
639-momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs @gol
640-mcmodel=@var{code-model} -mabi=@var{name} @gol
641-m32 -m64 -mx32 -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{num} @gol
642-msse2avx -mfentry -m8bit-idiv @gol
643-mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store}
644
645@emph{i386 and x86-64 Windows Options}
646@gccoptlist{-mconsole -mcygwin -mno-cygwin -mdll @gol
647-mnop-fun-dllimport -mthread @gol
648-municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable}
649
650@emph{IA-64 Options}
651@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mgnu-as  -mgnu-ld  -mno-pic @gol
652-mvolatile-asm-stop  -mregister-names  -msdata -mno-sdata @gol
653-mconstant-gp  -mauto-pic  -mfused-madd @gol
654-minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
655-minline-float-divide-max-throughput @gol
656-mno-inline-float-divide @gol
657-minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
658-minline-int-divide-max-throughput  @gol
659-mno-inline-int-divide @gol
660-minline-sqrt-min-latency -minline-sqrt-max-throughput @gol
661-mno-inline-sqrt @gol
662-mdwarf2-asm -mearly-stop-bits @gol
663-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} -mtls-size=@var{tls-size} @gol
664-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -milp32 -mlp64 @gol
665-msched-br-data-spec -msched-ar-data-spec -msched-control-spec @gol
666-msched-br-in-data-spec -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec @gol
667-msched-spec-ldc -msched-spec-control-ldc @gol
668-msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns @gol
669-msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path @gol
670-msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost @gol
671-msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}}
672
673@emph{IA-64/VMS Options}
674@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
675
676@emph{LM32 Options}
677@gccoptlist{-mbarrel-shift-enabled -mdivide-enabled -mmultiply-enabled @gol
678-msign-extend-enabled -muser-enabled}
679
680@emph{M32R/D Options}
681@gccoptlist{-m32r2 -m32rx -m32r @gol
682-mdebug @gol
683-malign-loops -mno-align-loops @gol
684-missue-rate=@var{number} @gol
685-mbranch-cost=@var{number} @gol
686-mmodel=@var{code-size-model-type} @gol
687-msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
688-mno-flush-func -mflush-func=@var{name} @gol
689-mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=@var{number} @gol
690-G @var{num}}
691
692@emph{M32C Options}
693@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -msim -memregs=@var{number}}
694
695@emph{M680x0 Options}
696@gccoptlist{-march=@var{arch}  -mcpu=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{tune}
697-m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60  -m68030  -m68040 @gol
698-m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -m5206e  -m528x  -m5307  -m5407 @gol
699-mcfv4e  -mbitfield  -mno-bitfield  -mc68000  -mc68020 @gol
700-mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mno-rtd  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mshort @gol
701-mno-short  -mhard-float  -m68881  -msoft-float  -mpcrel @gol
702-malign-int  -mstrict-align  -msep-data  -mno-sep-data @gol
703-mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library @gol
704-mxgot -mno-xgot}
705
706@emph{MCore Options}
707@gccoptlist{-mhardlit  -mno-hardlit  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mrelax-immediates @gol
708-mno-relax-immediates  -mwide-bitfields  -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
709-m4byte-functions  -mno-4byte-functions  -mcallgraph-data @gol
710-mno-callgraph-data  -mslow-bytes  -mno-slow-bytes  -mno-lsim @gol
711-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -m210  -m340  -mstack-increment}
712
713@emph{MeP Options}
714@gccoptlist{-mabsdiff -mall-opts -maverage -mbased=@var{n} -mbitops @gol
715-mc=@var{n} -mclip -mconfig=@var{name} -mcop -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 @gol
716-mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax @gol
717-mmult -mno-opts -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf @gol
718-mtiny=@var{n}}
719
720@emph{MicroBlaze Options}
721@gccoptlist{-msoft-float -mhard-float -msmall-divides -mcpu=@var{cpu} @gol
722-mmemcpy -mxl-soft-mul -mxl-soft-div -mxl-barrel-shift @gol
723-mxl-pattern-compare -mxl-stack-check -mxl-gp-opt -mno-clearbss @gol
724-mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt @gol
725-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}
726
727@emph{MIPS Options}
728@gccoptlist{-EL  -EB  -march=@var{arch}  -mtune=@var{arch} @gol
729-mips1  -mips2  -mips3  -mips4  -mips32  -mips32r2 @gol
730-mips64  -mips64r2 @gol
731-mips16  -mno-mips16  -mflip-mips16 @gol
732-minterlink-mips16  -mno-interlink-mips16 @gol
733-mabi=@var{abi}  -mabicalls  -mno-abicalls @gol
734-mshared  -mno-shared  -mplt  -mno-plt  -mxgot  -mno-xgot @gol
735-mgp32  -mgp64  -mfp32  -mfp64  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
736-msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -mdsp  -mno-dsp  -mdspr2  -mno-dspr2 @gol
737-mfpu=@var{fpu-type} @gol
738-msmartmips  -mno-smartmips @gol
739-mpaired-single  -mno-paired-single  -mdmx  -mno-mdmx @gol
740-mips3d  -mno-mips3d  -mmt  -mno-mt  -mllsc  -mno-llsc @gol
741-mlong64  -mlong32  -msym32  -mno-sym32 @gol
742-G@var{num}  -mlocal-sdata  -mno-local-sdata @gol
743-mextern-sdata  -mno-extern-sdata  -mgpopt  -mno-gopt @gol
744-membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data @gol
745-muninit-const-in-rodata  -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
746-mcode-readable=@var{setting} @gol
747-msplit-addresses  -mno-split-addresses @gol
748-mexplicit-relocs  -mno-explicit-relocs @gol
749-mcheck-zero-division  -mno-check-zero-division @gol
750-mdivide-traps  -mdivide-breaks @gol
751-mmemcpy  -mno-memcpy  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
752-mmad  -mno-mad  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -nocpp @gol
753-mfix-24k -mno-fix-24k @gol
754-mfix-r4000  -mno-fix-r4000  -mfix-r4400  -mno-fix-r4400 @gol
755-mfix-r10000 -mno-fix-r10000  -mfix-vr4120  -mno-fix-vr4120 @gol
756-mfix-vr4130  -mno-fix-vr4130  -mfix-sb1  -mno-fix-sb1 @gol
757-mflush-func=@var{func}  -mno-flush-func @gol
758-mbranch-cost=@var{num}  -mbranch-likely  -mno-branch-likely @gol
759-mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions @gol
760-mvr4130-align -mno-vr4130-align -msynci -mno-synci @gol
761-mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address}
762
763@emph{MMIX Options}
764@gccoptlist{-mlibfuncs  -mno-libfuncs  -mepsilon  -mno-epsilon  -mabi=gnu @gol
765-mabi=mmixware  -mzero-extend  -mknuthdiv  -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
766-melf  -mbranch-predict  -mno-branch-predict  -mbase-addresses @gol
767-mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit}
768
769@emph{MN10300 Options}
770@gccoptlist{-mmult-bug  -mno-mult-bug @gol
771-mno-am33 -mam33 -mam33-2 -mam34 @gol
772-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
773-mreturn-pointer-on-d0 @gol
774-mno-crt0  -mrelax -mliw -msetlb}
775
776@emph{PDP-11 Options}
777@gccoptlist{-mfpu  -msoft-float  -mac0  -mno-ac0  -m40  -m45  -m10 @gol
778-mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin  -mint32  -mno-int16 @gol
779-mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32  -mno-float64 @gol
780-mfloat64  -mno-float32  -mabshi  -mno-abshi @gol
781-mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap @gol
782-munix-asm  -mdec-asm}
783
784@emph{picoChip Options}
785@gccoptlist{-mae=@var{ae_type} -mvliw-lookahead=@var{N} @gol
786-msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings}
787
788@emph{PowerPC Options}
789See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
790
791@emph{RL78 Options}
792@gccoptlist{-msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=rl78}
793
794@emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
795@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
796-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
797-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
798-mpower  -mno-power  -mpower2  -mno-power2 @gol
799-mpowerpc  -mpowerpc64  -mno-powerpc @gol
800-maltivec  -mno-altivec @gol
801-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
802-mpowerpc-gfxopt  -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
803-mmfcrf  -mno-mfcrf  -mpopcntb  -mno-popcntb -mpopcntd -mno-popcntd @gol
804-mfprnd  -mno-fprnd @gol
805-mcmpb -mno-cmpb -mmfpgpr -mno-mfpgpr -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
806-mnew-mnemonics  -mold-mnemonics @gol
807-mfull-toc   -mminimal-toc  -mno-fp-in-toc  -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
808-m64  -m32  -mxl-compat  -mno-xl-compat  -mpe @gol
809-malign-power  -malign-natural @gol
810-msoft-float  -mhard-float  -mmultiple  -mno-multiple @gol
811-msingle-float -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu @gol
812-mstring  -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update @gol
813-mavoid-indexed-addresses  -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses @gol
814-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -mbit-align  -mno-bit-align @gol
815-mstrict-align  -mno-strict-align  -mrelocatable @gol
816-mno-relocatable  -mrelocatable-lib  -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
817-mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle  -mlittle-endian  -mbig  -mbig-endian @gol
818-mdynamic-no-pic  -maltivec -mswdiv  -msingle-pic-base @gol
819-mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority} @gol
820-msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type} @gol
821-minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme} @gol
822-mcall-sysv  -mcall-netbsd @gol
823-maix-struct-return  -msvr4-struct-return @gol
824-mabi=@var{abi-type} -msecure-plt -mbss-plt @gol
825-mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num} @gol
826-misel -mno-isel @gol
827-misel=yes  -misel=no @gol
828-mspe -mno-spe @gol
829-mspe=yes  -mspe=no @gol
830-mpaired @gol
831-mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode @gol
832-mvrsave -mno-vrsave @gol
833-mmulhw -mno-mulhw @gol
834-mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb @gol
835-mfloat-gprs=yes  -mfloat-gprs=no -mfloat-gprs=single -mfloat-gprs=double @gol
836-mprototype  -mno-prototype @gol
837-msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife  -memb  -msdata @gol
838-msdata=@var{opt}  -mvxworks  -G @var{num}  -pthread @gol
839-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} -mno-recip -mrecip-precision @gol
840-mno-recip-precision @gol
841-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mfriz -mno-friz @gol
842-mpointers-to-nested-functions -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions @gol
843-msave-toc-indirect -mno-save-toc-indirect}
844
845@emph{RX Options}
846@gccoptlist{-m64bit-doubles  -m32bit-doubles  -fpu  -nofpu@gol
847-mcpu=@gol
848-mbig-endian-data -mlittle-endian-data @gol
849-msmall-data @gol
850-msim  -mno-sim@gol
851-mas100-syntax -mno-as100-syntax@gol
852-mrelax@gol
853-mmax-constant-size=@gol
854-mint-register=@gol
855-mpid@gol
856-msave-acc-in-interrupts}
857
858@emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
859@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
860-mhard-float  -msoft-float  -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
861-mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 @gol
862-mbackchain  -mno-backchain -mpacked-stack  -mno-packed-stack @gol
863-msmall-exec  -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
864-m64  -m31  -mdebug  -mno-debug  -mesa  -mzarch @gol
865-mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
866-mwarn-framesize  -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard}
867
868@emph{Score Options}
869@gccoptlist{-meb -mel @gol
870-mnhwloop @gol
871-muls @gol
872-mmac @gol
873-mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d}
874
875@emph{SH Options}
876@gccoptlist{-m1  -m2  -m2e @gol
877-m2a-nofpu -m2a-single-only -m2a-single -m2a @gol
878-m3  -m3e @gol
879-m4-nofpu  -m4-single-only  -m4-single  -m4 @gol
880-m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al @gol
881-m5-64media  -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
882-m5-32media  -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
883-m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
884-mb  -ml  -mdalign  -mrelax @gol
885-mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave @gol
886-mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops  -misize  -minline-ic_invalidate -mpadstruct @gol
887-mspace -mprefergot  -musermode -multcost=@var{number} -mdiv=@var{strategy} @gol
888-mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name} -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
889-madjust-unroll -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=@var{number} -mpt-fixed @gol
890-maccumulate-outgoing-args -minvalid-symbols -msoft-atomic @gol
891-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcbranchdi -mcmpeqdi -mfused-madd -mpretend-cmove}
892
893@emph{Solaris 2 Options}
894@gccoptlist{-mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text @gol
895-pthreads -pthread}
896
897@emph{SPARC Options}
898@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
899-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
900-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
901-mmemory-model=@var{mem-model} @gol
902-m32  -m64  -mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
903-mfaster-structs  -mno-faster-structs  -mflat  -mno-flat @gol
904-mfpu  -mno-fpu  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
905-mhard-quad-float  -msoft-quad-float @gol
906-mlittle-endian @gol
907-mstack-bias  -mno-stack-bias @gol
908-munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
909-mv8plus  -mno-v8plus  -mvis  -mno-vis @gol
910-mvis2  -mno-vis2  -mvis3  -mno-vis3 @gol
911-mfmaf  -mno-fmaf  -mpopc  -mno-popc @gol
912-mfix-at697f}
913
914@emph{SPU Options}
915@gccoptlist{-mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc @gol
916-msafe-dma -munsafe-dma @gol
917-mbranch-hints @gol
918-msmall-mem -mlarge-mem -mstdmain @gol
919-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
920-mea32 -mea64 @gol
921-maddress-space-conversion -mno-address-space-conversion @gol
922-mcache-size=@var{cache-size} @gol
923-matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates}
924
925@emph{System V Options}
926@gccoptlist{-Qy  -Qn  -YP,@var{paths}  -Ym,@var{dir}}
927
928@emph{TILE-Gx Options}
929@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32 -m64}
930
931@emph{TILEPro Options}
932@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32}
933
934@emph{V850 Options}
935@gccoptlist{-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls  -mep  -mno-ep @gol
936-mprolog-function  -mno-prolog-function  -mspace @gol
937-mtda=@var{n}  -msda=@var{n}  -mzda=@var{n} @gol
938-mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
939-mdisable-callt  -mno-disable-callt @gol
940-mv850e2v3 @gol
941-mv850e2 @gol
942-mv850e1 -mv850es @gol
943-mv850e @gol
944-mv850  -mbig-switch}
945
946@emph{VAX Options}
947@gccoptlist{-mg  -mgnu  -munix}
948
949@emph{VxWorks Options}
950@gccoptlist{-mrtp  -non-static  -Bstatic  -Bdynamic @gol
951-Xbind-lazy  -Xbind-now}
952
953@emph{x86-64 Options}
954See i386 and x86-64 Options.
955
956@emph{Xstormy16 Options}
957@gccoptlist{-msim}
958
959@emph{Xtensa Options}
960@gccoptlist{-mconst16 -mno-const16 @gol
961-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
962-mforce-no-pic @gol
963-mserialize-volatile  -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
964-mtext-section-literals  -mno-text-section-literals @gol
965-mtarget-align  -mno-target-align @gol
966-mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls}
967
968@emph{zSeries Options}
969See S/390 and zSeries Options.
970
971@item Code Generation Options
972@xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
973@gccoptlist{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}  -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
974-ffixed-@var{reg}  -fexceptions @gol
975-fnon-call-exceptions  -funwind-tables @gol
976-fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
977-finhibit-size-directive  -finstrument-functions @gol
978-finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{} @gol
979-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{} @gol
980-fno-common  -fno-ident @gol
981-fpcc-struct-return  -fpic  -fPIC -fpie -fPIE @gol
982-fno-jump-tables @gol
983-frecord-gcc-switches @gol
984-freg-struct-return  -fshort-enums @gol
985-fshort-double  -fshort-wchar @gol
986-fverbose-asm  -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]  -fstack-check @gol
987-fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}  -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
988-fno-stack-limit -fsplit-stack @gol
989-fleading-underscore  -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
990-ftrapv  -fwrapv  -fbounds-check @gol
991-fvisibility -fstrict-volatile-bitfields}
992@end table
993
994@menu
995* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
996                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
997                        or preprocessed source.
998* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
999* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
1000* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
1001                        and Objective-C++.
1002* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
1003                        formatted.
1004* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
1005* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
1006* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
1007* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
1008                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
1009* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
1010* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
1011* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
1012                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
1013* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
1014* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
1015@end menu
1016
1017@node Overall Options
1018@section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
1019
1020Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
1021proper, assembly and linking, always in that order.  GCC is capable of
1022preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
1023assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then each
1024assembler input file produces an object file, and linking combines all
1025the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input)
1026into an executable file.
1027
1028@cindex file name suffix
1029For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
1030compilation is done:
1031
1032@table @gcctabopt
1033@item @var{file}.c
1034C source code that must be preprocessed.
1035
1036@item @var{file}.i
1037C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1038
1039@item @var{file}.ii
1040C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1041
1042@item @var{file}.m
1043Objective-C source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1044library to make an Objective-C program work.
1045
1046@item @var{file}.mi
1047Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1048
1049@item @var{file}.mm
1050@itemx @var{file}.M
1051Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1052library to make an Objective-C++ program work.  Note that @samp{.M} refers
1053to a literal capital M@.
1054
1055@item @var{file}.mii
1056Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1057
1058@item @var{file}.h
1059C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a
1060precompiled header (default), or C, C++ header file to be turned into an
1061Ada spec (via the @option{-fdump-ada-spec} switch).
1062
1063@item @var{file}.cc
1064@itemx @var{file}.cp
1065@itemx @var{file}.cxx
1066@itemx @var{file}.cpp
1067@itemx @var{file}.CPP
1068@itemx @var{file}.c++
1069@itemx @var{file}.C
1070C++ source code that must be preprocessed.  Note that in @samp{.cxx},
1071the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}.  Likewise,
1072@samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
1073
1074@item @var{file}.mm
1075@itemx @var{file}.M
1076Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.
1077
1078@item @var{file}.mii
1079Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1080
1081@item @var{file}.hh
1082@itemx @var{file}.H
1083@itemx @var{file}.hp
1084@itemx @var{file}.hxx
1085@itemx @var{file}.hpp
1086@itemx @var{file}.HPP
1087@itemx @var{file}.h++
1088@itemx @var{file}.tcc
1089C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.
1090
1091@item @var{file}.f
1092@itemx @var{file}.for
1093@itemx @var{file}.ftn
1094Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1095
1096@item @var{file}.F
1097@itemx @var{file}.FOR
1098@itemx @var{file}.fpp
1099@itemx @var{file}.FPP
1100@itemx @var{file}.FTN
1101Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional
1102preprocessor).
1103
1104@item @var{file}.f90
1105@itemx @var{file}.f95
1106@itemx @var{file}.f03
1107@itemx @var{file}.f08
1108Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1109
1110@item @var{file}.F90
1111@itemx @var{file}.F95
1112@itemx @var{file}.F03
1113@itemx @var{file}.F08
1114Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
1115traditional preprocessor).
1116
1117@item @var{file}.go
1118Go source code.
1119
1120@c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
1121@c @var{file}.java
1122@c @var{file}.class
1123@c @var{file}.zip
1124@c @var{file}.jar
1125
1126@item @var{file}.ads
1127Ada source code file that contains a library unit declaration (a
1128declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
1129instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
1130generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also
1131called @dfn{specs}.
1132
1133@item @var{file}.adb
1134Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
1135package body).  Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
1136
1137@c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
1138@c Pascal:
1139@c @var{file}.p
1140@c @var{file}.pas
1141@c Ratfor:
1142@c @var{file}.r
1143
1144@item @var{file}.s
1145Assembler code.
1146
1147@item @var{file}.S
1148@itemx @var{file}.sx
1149Assembler code that must be preprocessed.
1150
1151@item @var{other}
1152An object file to be fed straight into linking.
1153Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
1154@end table
1155
1156@opindex x
1157You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
1158
1159@table @gcctabopt
1160@item -x @var{language}
1161Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
1162(rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
1163name suffix).  This option applies to all following input files until
1164the next @option{-x} option.  Possible values for @var{language} are:
1165@smallexample
1166c  c-header  cpp-output
1167c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
1168objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
1169objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
1170assembler  assembler-with-cpp
1171ada
1172f77  f77-cpp-input f95  f95-cpp-input
1173go
1174java
1175@end smallexample
1176
1177@item -x none
1178Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
1179handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
1180has not been used at all).
1181
1182@item -pass-exit-codes
1183@opindex pass-exit-codes
1184Normally the @command{gcc} program will exit with the code of 1 if any
1185phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code.  If you specify
1186@option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program will instead return with
1187numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error
1188indication.  The C, C++, and Fortran frontends return 4, if an internal
1189compiler error is encountered.
1190@end table
1191
1192If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
1193@option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
1194one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
1195@command{gcc} is to stop.  Note that some combinations (for example,
1196@samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
1197
1198@table @gcctabopt
1199@item -c
1200@opindex c
1201Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link.  The linking
1202stage simply is not done.  The ultimate output is in the form of an
1203object file for each source file.
1204
1205By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
1206the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
1207
1208Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
1209ignored.
1210
1211@item -S
1212@opindex S
1213Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble.  The output
1214is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
1215file specified.
1216
1217By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
1218replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
1219
1220Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1221
1222@item -E
1223@opindex E
1224Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The
1225output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
1226standard output.
1227
1228Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1229
1230@cindex output file option
1231@item -o @var{file}
1232@opindex o
1233Place output in file @var{file}.  This applies regardless to whatever
1234sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
1235an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1236
1237If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable
1238file in @file{a.out}, the object file for
1239@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in @file{@var{source}.o}, its
1240assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, a precompiled header file in
1241@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}.gch}, and all preprocessed C source on
1242standard output.
1243
1244@item -v
1245@opindex v
1246Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
1247of compilation.  Also print the version number of the compiler driver
1248program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
1249
1250@item -###
1251@opindex ###
1252Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and arguments
1253are quoted unless they contain only alphanumeric characters or @code{./-_}.
1254This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated command lines.
1255
1256@item -pipe
1257@opindex pipe
1258Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1259various stages of compilation.  This fails to work on some systems where
1260the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
1261no trouble.
1262
1263@item --help
1264@opindex help
1265Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line options
1266understood by @command{gcc}.  If the @option{-v} option is also specified
1267then @option{--help} will also be passed on to the various processes
1268invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command-line options
1269they accept.  If the @option{-Wextra} option has also been specified
1270(prior to the @option{--help} option), then command-line options that
1271have no documentation associated with them will also be displayed.
1272
1273@item --target-help
1274@opindex target-help
1275Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command-line
1276options for each tool.  For some targets extra target-specific
1277information may also be printed.
1278
1279@item --help=@{@var{class}@r{|[}^@r{]}@var{qualifier}@}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]}
1280Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1281options understood by the compiler that fit into all specified classes
1282and qualifiers.  These are the supported classes:
1283
1284@table @asis
1285@item @samp{optimizers}
1286This will display all of the optimization options supported by the
1287compiler.
1288
1289@item @samp{warnings}
1290This will display all of the options controlling warning messages
1291produced by the compiler.
1292
1293@item @samp{target}
1294This will display target-specific options.  Unlike the
1295@option{--target-help} option however, target-specific options of the
1296linker and assembler will not be displayed.  This is because those
1297tools do not currently support the extended @option{--help=} syntax.
1298
1299@item @samp{params}
1300This will display the values recognized by the @option{--param}
1301option.
1302
1303@item @var{language}
1304This will display the options supported for @var{language}, where
1305@var{language} is the name of one of the languages supported in this
1306version of GCC.
1307
1308@item @samp{common}
1309This will display the options that are common to all languages.
1310@end table
1311
1312These are the supported qualifiers:
1313
1314@table @asis
1315@item @samp{undocumented}
1316Display only those options that are undocumented.
1317
1318@item @samp{joined}
1319Display options taking an argument that appears after an equal
1320sign in the same continuous piece of text, such as:
1321@samp{--help=target}.
1322
1323@item @samp{separate}
1324Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate word
1325following the original option, such as: @samp{-o output-file}.
1326@end table
1327
1328Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific
1329switches supported by the compiler the following can be used:
1330
1331@smallexample
1332--help=target,undocumented
1333@end smallexample
1334
1335The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the
1336@samp{^} character, so for example to display all binary warning
1337options (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
1338argument) that have a description, use:
1339
1340@smallexample
1341--help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented
1342@end smallexample
1343
1344The argument to @option{--help=} should not consist solely of inverted
1345qualifiers.
1346
1347Combining several classes is possible, although this usually
1348restricts the output by so much that there is nothing to display.  One
1349case where it does work however is when one of the classes is
1350@var{target}.  So for example to display all the target-specific
1351optimization options the following can be used:
1352
1353@smallexample
1354--help=target,optimizers
1355@end smallexample
1356
1357The @option{--help=} option can be repeated on the command line.  Each
1358successive use will display its requested class of options, skipping
1359those that have already been displayed.
1360
1361If the @option{-Q} option appears on the command line before the
1362@option{--help=} option, then the descriptive text displayed by
1363@option{--help=} is changed.  Instead of describing the displayed
1364options, an indication is given as to whether the option is enabled,
1365disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
1366knows this at the point where the @option{--help=} option is used).
1367
1368Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of @command{gcc}:
1369
1370@smallexample
1371  % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
1372  The following options are target specific:
1373  -mabi=                                2
1374  -mabort-on-noreturn                   [disabled]
1375  -mapcs                                [disabled]
1376@end smallexample
1377
1378The output is sensitive to the effects of previous command-line
1379options, so for example it is possible to find out which optimizations
1380are enabled at @option{-O2} by using:
1381
1382@smallexample
1383-Q -O2 --help=optimizers
1384@end smallexample
1385
1386Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled
1387by @option{-O3} by using:
1388
1389@smallexample
1390gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
1391gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
1392diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled
1393@end smallexample
1394
1395@item -no-canonical-prefixes
1396@opindex no-canonical-prefixes
1397Do not expand any symbolic links, resolve references to @samp{/../}
1398or @samp{/./}, or make the path absolute when generating a relative
1399prefix.
1400
1401@item --version
1402@opindex version
1403Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC@.
1404
1405@item -wrapper
1406@opindex wrapper
1407Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program.  The name of the
1408wrapper program and its parameters are passed as a comma separated
1409list.
1410
1411@smallexample
1412gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args
1413@end smallexample
1414
1415This will invoke all subprograms of @command{gcc} under
1416@samp{gdb --args}, thus the invocation of @command{cc1} will be
1417@samp{gdb --args cc1 @dots{}}.
1418
1419@item -fplugin=@var{name}.so
1420Load the plugin code in file @var{name}.so, assumed to be a
1421shared object to be dlopen'd by the compiler.  The base name of
1422the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the
1423purposes of argument parsing (See
1424@option{-fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}} below).
1425Each plugin should define the callback functions specified in the
1426Plugins API.
1427
1428@item -fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}
1429Define an argument called @var{key} with a value of @var{value}
1430for the plugin called @var{name}.
1431
1432@item -fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]}
1433For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada
1434specs. @xref{Generating Ada Bindings for C and C++ headers,,, gnat_ugn,
1435GNAT User's Guide}, which provides detailed documentation on this feature.
1436
1437@item -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}
1438For input files in any language, generate corresponding Go
1439declarations in @var{file}.  This generates Go @code{const},
1440@code{type}, @code{var}, and @code{func} declarations which may be a
1441useful way to start writing a Go interface to code written in some
1442other language.
1443
1444@include @value{srcdir}/../libiberty/at-file.texi
1445@end table
1446
1447@node Invoking G++
1448@section Compiling C++ Programs
1449
1450@cindex suffixes for C++ source
1451@cindex C++ source file suffixes
1452C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
1453@samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
1454@samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh}, @samp{.hpp},
1455@samp{.H}, or (for shared template code) @samp{.tcc}; and
1456preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}.  GCC recognizes
1457files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
1458call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
1459with the name @command{gcc}).
1460
1461@findex g++
1462@findex c++
1463However, the use of @command{gcc} does not add the C++ library.
1464@command{g++} is a program that calls GCC and treats @samp{.c},
1465@samp{.h} and @samp{.i} files as C++ source files instead of C source
1466files unless @option{-x} is used, and automatically specifies linking
1467against the C++ library.  This program is also useful when
1468precompiling a C header file with a @samp{.h} extension for use in C++
1469compilations.  On many systems, @command{g++} is also installed with
1470the name @command{c++}.
1471
1472@cindex invoking @command{g++}
1473When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1474command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1475language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1476languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1477@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
1478explanations of options for languages related to C@.
1479@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
1480explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1481
1482@node C Dialect Options
1483@section Options Controlling C Dialect
1484@cindex dialect options
1485@cindex language dialect options
1486@cindex options, dialect
1487
1488The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1489from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1490accepts:
1491
1492@table @gcctabopt
1493@cindex ANSI support
1494@cindex ISO support
1495@item -ansi
1496@opindex ansi
1497In C mode, this is equivalent to @samp{-std=c90}. In C++ mode, it is
1498equivalent to @samp{-std=c++98}.
1499
1500This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1501C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1502such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1503predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1504type of system you are using.  It also enables the undesirable and
1505rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler,
1506it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1507the @code{inline} keyword.
1508
1509The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1510@code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1511@option{-ansi}.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1512course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1513in compilations done with @option{-ansi}.  Alternate predefined macros
1514such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1515without @option{-ansi}.
1516
1517The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1518rejected gratuitously.  For that, @option{-pedantic} is required in
1519addition to @option{-ansi}.  @xref{Warning Options}.
1520
1521The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1522option is used.  Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1523from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1524ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1525programs that might use these names for other things.
1526
1527Functions that would normally be built in but do not have semantics
1528defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1529functions when @option{-ansi} is used.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1530built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1531affected.
1532
1533@item -std=
1534@opindex std
1535Determine the language standard. @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
1536Supported by GCC}, for details of these standard versions.  This option
1537is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.
1538
1539The compiler can accept several base standards, such as @samp{c90} or
1540@samp{c++98}, and GNU dialects of those standards, such as
1541@samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu++98}.  By specifying a base standard, the
1542compiler will accept all programs following that standard and those
1543using GNU extensions that do not contradict it.  For example,
1544@samp{-std=c90} turns off certain features of GCC that are
1545incompatible with ISO C90, such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof}
1546keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in
1547ISO C90, such as omitting the middle term of a @code{?:}
1548expression. On the other hand, by specifying a GNU dialect of a
1549standard, all features the compiler support are enabled, even when
1550those features change the meaning of the base standard and some
1551strict-conforming programs may be rejected.  The particular standard
1552is used by @option{-pedantic} to identify which features are GNU
1553extensions given that version of the standard. For example
1554@samp{-std=gnu90 -pedantic} would warn about C++ style @samp{//}
1555comments, while @samp{-std=gnu99 -pedantic} would not.
1556
1557A value for this option must be provided; possible values are
1558
1559@table @samp
1560@item c90
1561@itemx c89
1562@itemx iso9899:1990
1563Support all ISO C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict
1564with ISO C90 are disabled). Same as @option{-ansi} for C code.
1565
1566@item iso9899:199409
1567ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1568
1569@item c99
1570@itemx c9x
1571@itemx iso9899:1999
1572@itemx iso9899:199x
1573ISO C99.  Note that this standard is not yet fully supported; see
1574@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-4.7/c99status.html}} for more information.  The
1575names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1576
1577@item c11
1578@itemx c1x
1579@itemx iso9899:2011
1580ISO C11, the 2011 revision of the ISO C standard.
1581Support is incomplete and experimental.  The name @samp{c1x} is
1582deprecated.
1583
1584@item gnu90
1585@itemx gnu89
1586GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This
1587is the default for C code.
1588
1589@item gnu99
1590@itemx gnu9x
1591GNU dialect of ISO C99.  When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC,
1592this will become the default.  The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1593
1594@item gnu11
1595@item gnu1x
1596GNU dialect of ISO C11.  Support is incomplete and experimental.  The
1597name @samp{gnu1x} is deprecated.
1598
1599@item c++98
1600The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. Same as @option{-ansi} for
1601C++ code.
1602
1603@item gnu++98
1604GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++98}.  This is the default for
1605C++ code.
1606
1607@item c++11
1608The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.  Support for C++11 is still
1609experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1610
1611@item gnu++11
1612GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++11}. Support for C++11 is still
1613experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1614@end table
1615
1616@item -fgnu89-inline
1617@opindex fgnu89-inline
1618The option @option{-fgnu89-inline} tells GCC to use the traditional
1619GNU semantics for @code{inline} functions when in C99 mode.
1620@xref{Inline,,An Inline Function is As Fast As a Macro}.  This option
1621is accepted and ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including
16224.3.  In GCC versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in
1623C99 mode.  Using this option is roughly equivalent to adding the
1624@code{gnu_inline} function attribute to all inline functions
1625(@pxref{Function Attributes}).
1626
1627The option @option{-fno-gnu89-inline} explicitly tells GCC to use the
1628C99 semantics for @code{inline} when in C99 or gnu99 mode (i.e., it
1629specifies the default behavior).  This option was first supported in
1630GCC 4.3.  This option is not supported in @option{-std=c90} or
1631@option{-std=gnu90} mode.
1632
1633The preprocessor macros @code{__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__} and
1634@code{__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__} may be used to check which semantics are
1635in effect for @code{inline} functions.  @xref{Common Predefined
1636Macros,,,cpp,The C Preprocessor}.
1637
1638@item -aux-info @var{filename}
1639@opindex aux-info
1640Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1641declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1642files.  This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1643
1644Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1645each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1646implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1647@samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1648number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1649definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1650character).  In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1651arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1652comments, after the declaration.
1653
1654@item -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1655Accept variadic functions without named parameters.
1656
1657Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very
1658useful as it is not possible to read the arguments.  This is only
1659supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.
1660
1661@item -fno-asm
1662@opindex fno-asm
1663Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1664keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers.  You can use
1665the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1666instead.  @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1667
1668In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1669@code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords.  You may want to
1670use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1671effect.  In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1672switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1673@code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1674
1675@item -fno-builtin
1676@itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1677@opindex fno-builtin
1678@cindex built-in functions
1679Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1680@samp{__builtin_} as prefix.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1681functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1682including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1683@option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1684do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1685
1686GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1687more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1688instructions which adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1689may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller
1690and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1691cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1692of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,
1693when a function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use
1694information about that function to warn about problems with calls to
1695that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the
1696resulting code still contains calls to that function.  For example,
1697warnings are given with @option{-Wformat} for bad calls to
1698@code{printf}, when @code{printf} is built in, and @code{strlen} is
1699known not to modify global memory.
1700
1701With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1702only the built-in function @var{function} is
1703disabled.  @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}.  If a
1704function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1705option is ignored.  There is no corresponding
1706@option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1707built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1708@option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1709
1710@smallexample
1711#define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
1712#define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1713@end smallexample
1714
1715@item -fhosted
1716@opindex fhosted
1717@cindex hosted environment
1718
1719Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted environment.  This implies
1720@option{-fbuiltin}.  A hosted environment is one in which the
1721entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1722type of @code{int}.  Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1723This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1724
1725@item -ffreestanding
1726@opindex ffreestanding
1727@cindex hosted environment
1728
1729Assert that compilation takes place in a freestanding environment.  This
1730implies @option{-fno-builtin}.  A freestanding environment
1731is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1732not necessarily be at @code{main}.  The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1733This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1734
1735@xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1736freestanding and hosted environments.
1737
1738@item -fopenmp
1739@opindex fopenmp
1740@cindex OpenMP parallel
1741Enable handling of OpenMP directives @code{#pragma omp} in C/C++ and
1742@code{!$omp} in Fortran.  When @option{-fopenmp} is specified, the
1743compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application
1744Program Interface v3.0 @w{@uref{http://www.openmp.org/}}.  This option
1745implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets that
1746have support for @option{-pthread}.
1747
1748@item -fgnu-tm
1749@opindex fgnu-tm
1750When the option @option{-fgnu-tm} is specified, the compiler will
1751generate code for the Linux variant of Intel's current Transactional
1752Memory ABI specification document (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009).  This is
1753an experimental feature whose interface may change in future versions
1754of GCC, as the official specification changes.  Please note that not
1755all architectures are supported for this feature.
1756
1757For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,
1758@xref{Enabling libitm,,The GNU Transactional Memory Library,libitm,GNU
1759Transactional Memory Library}.
1760
1761Note that the transactional memory feature is not supported with
1762non-call exceptions (@option{-fnon-call-exceptions}).
1763
1764@item -fms-extensions
1765@opindex fms-extensions
1766Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1767
1768In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar
1769to previous types declarations.
1770
1771@smallexample
1772typedef int UOW;
1773struct ABC @{
1774  UOW UOW;
1775@};
1776@end smallexample
1777
1778Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1779accepted with this option.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed struct/union
1780fields within structs/unions}, for details.
1781
1782@item -fplan9-extensions
1783Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.
1784
1785This enables @option{-fms-extensions}, permits passing pointers to
1786structures with anonymous fields to functions that expect pointers to
1787elements of the type of the field, and permits referring to anonymous
1788fields declared using a typedef.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed
1789struct/union fields within structs/unions}, for details.  This is only
1790supported for C, not C++.
1791
1792@item -trigraphs
1793@opindex trigraphs
1794Support ISO C trigraphs.  The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1795options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1796
1797@item -no-integrated-cpp
1798@opindex no-integrated-cpp
1799Performs a compilation in two passes: preprocessing and compiling.  This
1800option allows a user supplied "cc1", "cc1plus", or "cc1obj" via the
1801@option{-B} option.  The user supplied compilation step can then add in
1802an additional preprocessing step after normal preprocessing but before
1803compiling.  The default is to use the integrated cpp (internal cpp)
1804
1805The semantics of this option will change if "cc1", "cc1plus", and
1806"cc1obj" are merged.
1807
1808@cindex traditional C language
1809@cindex C language, traditional
1810@item -traditional
1811@itemx -traditional-cpp
1812@opindex traditional-cpp
1813@opindex traditional
1814Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1815C compiler.  They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1816The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode.  See the GNU
1817CPP manual for details.
1818
1819@item -fcond-mismatch
1820@opindex fcond-mismatch
1821Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1822third arguments.  The value of such an expression is void.  This option
1823is not supported for C++.
1824
1825@item -flax-vector-conversions
1826@opindex flax-vector-conversions
1827Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers of
1828elements and/or incompatible element types.  This option should not be
1829used for new code.
1830
1831@item -funsigned-char
1832@opindex funsigned-char
1833Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1834
1835Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1836be.  It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1837@code{signed char} by default.
1838
1839Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1840@code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1841But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1842expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1843machines they were written for.  This option, and its inverse, let you
1844make such a program work with the opposite default.
1845
1846The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1847@code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1848is always just like one of those two.
1849
1850@item -fsigned-char
1851@opindex fsigned-char
1852Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1853
1854Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1855the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}.  Likewise, the option
1856@option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1857
1858@item -fsigned-bitfields
1859@itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1860@itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1861@itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1862@opindex fsigned-bitfields
1863@opindex funsigned-bitfields
1864@opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1865@opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1866These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1867declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}.  By
1868default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1869basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1870@end table
1871
1872@node C++ Dialect Options
1873@section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1874
1875@cindex compiler options, C++
1876@cindex C++ options, command-line
1877@cindex options, C++
1878This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1879for C++ programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler options
1880regardless of what language your program is in.  For example, you
1881might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
1882
1883@smallexample
1884g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
1885@end smallexample
1886
1887@noindent
1888In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
1889only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
1890language supported by GCC@.
1891
1892Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
1893
1894@table @gcctabopt
1895
1896@item -fabi-version=@var{n}
1897@opindex fabi-version
1898Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI@.  Version 2 is the version of the
1899C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.  Version 1 is the version of
1900the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.  Version 0 will always be
1901the version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.
1902Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0 will change as ABI bugs
1903are fixed.
1904
1905The default is version 2.
1906
1907Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a
1908template argument.
1909
1910Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard
1911mangling for vector types.
1912
1913Version 5, which first appeared in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling of
1914attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of a
1915plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of
1916another parameter.
1917
1918Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion
1919behavior of C++11 scoped enums and the mangling of template argument
1920packs, const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class scope function
1921used as a template argument.
1922
1923See also @option{-Wabi}.
1924
1925@item -fno-access-control
1926@opindex fno-access-control
1927Turn off all access checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working
1928around bugs in the access control code.
1929
1930@item -fcheck-new
1931@opindex fcheck-new
1932Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
1933before attempting to modify the storage allocated.  This check is
1934normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
1935@code{operator new} will only return @code{0} if it is declared
1936@samp{throw()}, in which case the compiler will always check the
1937return value even without this option.  In all other cases, when
1938@code{operator new} has a non-empty exception specification, memory
1939exhaustion is signalled by throwing @code{std::bad_alloc}.  See also
1940@samp{new (nothrow)}.
1941
1942@item -fconserve-space
1943@opindex fconserve-space
1944Put uninitialized or run-time-initialized global variables into the
1945common segment, as C does.  This saves space in the executable at the
1946cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions.  If you compile with this
1947flag and your program mysteriously crashes after @code{main()} has
1948completed, you may have an object that is being destroyed twice because
1949two definitions were merged.
1950
1951This option is no longer useful on most targets, now that support has
1952been added for putting variables into BSS without making them common.
1953
1954@item -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}
1955@opindex fconstexpr-depth
1956Set the maximum nested evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr functions
1957to @var{n}.  A limit is needed to detect endless recursion during
1958constant expression evaluation.  The minimum specified by the standard
1959is 512.
1960
1961@item -fdeduce-init-list
1962@opindex fdeduce-init-list
1963Enable deduction of a template type parameter as
1964std::initializer_list from a brace-enclosed initializer list, i.e.
1965
1966@smallexample
1967template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
1968@{
1969  return realfn (t);
1970@}
1971
1972void f()
1973@{
1974  forward(@{1,2@}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
1975@}
1976@end smallexample
1977
1978This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the
1979originally proposed semantics for the C++11 standard, but was not part
1980of the final standard, so it is disabled by default.  This option is
1981deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of G++.
1982
1983@item -ffriend-injection
1984@opindex ffriend-injection
1985Inject friend functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are
1986visible outside the scope of the class in which they are declared.
1987Friend functions were documented to work this way in the old Annotated
1988C++ Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked
1989that way.  However, in ISO C++ a friend function that is not declared
1990in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument dependent
1991lookup.  This option causes friends to be injected as they were in
1992earlier releases.
1993
1994This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future
1995release of G++.
1996
1997@item -fno-elide-constructors
1998@opindex fno-elide-constructors
1999The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
2000that is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
2001Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
2002call the copy constructor in all cases.
2003
2004@item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
2005@opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
2006Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications
2007at run time.  This option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful
2008for reducing code size in production builds, much like defining
2009@samp{NDEBUG}.  This does not give user code permission to throw
2010exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the compiler
2011will still optimize based on the specifications, so throwing an
2012unexpected exception will result in undefined behavior.
2013
2014@item -ffor-scope
2015@itemx -fno-for-scope
2016@opindex ffor-scope
2017@opindex fno-for-scope
2018If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2019a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
2020as specified by the C++ standard.
2021If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2022a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
2023as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
2024implementations of C++.
2025
2026The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard,
2027but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
2028otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
2029
2030@item -fno-gnu-keywords
2031@opindex fno-gnu-keywords
2032Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
2033word as an identifier.  You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
2034@option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
2035
2036@item -fno-implicit-templates
2037@opindex fno-implicit-templates
2038Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated
2039implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
2040@xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
2041
2042@item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
2043@opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
2044Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
2045The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
2046without optimization will need the same set of explicit instantiations.
2047
2048@item -fno-implement-inlines
2049@opindex fno-implement-inlines
2050To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
2051controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}.  This will cause linker
2052errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
2053
2054@item -fms-extensions
2055@opindex fms-extensions
2056Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
2057int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
2058
2059@item -fno-nonansi-builtins
2060@opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
2061Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
2062ANSI/ISO C@.  These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
2063@code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
2064
2065@item -fnothrow-opt
2066@opindex fnothrow-opt
2067Treat a @code{throw()} exception specification as though it were a
2068@code{noexcept} specification to reduce or eliminate the text size
2069overhead relative to a function with no exception specification.  If
2070the function has local variables of types with non-trivial
2071destructors, the exception specification will actually make the
2072function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be
2073optimized away.  The semantic effect is that an exception thrown out of
2074a function with such an exception specification will result in a call
2075to @code{terminate} rather than @code{unexpected}.
2076
2077@item -fno-operator-names
2078@opindex fno-operator-names
2079Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
2080@code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
2081synonyms as keywords.
2082
2083@item -fno-optional-diags
2084@opindex fno-optional-diags
2085Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
2086issue.  Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
2087a name having multiple meanings within a class.
2088
2089@item -fpermissive
2090@opindex fpermissive
2091Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
2092warnings.  Thus, using @option{-fpermissive} will allow some
2093nonconforming code to compile.
2094
2095@item -fno-pretty-templates
2096@opindex fno-pretty-templates
2097When an error message refers to a specialization of a function
2098template, the compiler will normally print the signature of the
2099template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or
2100typenames in the signature (e.g. @code{void f(T) [with T = int]}
2101rather than @code{void f(int)}) so that it's clear which template is
2102involved.  When an error message refers to a specialization of a class
2103template, the compiler will omit any template arguments that match
2104the default template arguments for that template.  If either of these
2105behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather than
2106easier, using @option{-fno-pretty-templates} will disable them.
2107
2108@item -frepo
2109@opindex frepo
2110Enable automatic template instantiation at link time.  This option also
2111implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}.  @xref{Template
2112Instantiation}, for more information.
2113
2114@item -fno-rtti
2115@opindex fno-rtti
2116Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
2117functions for use by the C++ run-time type identification features
2118(@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}).  If you don't use those parts
2119of the language, you can save some space by using this flag.  Note that
2120exception handling uses the same information, but it will generate it as
2121needed. The @samp{dynamic_cast} operator can still be used for casts that
2122do not require run-time type information, i.e.@: casts to @code{void *} or to
2123unambiguous base classes.
2124
2125@item -fstats
2126@opindex fstats
2127Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
2128This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
2129
2130@item -fstrict-enums
2131@opindex fstrict-enums
2132Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of
2133enumerated type can only be one of the values of the enumeration (as
2134defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
2135represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the
2136enumerators).  This assumption may not be valid if the program uses a
2137cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated type.
2138
2139@item -ftemplate-depth=@var{n}
2140@opindex ftemplate-depth
2141Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
2142A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
2143endless recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
2144conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17
2145(changed to 1024 in C++11).  The default value is 900, as the compiler
2146can run out of stack space before hitting 1024 in some situations.
2147
2148@item -fno-threadsafe-statics
2149@opindex fno-threadsafe-statics
2150Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
2151ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics.  You can use this
2152option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need to be
2153thread-safe.
2154
2155@item -fuse-cxa-atexit
2156@opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
2157Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
2158@code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
2159This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
2160destructors, but will only work if your C library supports
2161@code{__cxa_atexit}.
2162
2163@item -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2164@opindex fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2165Don't use the @code{__cxa_get_exception_ptr} runtime routine.  This
2166will cause @code{std::uncaught_exception} to be incorrect, but is necessary
2167if the runtime routine is not available.
2168
2169@item -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2170@opindex fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2171This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
2172pointers to inline functions or methods where the addresses of the two functions
2173were taken in different shared objects.
2174
2175The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with
2176@code{__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))} so that they do not
2177appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT indirection
2178when used within the DSO@.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect
2179on load and link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the
2180dynamic export table when the library makes heavy use of templates.
2181
2182The behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
2183methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static variables
2184local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce that
2185the function is defined in only one shared object.
2186
2187You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the
2188effect of the switch for that method.  For example, if you do want to
2189compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might mark it as
2190having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit
2191visibility will have no effect.
2192
2193Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option
2194as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library boundary.
2195@xref{Template Instantiation}.
2196
2197@item -fvisibility-ms-compat
2198@opindex fvisibility-ms-compat
2199This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++
2200linkage model compatible with that of Microsoft Visual Studio.
2201
2202The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:
2203
2204@enumerate
2205@item
2206It sets the default visibility to @code{hidden}, like
2207@option{-fvisibility=hidden}.
2208
2209@item
2210Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.
2211
2212@item
2213The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit
2214visibility specifications that are defined in more than one different
2215shared object: those declarations are permitted if they would have
2216been permitted when this option was not used.
2217@end enumerate
2218
2219In new code it is better to use @option{-fvisibility=hidden} and
2220export those classes that are intended to be externally visible.
2221Unfortunately it is possible for code to rely, perhaps accidentally,
2222on the Visual Studio behavior.
2223
2224Among the consequences of these changes are that static data members
2225of the same type with the same name but defined in different shared
2226objects will be different, so changing one will not change the other;
2227and that pointers to function members defined in different shared
2228objects may not compare equal.  When this flag is given, it is a
2229violation of the ODR to define types with the same name differently.
2230
2231@item -fno-weak
2232@opindex fno-weak
2233Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
2234By default, G++ will use weak symbols if they are available.  This
2235option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
2236it will result in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option may
2237be removed in a future release of G++.
2238
2239@item -nostdinc++
2240@opindex nostdinc++
2241Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
2242C++, but do still search the other standard directories.  (This option
2243is used when building the C++ library.)
2244@end table
2245
2246In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
2247have meanings only for C++ programs:
2248
2249@table @gcctabopt
2250@item -fno-default-inline
2251@opindex fno-default-inline
2252Do not assume @samp{inline} for functions defined inside a class scope.
2253@xref{Optimize Options,,Options That Control Optimization}.  Note that these
2254functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't be
2255inlined by default.
2256
2257@item -Wabi @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2258@opindex Wabi
2259@opindex Wno-abi
2260Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
2261vendor-neutral C++ ABI@.  Although an effort has been made to warn about
2262all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
2263even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may also be
2264cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
2265will be compatible.
2266
2267You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
2268concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
2269compatible with code generated by other compilers.
2270
2271The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=2} (the default) include:
2272
2273@itemize @bullet
2274
2275@item
2276A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is
2277mangled incorrectly:
2278@smallexample
2279extern int N;
2280template <int &> struct S @{@};
2281void n (S<N>) @{2@}
2282@end smallexample
2283
2284This is fixed in @option{-fabi-version=3}.
2285
2286@item
2287SIMD vector types declared using @code{__attribute ((vector_size))} are
2288mangled in a non-standard way that does not allow for overloading of
2289functions taking vectors of different sizes.
2290
2291The mangling is changed in @option{-fabi-version=4}.
2292@end itemize
2293
2294The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=1} include:
2295
2296@itemize @bullet
2297
2298@item
2299Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to
2300pack data into the same byte as a base class.  For example:
2301
2302@smallexample
2303struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
2304struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
2305@end smallexample
2306
2307@noindent
2308In this case, G++ will place @code{B::f2} into the same byte
2309as@code{A::f1}; other compilers will not.  You can avoid this problem
2310by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
2311byte size on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to
2312layout @code{B} identically.
2313
2314@item
2315Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use
2316tail padding when laying out virtual bases.  For example:
2317
2318@smallexample
2319struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
2320struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
2321struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
2322@end smallexample
2323
2324@noindent
2325In this case, G++ will not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
2326@code{A}; other compilers will.  You can avoid this problem by
2327explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
2328alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that will cause G++ and other
2329compilers to layout @code{C} identically.
2330
2331@item
2332Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
2333of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For
2334example:
2335
2336@smallexample
2337union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
2338@end smallexample
2339
2340@noindent
2341Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the
2342union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
2343
2344@item
2345Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:
2346
2347@smallexample
2348struct A @{@};
2349
2350struct B @{
2351  A a;
2352  virtual void f ();
2353@};
2354
2355struct C : public B, public A @{@};
2356@end smallexample
2357
2358@noindent
2359G++ will place the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
2360it should be placed at offset zero.  G++ mistakenly believes that the
2361@code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
2362
2363@item
2364Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
2365template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
2366
2367@smallexample
2368template <typename Q>
2369void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
2370
2371template <template <typename> class Q>
2372void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
2373@end smallexample
2374
2375@noindent
2376Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
2377
2378@end itemize
2379
2380It also warns psABI related changes.  The known psABI changes at this
2381point include:
2382
2383@itemize @bullet
2384
2385@item
2386For SYSV/x86-64, when passing union with long double, it is changed to
2387pass in memory as specified in psABI.  For example:
2388
2389@smallexample
2390union U @{
2391  long double ld;
2392  int i;
2393@};
2394@end smallexample
2395
2396@noindent
2397@code{union U} will always be passed in memory.
2398
2399@end itemize
2400
2401@item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2402@opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
2403@opindex Wno-ctor-dtor-privacy
2404Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
2405destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends nor
2406public static member functions.
2407
2408@item -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2409@opindex Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor
2410@opindex Wno-delete-non-virtual-dtor
2411Warn when @samp{delete} is used to destroy an instance of a class that
2412has virtual functions and non-virtual destructor. It is unsafe to delete
2413an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a base class if the
2414base class does not have a virtual destructor.  This warning is enabled
2415by @option{-Wall}.
2416
2417@item -Wnarrowing @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2418@opindex Wnarrowing
2419@opindex Wno-narrowing
2420Warn when a narrowing conversion prohibited by C++11 occurs within
2421@samp{@{ @}}, e.g.
2422
2423@smallexample
2424int i = @{ 2.2 @}; // error: narrowing from double to int
2425@end smallexample
2426
2427This flag is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wc++11-compat}.
2428
2429With -std=c++11, @option{-Wno-narrowing} suppresses the diagnostic
2430required by the standard.  Note that this does not affect the meaning
2431of well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered
2432ill-formed in SFINAE context.
2433
2434@item -Wnoexcept @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2435@opindex Wnoexcept
2436@opindex Wno-noexcept
2437Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call
2438to a function that does not have a non-throwing exception
2439specification (i.e. @samp{throw()} or @samp{noexcept}) but is known by
2440the compiler to never throw an exception.
2441
2442@item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2443@opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
2444@opindex Wno-non-virtual-dtor
2445Warn when a class has virtual functions and accessible non-virtual
2446destructor, in which case it would be possible but unsafe to delete
2447an instance of a derived class through a pointer to the base class.
2448This warning is also enabled if @option{-Weffc++} is specified.
2449
2450@item -Wreorder @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2451@opindex Wreorder
2452@opindex Wno-reorder
2453@cindex reordering, warning
2454@cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
2455Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
2456match the order in which they must be executed.  For instance:
2457
2458@smallexample
2459struct A @{
2460  int i;
2461  int j;
2462  A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
2463@};
2464@end smallexample
2465
2466The compiler will rearrange the member initializers for @samp{i}
2467and @samp{j} to match the declaration order of the members, emitting
2468a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2469@end table
2470
2471The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
2472
2473@table @gcctabopt
2474@item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2475@opindex Weffc++
2476@opindex Wno-effc++
2477Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
2478@cite{Effective C++, Second Edition} book:
2479
2480@itemize @bullet
2481@item
2482Item 11:  Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
2483with dynamically allocated memory.
2484
2485@item
2486Item 12:  Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
2487
2488@item
2489Item 14:  Make destructors virtual in base classes.
2490
2491@item
2492Item 15:  Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
2493
2494@item
2495Item 23:  Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
2496
2497@end itemize
2498
2499Also warn about violations of the following style guidelines from
2500Scott Meyers' @cite{More Effective C++} book:
2501
2502@itemize @bullet
2503@item
2504Item 6:  Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
2505decrement operators.
2506
2507@item
2508Item 7:  Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
2509
2510@end itemize
2511
2512When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
2513headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use @samp{grep -v}
2514to filter out those warnings.
2515
2516@item -Wstrict-null-sentinel @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2517@opindex Wstrict-null-sentinel
2518@opindex Wno-strict-null-sentinel
2519Warn also about the use of an uncasted @code{NULL} as sentinel.  When
2520compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as @code{NULL} is defined
2521to @code{__null}.  Although it is a null pointer constant not a null pointer,
2522it is guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is
2523not portable across different compilers.
2524
2525@item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2526@opindex Wno-non-template-friend
2527@opindex Wnon-template-friend
2528Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
2529within a template.  Since the advent of explicit template specification
2530support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
2531@samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
2532friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function.  (Section
253314.5.3).  Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
2534could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
2535function.  Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
2536behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
2537check existing code for potential trouble spots and is on by default.
2538This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
2539@option{-Wno-non-template-friend}, which keeps the conformant compiler code
2540but disables the helpful warning.
2541
2542@item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2543@opindex Wold-style-cast
2544@opindex Wno-old-style-cast
2545Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
2546a C++ program.  The new-style casts (@samp{dynamic_cast},
2547@samp{static_cast}, @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are
2548less vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
2549
2550@item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2551@opindex Woverloaded-virtual
2552@opindex Wno-overloaded-virtual
2553@cindex overloaded virtual function, warning
2554@cindex warning for overloaded virtual function
2555Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
2556base class.  For example, in:
2557
2558@smallexample
2559struct A @{
2560  virtual void f();
2561@};
2562
2563struct B: public A @{
2564  void f(int);
2565@};
2566@end smallexample
2567
2568the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
2569like:
2570
2571@smallexample
2572B* b;
2573b->f();
2574@end smallexample
2575
2576will fail to compile.
2577
2578@item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2579@opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
2580@opindex Wpmf-conversions
2581Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
2582to a plain pointer.
2583
2584@item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2585@opindex Wsign-promo
2586@opindex Wno-sign-promo
2587Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
2588enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned type of
2589the same size.  Previous versions of G++ would try to preserve
2590unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
2591
2592@smallexample
2593struct A @{
2594  operator int ();
2595  A& operator = (int);
2596@};
2597
2598main ()
2599@{
2600  A a,b;
2601  a = b;
2602@}
2603@end smallexample
2604
2605In this example, G++ will synthesize a default @samp{A& operator =
2606(const A&);}, while cfront will use the user-defined @samp{operator =}.
2607@end table
2608
2609@node Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options
2610@section Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
2611
2612@cindex compiler options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2613@cindex Objective-C and Objective-C++ options, command-line
2614@cindex options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2615(NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
2616languages themselves.  @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
2617Supported by GCC}, for references.)
2618
2619This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
2620for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs, but you can also use most of
2621the language-independent GNU compiler options.
2622For example, you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
2623
2624@smallexample
2625gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
2626@end smallexample
2627
2628@noindent
2629In this example, @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
2630Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with
2631any language supported by GCC@.
2632
2633Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language, Objective-C
2634compilations may also use options specific to the C front-end (e.g.,
2635@option{-Wtraditional}).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
2636C++-specific options (e.g., @option{-Wabi}).
2637
2638Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
2639and Objective-C++ programs:
2640
2641@table @gcctabopt
2642@item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
2643@opindex fconstant-string-class
2644Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
2645literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}.  The default
2646class name is @code{NXConstantString} if the GNU runtime is being used, and
2647@code{NSConstantString} if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The
2648@option{-fconstant-cfstrings} option, if also present, will override the
2649@option{-fconstant-string-class} setting and cause @code{@@"@dots{}"} literals
2650to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2651
2652@item -fgnu-runtime
2653@opindex fgnu-runtime
2654Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2655runtime.  This is the default for most types of systems.
2656
2657@item -fnext-runtime
2658@opindex fnext-runtime
2659Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.  This is the default
2660for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@.  The macro
2661@code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
2662used.
2663
2664@item -fno-nil-receivers
2665@opindex fno-nil-receivers
2666Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches (@code{[receiver
2667message:arg]}) in this translation unit ensure that the receiver is
2668not @code{nil}.  This allows for more efficient entry points in the
2669runtime to be used.  This option is only available in conjunction with
2670the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.
2671
2672@item -fobjc-abi-version=@var{n}
2673@opindex fobjc-abi-version
2674Use version @var{n} of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.
2675This option is currently supported only for the NeXT runtime.  In that
2676case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI without support for
2677properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 1 is the
2678traditional (32-bit) ABI with support for properties and other
2679Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 2 is the modern (64-bit) ABI.  If
2680nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target
2681machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit target machines.
2682
2683@item -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2684@opindex fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2685For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a
2686C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor.  If so, synthesize a
2687special @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} instance method which will run
2688non-trivial default constructors on any such instance variables, in order,
2689and then return @code{self}.  Similarly, check if any instance variable
2690is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and if so, synthesize a
2691special @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} method which will run
2692all such default destructors, in reverse order.
2693
2694The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct}
2695methods thusly generated will only operate on instance variables
2696declared in the current Objective-C class, and not those inherited
2697from superclasses.  It is the responsibility of the Objective-C
2698runtime to invoke all such methods in an object's inheritance
2699hierarchy.  The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} methods will be invoked
2700by the runtime immediately after a new object instance is allocated;
2701the @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods will be invoked immediately
2702before the runtime deallocates an object instance.
2703
2704As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has
2705support for invoking the @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and
2706@code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods.
2707
2708@item -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2709@opindex fobjc-direct-dispatch
2710Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is
2711accomplished via the comm page.
2712
2713@item -fobjc-exceptions
2714@opindex fobjc-exceptions
2715Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in
2716Objective-C, similar to what is offered by C++ and Java.  This option
2717is required to use the Objective-C keywords @code{@@try},
2718@code{@@throw}, @code{@@catch}, @code{@@finally} and
2719@code{@@synchronized}.  This option is available with both the GNU
2720runtime and the NeXT runtime (but not available in conjunction with
2721the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).
2722
2723@item -fobjc-gc
2724@opindex fobjc-gc
2725Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++
2726programs.  This option is only available with the NeXT runtime; the
2727GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation that
2728does not require special compiler flags.
2729
2730@item -fobjc-nilcheck
2731@opindex fobjc-nilcheck
2732For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil
2733receiver in method invocations before doing the actual method call.
2734This is the default and can be disabled using
2735@option{-fno-objc-nilcheck}.  Class methods and super calls are never
2736checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag is set to.
2737Currently this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older
2738version of the NeXT runtime ABI, is used.
2739
2740@item -fobjc-std=objc1
2741@opindex fobjc-std
2742Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language
2743recognized by GCC 4.0.  This only affects the Objective-C additions to
2744the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++ standards,
2745which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags.  When
2746this option is used with the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler,
2747any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by GCC 4.0 is rejected.
2748This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can
2749be compiled with older versions of GCC.
2750
2751@item -freplace-objc-classes
2752@opindex freplace-objc-classes
2753Emit a special marker instructing @command{ld(1)} not to statically link in
2754the resulting object file, and allow @command{dyld(1)} to load it in at
2755run time instead.  This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-Continue
2756debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and
2757dynamically reloaded in the course of program execution, without the need
2758to restart the program itself.  Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality
2759is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
2760and later.
2761
2762@item -fzero-link
2763@opindex fzero-link
2764When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls
2765to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")} (when the name of the class is known at
2766compile time) with static class references that get initialized at load time,
2767which improves run-time performance.  Specifying the @option{-fzero-link} flag
2768suppresses this behavior and causes calls to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")}
2769to be retained.  This is useful in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows
2770for individual class implementations to be modified during program execution.
2771The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to @code{objc_get_class("@dots{}")}
2772regardless of command-line options.
2773
2774@item -gen-decls
2775@opindex gen-decls
2776Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
2777file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
2778
2779@item -Wassign-intercept @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2780@opindex Wassign-intercept
2781@opindex Wno-assign-intercept
2782Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2783garbage collector.
2784
2785@item -Wno-protocol @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2786@opindex Wno-protocol
2787@opindex Wprotocol
2788If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
2789every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class.  The
2790default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
2791implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
2792from the superclass.  If you use the @option{-Wno-protocol} option, then
2793methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
2794and no warning is issued for them.
2795
2796@item -Wselector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2797@opindex Wselector
2798@opindex Wno-selector
2799Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
2800found during compilation.  The check is performed on the list of methods
2801in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally, a check is performed
2802for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
2803expression, and a corresponding method for that selector has been found
2804during compilation.  Because these checks scan the method table only at
2805the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
2806stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
2807found during compilation, or because the @option{-fsyntax-only} option is
2808being used.
2809
2810@item -Wstrict-selector-match @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2811@opindex Wstrict-selector-match
2812@opindex Wno-strict-selector-match
2813Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are
2814found for a given selector when attempting to send a message using this
2815selector to a receiver of type @code{id} or @code{Class}.  When this flag
2816is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler will omit such warnings
2817if any differences found are confined to types that share the same size
2818and alignment.
2819
2820@item -Wundeclared-selector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2821@opindex Wundeclared-selector
2822@opindex Wno-undeclared-selector
2823Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
2824undeclared selector is found.  A selector is considered undeclared if no
2825method with that name has been declared before the
2826@code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression, either explicitly in an
2827@code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly in
2828an @code{@@implementation} section.  This option always performs its
2829checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found,
2830while @option{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
2831compilation.  This also enforces the coding style convention
2832that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
2833
2834@item -print-objc-runtime-info
2835@opindex print-objc-runtime-info
2836Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by
2837value, if any.
2838
2839@end table
2840
2841@node Language Independent Options
2842@section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
2843@cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
2844@cindex diagnostic messages
2845@cindex message formatting
2846
2847Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
2848the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}).  The options described
2849below can be used to control the diagnostic messages formatting
2850algorithm, e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
2851information should be reported.  Right now, only the C++ front end can
2852honor these options.  However it is expected, in the near future, that
2853the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.
2854
2855@table @gcctabopt
2856@item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
2857@opindex fmessage-length
2858Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
2859characters.  The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
2860the front ends supported by GCC@.  If @var{n} is zero, then no
2861line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single
2862line.
2863
2864@opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
2865@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
2866Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages
2867reporter to emit @emph{once} source location information; that is, in
2868case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
2869be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
2870over and over, in subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default
2871behavior.
2872
2873@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
2874Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic
2875messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
2876prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
2877a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
2878
2879@item -fno-diagnostics-show-option
2880@opindex fno-diagnostics-show-option
2881@opindex fdiagnostics-show-option
2882By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the
2883command-line option that directly controls the diagnostic (if such an
2884option is known to the diagnostic machinery).  Specifying the
2885@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag suppresses that behavior.
2886
2887@end table
2888
2889@node Warning Options
2890@section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
2891@cindex options to control warnings
2892@cindex warning messages
2893@cindex messages, warning
2894@cindex suppressing warnings
2895
2896Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that
2897are not inherently erroneous but that are risky or suggest there
2898may have been an error.
2899
2900The following language-independent options do not enable specific
2901warnings but control the kinds of diagnostics produced by GCC.
2902
2903@table @gcctabopt
2904@cindex syntax checking
2905@item -fsyntax-only
2906@opindex fsyntax-only
2907Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
2908
2909@item -fmax-errors=@var{n}
2910@opindex fmax-errors
2911Limits the maximum number of error messages to @var{n}, at which point
2912GCC bails out rather than attempting to continue processing the source
2913code.  If @var{n} is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number
2914of error messages produced.  If @option{-Wfatal-errors} is also
2915specified, then @option{-Wfatal-errors} takes precedence over this
2916option.
2917
2918@item -w
2919@opindex w
2920Inhibit all warning messages.
2921
2922@item -Werror
2923@opindex Werror
2924@opindex Wno-error
2925Make all warnings into errors.
2926
2927@item -Werror=
2928@opindex Werror=
2929@opindex Wno-error=
2930Make the specified warning into an error.  The specifier for a warning
2931is appended, for example @option{-Werror=switch} turns the warnings
2932controlled by @option{-Wswitch} into errors.  This switch takes a
2933negative form, to be used to negate @option{-Werror} for specific
2934warnings, for example @option{-Wno-error=switch} makes
2935@option{-Wswitch} warnings not be errors, even when @option{-Werror}
2936is in effect.
2937
2938The warning message for each controllable warning includes the
2939option that controls the warning.  That option can then be used with
2940@option{-Werror=} and @option{-Wno-error=} as described above.
2941(Printing of the option in the warning message can be disabled using the
2942@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag.)
2943
2944Note that specifying @option{-Werror=}@var{foo} automatically implies
2945@option{-W}@var{foo}.  However, @option{-Wno-error=}@var{foo} does not
2946imply anything.
2947
2948@item -Wfatal-errors
2949@opindex Wfatal-errors
2950@opindex Wno-fatal-errors
2951This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error
2952occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing further error
2953messages.
2954
2955@end table
2956
2957You can request many specific warnings with options beginning
2958@samp{-W}, for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on
2959implicit declarations.  Each of these specific warning options also
2960has a negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings; for
2961example, @option{-Wno-implicit}.  This manual lists only one of the
2962two forms, whichever is not the default.  For further,
2963language-specific options also refer to @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
2964@ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
2965
2966When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g.,
2967@option{-Wunknown-warning}), GCC will emit a diagnostic stating
2968that the option is not recognized.  However, if the @option{-Wno-} form
2969is used, the behavior is slightly different: No diagnostic will be
2970produced for @option{-Wno-unknown-warning} unless other diagnostics
2971are being produced.  This allows the use of new @option{-Wno-} options
2972with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the compiler will
2973warn that an unrecognized option was used.
2974
2975@table @gcctabopt
2976@item -pedantic
2977@opindex pedantic
2978Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
2979reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
2980programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For ISO C, follows the
2981version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
2982
2983Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
2984this option (though a rare few will require @option{-ansi} or a
2985@option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@.  However,
2986without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
2987features are supported as well.  With this option, they are rejected.
2988
2989@option{-pedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
2990alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}.  Pedantic
2991warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
2992@code{__extension__}.  However, only system header files should use
2993these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
2994@xref{Alternate Keywords}.
2995
2996Some users try to use @option{-pedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
2997C conformance.  They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
2998it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
2999ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
3000diagnostics have been added.
3001
3002A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
3003some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
3004be quite different from @option{-pedantic}.  We don't have plans to
3005support such a feature in the near future.
3006
3007Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
3008extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
3009corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
3010extended dialect is based.  Warnings from @option{-pedantic} are given
3011where they are required by the base standard.  (It would not make sense
3012for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
3013C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
3014features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
3015nothing to warn about.)
3016
3017@item -pedantic-errors
3018@opindex pedantic-errors
3019Like @option{-pedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
3020warnings.
3021
3022@item -Wall
3023@opindex Wall
3024@opindex Wno-all
3025This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users
3026consider questionable, and that are easy to avoid (or modify to
3027prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros.  This also
3028enables some language-specific warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect
3029Options} and @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
3030
3031@option{-Wall} turns on the following warning flags:
3032
3033@gccoptlist{-Waddress   @gol
3034-Warray-bounds @r{(only with} @option{-O2}@r{)}  @gol
3035-Wc++11-compat  @gol
3036-Wchar-subscripts  @gol
3037-Wenum-compare @r{(in C/Objc; this is on by default in C++)} @gol
3038-Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3039-Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3040-Wcomment  @gol
3041-Wformat   @gol
3042-Wmain @r{(only for C/ObjC and unless} @option{-ffreestanding}@r{)}  @gol
3043-Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
3044-Wmissing-braces  @gol
3045-Wnonnull  @gol
3046-Wparentheses  @gol
3047-Wpointer-sign  @gol
3048-Wreorder   @gol
3049-Wreturn-type  @gol
3050-Wsequence-point  @gol
3051-Wsign-compare @r{(only in C++)}  @gol
3052-Wstrict-aliasing  @gol
3053-Wstrict-overflow=1  @gol
3054-Wswitch  @gol
3055-Wtrigraphs  @gol
3056-Wuninitialized  @gol
3057-Wunknown-pragmas  @gol
3058-Wunused-function  @gol
3059-Wunused-label     @gol
3060-Wunused-value     @gol
3061-Wunused-variable  @gol
3062-Wvolatile-register-var @gol
3063}
3064
3065Note that some warning flags are not implied by @option{-Wall}.  Some of
3066them warn about constructions that users generally do not consider
3067questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
3068others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in
3069some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
3070the warning. Some of them are enabled by @option{-Wextra} but many of
3071them must be enabled individually.
3072
3073@item -Wextra
3074@opindex W
3075@opindex Wextra
3076@opindex Wno-extra
3077This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by
3078@option{-Wall}. (This option used to be called @option{-W}.  The older
3079name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)
3080
3081@gccoptlist{-Wclobbered  @gol
3082-Wempty-body  @gol
3083-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
3084-Wmissing-field-initializers  @gol
3085-Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C only)}  @gol
3086-Wold-style-declaration @r{(C only)}  @gol
3087-Woverride-init  @gol
3088-Wsign-compare  @gol
3089-Wtype-limits  @gol
3090-Wuninitialized  @gol
3091-Wunused-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)} @gol
3092-Wunused-but-set-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)}  @gol
3093}
3094
3095The option @option{-Wextra} also prints warning messages for the
3096following cases:
3097
3098@itemize @bullet
3099
3100@item
3101A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
3102@samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
3103
3104@item
3105(C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a
3106conditional expression.
3107
3108@item
3109(C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.
3110
3111@item
3112(C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared @samp{register}.
3113
3114@item
3115(C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been declared
3116@samp{register}.
3117
3118@item
3119(C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy
3120constructor.
3121
3122@end itemize
3123
3124@item -Wchar-subscripts
3125@opindex Wchar-subscripts
3126@opindex Wno-char-subscripts
3127Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}.  This is a common cause
3128of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
3129machines.
3130This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3131
3132@item -Wcomment
3133@opindex Wcomment
3134@opindex Wno-comment
3135Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
3136comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
3137This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3138
3139@item -Wno-coverage-mismatch
3140@opindex Wno-coverage-mismatch
3141Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the
3142@option{-fprofile-use} option.
3143If a source file was changed between @option{-fprofile-gen} and
3144@option{-fprofile-use}, the files with the profile feedback can fail
3145to match the source file and GCC cannot use the profile feedback
3146information.  By default, this warning is enabled and is treated as an
3147error.  @option{-Wno-coverage-mismatch} can be used to disable the
3148warning or @option{-Wno-error=coverage-mismatch} can be used to
3149disable the error.  Disabling the error for this warning can result in
3150poorly optimized code and is useful only in the
3151case of very minor changes such as bug fixes to an existing code-base.
3152Completely disabling the warning is not recommended.
3153
3154@item -Wno-cpp
3155@r{(C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)}
3156
3157Suppress warning messages emitted by @code{#warning} directives.
3158
3159@item -Wdouble-promotion @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3160@opindex Wdouble-promotion
3161@opindex Wno-double-promotion
3162Give a warning when a value of type @code{float} is implicitly
3163promoted to @code{double}.  CPUs with a 32-bit ``single-precision''
3164floating-point unit implement @code{float} in hardware, but emulate
3165@code{double} in software.  On such a machine, doing computations
3166using @code{double} values is much more expensive because of the
3167overhead required for software emulation.
3168
3169It is easy to accidentally do computations with @code{double} because
3170floating-point literals are implicitly of type @code{double}.  For
3171example, in:
3172@smallexample
3173@group
3174float area(float radius)
3175@{
3176   return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
3177@}
3178@end group
3179@end smallexample
3180the compiler will perform the entire computation with @code{double}
3181because the floating-point literal is a @code{double}.
3182
3183@item -Wformat
3184@opindex Wformat
3185@opindex Wno-format
3186@opindex ffreestanding
3187@opindex fno-builtin
3188Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
3189the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
3190specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
3191sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
3192attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
3193@code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
3194not in the C standard) families (or other target-specific families).
3195Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
3196specified depends on the standard version selected, and such checks of
3197functions without the attribute specified are disabled by
3198@option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-fno-builtin}.
3199
3200The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
3201libc version 2.2.  These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
3202as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
3203extensions.  Other library implementations may not support all these
3204features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
3205particular library's limitations.  However, if @option{-pedantic} is used
3206with @option{-Wformat}, warnings will be given about format features not
3207in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
3208since those are not in any version of the C standard).  @xref{C Dialect
3209Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
3210
3211Since @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for
3212several functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}.
3213
3214@option{-Wformat} is included in @option{-Wall}.  For more control over some
3215aspects of format checking, the options @option{-Wformat-y2k},
3216@option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, @option{-Wno-format-zero-length},
3217@option{-Wformat-nonliteral}, @option{-Wformat-security}, and
3218@option{-Wformat=2} are available, but are not included in @option{-Wall}.
3219
3220@item -Wformat-y2k
3221@opindex Wformat-y2k
3222@opindex Wno-format-y2k
3223If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about @code{strftime}
3224formats that may yield only a two-digit year.
3225
3226@item -Wno-format-contains-nul
3227@opindex Wno-format-contains-nul
3228@opindex Wformat-contains-nul
3229If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about format strings that
3230contain NUL bytes.
3231
3232@item -Wno-format-extra-args
3233@opindex Wno-format-extra-args
3234@opindex Wformat-extra-args
3235If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
3236@code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function.  The C standard specifies
3237that such arguments are ignored.
3238
3239Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
3240specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
3241warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
3242type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments.  However,
3243in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option will suppress the
3244warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
3245Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
3246
3247@item -Wno-format-zero-length
3248@opindex Wno-format-zero-length
3249@opindex Wformat-zero-length
3250If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
3251The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
3252
3253@item -Wformat-nonliteral
3254@opindex Wformat-nonliteral
3255@opindex Wno-format-nonliteral
3256If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
3257string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
3258takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
3259
3260@item -Wformat-security
3261@opindex Wformat-security
3262@opindex Wno-format-security
3263If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
3264functions that represent possible security problems.  At present, this
3265warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
3266format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
3267as in @code{printf (foo);}.  This may be a security hole if the format
3268string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}.  (This is
3269currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
3270in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
3271included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
3272
3273@item -Wformat=2
3274@opindex Wformat=2
3275@opindex Wno-format=2
3276Enable @option{-Wformat} plus format checks not included in
3277@option{-Wformat}.  Currently equivalent to @samp{-Wformat
3278-Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k}.
3279
3280@item -Wnonnull
3281@opindex Wnonnull
3282@opindex Wno-nonnull
3283Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
3284requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
3285
3286@option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}.  It
3287can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
3288
3289@item -Winit-self @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3290@opindex Winit-self
3291@opindex Wno-init-self
3292Warn about uninitialized variables that are initialized with themselves.
3293Note this option can only be used with the @option{-Wuninitialized} option.
3294
3295For example, GCC will warn about @code{i} being uninitialized in the
3296following snippet only when @option{-Winit-self} has been specified:
3297@smallexample
3298@group
3299int f()
3300@{
3301  int i = i;
3302  return i;
3303@}
3304@end group
3305@end smallexample
3306
3307@item -Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3308@opindex Wimplicit-int
3309@opindex Wno-implicit-int
3310Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
3311This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3312
3313@item -Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3314@opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
3315@opindex Wno-implicit-function-declaration
3316Give a warning whenever a function is used before being declared. In
3317C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this warning is
3318enabled by default and it is made into an error by
3319@option{-pedantic-errors}. This warning is also enabled by
3320@option{-Wall}.
3321
3322@item -Wimplicit @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3323@opindex Wimplicit
3324@opindex Wno-implicit
3325Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
3326This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3327
3328@item -Wignored-qualifiers @r{(C and C++ only)}
3329@opindex Wignored-qualifiers
3330@opindex Wno-ignored-qualifiers
3331Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier
3332such as @code{const}.  For ISO C such a type qualifier has no effect,
3333since the value returned by a function is not an lvalue.
3334For C++, the warning is only emitted for scalar types or @code{void}.
3335ISO C prohibits qualified @code{void} return types on function
3336definitions, so such return types always receive a warning
3337even without this option.
3338
3339This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
3340
3341@item -Wmain
3342@opindex Wmain
3343@opindex Wno-main
3344Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious.  @samp{main} should be
3345a function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
3346arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.  This warning
3347is enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either @option{-Wall}
3348or @option{-pedantic}.
3349
3350@item -Wmissing-braces
3351@opindex Wmissing-braces
3352@opindex Wno-missing-braces
3353Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.  In
3354the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
3355bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed.
3356
3357@smallexample
3358int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
3359int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
3360@end smallexample
3361
3362This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3363
3364@item -Wmissing-include-dirs @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3365@opindex Wmissing-include-dirs
3366@opindex Wno-missing-include-dirs
3367Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
3368
3369@item -Wparentheses
3370@opindex Wparentheses
3371@opindex Wno-parentheses
3372Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
3373as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
3374is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
3375often get confused about.
3376
3377Also warn if a comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is
3378equivalent to @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different
3379interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
3380
3381Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
3382@code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs.  Here is an example of
3383such a case:
3384
3385@smallexample
3386@group
3387@{
3388  if (a)
3389    if (b)
3390      foo ();
3391  else
3392    bar ();
3393@}
3394@end group
3395@end smallexample
3396
3397In C/C++, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible
3398@code{if} statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}.  This is
3399often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above
3400example by indentation the programmer chose.  When there is the
3401potential for this confusion, GCC will issue a warning when this flag
3402is specified.  To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around
3403the innermost @code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else}
3404could belong to the enclosing @code{if}.  The resulting code would
3405look like this:
3406
3407@smallexample
3408@group
3409@{
3410  if (a)
3411    @{
3412      if (b)
3413        foo ();
3414      else
3415        bar ();
3416    @}
3417@}
3418@end group
3419@end smallexample
3420
3421Also warn for dangerous uses of the
3422?: with omitted middle operand GNU extension. When the condition
3423in the ?: operator is a boolean expression the omitted value will
3424be always 1. Often the user expects it to be a value computed
3425inside the conditional expression instead.
3426
3427This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3428
3429@item -Wsequence-point
3430@opindex Wsequence-point
3431@opindex Wno-sequence-point
3432Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
3433of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
3434
3435The C and C++ standards defines the order in which expressions in a C/C++
3436program are evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent
3437a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those
3438executed before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These
3439occur after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part
3440of a larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
3441@code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
3442function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
3443expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
3444Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
3445evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All
3446these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
3447since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
3448with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
3449are called is not specified.  However, the standards committee have
3450ruled that function calls do not overlap.
3451
3452It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
3453values of objects take effect.  Programs whose behavior depends on this
3454have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that ``Between
3455the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored
3456value modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression.
3457Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to determine the value
3458to be stored.''.  If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
3459particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
3460
3461Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
3462= b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}.  Some more complicated cases are not
3463diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
3464result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
3465this sort of problem in programs.
3466
3467The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
3468over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
3469Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
3470definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
3471@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/readings.html}.
3472
3473This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} for C and C++.
3474
3475@item -Wreturn-type
3476@opindex Wreturn-type
3477@opindex Wno-return-type
3478Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults
3479to @code{int}.  Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
3480return-value in a function whose return-type is not @code{void}
3481(falling off the end of the function body is considered returning
3482without a value), and about a @code{return} statement with an
3483expression in a function whose return-type is @code{void}.
3484
3485For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
3486message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified.  The only
3487exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
3488
3489This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3490
3491@item -Wswitch
3492@opindex Wswitch
3493@opindex Wno-switch
3494Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3495and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3496enumeration.  (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
3497warning.)  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3498provoke warnings when this option is used (even if there is a
3499@code{default} label).
3500This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3501
3502@item -Wswitch-default
3503@opindex Wswitch-default
3504@opindex Wno-switch-default
3505Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
3506case.
3507
3508@item -Wswitch-enum
3509@opindex Wswitch-enum
3510@opindex Wno-switch-enum
3511Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3512and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3513enumeration.  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3514provoke warnings when this option is used.  The only difference
3515between @option{-Wswitch} and this option is that this option gives a
3516warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a
3517@code{default} label.
3518
3519@item -Wsync-nand @r{(C and C++ only)}
3520@opindex Wsync-nand
3521@opindex Wno-sync-nand
3522Warn when @code{__sync_fetch_and_nand} and @code{__sync_nand_and_fetch}
3523built-in functions are used.  These functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.
3524
3525@item -Wtrigraphs
3526@opindex Wtrigraphs
3527@opindex Wno-trigraphs
3528Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
3529the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
3530This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3531
3532@item -Wunused-but-set-parameter
3533@opindex Wunused-but-set-parameter
3534@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-parameter
3535Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3536(aside from its declaration).
3537
3538To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3539(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3540
3541This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused} together with
3542@option{-Wextra}.
3543
3544@item -Wunused-but-set-variable
3545@opindex Wunused-but-set-variable
3546@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-variable
3547Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3548(aside from its declaration).
3549This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3550
3551To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3552(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3553
3554This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused}, which is enabled
3555by @option{-Wall}.
3556
3557@item -Wunused-function
3558@opindex Wunused-function
3559@opindex Wno-unused-function
3560Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
3561non-inline static function is unused.
3562This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3563
3564@item -Wunused-label
3565@opindex Wunused-label
3566@opindex Wno-unused-label
3567Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
3568This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3569
3570To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3571(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3572
3573@item -Wunused-local-typedefs @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
3574@opindex Wunused-local-typedefs
3575Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.
3576
3577@item -Wunused-parameter
3578@opindex Wunused-parameter
3579@opindex Wno-unused-parameter
3580Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
3581
3582To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3583(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3584
3585@item -Wno-unused-result
3586@opindex Wunused-result
3587@opindex Wno-unused-result
3588Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute
3589@code{warn_unused_result} (@pxref{Function Attributes}) does not use
3590its return value. The default is @option{-Wunused-result}.
3591
3592@item -Wunused-variable
3593@opindex Wunused-variable
3594@opindex Wno-unused-variable
3595Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
3596aside from its declaration.
3597This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3598
3599To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3600(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3601
3602@item -Wunused-value
3603@opindex Wunused-value
3604@opindex Wno-unused-value
3605Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not
3606used. To suppress this warning cast the unused expression to
3607@samp{void}. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand
3608side of a comma expression that contains no side effects. For example,
3609an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} will cause a warning, while
3610@samp{x[(void)i,j]} will not.
3611
3612This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3613
3614@item -Wunused
3615@opindex Wunused
3616@opindex Wno-unused
3617All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
3618
3619In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
3620either specify @samp{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @samp{-Wall} implies
3621@samp{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
3622
3623@item -Wuninitialized
3624@opindex Wuninitialized
3625@opindex Wno-uninitialized
3626Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized
3627or if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call. In C++,
3628warn if a non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member
3629appears in a class without constructors.
3630
3631If you want to warn about code that uses the uninitialized value of the
3632variable in its own initializer, use the @option{-Winit-self} option.
3633
3634These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
3635elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
3636variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole.  They do
3637not occur for variables or elements declared @code{volatile}.  Because
3638these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or elements
3639for which there are warnings will depend on the precise optimization
3640options and version of GCC used.
3641
3642Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
3643to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
3644computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
3645are printed.
3646
3647@item -Wmaybe-uninitialized
3648@opindex Wmaybe-uninitialized
3649@opindex Wno-maybe-uninitialized
3650For an automatic variable, if there exists a path from the function
3651entry to a use of the variable that is initialized, but there exist
3652some other paths the variable is not initialized, the compiler will
3653emit a warning if it can not prove the uninitialized paths do not
3654happen at run time. These warnings are made optional because GCC is
3655not smart enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
3656despite appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how
3657this can happen:
3658
3659@smallexample
3660@group
3661@{
3662  int x;
3663  switch (y)
3664    @{
3665    case 1: x = 1;
3666      break;
3667    case 2: x = 4;
3668      break;
3669    case 3: x = 5;
3670    @}
3671  foo (x);
3672@}
3673@end group
3674@end smallexample
3675
3676@noindent
3677If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
3678always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. To suppress the
3679warning, the user needs to provide a default case with assert(0) or
3680similar code.
3681
3682@cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
3683This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
3684changed by a call to @code{longjmp}.  These warnings as well are possible
3685only in optimizing compilation.
3686
3687The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}.  It cannot know
3688where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
3689call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may get a warning
3690even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
3691in fact be called at the place that would cause a problem.
3692
3693Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
3694you use that never return as @code{noreturn}.  @xref{Function
3695Attributes}.
3696
3697This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wextra}.
3698
3699@item -Wunknown-pragmas
3700@opindex Wunknown-pragmas
3701@opindex Wno-unknown-pragmas
3702@cindex warning for unknown pragmas
3703@cindex unknown pragmas, warning
3704@cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
3705Warn when a @code{#pragma} directive is encountered that is not understood by
3706GCC@.  If this command-line option is used, warnings will even be issued
3707for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not the case if
3708the warnings were only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command-line option.
3709
3710@item -Wno-pragmas
3711@opindex Wno-pragmas
3712@opindex Wpragmas
3713Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
3714invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas.  See also
3715@samp{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
3716
3717@item -Wstrict-aliasing
3718@opindex Wstrict-aliasing
3719@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing
3720This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3721It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3722compiler is using for optimization.  The warning does not catch all
3723cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls.  It is
3724included in @option{-Wall}.
3725It is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=3}
3726
3727@item -Wstrict-aliasing=n
3728@opindex Wstrict-aliasing=n
3729@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing=n
3730This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3731It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3732compiler is using for optimization.
3733Higher levels correspond to higher accuracy (fewer false positives).
3734Higher levels also correspond to more effort, similar to the way -O works.
3735@option{-Wstrict-aliasing} is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=n},
3736with n=3.
3737
3738Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.
3739Possibly useful when higher levels
3740do not warn but -fstrict-aliasing still breaks the code, as it has very few
3741false negatives.  However, it has many false positives.
3742Warns for all pointer conversions between possibly incompatible types,
3743even if never dereferenced.  Runs in the front end only.
3744
3745Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise.
3746May still have many false positives (not as many as level 1 though),
3747and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).
3748Unlike level 1, it only warns when an address is taken.  Warns about
3749incomplete types.  Runs in the front end only.
3750
3751Level 3 (default for @option{-Wstrict-aliasing}):
3752Should have very few false positives and few false
3753negatives.  Slightly slower than levels 1 or 2 when optimization is enabled.
3754Takes care of the common pun+dereference pattern in the front end:
3755@code{*(int*)&some_float}.
3756If optimization is enabled, it also runs in the back end, where it deals
3757with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to information.
3758Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.
3759Does not warn about incomplete types.
3760
3761@item -Wstrict-overflow
3762@itemx -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n}
3763@opindex Wstrict-overflow
3764@opindex Wno-strict-overflow
3765This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is active.
3766It warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
3767assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it does not
3768warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only warns
3769about cases where the compiler implements some optimization.  Thus
3770this warning depends on the optimization level.
3771
3772An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
3773perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such that
3774overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
3775easily give a false positive: a warning about code that is not
3776actually a problem.  To help focus on important issues, several
3777warning levels are defined.  No warnings are issued for the use of
3778undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop
3779will require, in particular when determining whether a loop will be
3780executed at all.
3781
3782@table @gcctabopt
3783@item -Wstrict-overflow=1
3784Warn about cases that are both questionable and easy to avoid.  For
3785example: @code{x + 1 > x}; with @option{-fstrict-overflow}, the
3786compiler will simplify this to @code{1}.  This level of
3787@option{-Wstrict-overflow} is enabled by @option{-Wall}; higher levels
3788are not, and must be explicitly requested.
3789
3790@item -Wstrict-overflow=2
3791Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a
3792constant.  For example: @code{abs (x) >= 0}.  This can only be
3793simplified when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is in effect, because
3794@code{abs (INT_MIN)} overflows to @code{INT_MIN}, which is less than
3795zero.  @option{-Wstrict-overflow} (with no level) is the same as
3796@option{-Wstrict-overflow=2}.
3797
3798@item -Wstrict-overflow=3
3799Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For
3800example: @code{x + 1 > 1} will be simplified to @code{x > 0}.
3801
3802@item -Wstrict-overflow=4
3803Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.
3804For example: @code{(x * 10) / 5} will be simplified to @code{x * 2}.
3805
3806@item -Wstrict-overflow=5
3807Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude of a
3808constant involved in a comparison.  For example: @code{x + 2 > y} will
3809be simplified to @code{x + 1 >= y}.  This is reported only at the
3810highest warning level because this simplification applies to many
3811comparisons, so this warning level will give a very large number of
3812false positives.
3813@end table
3814
3815@item -Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]}
3816@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=
3817@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=
3818Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The
3819attributes currently supported are listed below.
3820
3821@table @gcctabopt
3822@item -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3823@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=const
3824@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3825@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3826@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=pure
3827@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=const
3828@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=const
3829@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3830@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=noreturn
3831
3832Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes
3833@code{pure}, @code{const} or @code{noreturn}.  The compiler only warns for
3834functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of @code{pure} and
3835@code{const}) if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function
3836returns normally if it doesn't contain an infinite loop nor returns abnormally
3837by throwing, calling @code{abort()} or trapping.  This analysis requires option
3838@option{-fipa-pure-const}, which is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
3839higher.  Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.
3840@end table
3841
3842@item -Warray-bounds
3843@opindex Wno-array-bounds
3844@opindex Warray-bounds
3845This option is only active when @option{-ftree-vrp} is active
3846(default for @option{-O2} and above). It warns about subscripts to arrays
3847that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3848
3849@item -Wno-div-by-zero
3850@opindex Wno-div-by-zero
3851@opindex Wdiv-by-zero
3852Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero.  Floating-point
3853division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
3854obtaining infinities and NaNs.
3855
3856@item -Wsystem-headers
3857@opindex Wsystem-headers
3858@opindex Wno-system-headers
3859@cindex warnings from system headers
3860@cindex system headers, warnings from
3861Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
3862Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
3863that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
3864compiler output harder to read.  Using this command-line option tells
3865GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
3866code.  However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
3867option will @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
3868headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
3869
3870@item -Wtrampolines
3871@opindex Wtrampolines
3872@opindex Wno-trampolines
3873 Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.
3874
3875 A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
3876 time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
3877 is used to call the nested function indirectly.  For some targets, it
3878 is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment.  But,
3879 for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
3880 to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.
3881
3882@item -Wfloat-equal
3883@opindex Wfloat-equal
3884@opindex Wno-float-equal
3885Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.
3886
3887The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
3888programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
3889infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this, then you need
3890to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
3891likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
3892when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
3893different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
3894would check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
3895this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
3896probably mistaken.
3897
3898@item -Wtraditional @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3899@opindex Wtraditional
3900@opindex Wno-traditional
3901Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
3902ISO C@.  Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
3903equivalent, and/or problematic constructs that should be avoided.
3904
3905@itemize @bullet
3906@item
3907Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
3908In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
3909but does not in ISO C@.
3910
3911@item
3912In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
3913Traditional preprocessors would only consider a line to be a directive
3914if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line.  Therefore
3915@option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
3916understands but would ignore because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
3917first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives like
3918@samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them.  Some
3919traditional implementations would not recognize @samp{#elif}, so it
3920suggests avoiding it altogether.
3921
3922@item
3923A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
3924
3925@item
3926The unary plus operator.
3927
3928@item
3929The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating-point
3930constant suffixes.  (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
3931constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
3932headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
3933Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
3934warnings, however GCC's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
3935avoid warning in these cases.
3936
3937@item
3938A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
3939the block.
3940
3941@item
3942A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
3943
3944@item
3945A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
3946This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
3947
3948@item
3949The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
3950signedness from its traditional type.  This warning is only issued if
3951the base of the constant is ten.  I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
3952typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
3953
3954@item
3955Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
3956
3957@item
3958Initialization of automatic aggregates.
3959
3960@item
3961Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate
3962namespace for labels.
3963
3964@item
3965Initialization of unions.  If the initializer is zero, the warning is
3966omitted.  This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
3967user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
3968initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
3969traditional C case.
3970
3971@item
3972Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values and vice
3973versa.  The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
3974C would cause serious problems.  This is a subset of the possible
3975conversion warnings, for the full set use @option{-Wtraditional-conversion}.
3976
3977@item
3978Use of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is
3979@emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
3980because these ISO C features will appear in your code when using
3981libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
3982@code{VPARAMS}.  This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
3983because that feature is already a GCC extension and thus not relevant to
3984traditional C compatibility.
3985@end itemize
3986
3987@item -Wtraditional-conversion @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3988@opindex Wtraditional-conversion
3989@opindex Wno-traditional-conversion
3990Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
3991would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype.  This
3992includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
3993conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed-point argument
3994except when the same as the default promotion.
3995
3996@item -Wdeclaration-after-statement @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3997@opindex Wdeclaration-after-statement
3998@opindex Wno-declaration-after-statement
3999Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This
4000construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is by default
4001allowed in GCC@.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not supported by
4002GCC versions before GCC 3.0.  @xref{Mixed Declarations}.
4003
4004@item -Wundef
4005@opindex Wundef
4006@opindex Wno-undef
4007Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
4008
4009@item -Wno-endif-labels
4010@opindex Wno-endif-labels
4011@opindex Wendif-labels
4012Do not warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
4013
4014@item -Wshadow
4015@opindex Wshadow
4016@opindex Wno-shadow
4017Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows another variable,
4018parameter, type, or class member (in C++), or whenever a built-in function
4019is shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler will not warn if a local variable
4020shadows a struct/class/enum, but will warn if it shadows an explicit typedef.
4021
4022@item -Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4023@opindex Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4024@opindex Wlarger-than-@var{len}
4025Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
4026
4027@item -Wframe-larger-than=@var{len}
4028@opindex Wframe-larger-than
4029Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than @var{len} bytes.
4030The computation done to determine the stack frame size is approximate
4031and not conservative.
4032The actual requirements may be somewhat greater than @var{len}
4033even if you do not get a warning.  In addition, any space allocated
4034via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related constructs
4035is not included by the compiler when determining
4036whether or not to issue a warning.
4037
4038@item -Wno-free-nonheap-object
4039@opindex Wno-free-nonheap-object
4040@opindex Wfree-nonheap-object
4041Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not allocated
4042on the heap.
4043
4044@item -Wstack-usage=@var{len}
4045@opindex Wstack-usage
4046Warn if the stack usage of a function might be larger than @var{len} bytes.
4047The computation done to determine the stack usage is conservative.
4048Any space allocated via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related
4049constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or not to
4050issue a warning.
4051
4052The message is in keeping with the output of @option{-fstack-usage}.
4053
4054@itemize
4055@item
4056If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified amount, it's:
4057
4058@smallexample
4059  warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes
4060@end smallexample
4061@item
4062If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:
4063
4064@smallexample
4065  warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes
4066@end smallexample
4067@item
4068If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:
4069
4070@smallexample
4071  warning: stack usage might be unbounded
4072@end smallexample
4073@end itemize
4074
4075@item -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4076@opindex Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4077@opindex Wno-unsafe-loop-optimizations
4078Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler could not
4079assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices.  With
4080@option{-funsafe-loop-optimizations} warn if the compiler made
4081such assumptions.
4082
4083@item -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @r{(MinGW targets only)}
4084@opindex Wno-pedantic-ms-format
4085@opindex Wpedantic-ms-format
4086Disables the warnings about non-ISO @code{printf} / @code{scanf} format
4087width specifiers @code{I32}, @code{I64}, and @code{I} used on Windows targets
4088depending on the MS runtime, when you are using the options @option{-Wformat}
4089and @option{-pedantic} without gnu-extensions.
4090
4091@item -Wpointer-arith
4092@opindex Wpointer-arith
4093@opindex Wno-pointer-arith
4094Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
4095of @code{void}.  GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
4096convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
4097to functions.  In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves
4098@code{NULL}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-pedantic}.
4099
4100@item -Wtype-limits
4101@opindex Wtype-limits
4102@opindex Wno-type-limits
4103Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited
4104range of the data type, but do not warn for constant expressions.  For
4105example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared against zero with
4106@samp{<} or @samp{>=}.  This warning is also enabled by
4107@option{-Wextra}.
4108
4109@item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4110@opindex Wbad-function-cast
4111@opindex Wno-bad-function-cast
4112Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
4113For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
4114
4115@item -Wc++-compat @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4116Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of
4117ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.@: request for implicit conversion from
4118@code{void *} to a pointer to non-@code{void} type.
4119
4120@item -Wc++11-compat @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4121Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++ 1998
4122and ISO C++ 2011, e.g., identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are keywords
4123in ISO C++ 2011.  This warning turns on @option{-Wnarrowing} and is
4124enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4125
4126@item -Wcast-qual
4127@opindex Wcast-qual
4128@opindex Wno-cast-qual
4129Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
4130the target type.  For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
4131to an ordinary @code{char *}.
4132
4133Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an
4134unsafe way.  For example, casting @code{char **} to @code{const char **}
4135is unsafe, as in this example:
4136
4137@smallexample
4138  /* p is char ** value.  */
4139  const char **q = (const char **) p;
4140  /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK.  */
4141  *q = "string";
4142  /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory.  */
4143  **p = 'b';
4144@end smallexample
4145
4146@item -Wcast-align
4147@opindex Wcast-align
4148@opindex Wno-cast-align
4149Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
4150target is increased.  For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
4151an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
4152two- or four-byte boundaries.
4153
4154@item -Wwrite-strings
4155@opindex Wwrite-strings
4156@opindex Wno-write-strings
4157When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
4158char[@var{length}]} so that copying the address of one into a
4159non-@code{const} @code{char *} pointer will get a warning.  These
4160warnings will help you find at compile time code that can try to write
4161into a string constant, but only if you have been very careful about
4162using @code{const} in declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it will
4163just be a nuisance. This is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request
4164these warnings.
4165
4166When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from string
4167literals to @code{char *}.  This warning is enabled by default for C++
4168programs.
4169
4170@item -Wclobbered
4171@opindex Wclobbered
4172@opindex Wno-clobbered
4173Warn for variables that might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or
4174@samp{vfork}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4175
4176@item -Wconversion
4177@opindex Wconversion
4178@opindex Wno-conversion
4179Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This includes
4180conversions between real and integer, like @code{abs (x)} when
4181@code{x} is @code{double}; conversions between signed and unsigned,
4182like @code{unsigned ui = -1}; and conversions to smaller types, like
4183@code{sqrtf (M_PI)}. Do not warn for explicit casts like @code{abs
4184((int) x)} and @code{ui = (unsigned) -1}, or if the value is not
4185changed by the conversion like in @code{abs (2.0)}.  Warnings about
4186conversions between signed and unsigned integers can be disabled by
4187using @option{-Wno-sign-conversion}.
4188
4189For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined
4190conversions; and conversions that will never use a type conversion
4191operator: conversions to @code{void}, the same type, a base class or a
4192reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and
4193unsigned integers are disabled by default in C++ unless
4194@option{-Wsign-conversion} is explicitly enabled.
4195
4196@item -Wno-conversion-null @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4197@opindex Wconversion-null
4198@opindex Wno-conversion-null
4199Do not warn for conversions between @code{NULL} and non-pointer
4200types. @option{-Wconversion-null} is enabled by default.
4201
4202@item -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4203@opindex Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant
4204@opindex Wno-zero-as-null-pointer-constant
4205Warn when a literal '0' is used as null pointer constant.  This can
4206be useful to facilitate the conversion to @code{nullptr} in C++11.
4207
4208@item -Wempty-body
4209@opindex Wempty-body
4210@opindex Wno-empty-body
4211Warn if an empty body occurs in an @samp{if}, @samp{else} or @samp{do
4212while} statement.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4213
4214@item -Wenum-compare
4215@opindex Wenum-compare
4216@opindex Wno-enum-compare
4217Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated types.
4218In C++ enumeral mismatches in conditional expressions are also
4219diagnosed and the warning is enabled by default.  In C this warning is
4220enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4221
4222@item -Wjump-misses-init @r{(C, Objective-C only)}
4223@opindex Wjump-misses-init
4224@opindex Wno-jump-misses-init
4225Warn if a @code{goto} statement or a @code{switch} statement jumps
4226forward across the initialization of a variable, or jumps backward to a
4227label after the variable has been initialized.  This only warns about
4228variables that are initialized when they are declared.  This warning is
4229only supported for C and Objective-C; in C++ this sort of branch is an
4230error in any case.
4231
4232@option{-Wjump-misses-init} is included in @option{-Wc++-compat}.  It
4233can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-jump-misses-init} option.
4234
4235@item -Wsign-compare
4236@opindex Wsign-compare
4237@opindex Wno-sign-compare
4238@cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
4239@cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
4240@cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
4241Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
4242an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
4243This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
4244of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
4245
4246@item -Wsign-conversion
4247@opindex Wsign-conversion
4248@opindex Wno-sign-conversion
4249Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer
4250value, like assigning a signed integer expression to an unsigned
4251integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
4252option is enabled also by @option{-Wconversion}.
4253
4254@item -Waddress
4255@opindex Waddress
4256@opindex Wno-address
4257Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
4258the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
4259@code{void func(void); if (func)}, and comparisons against the memory
4260address of a string literal, such as @code{if (x == "abc")}.  Such
4261uses typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
4262always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
4263indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
4264call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
4265behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that the
4266programmer intended to use @code{strcmp}.  This warning is enabled by
4267@option{-Wall}.
4268
4269@item -Wlogical-op
4270@opindex Wlogical-op
4271@opindex Wno-logical-op
4272Warn about suspicious uses of logical operators in expressions.
4273This includes using logical operators in contexts where a
4274bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.
4275
4276@item -Waggregate-return
4277@opindex Waggregate-return
4278@opindex Wno-aggregate-return
4279Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
4280called.  (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
4281a warning.)
4282
4283@item -Wno-attributes
4284@opindex Wno-attributes
4285@opindex Wattributes
4286Do not warn if an unexpected @code{__attribute__} is used, such as
4287unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
4288etc.  This will not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
4289attributes.
4290
4291@item -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4292@opindex Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4293@opindex Wbuiltin-macro-redefined
4294Do not warn if certain built-in macros are redefined.  This suppresses
4295warnings for redefinition of @code{__TIMESTAMP__}, @code{__TIME__},
4296@code{__DATE__}, @code{__FILE__}, and @code{__BASE_FILE__}.
4297
4298@item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4299@opindex Wstrict-prototypes
4300@opindex Wno-strict-prototypes
4301Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
4302argument types.  (An old-style function definition is permitted without
4303a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the argument
4304types.)
4305
4306@item -Wold-style-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4307@opindex Wold-style-declaration
4308@opindex Wno-old-style-declaration
4309Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a
4310declaration. For example, warn if storage-class specifiers like
4311@code{static} are not the first things in a declaration.  This warning
4312is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4313
4314@item -Wold-style-definition @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4315@opindex Wold-style-definition
4316@opindex Wno-old-style-definition
4317Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given
4318even if there is a previous prototype.
4319
4320@item -Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4321@opindex Wmissing-parameter-type
4322@opindex Wno-missing-parameter-type
4323A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
4324functions:
4325
4326@smallexample
4327void foo(bar) @{ @}
4328@end smallexample
4329
4330This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4331
4332@item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4333@opindex Wmissing-prototypes
4334@opindex Wno-missing-prototypes
4335Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
4336declaration.  This warning is issued even if the definition itself
4337provides a prototype.  The aim is to detect global functions that
4338are not declared in header files.
4339
4340@item -Wmissing-declarations
4341@opindex Wmissing-declarations
4342@opindex Wno-missing-declarations
4343Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
4344Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
4345Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
4346header files.  In C++, no warnings are issued for function templates,
4347or for inline functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.
4348
4349@item -Wmissing-field-initializers
4350@opindex Wmissing-field-initializers
4351@opindex Wno-missing-field-initializers
4352@opindex W
4353@opindex Wextra
4354@opindex Wno-extra
4355Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing.  For
4356example, the following code would cause such a warning, because
4357@code{x.h} is implicitly zero:
4358
4359@smallexample
4360struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4361struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
4362@end smallexample
4363
4364This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the following
4365modification would not trigger a warning:
4366
4367@smallexample
4368struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4369struct s x = @{ .f = 3, .g = 4 @};
4370@end smallexample
4371
4372This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other @option{-Wextra}
4373warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers}.
4374
4375@item -Wmissing-format-attribute
4376@opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
4377@opindex Wno-missing-format-attribute
4378@opindex Wformat
4379@opindex Wno-format
4380Warn about function pointers that might be candidates for @code{format}
4381attributes.  Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.
4382GCC will guess that function pointers with @code{format} attributes that
4383are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return
4384statements should have a corresponding @code{format} attribute in the
4385resulting type.  I.e.@: the left-hand side of the assignment or
4386initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type
4387of the containing function respectively should also have a @code{format}
4388attribute to avoid the warning.
4389
4390GCC will also warn about function definitions that might be
4391candidates for @code{format} attributes.  Again, these are only
4392possible candidates.  GCC will guess that @code{format} attributes
4393might be appropriate for any function that calls a function like
4394@code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
4395case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
4396appropriate may not be detected.
4397
4398@item -Wno-multichar
4399@opindex Wno-multichar
4400@opindex Wmultichar
4401Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
4402Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
4403implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
4404
4405@item -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
4406@opindex Wnormalized=
4407@cindex NFC
4408@cindex NFKC
4409@cindex character set, input normalization
4410In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
4411different sequences of characters.  However, sometimes when characters
4412outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
4413different character sequences that look the same.  To avoid confusion,
4414the ISO 10646 standard sets out some @dfn{normalization rules} which
4415when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are turned into
4416the same sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers that
4417have not been normalized; this option controls that warning.
4418
4419There are four levels of warning supported by GCC.  The default is
4420@option{-Wnormalized=nfc}, which warns about any identifier that is
4421not in the ISO 10646 ``C'' normalized form, @dfn{NFC}.  NFC is the
4422recommended form for most uses.
4423
4424Unfortunately, there are some characters allowed in identifiers by
4425ISO C and ISO C++ that, when turned into NFC, are not allowed in
4426identifiers.  That is, there's no way to use these symbols in portable
4427ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC@.
4428@option{-Wnormalized=id} suppresses the warning for these characters.
4429It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
4430this, which is why this option is not the default.
4431
4432You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
4433@option{-Wnormalized=none}.  You would only want to do this if you
4434were using some other normalization scheme (like ``D''), because
4435otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.
4436
4437Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look identical
4438in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once formatting has
4439been applied.  For instance @code{\u207F}, ``SUPERSCRIPT LATIN SMALL
4440LETTER N'', will display just like a regular @code{n} that has been
4441placed in a superscript.  ISO 10646 defines the @dfn{NFKC}
4442normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
4443well, and GCC will warn if your code is not in NFKC if you use
4444@option{-Wnormalized=nfkc}.  This warning is comparable to warning
4445about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
4446confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
4447useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment is
4448unable to be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
4449
4450@item -Wno-deprecated
4451@opindex Wno-deprecated
4452@opindex Wdeprecated
4453Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.  @xref{Deprecated Features}.
4454
4455@item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
4456@opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
4457@opindex Wdeprecated-declarations
4458Do not warn about uses of functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}),
4459variables (@pxref{Variable Attributes}), and types (@pxref{Type
4460Attributes}) marked as deprecated by using the @code{deprecated}
4461attribute.
4462
4463@item -Wno-overflow
4464@opindex Wno-overflow
4465@opindex Woverflow
4466Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
4467
4468@item -Woverride-init @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4469@opindex Woverride-init
4470@opindex Wno-override-init
4471@opindex W
4472@opindex Wextra
4473@opindex Wno-extra
4474Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when
4475using designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
4476Initializers}).
4477
4478This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other
4479@option{-Wextra} warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra
4480-Wno-override-init}.
4481
4482@item -Wpacked
4483@opindex Wpacked
4484@opindex Wno-packed
4485Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
4486attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
4487Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit.  For
4488instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
4489will be misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
4490have the packed attribute:
4491
4492@smallexample
4493@group
4494struct foo @{
4495  int x;
4496  char a, b, c, d;
4497@} __attribute__((packed));
4498struct bar @{
4499  char z;
4500  struct foo f;
4501@};
4502@end group
4503@end smallexample
4504
4505@item -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4506@opindex Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4507@opindex Wno-packed-bitfield-compat
4508The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the @code{packed} attribute
4509on bit-fields of type @code{char}.  This has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but
4510the change can lead to differences in the structure layout.  GCC
4511informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.
4512For example there is no longer a 4-bit padding between field @code{a}
4513and @code{b} in this structure:
4514
4515@smallexample
4516struct foo
4517@{
4518  char a:4;
4519  char b:8;
4520@} __attribute__ ((packed));
4521@end smallexample
4522
4523This warning is enabled by default.  Use
4524@option{-Wno-packed-bitfield-compat} to disable this warning.
4525
4526@item -Wpadded
4527@opindex Wpadded
4528@opindex Wno-padded
4529Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
4530of the structure or to align the whole structure.  Sometimes when this
4531happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
4532reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
4533
4534@item -Wredundant-decls
4535@opindex Wredundant-decls
4536@opindex Wno-redundant-decls
4537Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
4538cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
4539
4540@item -Wnested-externs @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4541@opindex Wnested-externs
4542@opindex Wno-nested-externs
4543Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
4544
4545@item -Winline
4546@opindex Winline
4547@opindex Wno-inline
4548Warn if a function can not be inlined and it was declared as inline.
4549Even with this option, the compiler will not warn about failures to
4550inline functions declared in system headers.
4551
4552The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not
4553to inline a function.  For example, the compiler takes into account
4554the size of the function being inlined and the amount of inlining
4555that has already been done in the current function.  Therefore,
4556seemingly insignificant changes in the source program can cause the
4557warnings produced by @option{-Winline} to appear or disappear.
4558
4559@item -Wno-invalid-offsetof @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4560@opindex Wno-invalid-offsetof
4561@opindex Winvalid-offsetof
4562Suppress warnings from applying the @samp{offsetof} macro to a non-POD
4563type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++ standard, applying @samp{offsetof}
4564to a non-POD type is undefined.  In existing C++ implementations,
4565however, @samp{offsetof} typically gives meaningful results even when
4566applied to certain kinds of non-POD types. (Such as a simple
4567@samp{struct} that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a
4568constructor.)  This flag is for users who are aware that they are
4569writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore the
4570warning about it.
4571
4572The restrictions on @samp{offsetof} may be relaxed in a future version
4573of the C++ standard.
4574
4575@item -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4576@opindex Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4577@opindex Wint-to-pointer-cast
4578Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
4579different size. In C++, casting to a pointer type of smaller size is
4580an error. @option{Wint-to-pointer-cast} is enabled by default.
4581
4582
4583@item -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4584@opindex Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
4585@opindex Wpointer-to-int-cast
4586Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
4587different size.
4588
4589@item -Winvalid-pch
4590@opindex Winvalid-pch
4591@opindex Wno-invalid-pch
4592Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
4593the search path but can't be used.
4594
4595@item -Wlong-long
4596@opindex Wlong-long
4597@opindex Wno-long-long
4598Warn if @samp{long long} type is used.  This is enabled by either
4599@option{-pedantic} or @option{-Wtraditional} in ISO C90 and C++98
4600modes.  To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}.
4601
4602@item -Wvariadic-macros
4603@opindex Wvariadic-macros
4604@opindex Wno-variadic-macros
4605Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU
4606alternate syntax when in pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.
4607To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-variadic-macros}.
4608
4609@item -Wvector-operation-performance
4610@opindex Wvector-operation-performance
4611@opindex Wno-vector-operation-performance
4612Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities of the
4613architecture.  Mainly useful for the performance tuning.
4614Vector operation can be implemented @code{piecewise}, which means that the
4615scalar operation is performed on every vector element;
4616@code{in parallel}, which means that the vector operation is implemented
4617using scalars of wider type, which normally is more performance efficient;
4618and @code{as a single scalar}, which means that vector fits into a
4619scalar type.
4620
4621@item -Wvla
4622@opindex Wvla
4623@opindex Wno-vla
4624Warn if variable length array is used in the code.
4625@option{-Wno-vla} will prevent the @option{-pedantic} warning of
4626the variable length array.
4627
4628@item -Wvolatile-register-var
4629@opindex Wvolatile-register-var
4630@opindex Wno-volatile-register-var
4631Warn if a register variable is declared volatile.  The volatile
4632modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate reads
4633and/or writes to register variables.  This warning is enabled by
4634@option{-Wall}.
4635
4636@item -Wdisabled-optimization
4637@opindex Wdisabled-optimization
4638@opindex Wno-disabled-optimization
4639Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does
4640not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
4641merely indicates that GCC's optimizers were unable to handle the code
4642effectively.  Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
4643complex; GCC will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization
4644itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
4645
4646@item -Wpointer-sign @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4647@opindex Wpointer-sign
4648@opindex Wno-pointer-sign
4649Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different signedness.
4650This option is only supported for C and Objective-C@.  It is implied by
4651@option{-Wall} and by @option{-pedantic}, which can be disabled with
4652@option{-Wno-pointer-sign}.
4653
4654@item -Wstack-protector
4655@opindex Wstack-protector
4656@opindex Wno-stack-protector
4657This option is only active when @option{-fstack-protector} is active.  It
4658warns about functions that will not be protected against stack smashing.
4659
4660@item -Wno-mudflap
4661@opindex Wno-mudflap
4662Suppress warnings about constructs that cannot be instrumented by
4663@option{-fmudflap}.
4664
4665@item -Woverlength-strings
4666@opindex Woverlength-strings
4667@opindex Wno-overlength-strings
4668Warn about string constants that are longer than the ``minimum
4669maximum'' length specified in the C standard.  Modern compilers
4670generally allow string constants that are much longer than the
4671standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
4672using longer strings.
4673
4674The limit applies @emph{after} string constant concatenation, and does
4675not count the trailing NUL@.  In C90, the limit was 509 characters; in
4676C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
4677minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++@.
4678
4679This option is implied by @option{-pedantic}, and can be disabled with
4680@option{-Wno-overlength-strings}.
4681
4682@item -Wunsuffixed-float-constants @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4683@opindex Wunsuffixed-float-constants
4684
4685GCC will issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have
4686a suffix.  When used together with @option{-Wsystem-headers} it will
4687warn about such constants in system header files.  This can be useful
4688when preparing code to use with the @code{FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64} pragma
4689from the decimal floating-point extension to C99.
4690@end table
4691
4692@node Debugging Options
4693@section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
4694@cindex options, debugging
4695@cindex debugging information options
4696
4697GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
4698either your program or GCC:
4699
4700@table @gcctabopt
4701@item -g
4702@opindex g
4703Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
4704(stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF 2)@.  GDB can work with this debugging
4705information.
4706
4707On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
4708debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
4709makes debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other debuggers
4710crash or
4711refuse to read the program.  If you want to control for certain whether
4712to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
4713@option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms} (see below).
4714
4715GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
4716@option{-O}.  The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
4717produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
4718at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
4719some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
4720results or their values were already at hand; some statements may
4721execute in different places because they were moved out of loops.
4722
4723Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This makes
4724it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
4725
4726The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
4727capability for more than one debugging format.
4728
4729@item -ggdb
4730@opindex ggdb
4731Produce debugging information for use by GDB@.  This means to use the
4732most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
4733if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
4734possible.
4735
4736@item -gstabs
4737@opindex gstabs
4738Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4739without GDB extensions.  This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
4740systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
4741produces stabs debugging output that is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
4742On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
4743
4744@item -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4745@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4746Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4747for only symbols that are actually used.
4748
4749@item -femit-class-debug-always
4750Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one
4751object file, emit it in all object files using the class.  This option
4752should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle the way GCC
4753normally emits debugging information for classes because using this
4754option will increase the size of debugging information by as much as a
4755factor of two.
4756
4757@item -fno-debug-types-section
4758@opindex fno-debug-types-section
4759@opindex fdebug-types-section
4760By default when using DWARF v4 or higher type DIEs will be put into
4761their own .debug_types section instead of making them part of the
4762.debug_info section.  It is more efficient to put them in a separate
4763comdat sections since the linker will then be able to remove duplicates.
4764But not all DWARF consumers support .debug_types sections yet.
4765
4766@item -gstabs+
4767@opindex gstabs+
4768Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4769using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4770use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4771refuse to read the program.
4772
4773@item -gcoff
4774@opindex gcoff
4775Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
4776This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
4777System V Release 4.
4778
4779@item -gxcoff
4780@opindex gxcoff
4781Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
4782This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
4783
4784@item -gxcoff+
4785@opindex gxcoff+
4786Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
4787using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4788use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4789refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
4790assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
4791
4792@item -gdwarf-@var{version}
4793@opindex gdwarf-@var{version}
4794Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is
4795supported).  This is the format used by DBX on IRIX 6.  The value
4796of @var{version} may be either 2, 3 or 4; the default version is 2.
4797
4798Note that with DWARF version 2 some ports require, and will always
4799use, some non-conflicting DWARF 3 extensions in the unwind tables.
4800
4801Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}
4802for maximum benefit.
4803
4804@item -grecord-gcc-switches
4805@opindex grecord-gcc-switches
4806This switch causes the command-line options used to invoke the
4807compiler that may affect code generation to be appended to the
4808DW_AT_producer attribute in DWARF debugging information.  The options
4809are concatenated with spaces separating them from each other and from
4810the compiler version.  See also @option{-frecord-gcc-switches} for another
4811way of storing compiler options into the object file.
4812
4813@item -gno-record-gcc-switches
4814@opindex gno-record-gcc-switches
4815Disallow appending command-line options to the DW_AT_producer attribute
4816in DWARF debugging information.  This is the default.
4817
4818@item -gstrict-dwarf
4819@opindex gstrict-dwarf
4820Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected
4821with @option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.  On most targets using non-conflicting
4822DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.
4823
4824@item -gno-strict-dwarf
4825@opindex gno-strict-dwarf
4826Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with
4827@option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.
4828
4829@item -gvms
4830@opindex gvms
4831Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is
4832supported).  This is the format used by DEBUG on VMS systems.
4833
4834@item -g@var{level}
4835@itemx -ggdb@var{level}
4836@itemx -gstabs@var{level}
4837@itemx -gcoff@var{level}
4838@itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
4839@itemx -gvms@var{level}
4840Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
4841much information.  The default level is 2.
4842
4843Level 0 produces no debug information at all.  Thus, @option{-g0} negates
4844@option{-g}.
4845
4846Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
4847parts of the program that you don't plan to debug.  This includes
4848descriptions of functions and external variables, but no information
4849about local variables and no line numbers.
4850
4851Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
4852present in the program.  Some debuggers support macro expansion when
4853you use @option{-g3}.
4854
4855@option{-gdwarf-2} does not accept a concatenated debug level, because
4856GCC used to support an option @option{-gdwarf} that meant to generate
4857debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very
4858different from version 2), and it would have been too confusing.  That
4859debug format is long obsolete, but the option cannot be changed now.
4860Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}} option to change the
4861debug level for DWARF.
4862
4863@item -gtoggle
4864@opindex gtoggle
4865Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option would have
4866generated it, or turn it on at level 2 otherwise.  The position of this
4867argument in the command line does not matter, it takes effect after all
4868other options are processed, and it does so only once, no matter how
4869many times it is given.  This is mainly intended to be used with
4870@option{-fcompare-debug}.
4871
4872@item -fdump-final-insns@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
4873@opindex fdump-final-insns
4874Dump the final internal representation (RTL) to @var{file}.  If the
4875optional argument is omitted (or if @var{file} is @code{.}), the name
4876of the dump file will be determined by appending @code{.gkd} to the
4877compilation output file name.
4878
4879@item -fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}
4880@opindex fcompare-debug
4881@opindex fno-compare-debug
4882If no error occurs during compilation, run the compiler a second time,
4883adding @var{opts} and @option{-fcompare-debug-second} to the arguments
4884passed to the second compilation.  Dump the final internal
4885representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.
4886
4887If the equal sign is omitted, the default @option{-gtoggle} is used.
4888
4889The environment variable @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG}, if defined, non-empty
4890and nonzero, implicitly enables @option{-fcompare-debug}.  If
4891@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is defined to a string starting with a dash,
4892then it is used for @var{opts}, otherwise the default @option{-gtoggle}
4893is used.
4894
4895@option{-fcompare-debug=}, with the equal sign but without @var{opts},
4896is equivalent to @option{-fno-compare-debug}, which disables the dumping
4897of the final representation and the second compilation, preventing even
4898@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} from taking effect.
4899
4900To verify full coverage during @option{-fcompare-debug} testing, set
4901@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to say @samp{-fcompare-debug-not-overridden},
4902which GCC will reject as an invalid option in any actual compilation
4903(rather than preprocessing, assembly or linking).  To get just a
4904warning, setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to @samp{-w%n-fcompare-debug
4905not overridden} will do.
4906
4907@item -fcompare-debug-second
4908@opindex fcompare-debug-second
4909This option is implicitly passed to the compiler for the second
4910compilation requested by @option{-fcompare-debug}, along with options to
4911silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
4912side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output.  Dump
4913files and preserved temporary files are renamed so as to contain the
4914@code{.gk} additional extension during the second compilation, to avoid
4915overwriting those generated by the first.
4916
4917When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the
4918@emph{first} compilation to be skipped, which makes it useful for little
4919other than debugging the compiler proper.
4920
4921@item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4922@opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4923Compress DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
4924information about each symbol.  This option only makes sense when
4925generating DWARF2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
4926
4927@item -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
4928Emit debug information for struct-like types
4929only when the base name of the compilation source file
4930matches the base name of file in which the struct was defined.
4931
4932This option substantially reduces the size of debugging information,
4933but at significant potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4934See @option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} for a less aggressive option.
4935See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4936
4937This option works only with DWARF 2.
4938
4939@item -femit-struct-debug-reduced
4940Emit debug information for struct-like types
4941only when the base name of the compilation source file
4942matches the base name of file in which the type was defined,
4943unless the struct is a template or defined in a system header.
4944
4945This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information,
4946with some potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4947See @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly} for a more aggressive option.
4948See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4949
4950This option works only with DWARF 2.
4951
4952@item -femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]}
4953Specify the struct-like types
4954for which the compiler will generate debug information.
4955The intent is to reduce duplicate struct debug information
4956between different object files within the same program.
4957
4958This option is a detailed version of
4959@option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} and @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly},
4960which will serve for most needs.
4961
4962A specification has the syntax@*
4963[@samp{dir:}|@samp{ind:}][@samp{ord:}|@samp{gen:}](@samp{any}|@samp{sys}|@samp{base}|@samp{none})
4964
4965The optional first word limits the specification to
4966structs that are used directly (@samp{dir:}) or used indirectly (@samp{ind:}).
4967A struct type is used directly when it is the type of a variable, member.
4968Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.
4969That is, when use of an incomplete struct would be legal, the use is indirect.
4970An example is
4971@samp{struct one direct; struct two * indirect;}.
4972
4973The optional second word limits the specification to
4974ordinary structs (@samp{ord:}) or generic structs (@samp{gen:}).
4975Generic structs are a bit complicated to explain.
4976For C++, these are non-explicit specializations of template classes,
4977or non-template classes within the above.
4978Other programming languages have generics,
4979but @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} does not yet implement them.
4980
4981The third word specifies the source files for those
4982structs for which the compiler will emit debug information.
4983The values @samp{none} and @samp{any} have the normal meaning.
4984The value @samp{base} means that
4985the base of name of the file in which the type declaration appears
4986must match the base of the name of the main compilation file.
4987In practice, this means that
4988types declared in @file{foo.c} and @file{foo.h} will have debug information,
4989but types declared in other header will not.
4990The value @samp{sys} means those types satisfying @samp{base}
4991or declared in system or compiler headers.
4992
4993You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.
4994
4995The default is @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed=all}.
4996
4997This option works only with DWARF 2.
4998
4999@item -fno-merge-debug-strings
5000@opindex fmerge-debug-strings
5001@opindex fno-merge-debug-strings
5002Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging
5003information that are identical in different object files.  Merging is
5004not supported by all assemblers or linkers.  Merging decreases the size
5005of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing
5006link processing time.  Merging is enabled by default.
5007
5008@item -fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new}
5009@opindex fdebug-prefix-map
5010When compiling files in directory @file{@var{old}}, record debugging
5011information describing them as in @file{@var{new}} instead.
5012
5013@item -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5014@opindex fdwarf2-cfi-asm
5015@opindex fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5016Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated @code{.eh_frame} section
5017instead of using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives.
5018
5019@cindex @command{prof}
5020@item -p
5021@opindex p
5022Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5023analysis program @command{prof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5024the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5025linking.
5026
5027@cindex @command{gprof}
5028@item -pg
5029@opindex pg
5030Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5031analysis program @command{gprof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5032the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5033linking.
5034
5035@item -Q
5036@opindex Q
5037Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
5038print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
5039
5040@item -ftime-report
5041@opindex ftime-report
5042Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
5043pass when it finishes.
5044
5045@item -fmem-report
5046@opindex fmem-report
5047Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5048allocation when it finishes.
5049
5050@item -fpre-ipa-mem-report
5051@opindex fpre-ipa-mem-report
5052@item -fpost-ipa-mem-report
5053@opindex fpost-ipa-mem-report
5054Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5055allocation before or after interprocedural optimization.
5056
5057@item -fstack-usage
5058@opindex fstack-usage
5059Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program, on a
5060per-function basis.  The filename for the dump is made by appending
5061@file{.su} to the @var{auxname}.  @var{auxname} is generated from the name of
5062the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable,
5063otherwise it is the basename of the source file.  An entry is made up
5064of three fields:
5065
5066@itemize
5067@item
5068The name of the function.
5069@item
5070A number of bytes.
5071@item
5072One or more qualifiers: @code{static}, @code{dynamic}, @code{bounded}.
5073@end itemize
5074
5075The qualifier @code{static} means that the function manipulates the stack
5076statically: a fixed number of bytes are allocated for the frame on function
5077entry and released on function exit; no stack adjustments are otherwise made
5078in the function.  The second field is this fixed number of bytes.
5079
5080The qualifier @code{dynamic} means that the function manipulates the stack
5081dynamically: in addition to the static allocation described above, stack
5082adjustments are made in the body of the function, for example to push/pop
5083arguments around function calls.  If the qualifier @code{bounded} is also
5084present, the amount of these adjustments is bounded at compile time and
5085the second field is an upper bound of the total amount of stack used by
5086the function.  If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
5087not bounded at compile time and the second field only represents the
5088bounded part.
5089
5090@item -fprofile-arcs
5091@opindex fprofile-arcs
5092Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented.  During
5093execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
5094executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the compiled
5095program exits it saves this data to a file called
5096@file{@var{auxname}.gcda} for each source file.  The data may be used for
5097profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
5098test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}).  Each object file's
5099@var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5100explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
5101the basename of the source file.  In both cases any suffix is removed
5102(e.g.@: @file{foo.gcda} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
5103@file{dir/foo.gcda} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
5104@xref{Cross-profiling}.
5105
5106@cindex @command{gcov}
5107@item --coverage
5108@opindex coverage
5109
5110This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage
5111analysis.  The option is a synonym for @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5112@option{-ftest-coverage} (when compiling) and @option{-lgcov} (when
5113linking).  See the documentation for those options for more details.
5114
5115@itemize
5116
5117@item
5118Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
5119and code generation options.  For test coverage analysis, use the
5120additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option.  You do not need to profile
5121every source file in a program.
5122
5123@item
5124Link your object files with @option{-lgcov} or @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5125(the latter implies the former).
5126
5127@item
5128Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
5129information.  This may be repeated any number of times.  You can run
5130concurrent instances of your program, and provided that the file system
5131supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated.  Also
5132@code{fork} calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting
5133will not happen).
5134
5135@item
5136For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
5137the same optimization and code generation options plus
5138@option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
5139Control Optimization}).
5140
5141@item
5142For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
5143information from the @file{.gcno} and @file{.gcda} files.  Refer to the
5144@command{gcov} documentation for further information.
5145
5146@end itemize
5147
5148With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
5149creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
5150Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
5151compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
5152executed.  When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
5153instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
5154block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
5155
5156@need 2000
5157@item -ftest-coverage
5158@opindex ftest-coverage
5159Produce a notes file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
5160(@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
5161show program coverage.  Each source file's note file is called
5162@file{@var{auxname}.gcno}.  Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
5163above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
5164generate test coverage data.  Coverage data will match the source files
5165more closely, if you do not optimize.
5166
5167@item -fdbg-cnt-list
5168@opindex fdbg-cnt-list
5169Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.
5170
5171
5172@item -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list}
5173@opindex fdbg-cnt
5174Set the internal debug counter upper bound.  @var{counter-value-list}
5175is a comma-separated list of @var{name}:@var{value} pairs
5176which sets the upper bound of each debug counter @var{name} to @var{value}.
5177All debug counters have the initial upper bound of @var{UINT_MAX},
5178thus dbg_cnt() returns true always unless the upper bound is set by this option.
5179e.g. With -fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0
5180dbg_cnt(dce) will return true only for first 10 invocations
5181
5182@itemx -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}
5183@itemx -fdisable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5184@opindex fdisable-
5185@opindex fenable-
5186
5187This is a set of debugging options that are used to explicitly disable/enable
5188optimization passes. For compiler users, regular options for enabling/disabling
5189passes should be used instead.
5190
5191@itemize
5192
5193@item -fdisable-ipa-@var{pass}
5194Disable ipa pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5195statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5196appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5197
5198@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}
5199@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5200Disable rtl pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5201statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5202appended with a sequential number starting from 1.  @var{range-list} is a comma
5203seperated list of function ranges or assembler names.  Each range is a number
5204pair seperated by a colon.  The range is inclusive in both ends.  If the range
5205is trivial, the number pair can be simplified as a single number.  If the
5206function's cgraph node's @var{uid} is falling within one of the specified ranges,
5207the @var{pass} is disabled for that function.  The @var{uid} is shown in the
5208function header of a dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using
5209option @option{-fdump-passes}.
5210
5211@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}
5212@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5213Disable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description of
5214option arguments.
5215
5216@item -fenable-ipa-@var{pass}
5217Enable ipa pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5218statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5219appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5220
5221@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}
5222@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5223Enable rtl pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for option argument
5224description and examples.
5225
5226@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}
5227@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5228Enable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description
5229of option arguments.
5230
5231@smallexample
5232
5233# disable ccp1 for all functions
5234   -fdisable-tree-ccp1
5235# disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
5236   -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
5237# disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
5238# [300,400], and [400,1000]
5239# disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
5240   -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
5241# disable early inlining
5242   -fdisable-tree-einline
5243# disable ipa inlining
5244   -fdisable-ipa-inline
5245# enable tree full unroll
5246   -fenable-tree-unroll
5247
5248@end smallexample
5249
5250@end itemize
5251
5252@item -d@var{letters}
5253@itemx -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
5254@opindex d
5255Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
5256@var{letters}.  This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
5257compiler.  The file names for most of the dumps are made by appending
5258a pass number and a word to the @var{dumpname}, and the files are
5259created in the directory of the output file.  Note that the pass
5260number is computed statically as passes get registered into the pass
5261manager.  Thus the numbering is not related to the dynamic order of
5262execution of passes.  In particular, a pass installed by a plugin
5263could have a number over 200 even if it executed quite early.
5264@var{dumpname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5265explicitly specified and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the
5266basename of the source file. These switches may have different effects
5267when @option{-E} is used for preprocessing.
5268
5269Debug dumps can be enabled with a @option{-fdump-rtl} switch or some
5270@option{-d} option @var{letters}.  Here are the possible
5271letters for use in @var{pass} and @var{letters}, and their meanings:
5272
5273@table @gcctabopt
5274
5275@item -fdump-rtl-alignments
5276@opindex fdump-rtl-alignments
5277Dump after branch alignments have been computed.
5278
5279@item -fdump-rtl-asmcons
5280@opindex fdump-rtl-asmcons
5281Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.
5282
5283@item -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5284@opindex fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5285Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery.  This pass is only run on
5286architectures that have auto inc or auto dec instructions.
5287
5288@item -fdump-rtl-barriers
5289@opindex fdump-rtl-barriers
5290Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.
5291
5292@item -fdump-rtl-bbpart
5293@opindex fdump-rtl-bbpart
5294Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.
5295
5296@item -fdump-rtl-bbro
5297@opindex fdump-rtl-bbro
5298Dump after block reordering.
5299
5300@item -fdump-rtl-btl1
5301@itemx -fdump-rtl-btl2
5302@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5303@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5304@option{-fdump-rtl-btl1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-btl2} enable dumping
5305after the two branch
5306target load optimization passes.
5307
5308@item -fdump-rtl-bypass
5309@opindex fdump-rtl-bypass
5310Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.
5311
5312@item -fdump-rtl-combine
5313@opindex fdump-rtl-combine
5314Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.
5315
5316@item -fdump-rtl-compgotos
5317@opindex fdump-rtl-compgotos
5318Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.
5319
5320@item -fdump-rtl-ce1
5321@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce2
5322@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce3
5323@opindex fdump-rtl-ce1
5324@opindex fdump-rtl-ce2
5325@opindex fdump-rtl-ce3
5326@option{-fdump-rtl-ce1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-ce2}, and
5327@option{-fdump-rtl-ce3} enable dumping after the three
5328if conversion passes.
5329
5330@itemx -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5331@opindex fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5332Dump after hard register copy propagation.
5333
5334@itemx -fdump-rtl-csa
5335@opindex fdump-rtl-csa
5336Dump after combining stack adjustments.
5337
5338@item -fdump-rtl-cse1
5339@itemx -fdump-rtl-cse2
5340@opindex fdump-rtl-cse1
5341@opindex fdump-rtl-cse2
5342@option{-fdump-rtl-cse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-cse2} enable dumping after
5343the two common sub-expression elimination passes.
5344
5345@itemx -fdump-rtl-dce
5346@opindex fdump-rtl-dce
5347Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.
5348
5349@itemx -fdump-rtl-dbr
5350@opindex fdump-rtl-dbr
5351Dump after delayed branch scheduling.
5352
5353@item -fdump-rtl-dce1
5354@itemx -fdump-rtl-dce2
5355@opindex fdump-rtl-dce1
5356@opindex fdump-rtl-dce2
5357@option{-fdump-rtl-dce1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-dce2} enable dumping after
5358the two dead store elimination passes.
5359
5360@item -fdump-rtl-eh
5361@opindex fdump-rtl-eh
5362Dump after finalization of EH handling code.
5363
5364@item -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5365@opindex fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5366Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.
5367
5368@item -fdump-rtl-expand
5369@opindex fdump-rtl-expand
5370Dump after RTL generation.
5371
5372@item -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5373@itemx -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5374@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5375@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5376@option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop2} enable
5377dumping after the two forward propagation passes.
5378
5379@item -fdump-rtl-gcse1
5380@itemx -fdump-rtl-gcse2
5381@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse1
5382@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse2
5383@option{-fdump-rtl-gcse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse2} enable dumping
5384after global common subexpression elimination.
5385
5386@item -fdump-rtl-init-regs
5387@opindex fdump-rtl-init-regs
5388Dump after the initialization of the registers.
5389
5390@item -fdump-rtl-initvals
5391@opindex fdump-rtl-initvals
5392Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.
5393
5394@itemx -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5395@opindex fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5396Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.
5397
5398@item -fdump-rtl-ira
5399@opindex fdump-rtl-ira
5400Dump after iterated register allocation.
5401
5402@item -fdump-rtl-jump
5403@opindex fdump-rtl-jump
5404Dump after the second jump optimization.
5405
5406@item -fdump-rtl-loop2
5407@opindex fdump-rtl-loop2
5408@option{-fdump-rtl-loop2} enables dumping after the rtl
5409loop optimization passes.
5410
5411@item -fdump-rtl-mach
5412@opindex fdump-rtl-mach
5413Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that
5414pass exists.
5415
5416@item -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5417@opindex fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5418Dump after removing redundant mode switches.
5419
5420@item -fdump-rtl-rnreg
5421@opindex fdump-rtl-rnreg
5422Dump after register renumbering.
5423
5424@itemx -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5425@opindex fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5426Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.
5427
5428@item -fdump-rtl-peephole2
5429@opindex fdump-rtl-peephole2
5430Dump after the peephole pass.
5431
5432@item -fdump-rtl-postreload
5433@opindex fdump-rtl-postreload
5434Dump after post-reload optimizations.
5435
5436@itemx -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5437@opindex fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5438Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.
5439
5440@item -fdump-rtl-regmove
5441@opindex fdump-rtl-regmove
5442Dump after the register move pass.
5443
5444@item -fdump-rtl-sched1
5445@itemx -fdump-rtl-sched2
5446@opindex fdump-rtl-sched1
5447@opindex fdump-rtl-sched2
5448@option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} enable dumping
5449after the basic block scheduling passes.
5450
5451@item -fdump-rtl-see
5452@opindex fdump-rtl-see
5453Dump after sign extension elimination.
5454
5455@item -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5456@opindex fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5457Dump after common sequence discovery.
5458
5459@item -fdump-rtl-shorten
5460@opindex fdump-rtl-shorten
5461Dump after shortening branches.
5462
5463@item -fdump-rtl-sibling
5464@opindex fdump-rtl-sibling
5465Dump after sibling call optimizations.
5466
5467@item -fdump-rtl-split1
5468@itemx -fdump-rtl-split2
5469@itemx -fdump-rtl-split3
5470@itemx -fdump-rtl-split4
5471@itemx -fdump-rtl-split5
5472@opindex fdump-rtl-split1
5473@opindex fdump-rtl-split2
5474@opindex fdump-rtl-split3
5475@opindex fdump-rtl-split4
5476@opindex fdump-rtl-split5
5477@option{-fdump-rtl-split1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split2},
5478@option{-fdump-rtl-split3}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split4} and
5479@option{-fdump-rtl-split5} enable dumping after five rounds of
5480instruction splitting.
5481
5482@item -fdump-rtl-sms
5483@opindex fdump-rtl-sms
5484Dump after modulo scheduling.  This pass is only run on some
5485architectures.
5486
5487@item -fdump-rtl-stack
5488@opindex fdump-rtl-stack
5489Dump after conversion from GCC's "flat register file" registers to the
5490x87's stack-like registers.  This pass is only run on x86 variants.
5491
5492@item -fdump-rtl-subreg1
5493@itemx -fdump-rtl-subreg2
5494@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg1
5495@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg2
5496@option{-fdump-rtl-subreg1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-subreg2} enable dumping after
5497the two subreg expansion passes.
5498
5499@item -fdump-rtl-unshare
5500@opindex fdump-rtl-unshare
5501Dump after all rtl has been unshared.
5502
5503@item -fdump-rtl-vartrack
5504@opindex fdump-rtl-vartrack
5505Dump after variable tracking.
5506
5507@item -fdump-rtl-vregs
5508@opindex fdump-rtl-vregs
5509Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.
5510
5511@item -fdump-rtl-web
5512@opindex fdump-rtl-web
5513Dump after live range splitting.
5514
5515@item -fdump-rtl-regclass
5516@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5517@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5518@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinit
5519@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinish
5520@opindex fdump-rtl-regclass
5521@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5522@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5523@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinit
5524@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinish
5525These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.
5526
5527@item -da
5528@itemx -fdump-rtl-all
5529@opindex da
5530@opindex fdump-rtl-all
5531Produce all the dumps listed above.
5532
5533@item -dA
5534@opindex dA
5535Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
5536
5537@item -dD
5538@opindex dD
5539Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
5540normal output.
5541
5542@item -dH
5543@opindex dH
5544Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
5545
5546@item -dp
5547@opindex dp
5548Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
5549pattern and alternative was used.  The length of each instruction is
5550also printed.
5551
5552@item -dP
5553@opindex dP
5554Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
5555Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
5556
5557@item -dv
5558@opindex dv
5559For each of the other indicated dump files (@option{-fdump-rtl-@var{pass}}),
5560dump a representation of the control flow graph suitable for viewing with VCG
5561to @file{@var{file}.@var{pass}.vcg}.
5562
5563@item -dx
5564@opindex dx
5565Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used
5566with @option{-fdump-rtl-expand}.
5567@end table
5568
5569@item -fdump-noaddr
5570@opindex fdump-noaddr
5571When doing debugging dumps, suppress address output.  This makes it more
5572feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with
5573different compiler binaries and/or different
5574text / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
5575
5576@item -fdump-unnumbered
5577@opindex fdump-unnumbered
5578When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address output.
5579This makes it more feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler
5580invocations with different options, in particular with and without
5581@option{-g}.
5582
5583@item -fdump-unnumbered-links
5584@opindex fdump-unnumbered-links
5585When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress
5586instruction numbers for the links to the previous and next instructions
5587in a sequence.
5588
5589@item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C++ only)}
5590@itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5591@opindex fdump-translation-unit
5592Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
5593unit to a file.  The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
5594source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as the
5595output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
5596controls the details of the dump as described for the
5597@option{-fdump-tree} options.
5598
5599@item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
5600@itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5601@opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
5602Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
5603table layout to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5604@file{.class} to the source file name, and the file is created in the
5605same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form
5606is used, @var{options} controls the details of the dump as described
5607for the @option{-fdump-tree} options.
5608
5609@item -fdump-ipa-@var{switch}
5610@opindex fdump-ipa
5611Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
5612language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5613switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is created
5614in the same directory as the output file.  The following dumps are
5615possible:
5616
5617@table @samp
5618@item all
5619Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.
5620
5621@item cgraph
5622Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal,
5623and inlining decisions.
5624
5625@item inline
5626Dump after function inlining.
5627
5628@end table
5629
5630@item -fdump-passes
5631@opindex fdump-passes
5632Dump the list of optimization passes that are turned on and off by
5633the current command-line options.
5634
5635@item -fdump-statistics-@var{option}
5636@opindex fdump-statistics
5637Enable and control dumping of pass statistics in a separate file.  The
5638file name is generated by appending a suffix ending in
5639@samp{.statistics} to the source file name, and the file is created in
5640the same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{option}}
5641form is used, @samp{-stats} will cause counters to be summed over the
5642whole compilation unit while @samp{-details} will dump every event as
5643the passes generate them.  The default with no option is to sum
5644counters for each function compiled.
5645
5646@item -fdump-tree-@var{switch}
5647@itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}
5648@opindex fdump-tree
5649Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
5650language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5651switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
5652created in the same directory as the output file.  If the
5653@samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options} is a list of
5654@samp{-} separated options which control the details of the dump.  Not
5655all options are applicable to all dumps; those that are not
5656meaningful will be ignored.  The following options are available
5657
5658@table @samp
5659@item address
5660Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it
5661changes according to the environment and source file.  Its primary use
5662is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
5663@item asmname
5664If @code{DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME} has been set for a given decl, use that
5665in the dump instead of @code{DECL_NAME}.  Its primary use is ease of
5666use working backward from mangled names in the assembly file.
5667@item slim
5668Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
5669because that scope has been reached.  Only dump such items when they
5670are directly reachable by some other path.  When dumping pretty-printed
5671trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.
5672@item raw
5673Print a raw representation of the tree.  By default, trees are
5674pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
5675@item details
5676Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).
5677@item stats
5678Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump
5679option).
5680@item blocks
5681Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
5682@item vops
5683Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
5684@item lineno
5685Enable showing line numbers for statements.
5686@item uid
5687Enable showing the unique ID (@code{DECL_UID}) for each variable.
5688@item verbose
5689Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.
5690@item eh
5691Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.
5692@item scev
5693Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.
5694@item all
5695Turn on all options, except @option{raw}, @option{slim}, @option{verbose}
5696and @option{lineno}.
5697@end table
5698
5699The following tree dumps are possible:
5700@table @samp
5701
5702@item original
5703@opindex fdump-tree-original
5704Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
5705
5706@item optimized
5707@opindex fdump-tree-optimized
5708Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
5709
5710@item gimple
5711@opindex fdump-tree-gimple
5712Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The
5713file name is made by appending @file{.gimple} to the source file name.
5714
5715@item cfg
5716@opindex fdump-tree-cfg
5717Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is
5718made by appending @file{.cfg} to the source file name.
5719
5720@item vcg
5721@opindex fdump-tree-vcg
5722Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file in VCG format.  The
5723file name is made by appending @file{.vcg} to the source file name.  Note
5724that if the file contains more than one function, the generated file cannot
5725be used directly by VCG@.  You will need to cut and paste each function's
5726graph into its own separate file first.
5727
5728@item ch
5729@opindex fdump-tree-ch
5730Dump each function after copying loop headers.  The file name is made by
5731appending @file{.ch} to the source file name.
5732
5733@item ssa
5734@opindex fdump-tree-ssa
5735Dump SSA related information to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5736@file{.ssa} to the source file name.
5737
5738@item alias
5739@opindex fdump-tree-alias
5740Dump aliasing information for each function.  The file name is made by
5741appending @file{.alias} to the source file name.
5742
5743@item ccp
5744@opindex fdump-tree-ccp
5745Dump each function after CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5746@file{.ccp} to the source file name.
5747
5748@item storeccp
5749@opindex fdump-tree-storeccp
5750Dump each function after STORE-CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5751@file{.storeccp} to the source file name.
5752
5753@item pre
5754@opindex fdump-tree-pre
5755Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5756by appending @file{.pre} to the source file name.
5757
5758@item fre
5759@opindex fdump-tree-fre
5760Dump trees after full redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5761by appending @file{.fre} to the source file name.
5762
5763@item copyprop
5764@opindex fdump-tree-copyprop
5765Dump trees after copy propagation.  The file name is made
5766by appending @file{.copyprop} to the source file name.
5767
5768@item store_copyprop
5769@opindex fdump-tree-store_copyprop
5770Dump trees after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made
5771by appending @file{.store_copyprop} to the source file name.
5772
5773@item dce
5774@opindex fdump-tree-dce
5775Dump each function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by
5776appending @file{.dce} to the source file name.
5777
5778@item mudflap
5779@opindex fdump-tree-mudflap
5780Dump each function after adding mudflap instrumentation.  The file name is
5781made by appending @file{.mudflap} to the source file name.
5782
5783@item sra
5784@opindex fdump-tree-sra
5785Dump each function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The
5786file name is made by appending @file{.sra} to the source file name.
5787
5788@item sink
5789@opindex fdump-tree-sink
5790Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made
5791by appending @file{.sink} to the source file name.
5792
5793@item dom
5794@opindex fdump-tree-dom
5795Dump each function after applying dominator tree optimizations.  The file
5796name is made by appending @file{.dom} to the source file name.
5797
5798@item dse
5799@opindex fdump-tree-dse
5800Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file
5801name is made by appending @file{.dse} to the source file name.
5802
5803@item phiopt
5804@opindex fdump-tree-phiopt
5805Dump each function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file
5806name is made by appending @file{.phiopt} to the source file name.
5807
5808@item forwprop
5809@opindex fdump-tree-forwprop
5810Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The file
5811name is made by appending @file{.forwprop} to the source file name.
5812
5813@item copyrename
5814@opindex fdump-tree-copyrename
5815Dump each function after applying the copy rename optimization.  The file
5816name is made by appending @file{.copyrename} to the source file name.
5817
5818@item nrv
5819@opindex fdump-tree-nrv
5820Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on
5821generic trees.  The file name is made by appending @file{.nrv} to the source
5822file name.
5823
5824@item vect
5825@opindex fdump-tree-vect
5826Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name is
5827made by appending @file{.vect} to the source file name.
5828
5829@item slp
5830@opindex fdump-tree-slp
5831Dump each function after applying vectorization of basic blocks.  The file name
5832is made by appending @file{.slp} to the source file name.
5833
5834@item vrp
5835@opindex fdump-tree-vrp
5836Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name
5837is made by appending @file{.vrp} to the source file name.
5838
5839@item all
5840@opindex fdump-tree-all
5841Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.
5842@end table
5843
5844@item -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n}
5845@opindex ftree-vectorizer-verbose
5846This option controls the amount of debugging output the vectorizer prints.
5847This information is written to standard error, unless
5848@option{-fdump-tree-all} or @option{-fdump-tree-vect} is specified,
5849in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, @file{.vect}.
5850For @var{n}=0 no diagnostic information is reported.
5851If @var{n}=1 the vectorizer reports each loop that got vectorized,
5852and the total number of loops that got vectorized.
5853If @var{n}=2 the vectorizer also reports non-vectorized loops that passed
5854the first analysis phase (vect_analyze_loop_form) - i.e.@: countable,
5855inner-most, single-bb, single-entry/exit loops.  This is the same verbosity
5856level that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-stats} uses.
5857Higher verbosity levels mean either more information dumped for each
5858reported loop, or same amount of information reported for more loops:
5859if @var{n}=3, vectorizer cost model information is reported.
5860If @var{n}=4, alignment related information is added to the reports.
5861If @var{n}=5, data-references related information (e.g.@: memory dependences,
5862memory access-patterns) is added to the reports.
5863If @var{n}=6, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized inner-most loops
5864that did not pass the first analysis phase (i.e., may not be countable, or
5865may have complicated control-flow).
5866If @var{n}=7, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized nested loops.
5867If @var{n}=8, SLP related information is added to the reports.
5868For @var{n}=9, all the information the vectorizer generates during its
5869analysis and transformation is reported.  This is the same verbosity level
5870that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-details} uses.
5871
5872@item -frandom-seed=@var{string}
5873@opindex frandom-seed
5874This option provides a seed that GCC uses when it would otherwise use
5875random numbers.  It is used to generate certain symbol names
5876that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to
5877place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that
5878produce them.  You can use the @option{-frandom-seed} option to produce
5879reproducibly identical object files.
5880
5881The @var{string} should be different for every file you compile.
5882
5883@item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
5884@opindex fsched-verbose
5885On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
5886amount of debugging output the scheduler prints.  This information is
5887written to standard error, unless @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} or
5888@option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} is specified, in which case it is output
5889to the usual dump listing file, @file{.sched1} or @file{.sched2}
5890respectively.  However for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is
5891always printed to standard error.
5892
5893For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
5894same information as @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2}.
5895For @var{n} greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities,
5896detailed ready list information and unit/insn info.  For @var{n} greater
5897than two, it includes RTL at abort point, control-flow and regions info.
5898And for @var{n} over four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes
5899dependence info.
5900
5901@item -save-temps
5902@itemx -save-temps=cwd
5903@opindex save-temps
5904Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
5905in the current directory and name them based on the source file.  Thus,
5906compiling @file{foo.c} with @samp{-c -save-temps} would produce files
5907@file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}.  This creates a
5908preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
5909normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
5910
5911When used in combination with the @option{-x} command-line option,
5912@option{-save-temps} is sensible enough to avoid over writing an
5913input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.
5914The corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
5915source file before using @option{-save-temps}.
5916
5917If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source
5918files that share a common base name in different subdirectories or the
5919same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it is
5920likely that the different parallel compilers will interfere with each
5921other, and overwrite the temporary files.  For instance:
5922
5923@smallexample
5924gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
5925gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&
5926@end smallexample
5927
5928may result in @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.o} being written to
5929simultaneously by both compilers.
5930
5931@item -save-temps=obj
5932@opindex save-temps=obj
5933Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently.  If the
5934@option{-o} option is used, the temporary files are based on the
5935object file.  If the @option{-o} option is not used, the
5936@option{-save-temps=obj} switch behaves like @option{-save-temps}.
5937
5938For example:
5939
5940@smallexample
5941gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
5942gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
5943gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar
5944@end smallexample
5945
5946would create @file{foo.i}, @file{foo.s}, @file{dir/xbar.i},
5947@file{dir/xbar.s}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.i}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.s}, and
5948@file{dir2/yfoobar.o}.
5949
5950@item -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
5951@opindex time
5952Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
5953sequence.  For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
5954(plus the linker if linking is done).
5955
5956Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:
5957
5958@smallexample
5959# cc1 0.12 0.01
5960# as 0.00 0.01
5961@end smallexample
5962
5963The first number on each line is the ``user time'', that is time spent
5964executing the program itself.  The second number is ``system time'',
5965time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
5966Both numbers are in seconds.
5967
5968With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the
5969named file, and it looks like this:
5970
5971@smallexample
59720.12 0.01 cc1 @var{options}
59730.00 0.01 as @var{options}
5974@end smallexample
5975
5976The ``user time'' and the ``system time'' are moved before the program
5977name, and the options passed to the program are displayed, so that one
5978can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which options.
5979
5980@item -fvar-tracking
5981@opindex fvar-tracking
5982Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each
5983position in code.  Better debugging information is then generated
5984(if the debugging information format supports this information).
5985
5986It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (@option{-Os},
5987@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}), debugging information (@option{-g}) and
5988the debug info format supports it.
5989
5990@item -fvar-tracking-assignments
5991@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments
5992@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments
5993Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and
5994attempt to carry the annotations over throughout the compilation all the
5995way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information while
5996optimizing.  Use of @option{-gdwarf-4} is recommended along with it.
5997
5998It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case
5999annotations will be created and maintained, but discarded at the end.
6000
6001@item -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6002@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6003@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments-toggle
6004Toggle @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, in the same way that
6005@option{-gtoggle} toggles @option{-g}.
6006
6007@item -print-file-name=@var{library}
6008@opindex print-file-name
6009Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
6010would be used when linking---and don't do anything else.  With this
6011option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
6012file name.
6013
6014@item -print-multi-directory
6015@opindex print-multi-directory
6016Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
6017other switches present in the command line.  This directory is supposed
6018to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
6019
6020@item -print-multi-lib
6021@opindex print-multi-lib
6022Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
6023that enable them.  The directory name is separated from the switches by
6024@samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
6025@samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to
6026ease shell-processing.
6027
6028@item -print-multi-os-directory
6029@opindex print-multi-os-directory
6030Print the path to OS libraries for the selected
6031multilib, relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.  If OS libraries are
6032present in the @file{lib} subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is
6033usually just @file{.}, if OS libraries are present in @file{lib@var{suffix}}
6034sibling directories this prints e.g.@: @file{../lib64}, @file{../lib} or
6035@file{../lib32}, or if OS libraries are present in @file{lib/@var{subdir}}
6036subdirectories it prints e.g.@: @file{amd64}, @file{sparcv9} or @file{ev6}.
6037
6038@item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
6039@opindex print-prog-name
6040Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
6041
6042@item -print-libgcc-file-name
6043@opindex print-libgcc-file-name
6044Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
6045
6046This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6047but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}.  You can do
6048
6049@smallexample
6050gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
6051@end smallexample
6052
6053@item -print-search-dirs
6054@opindex print-search-dirs
6055Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
6056program and library directories @command{gcc} will search---and don't do anything else.
6057
6058This is useful when @command{gcc} prints the error message
6059@samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
6060To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
6061components where @command{gcc} expects to find them, or you can set the environment
6062variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
6063Don't forget the trailing @samp{/}.
6064@xref{Environment Variables}.
6065
6066@item -print-sysroot
6067@opindex print-sysroot
6068Print the target sysroot directory that will be used during
6069compilation.  This is the target sysroot specified either at configure
6070time or using the @option{--sysroot} option, possibly with an extra
6071suffix that depends on compilation options.  If no target sysroot is
6072specified, the option prints nothing.
6073
6074@item -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6075@opindex print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6076Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for
6077headers, or give an error if the compiler is not configured with such
6078a suffix---and don't do anything else.
6079
6080@item -dumpmachine
6081@opindex dumpmachine
6082Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
6083@samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
6084
6085@item -dumpversion
6086@opindex dumpversion
6087Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
6088anything else.
6089
6090@item -dumpspecs
6091@opindex dumpspecs
6092Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This
6093is used when GCC itself is being built.)  @xref{Spec Files}.
6094
6095@item -feliminate-unused-debug-types
6096@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-types
6097Normally, when producing DWARF2 output, GCC will emit debugging
6098information for all types declared in a compilation
6099unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used
6100in that compilation unit.  Sometimes this is useful, such as
6101if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is
6102not actually used in your program (but is declared).  More often,
6103however, this results in a significant amount of wasted space.
6104With this option, GCC will avoid producing debug symbol output
6105for types that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.
6106@end table
6107
6108@node Optimize Options
6109@section Options That Control Optimization
6110@cindex optimize options
6111@cindex options, optimization
6112
6113These options control various sorts of optimizations.
6114
6115Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
6116cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
6117results.  Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
6118breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
6119variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
6120function and get exactly the results you would expect from the source
6121code.
6122
6123Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
6124the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
6125and possibly the ability to debug the program.
6126
6127The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of the
6128program.  Compiling multiple files at once to a single output file mode allows
6129the compiler to use information gained from all of the files when compiling
6130each of them.
6131
6132Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only
6133optimizations that have a flag are listed in this section.
6134
6135Most optimizations are only enabled if an @option{-O} level is set on
6136the command line.  Otherwise they are disabled, even if individual
6137optimization flags are specified.
6138
6139Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different
6140set of optimizations may be enabled at each @option{-O} level than
6141those listed here.  You can invoke GCC with @samp{-Q --help=optimizers}
6142to find out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.
6143@xref{Overall Options}, for examples.
6144
6145@table @gcctabopt
6146@item -O
6147@itemx -O1
6148@opindex O
6149@opindex O1
6150Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
6151more memory for a large function.
6152
6153With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
6154time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
6155compilation time.
6156
6157@option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
6158@gccoptlist{
6159-fauto-inc-dec @gol
6160-fcompare-elim @gol
6161-fcprop-registers @gol
6162-fdce @gol
6163-fdefer-pop @gol
6164-fdelayed-branch @gol
6165-fdse @gol
6166-fguess-branch-probability @gol
6167-fif-conversion2 @gol
6168-fif-conversion @gol
6169-fipa-pure-const @gol
6170-fipa-profile @gol
6171-fipa-reference @gol
6172-fmerge-constants
6173-fsplit-wide-types @gol
6174-ftree-bit-ccp @gol
6175-ftree-builtin-call-dce @gol
6176-ftree-ccp @gol
6177-ftree-ch @gol
6178-ftree-copyrename @gol
6179-ftree-dce @gol
6180-ftree-dominator-opts @gol
6181-ftree-dse @gol
6182-ftree-forwprop @gol
6183-ftree-fre @gol
6184-ftree-phiprop @gol
6185-ftree-sra @gol
6186-ftree-pta @gol
6187-ftree-ter @gol
6188-funit-at-a-time}
6189
6190@option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
6191where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
6192
6193@item -O2
6194@opindex O2
6195Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
6196that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff.
6197As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
6198and the performance of the generated code.
6199
6200@option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}.  It
6201also turns on the following optimization flags:
6202@gccoptlist{-fthread-jumps @gol
6203-falign-functions  -falign-jumps @gol
6204-falign-loops  -falign-labels @gol
6205-fcaller-saves @gol
6206-fcrossjumping @gol
6207-fcse-follow-jumps  -fcse-skip-blocks @gol
6208-fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
6209-fdevirtualize @gol
6210-fexpensive-optimizations @gol
6211-fgcse  -fgcse-lm  @gol
6212-finline-small-functions @gol
6213-findirect-inlining @gol
6214-fipa-sra @gol
6215-foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
6216-fpartial-inlining @gol
6217-fpeephole2 @gol
6218-fregmove @gol
6219-freorder-blocks  -freorder-functions @gol
6220-frerun-cse-after-loop  @gol
6221-fsched-interblock  -fsched-spec @gol
6222-fschedule-insns  -fschedule-insns2 @gol
6223-fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
6224-ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
6225-ftree-pre @gol
6226-ftree-vrp}
6227
6228Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
6229invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
6230
6231@item -O3
6232@opindex O3
6233Optimize yet more.  @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified
6234by @option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions},
6235@option{-funswitch-loops}, @option{-fpredictive-commoning},
6236@option{-fgcse-after-reload}, @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
6237@option{-fipa-cp-clone} options.
6238
6239@item -O0
6240@opindex O0
6241Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected
6242results.  This is the default.
6243
6244@item -Os
6245@opindex Os
6246Optimize for size.  @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
6247do not typically increase code size.  It also performs further
6248optimizations designed to reduce code size.
6249
6250@option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
6251@gccoptlist{-falign-functions  -falign-jumps  -falign-loops @gol
6252-falign-labels  -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition @gol
6253-fprefetch-loop-arrays  -ftree-vect-loop-version}
6254
6255@item -Ofast
6256@opindex Ofast
6257Disregard strict standards compliance.  @option{-Ofast} enables all
6258@option{-O3} optimizations.  It also enables optimizations that are not
6259valid for all standard compliant programs.
6260It turns on @option{-ffast-math} and the Fortran-specific
6261@option{-fno-protect-parens} and @option{-fstack-arrays}.
6262
6263If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
6264the last such option is the one that is effective.
6265@end table
6266
6267Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
6268flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
6269form of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table
6270below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically will
6271use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
6272or adding it.
6273
6274The following options control specific optimizations.  They are either
6275activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are.  You
6276can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
6277optimizations to be performed is desired.
6278
6279@table @gcctabopt
6280@item -fno-default-inline
6281@opindex fno-default-inline
6282Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are
6283defined inside the class scope (C++ only).  Otherwise, when you specify
6284@w{@option{-O}}, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
6285inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add @samp{inline} in front of
6286the member function name.
6287
6288@item -fno-defer-pop
6289@opindex fno-defer-pop
6290Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
6291returns.  For machines that must pop arguments after a function call,
6292the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
6293function calls and pops them all at once.
6294
6295Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6296
6297@item -fforward-propagate
6298@opindex fforward-propagate
6299Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL@.  The pass tries to combine two
6300instructions and checks if the result can be simplified.  If loop unrolling
6301is active, two passes are performed and the second is scheduled after
6302loop unrolling.
6303
6304This option is enabled by default at optimization levels @option{-O},
6305@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6306
6307@item -ffp-contract=@var{style}
6308@opindex ffp-contract
6309@option{-ffp-contract=off} disables floating-point expression contraction.
6310@option{-ffp-contract=fast} enables floating-point expression contraction
6311such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target has
6312native support for them.
6313@option{-ffp-contract=on} enables floating-point expression contraction
6314if allowed by the language standard.  This is currently not implemented
6315and treated equal to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
6316
6317The default is @option{-ffp-contract=fast}.
6318
6319@item -fomit-frame-pointer
6320@opindex fomit-frame-pointer
6321Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
6322don't need one.  This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
6323restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
6324in many functions.  @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
6325some machines.}
6326
6327On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
6328the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
6329and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist.  The
6330machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
6331whether a target machine supports this flag.  @xref{Registers,,Register
6332Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
6333
6334Starting with GCC version 4.6, the default setting (when not optimizing for
6335size) for 32-bit Linux x86 and 32-bit Darwin x86 targets has been changed to
6336@option{-fomit-frame-pointer}.  The default can be reverted to
6337@option{-fno-omit-frame-pointer} by configuring GCC with the
6338@option{--enable-frame-pointer} configure option.
6339
6340Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6341
6342@item -foptimize-sibling-calls
6343@opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
6344Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
6345
6346Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6347
6348@item -fno-inline
6349@opindex fno-inline
6350Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with
6351the @code{always_inline} attribute.  This is the default when not
6352optimizing.
6353
6354Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them
6355with the @code{noinline} attribute.
6356
6357@item -finline-small-functions
6358@opindex finline-small-functions
6359Integrate functions into their callers when their body is smaller than expected
6360function call code (so overall size of program gets smaller).  The compiler
6361heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth integrating
6362in this way.  This inlining applies to all functions, even those not declared
6363inline.
6364
6365Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6366
6367@item -findirect-inlining
6368@opindex findirect-inlining
6369Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to be known at compile
6370time thanks to previous inlining.  This option has any effect only
6371when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
6372or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
6373
6374Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6375
6376@item -finline-functions
6377@opindex finline-functions
6378Consider all functions for inlining, even if they are not declared inline.
6379The compiler heuristically decides which functions are worth integrating
6380in this way.
6381
6382If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
6383declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
6384assembler code in its own right.
6385
6386Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
6387
6388@item -finline-functions-called-once
6389@opindex finline-functions-called-once
6390Consider all @code{static} functions called once for inlining into their
6391caller even if they are not marked @code{inline}.  If a call to a given
6392function is integrated, then the function is not output as assembler code
6393in its own right.
6394
6395Enabled at levels @option{-O1}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6396
6397@item -fearly-inlining
6398@opindex fearly-inlining
6399Inline functions marked by @code{always_inline} and functions whose body seems
6400smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
6401@option{-fprofile-generate} instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
6402makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs
6403having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
6404
6405Enabled by default.
6406
6407@item -fipa-sra
6408@opindex fipa-sra
6409Perform interprocedural scalar replacement of aggregates, removal of
6410unused parameters and replacement of parameters passed by reference
6411by parameters passed by value.
6412
6413Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6414
6415@item -finline-limit=@var{n}
6416@opindex finline-limit
6417By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag
6418allows coarse control of this limit.  @var{n} is the size of functions that
6419can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.
6420
6421Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may be
6422specified individually by using @option{--param @var{name}=@var{value}}.
6423The @option{-finline-limit=@var{n}} option sets some of these parameters
6424as follows:
6425
6426@table @gcctabopt
6427@item max-inline-insns-single
6428is set to @var{n}/2.
6429@item max-inline-insns-auto
6430is set to @var{n}/2.
6431@end table
6432
6433See below for a documentation of the individual
6434parameters controlling inlining and for the defaults of these parameters.
6435
6436@emph{Note:} there may be no value to @option{-finline-limit} that results
6437in default behavior.
6438
6439@emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
6440abstract measurement of function's size.  In no way does it represent a count
6441of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
6442release to an another.
6443
6444@item -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6445@opindex -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6446This is a more fine-grained version of @option{-fkeep-inline-functions},
6447which applies only to functions that are declared using the @code{dllexport}
6448attribute or declspec (@xref{Function Attributes,,Declaring Attributes of
6449Functions}.)
6450
6451@item -fkeep-inline-functions
6452@opindex fkeep-inline-functions
6453In C, emit @code{static} functions that are declared @code{inline}
6454into the object file, even if the function has been inlined into all
6455of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions using the
6456@code{extern inline} extension in GNU C90@.  In C++, emit any and all
6457inline functions into the object file.
6458
6459@item -fkeep-static-consts
6460@opindex fkeep-static-consts
6461Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
6462on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
6463
6464GCC enables this option by default.  If you want to force the compiler to
6465check if the variable was referenced, regardless of whether or not
6466optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
6467
6468@item -fmerge-constants
6469@opindex fmerge-constants
6470Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating-point
6471constants) across compilation units.
6472
6473This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
6474linker support it.  Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
6475behavior.
6476
6477Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6478
6479@item -fmerge-all-constants
6480@opindex fmerge-all-constants
6481Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
6482
6483This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}.  In addition to
6484@option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g.@: even constant initialized
6485arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-point
6486types.  Languages like C or C++ require each variable, including multiple
6487instances of the same variable in recursive calls, to have distinct locations,
6488so using this option will result in non-conforming
6489behavior.
6490
6491@item -fmodulo-sched
6492@opindex fmodulo-sched
6493Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling
6494pass.  This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders their
6495instructions by overlapping different iterations.
6496
6497@item -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6498@opindex fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6499Perform more aggressive SMS based modulo scheduling with register moves
6500allowed.  By setting this flag certain anti-dependences edges will be
6501deleted which will trigger the generation of reg-moves based on the
6502life-range analysis.  This option is effective only with
6503@option{-fmodulo-sched} enabled.
6504
6505@item -fno-branch-count-reg
6506@opindex fno-branch-count-reg
6507Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
6508but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
6509register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
6510This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
6511instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
6512
6513The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}.
6514
6515@item -fno-function-cse
6516@opindex fno-function-cse
6517Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
6518calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
6519
6520This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
6521that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
6522performed when this option is not used.
6523
6524The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
6525
6526@item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6527@opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6528If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
6529are initialized to zero into BSS@.  This can save space in the resulting
6530code.
6531
6532This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
6533rely on variables going to the data section.  E.g., so that the
6534resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
6535assumptions based on that.
6536
6537The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
6538
6539@item -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir
6540@opindex fmudflap
6541@opindex fmudflapth
6542@opindex fmudflapir
6543@cindex bounds checking
6544@cindex mudflap
6545For front-ends that support it (C and C++), instrument all risky
6546pointer/array dereferencing operations, some standard library
6547string/heap functions, and some other associated constructs with
6548range/validity tests.  Modules so instrumented should be immune to
6549buffer overflows, invalid heap use, and some other classes of C/C++
6550programming errors.  The instrumentation relies on a separate runtime
6551library (@file{libmudflap}), which will be linked into a program if
6552@option{-fmudflap} is given at link time.  Run-time behavior of the
6553instrumented program is controlled by the @env{MUDFLAP_OPTIONS}
6554environment variable.  See @code{env MUDFLAP_OPTIONS=-help a.out}
6555for its options.
6556
6557Use @option{-fmudflapth} instead of @option{-fmudflap} to compile and to
6558link if your program is multi-threaded.  Use @option{-fmudflapir}, in
6559addition to @option{-fmudflap} or @option{-fmudflapth}, if
6560instrumentation should ignore pointer reads.  This produces less
6561instrumentation (and therefore faster execution) and still provides
6562some protection against outright memory corrupting writes, but allows
6563erroneously read data to propagate within a program.
6564
6565@item -fthread-jumps
6566@opindex fthread-jumps
6567Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a
6568location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found.  If
6569so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
6570second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
6571the condition is known to be true or false.
6572
6573Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6574
6575@item -fsplit-wide-types
6576@opindex fsplit-wide-types
6577When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as @code{long
6578long} on a 32-bit system, split the registers apart and allocate them
6579independently.  This normally generates better code for those types,
6580but may make debugging more difficult.
6581
6582Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3},
6583@option{-Os}.
6584
6585@item -fcse-follow-jumps
6586@opindex fcse-follow-jumps
6587In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions
6588when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path.  For
6589example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
6590@code{else} clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition
6591tested is false.
6592
6593Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6594
6595@item -fcse-skip-blocks
6596@opindex fcse-skip-blocks
6597This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
6598follow jumps that conditionally skip over blocks.  When CSE
6599encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
6600@option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
6601body of the @code{if}.
6602
6603Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6604
6605@item -frerun-cse-after-loop
6606@opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
6607Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been
6608performed.
6609
6610Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6611
6612@item -fgcse
6613@opindex fgcse
6614Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
6615This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
6616
6617@emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
6618extension, you may get better run-time performance if you disable
6619the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
6620@option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
6621
6622Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6623
6624@item -fgcse-lm
6625@opindex fgcse-lm
6626When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will
6627attempt to move loads that are only killed by stores into themselves.  This
6628allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
6629the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
6630
6631Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
6632
6633@item -fgcse-sm
6634@opindex fgcse-sm
6635When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, a store motion pass is run after
6636global common subexpression elimination.  This pass will attempt to move
6637stores out of loops.  When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm},
6638loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before
6639the loop and a store after the loop.
6640
6641Not enabled at any optimization level.
6642
6643@item -fgcse-las
6644@opindex fgcse-las
6645When @option{-fgcse-las} is enabled, the global common subexpression
6646elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores to the
6647same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
6648
6649Not enabled at any optimization level.
6650
6651@item -fgcse-after-reload
6652@opindex fgcse-after-reload
6653When @option{-fgcse-after-reload} is enabled, a redundant load elimination
6654pass is performed after reload.  The purpose of this pass is to cleanup
6655redundant spilling.
6656
6657@item -funsafe-loop-optimizations
6658@opindex funsafe-loop-optimizations
6659If given, the loop optimizer will assume that loop indices do not
6660overflow, and that the loops with nontrivial exit condition are not
6661infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
6662the loop optimizer itself cannot prove that these assumptions are valid.
6663Using @option{-Wunsafe-loop-optimizations}, the compiler will warn you
6664if it finds this kind of loop.
6665
6666@item -fcrossjumping
6667@opindex fcrossjumping
6668Perform cross-jumping transformation.  This transformation unifies equivalent code and save code size.  The
6669resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
6670
6671Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6672
6673@item -fauto-inc-dec
6674@opindex fauto-inc-dec
6675Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.
6676This pass is always skipped on architectures that do not have
6677instructions to support this.  Enabled by default at @option{-O} and
6678higher on architectures that support this.
6679
6680@item -fdce
6681@opindex fdce
6682Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL@.
6683Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6684
6685@item -fdse
6686@opindex fdse
6687Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL@.
6688Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6689
6690@item -fif-conversion
6691@opindex fif-conversion
6692Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.  This
6693include use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
6694some tricks doable by standard arithmetics.  The use of conditional execution
6695on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
6696
6697Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6698
6699@item -fif-conversion2
6700@opindex fif-conversion2
6701Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
6702branch-less equivalents.
6703
6704Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6705
6706@item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6707@opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6708Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers, and that
6709no code or data element resides there.  This enables simple constant
6710folding optimizations at all optimization levels.  In addition, other
6711optimization passes in GCC use this flag to control global dataflow
6712analyses that eliminate useless checks for null pointers; these assume
6713that if a pointer is checked after it has already been dereferenced,
6714it cannot be null.
6715
6716Note however that in some environments this assumption is not true.
6717Use @option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
6718for programs that depend on that behavior.
6719
6720Some targets, especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.
6721Otherwise it is enabled at all levels: @option{-O0}, @option{-O1},
6722@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.  Passes that use the information
6723are enabled independently at different optimization levels.
6724
6725@item -fdevirtualize
6726@opindex fdevirtualize
6727Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.  This
6728is done both within a procedure and interprocedurally as part of
6729indirect inlining (@code{-findirect-inlining}) and interprocedural constant
6730propagation (@option{-fipa-cp}).
6731Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6732
6733@item -fexpensive-optimizations
6734@opindex fexpensive-optimizations
6735Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
6736
6737Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6738
6739@item -free
6740@opindex free
6741Attempt to remove redundant extension instructions.  This is especially
6742helpful for the x86-64 architecture which implicitly zero-extends in 64-bit
6743registers after writing to their lower 32-bit half.
6744
6745Enabled for x86 at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6746
6747@item -foptimize-register-move
6748@itemx -fregmove
6749@opindex foptimize-register-move
6750@opindex fregmove
6751Attempt to reassign register numbers in move instructions and as
6752operands of other simple instructions in order to maximize the amount of
6753register tying.  This is especially helpful on machines with two-operand
6754instructions.
6755
6756Note @option{-fregmove} and @option{-foptimize-register-move} are the same
6757optimization.
6758
6759Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6760
6761@item -fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm}
6762Use the specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register
6763allocator.  The @var{algorithm} argument can be @samp{priority}, which
6764specifies Chow's priority coloring, or @samp{CB}, which specifies
6765Chaitin-Briggs coloring.  Chaitin-Briggs coloring is not implemented
6766for all architectures, but for those targets that do support it, it is
6767the default because it generates better code.
6768
6769@item -fira-region=@var{region}
6770Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator.  The
6771@var{region} argument should be one of the following:
6772
6773@table @samp
6774
6775@item all
6776Use all loops as register allocation regions.
6777This can give the best results for machines with a small and/or
6778irregular register set.
6779
6780@item mixed
6781Use all loops except for loops with small register pressure
6782as the regions.  This value usually gives
6783the best results in most cases and for most architectures,
6784and is enabled by default when compiling with optimization for speed
6785(@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}).
6786
6787@item one
6788Use all functions as a single region.
6789This typically results in the smallest code size, and is enabled by default for
6790@option{-Os} or @option{-O0}.
6791
6792@end table
6793
6794@item -fira-loop-pressure
6795@opindex fira-loop-pressure
6796Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to move
6797loop invariants.  This option usually results in generation
6798of faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>= 32
6799registers), but it can slow the compiler down.
6800
6801This option is enabled at level @option{-O3} for some targets.
6802
6803@item -fno-ira-share-save-slots
6804@opindex fno-ira-share-save-slots
6805Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard
6806registers living through a call.  Each hard register gets a
6807separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
6808larger.
6809
6810@item -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6811@opindex fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6812Disable sharing of stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.  Each
6813pseudo-register that does not get a hard register gets a separate
6814stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.
6815
6816@item -fira-verbose=@var{n}
6817@opindex fira-verbose
6818Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register allocator.
6819The default value is 5.  If the value @var{n} is greater or equal to 10,
6820the dump output is sent to stderr using the same format as @var{n} minus 10.
6821
6822@item -fdelayed-branch
6823@opindex fdelayed-branch
6824If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
6825to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
6826instructions.
6827
6828Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6829
6830@item -fschedule-insns
6831@opindex fschedule-insns
6832If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
6833eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable.  This
6834helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
6835by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
6836or floating-point instruction is required.
6837
6838Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6839
6840@item -fschedule-insns2
6841@opindex fschedule-insns2
6842Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
6843instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done.  This is
6844especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
6845registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
6846
6847Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6848
6849@item -fno-sched-interblock
6850@opindex fno-sched-interblock
6851Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally
6852enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6853with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6854
6855@item -fno-sched-spec
6856@opindex fno-sched-spec
6857Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally
6858enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6859with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6860
6861@item -fsched-pressure
6862@opindex fsched-pressure
6863Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before the register
6864allocation.  This only makes sense when scheduling before register
6865allocation is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at
6866@option{-O2} or higher.  Usage of this option can improve the
6867generated code and decrease its size by preventing register pressure
6868increase above the number of available hard registers and as a
6869consequence register spills in the register allocation.
6870
6871@item -fsched-spec-load
6872@opindex fsched-spec-load
6873Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes
6874sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6875@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6876
6877@item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6878@opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6879Allow speculative motion of more load instructions.  This only makes
6880sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6881@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6882
6883@item -fsched-stalled-insns
6884@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n}
6885@opindex fsched-stalled-insns
6886Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue
6887of stalled insns into the ready list, during the second scheduling pass.
6888@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns} means that no insns will be moved
6889prematurely, @option{-fsched-stalled-insns=0} means there is no limit
6890on how many queued insns can be moved prematurely.
6891@option{-fsched-stalled-insns} without a value is equivalent to
6892@option{-fsched-stalled-insns=1}.
6893
6894@item -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6895@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n}
6896@opindex fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6897Define how many insn groups (cycles) will be examined for a dependency
6898on a stalled insn that is candidate for premature removal from the queue
6899of stalled insns.  This has an effect only during the second scheduling pass,
6900and only if @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} is used.
6901@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep} is equivalent to
6902@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0}.
6903@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep} without a value is equivalent to
6904@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1}.
6905
6906@item -fsched2-use-superblocks
6907@opindex fsched2-use-superblocks
6908When scheduling after register allocation, do use superblock scheduling
6909algorithm.  Superblock scheduling allows motion across basic block boundaries
6910resulting on faster schedules.  This option is experimental, as not all machine
6911descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable
6912results from the algorithm.
6913
6914This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
6915@option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6916
6917@item -fsched-group-heuristic
6918@opindex fsched-group-heuristic
6919Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6920the instruction that belongs to a schedule group.  This is enabled
6921by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6922or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6923
6924@item -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6925@opindex fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6926Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6927instructions on the critical path.  This is enabled by default when
6928scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6929or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6930
6931@item -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6932@opindex fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6933Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This
6934heuristic favors speculative instructions with greater dependency weakness.
6935This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6936with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2}
6937or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6938
6939@item -fsched-rank-heuristic
6940@opindex fsched-rank-heuristic
6941Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6942the instruction belonging to a basic block with greater size or frequency.
6943This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6944with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6945at @option{-O2} or higher.
6946
6947@item -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6948@opindex fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6949Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6950favors the instruction that is less dependent on the last instruction
6951scheduled.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
6952i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6953at @option{-O2} or higher.
6954
6955@item -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6956@opindex fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6957Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6958favors the instruction that has more instructions depending on it.
6959This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6960with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6961at @option{-O2} or higher.
6962
6963@item -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6964@opindex freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6965The modulo scheduling comes before the traditional scheduling, if a loop
6966was modulo scheduled we may want to prevent the later scheduling passes
6967from changing its schedule, we use this option to control that.
6968
6969@item -fselective-scheduling
6970@opindex fselective-scheduling
6971Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6972scheduling runs instead of the first scheduler pass.
6973
6974@item -fselective-scheduling2
6975@opindex fselective-scheduling2
6976Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6977scheduling runs instead of the second scheduler pass.
6978
6979@item -fsel-sched-pipelining
6980@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining
6981Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.
6982This option has no effect until one of @option{-fselective-scheduling} or
6983@option{-fselective-scheduling2} is turned on.
6984
6985@item -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6986@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6987When pipelining loops during selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.
6988This option has no effect until @option{-fsel-sched-pipelining} is turned on.
6989
6990@item -fshrink-wrap
6991@opindex fshrink-wrap
6992Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need it,
6993rather than at the top of the function.  This flag is enabled by default at
6994@option{-O} and higher.
6995
6996@item -fcaller-saves
6997@opindex fcaller-saves
6998Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered by
6999function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
7000registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only when it
7001seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.
7002
7003This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
7004those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
7005
7006Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7007
7008@item -fcombine-stack-adjustments
7009@opindex fcombine-stack-adjustments
7010Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references
7011and then tries to find ways to combine them.
7012
7013Enabled by default at @option{-O1} and higher.
7014
7015@item -fconserve-stack
7016@opindex fconserve-stack
7017Attempt to minimize stack usage.  The compiler will attempt to use less
7018stack space, even if that makes the program slower.  This option
7019implies setting the @option{large-stack-frame} parameter to 100
7020and the @option{large-stack-frame-growth} parameter to 400.
7021
7022@item -ftree-reassoc
7023@opindex ftree-reassoc
7024Perform reassociation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7025at @option{-O} and higher.
7026
7027@item -ftree-pre
7028@opindex ftree-pre
7029Perform partial redundancy elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is
7030enabled by default at @option{-O2} and @option{-O3}.
7031
7032@item -ftree-forwprop
7033@opindex ftree-forwprop
7034Perform forward propagation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7035at @option{-O} and higher.
7036
7037@item -ftree-fre
7038@opindex ftree-fre
7039Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference
7040between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions
7041that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.
7042This analysis is faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
7043This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7044
7045@item -ftree-phiprop
7046@opindex ftree-phiprop
7047Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees.  This
7048pass is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7049
7050@item -ftree-copy-prop
7051@opindex ftree-copy-prop
7052Perform copy propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary
7053copy operations.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
7054higher.
7055
7056@item -fipa-pure-const
7057@opindex fipa-pure-const
7058Discover which functions are pure or constant.
7059Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7060
7061@item -fipa-reference
7062@opindex fipa-reference
7063Discover which static variables do not escape cannot escape the
7064compilation unit.
7065Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7066
7067@item -fipa-pta
7068@opindex fipa-pta
7069Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural modification
7070and reference analysis.  This option can cause excessive memory and
7071compile-time usage on large compilation units.  It is not enabled by
7072default at any optimization level.
7073
7074@item -fipa-profile
7075@opindex fipa-profile
7076Perform interprocedural profile propagation.  The functions called only from
7077cold functions are marked as cold. Also functions executed once (such as
7078@code{cold}, @code{noreturn}, static constructors or destructors) are identified. Cold
7079functions and loop less parts of functions executed once are then optimized for
7080size.
7081Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7082
7083@item -fipa-cp
7084@opindex fipa-cp
7085Perform interprocedural constant propagation.
7086This optimization analyzes the program to determine when values passed
7087to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.
7088This optimization can substantially increase performance
7089if the application has constants passed to functions.
7090This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O2}, @option{-Os} and @option{-O3}.
7091
7092@item -fipa-cp-clone
7093@opindex fipa-cp-clone
7094Perform function cloning to make interprocedural constant propagation stronger.
7095When enabled, interprocedural constant propagation will perform function cloning
7096when externally visible function can be called with constant arguments.
7097Because this optimization can create multiple copies of functions,
7098it may significantly increase code size
7099(see @option{--param ipcp-unit-growth=@var{value}}).
7100This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7101
7102@item -fipa-matrix-reorg
7103@opindex fipa-matrix-reorg
7104Perform matrix flattening and transposing.
7105Matrix flattening tries to replace an @math{m}-dimensional matrix
7106with its equivalent @math{n}-dimensional matrix, where @math{n < m}.
7107This reduces the level of indirection needed for accessing the elements
7108of the matrix. The second optimization is matrix transposing, which
7109attempts to change the order of the matrix's dimensions in order to
7110improve cache locality.
7111Both optimizations need the @option{-fwhole-program} flag.
7112Transposing is enabled only if profiling information is available.
7113
7114@item -ftree-sink
7115@opindex ftree-sink
7116Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is
7117enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7118
7119@item -ftree-bit-ccp
7120@opindex ftree-bit-ccp
7121Perform sparse conditional bit constant propagation on trees and propagate
7122pointer alignment information.
7123This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7124at @option{-O} and higher.  It requires that @option{-ftree-ccp} is enabled.
7125
7126@item -ftree-ccp
7127@opindex ftree-ccp
7128Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.  This
7129pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7130at @option{-O} and higher.
7131
7132@item -ftree-switch-conversion
7133Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to
7134initializations from a scalar array.  This flag is enabled by default
7135at @option{-O2} and higher.
7136
7137@item -ftree-tail-merge
7138Look for identical code sequences.  When found, replace one with a jump to the
7139other.  This optimization is known as tail merging or cross jumping.  This flag
7140is enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  The compilation time
7141in this pass can
7142be limited using @option{max-tail-merge-comparisons} parameter and
7143@option{max-tail-merge-iterations} parameter.
7144
7145@item -ftree-dce
7146@opindex ftree-dce
7147Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by
7148default at @option{-O} and higher.
7149
7150@item -ftree-builtin-call-dce
7151@opindex ftree-builtin-call-dce
7152Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to builtin functions
7153that may set @code{errno} but are otherwise side-effect free.  This flag is
7154enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher if @option{-Os} is not also
7155specified.
7156
7157@item -ftree-dominator-opts
7158@opindex ftree-dominator-opts
7159Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
7160propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and expression
7161simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This also
7162performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is
7163enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7164
7165@item -ftree-dse
7166@opindex ftree-dse
7167Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees.  A dead store is a store into
7168a memory location that is later overwritten by another store without
7169any intervening loads.  In this case the earlier store can be deleted.  This
7170flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7171
7172@item -ftree-ch
7173@opindex ftree-ch
7174Perform loop header copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases
7175effectiveness of code motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag
7176is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.  It is not enabled
7177for @option{-Os}, since it usually increases code size.
7178
7179@item -ftree-loop-optimize
7180@opindex ftree-loop-optimize
7181Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7182at @option{-O} and higher.
7183
7184@item -ftree-loop-linear
7185@opindex ftree-loop-linear
7186Perform loop interchange transformations on tree.  Same as
7187@option{-floop-interchange}.  To use this code transformation, GCC has
7188to be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7189enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7190
7191@item -floop-interchange
7192@opindex floop-interchange
7193Perform loop interchange transformations on loops.  Interchanging two
7194nested loops switches the inner and outer loops.  For example, given a
7195loop like:
7196@smallexample
7197DO J = 1, M
7198  DO I = 1, N
7199    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7200  ENDDO
7201ENDDO
7202@end smallexample
7203loop interchange will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7204@smallexample
7205DO I = 1, N
7206  DO J = 1, M
7207    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7208  ENDDO
7209ENDDO
7210@end smallexample
7211which can be beneficial when @code{N} is larger than the caches,
7212because in Fortran, the elements of an array are stored in memory
7213contiguously by column, and the original loop iterates over rows,
7214potentially creating at each access a cache miss.  This optimization
7215applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited to
7216Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7217with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7218Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7219
7220@item -floop-strip-mine
7221@opindex floop-strip-mine
7222Perform loop strip mining transformations on loops.  Strip mining
7223splits a loop into two nested loops.  The outer loop has strides
7224equal to the strip size and the inner loop has strides of the
7225original loop within a strip.  The strip length can be changed
7226using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example,
7227given a loop like:
7228@smallexample
7229DO I = 1, N
7230  A(I) = A(I) + C
7231ENDDO
7232@end smallexample
7233loop strip mining will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7234@smallexample
7235DO II = 1, N, 51
7236  DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7237    A(I) = A(I) + C
7238  ENDDO
7239ENDDO
7240@end smallexample
7241This optimization applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is
7242not limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to
7243be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7244enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7245
7246@item -floop-block
7247@opindex floop-block
7248Perform loop blocking transformations on loops.  Blocking strip mines
7249each loop in the loop nest such that the memory accesses of the
7250element loops fit inside caches.  The strip length can be changed
7251using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example, given
7252a loop like:
7253@smallexample
7254DO I = 1, N
7255  DO J = 1, M
7256    A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7257  ENDDO
7258ENDDO
7259@end smallexample
7260loop blocking will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7261@smallexample
7262DO II = 1, N, 51
7263  DO JJ = 1, M, 51
7264    DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7265      DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
7266        A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7267      ENDDO
7268    ENDDO
7269  ENDDO
7270ENDDO
7271@end smallexample
7272which can be beneficial when @code{M} is larger than the caches,
7273because the innermost loop will iterate over a smaller amount of data
7274which can be kept in the caches.  This optimization applies to all the
7275languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this
7276code transformation, GCC has to be configured with @option{--with-ppl}
7277and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the Graphite loop transformation
7278infrastructure.
7279
7280@item -fgraphite-identity
7281@opindex fgraphite-identity
7282Enable the identity transformation for graphite.  For every SCoP we generate
7283the polyhedral representation and transform it back to gimple.  Using
7284@option{-fgraphite-identity} we can check the costs or benefits of the
7285GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation.  Some minimal optimizations
7286are also performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and
7287dead code elimination in loops.
7288
7289@item -floop-flatten
7290@opindex floop-flatten
7291Removes the loop nesting structure: transforms the loop nest into a
7292single loop.  This transformation can be useful as an enablement
7293transform for vectorization and parallelization.  This feature
7294is experimental.
7295To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7296with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7297Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7298
7299@item -floop-parallelize-all
7300@opindex floop-parallelize-all
7301Use the Graphite data dependence analysis to identify loops that can
7302be parallelized.  Parallelize all the loops that can be analyzed to
7303not contain loop carried dependences without checking that it is
7304profitable to parallelize the loops.
7305
7306@item -fcheck-data-deps
7307@opindex fcheck-data-deps
7308Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers.  This option
7309is used for debugging the data dependence analyzers.
7310
7311@item -ftree-loop-if-convert
7312Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to
7313branch-less equivalents.  The intent is to remove control-flow from
7314the innermost loops in order to improve the ability of the
7315vectorization pass to handle these loops.  This is enabled by default
7316if vectorization is enabled.
7317
7318@item -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
7319Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.
7320This transformation can be unsafe for multi-threaded programs as it
7321transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional memory writes.
7322For example,
7323@smallexample
7324for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7325  if (cond)
7326    A[i] = expr;
7327@end smallexample
7328would be transformed to
7329@smallexample
7330for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7331  A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];
7332@end smallexample
7333potentially producing data races.
7334
7335@item -ftree-loop-distribution
7336Perform loop distribution.  This flag can improve cache performance on
7337big loop bodies and allow further loop optimizations, like
7338parallelization or vectorization, to take place.  For example, the loop
7339@smallexample
7340DO I = 1, N
7341  A(I) = B(I) + C
7342  D(I) = E(I) * F
7343ENDDO
7344@end smallexample
7345is transformed to
7346@smallexample
7347DO I = 1, N
7348   A(I) = B(I) + C
7349ENDDO
7350DO I = 1, N
7351   D(I) = E(I) * F
7352ENDDO
7353@end smallexample
7354
7355@item -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
7356Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with
7357calls to a library.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7358
7359This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to
7360memset zero.  For example, the loop
7361@smallexample
7362DO I = 1, N
7363  A(I) = 0
7364  B(I) = A(I) + I
7365ENDDO
7366@end smallexample
7367is transformed to
7368@smallexample
7369DO I = 1, N
7370   A(I) = 0
7371ENDDO
7372DO I = 1, N
7373   B(I) = A(I) + I
7374ENDDO
7375@end smallexample
7376and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.
7377
7378@item -ftree-loop-im
7379@opindex ftree-loop-im
7380Perform loop invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that
7381would be hard to handle at RTL level (function calls, operations that expand to
7382nontrivial sequences of insns).  With @option{-funswitch-loops} it also moves
7383operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we can use
7384just trivial invariantness analysis in loop unswitching.  The pass also includes
7385store motion.
7386
7387@item -ftree-loop-ivcanon
7388@opindex ftree-loop-ivcanon
7389Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in loops for which
7390determining number of iterations requires complicated analysis.  Later
7391optimizations then may determine the number easily.  Useful especially
7392in connection with unrolling.
7393
7394@item -fivopts
7395@opindex fivopts
7396Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction, induction
7397variable merging and induction variable elimination) on trees.
7398
7399@item -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
7400@opindex ftree-parallelize-loops
7401Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.
7402This is only possible for loops whose iterations are independent
7403and can be arbitrarily reordered.  The optimization is only
7404profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive,
7405rather than constrained e.g.@: by memory bandwidth.  This option
7406implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets
7407that have support for @option{-pthread}.
7408
7409@item -ftree-pta
7410@opindex ftree-pta
7411Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees.  This flag is
7412enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7413
7414@item -ftree-sra
7415@opindex ftree-sra
7416Perform scalar replacement of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure
7417references with scalars to prevent committing structures to memory too
7418early.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7419
7420@item -ftree-copyrename
7421@opindex ftree-copyrename
7422Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler
7423temporaries to other variables at copy locations, usually resulting in
7424variable names which more closely resemble the original variables.  This flag
7425is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7426
7427@item -ftree-ter
7428@opindex ftree-ter
7429Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal phase.  Single
7430use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use location with their
7431defining expression.  This results in non-GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders
7432much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL generation.  This is
7433enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7434
7435@item -ftree-vectorize
7436@opindex ftree-vectorize
7437Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7438@option{-O3}.
7439
7440@item -ftree-slp-vectorize
7441@opindex ftree-slp-vectorize
7442Perform basic block vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7443@option{-O3} and when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is enabled.
7444
7445@item -ftree-vect-loop-version
7446@opindex ftree-vect-loop-version
7447Perform loop versioning when doing loop vectorization on trees.  When a loop
7448appears to be vectorizable except that data alignment or data dependence cannot
7449be determined at compile time, then vectorized and non-vectorized versions of
7450the loop are generated along with run-time checks for alignment or dependence
7451to control which version is executed.  This option is enabled by default
7452except at level @option{-Os} where it is disabled.
7453
7454@item -fvect-cost-model
7455@opindex fvect-cost-model
7456Enable cost model for vectorization.
7457
7458@item -ftree-vrp
7459@opindex ftree-vrp
7460Perform Value Range Propagation on trees.  This is similar to the
7461constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values are
7462propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary range
7463checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is
7464enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  Null pointer check
7465elimination is only done if @option{-fdelete-null-pointer-checks} is
7466enabled.
7467
7468@item -ftracer
7469@opindex ftracer
7470Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
7471simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
7472better job.
7473
7474@item -funroll-loops
7475@opindex funroll-loops
7476Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
7477time or upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
7478@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}.  This option makes code larger,
7479and may or may not make it run faster.
7480
7481@item -funroll-all-loops
7482@opindex funroll-all-loops
7483Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
7484the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
7485@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
7486@option{-funroll-loops},
7487
7488@item -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7489@opindex fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7490Enables expressing of values of induction variables in later iterations
7491of the unrolled loop using the value in the first iteration.  This breaks
7492long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of the scheduling passes.
7493
7494Combination of @option{-fweb} and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
7495same effect.  However in cases the loop body is more complicated than
7496a single basic block, this is not reliable.  It also does not work at all
7497on some of the architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.
7498
7499This optimization is enabled by default.
7500
7501@item -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7502@opindex fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7503With this option, the compiler will create multiple copies of some
7504local variables when unrolling a loop which can result in superior code.
7505
7506@item -fpartial-inlining
7507@opindex fpartial-inlining
7508Inline parts of functions.  This option has any effect only
7509when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
7510or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
7511
7512Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
7513
7514@item -fpredictive-commoning
7515@opindex fpredictive-commoning
7516Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing computations
7517(especially memory loads and stores) performed in previous
7518iterations of loops.
7519
7520This option is enabled at level @option{-O3}.
7521
7522@item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
7523@opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
7524If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
7525memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
7526
7527This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
7528dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
7529
7530Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
7531
7532@item -fno-peephole
7533@itemx -fno-peephole2
7534@opindex fno-peephole
7535@opindex fno-peephole2
7536Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations.  The difference
7537between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
7538are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
7539other, a few use both.
7540
7541@option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
7542@option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7543
7544@item -fno-guess-branch-probability
7545@opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
7546Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
7547
7548GCC will use heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are
7549not provided by profiling feedback (@option{-fprofile-arcs}).  These
7550heuristics are based on the control flow graph.  If some branch probabilities
7551are specified by @samp{__builtin_expect}, then the heuristics will be
7552used to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph,
7553taking the @samp{__builtin_expect} info into account.  The interactions
7554between the heuristics and @samp{__builtin_expect} can be complex, and in
7555some cases, it may be useful to disable the heuristics so that the effects
7556of @samp{__builtin_expect} are easier to understand.
7557
7558The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
7559@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7560
7561@item -freorder-blocks
7562@opindex freorder-blocks
7563Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
7564taken branches and improve code locality.
7565
7566Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7567
7568@item -freorder-blocks-and-partition
7569@opindex freorder-blocks-and-partition
7570In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order
7571to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks
7572into separate sections of the assembly and .o files, to improve
7573paging and cache locality performance.
7574
7575This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
7576exception handling, for linkonce sections, for functions with a user-defined
7577section attribute and on any architecture that does not support named
7578sections.
7579
7580@item -freorder-functions
7581@opindex freorder-functions
7582Reorder functions in the object file in order to
7583improve code locality.  This is implemented by using special
7584subsections @code{.text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
7585@code{.text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions.  Reordering is done by
7586the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
7587place them in a reasonable way.
7588
7589Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option effective.  See
7590@option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
7591
7592Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7593
7594@item -fstrict-aliasing
7595@opindex fstrict-aliasing
7596Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
7597the language being compiled.  For C (and C++), this activates
7598optimizations based on the type of expressions.  In particular, an
7599object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
7600object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same.  For
7601example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
7602@code{void*} or a @code{double}.  A character type may alias any other
7603type.
7604
7605@anchor{Type-punning}Pay special attention to code like this:
7606@smallexample
7607union a_union @{
7608  int i;
7609  double d;
7610@};
7611
7612int f() @{
7613  union a_union t;
7614  t.d = 3.0;
7615  return t.i;
7616@}
7617@end smallexample
7618The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
7619recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common.  Even with
7620@option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
7621is accessed through the union type.  So, the code above will work as
7622expected.  @xref{Structures unions enumerations and bit-fields
7623implementation}.  However, this code might not:
7624@smallexample
7625int f() @{
7626  union a_union t;
7627  int* ip;
7628  t.d = 3.0;
7629  ip = &t.i;
7630  return *ip;
7631@}
7632@end smallexample
7633
7634Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer
7635and dereferencing the result has undefined behavior, even if the cast
7636uses a union type, e.g.:
7637@smallexample
7638int f() @{
7639  double d = 3.0;
7640  return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
7641@}
7642@end smallexample
7643
7644The @option{-fstrict-aliasing} option is enabled at levels
7645@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7646
7647@item -fstrict-overflow
7648@opindex fstrict-overflow
7649Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending
7650on the language being compiled.  For C (and C++) this means that
7651overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined, which
7652means that the compiler may assume that it will not happen.  This
7653permits various optimizations.  For example, the compiler will assume
7654that an expression like @code{i + 10 > i} will always be true for
7655signed @code{i}.  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is
7656undefined, as the expression is false if @code{i + 10} overflows when
7657using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is in effect any
7658attempt to determine whether an operation on signed numbers will
7659overflow must be written carefully to not actually involve overflow.
7660
7661This option also allows the compiler to assume strict pointer
7662semantics: given a pointer to an object, if adding an offset to that
7663pointer does not produce a pointer to the same object, the addition is
7664undefined.  This permits the compiler to conclude that @code{p + u >
7665p} is always true for a pointer @code{p} and unsigned integer
7666@code{u}.  This assumption is only valid because pointer wraparound is
7667undefined, as the expression is false if @code{p + u} overflows using
7668twos complement arithmetic.
7669
7670See also the @option{-fwrapv} option.  Using @option{-fwrapv} means
7671that integer signed overflow is fully defined: it wraps.  When
7672@option{-fwrapv} is used, there is no difference between
7673@option{-fstrict-overflow} and @option{-fno-strict-overflow} for
7674integers.  With @option{-fwrapv} certain types of overflow are
7675permitted.  For example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing
7676arithmetic on constants, the overflowed value can still be used with
7677@option{-fwrapv}, but not otherwise.
7678
7679The @option{-fstrict-overflow} option is enabled at levels
7680@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7681
7682@item -falign-functions
7683@itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
7684@opindex falign-functions
7685Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
7686@var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes.  For instance,
7687@option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
7688boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} would align to the next
768932-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
7690
7691@option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
7692equivalent and mean that functions will not be aligned.
7693
7694Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
7695in that case, it is rounded up.
7696
7697If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7698
7699Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7700
7701@item -falign-labels
7702@itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
7703@opindex falign-labels
7704Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
7705@var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  This option can easily
7706make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
7707branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
7708
7709@option{-fno-align-labels} and @option{-falign-labels=1} are
7710equivalent and mean that labels will not be aligned.
7711
7712If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
7713are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
7714
7715If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
7716which is very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
7717
7718Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7719
7720@item -falign-loops
7721@itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
7722@opindex falign-loops
7723Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
7724like @option{-falign-functions}.  The hope is that the loop will be
7725executed many times, which will make up for any execution of the dummy
7726operations.
7727
7728@option{-fno-align-loops} and @option{-falign-loops=1} are
7729equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7730
7731If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7732
7733Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7734
7735@item -falign-jumps
7736@itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
7737@opindex falign-jumps
7738Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
7739where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
7740bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  In this case, no dummy operations
7741need be executed.
7742
7743@option{-fno-align-jumps} and @option{-falign-jumps=1} are
7744equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7745
7746If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7747
7748Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7749
7750@item -funit-at-a-time
7751@opindex funit-at-a-time
7752This option is left for compatibility reasons. @option{-funit-at-a-time}
7753has no effect, while @option{-fno-unit-at-a-time} implies
7754@option{-fno-toplevel-reorder} and @option{-fno-section-anchors}.
7755
7756Enabled by default.
7757
7758@item -fno-toplevel-reorder
7759@opindex fno-toplevel-reorder
7760Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and @code{asm}
7761statements.  Output them in the same order that they appear in the
7762input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables
7763will not be removed.  This option is intended to support existing code
7764that relies on a particular ordering.  For new code, it is better to
7765use attributes.
7766
7767Enabled at level @option{-O0}.  When disabled explicitly, it also implies
7768@option{-fno-section-anchors}, which is otherwise enabled at @option{-O0} on some
7769targets.
7770
7771@item -fweb
7772@opindex fweb
7773Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes and assign
7774each web individual pseudo register.  This allows the register allocation pass
7775to operate on pseudos directly, but also strengthens several other optimization
7776passes, such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code remover.  It can,
7777however, make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a
7778``home register''.
7779
7780Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
7781
7782@item -fwhole-program
7783@opindex fwhole-program
7784Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole program being
7785compiled.  All public functions and variables with the exception of @code{main}
7786and those merged by attribute @code{externally_visible} become static functions
7787and in effect are optimized more aggressively by interprocedural optimizers. If @command{gold} is used as the linker plugin, @code{externally_visible} attributes are automatically added to functions (not variable yet due to a current @command{gold} issue) that are accessed outside of LTO objects according to resolution file produced by @command{gold}.  For other linkers that cannot generate resolution file, explicit @code{externally_visible} attributes are still necessary.
7788While this option is equivalent to proper use of the @code{static} keyword for
7789programs consisting of a single file, in combination with option
7790@option{-flto} this flag can be used to
7791compile many smaller scale programs since the functions and variables become
7792local for the whole combined compilation unit, not for the single source file
7793itself.
7794
7795This option implies @option{-fwhole-file} for Fortran programs.
7796
7797@item -flto[=@var{n}]
7798@opindex flto
7799This option runs the standard link-time optimizer.  When invoked
7800with source code, it generates GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal
7801representations) and writes it to special ELF sections in the object
7802file.  When the object files are linked together, all the function
7803bodies are read from these ELF sections and instantiated as if they
7804had been part of the same translation unit.
7805
7806To use the link-time optimizer, @option{-flto} needs to be specified at
7807compile time and during the final link.  For example:
7808
7809@smallexample
7810gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
7811gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
7812gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o
7813@end smallexample
7814
7815The first two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation
7816of GIMPLE into special ELF sections inside @file{foo.o} and
7817@file{bar.o}.  The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from
7818@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o}, merges the two files into a single
7819internal image, and compiles the result as usual.  Since both
7820@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o} are merged into a single image, this
7821causes all the interprocedural analyses and optimizations in GCC to
7822work across the two files as if they were a single one.  This means,
7823for example, that the inliner is able to inline functions in
7824@file{bar.o} into functions in @file{foo.o} and vice-versa.
7825
7826Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:
7827
7828@smallexample
7829gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c
7830@end smallexample
7831
7832The above generates bytecode for @file{foo.c} and @file{bar.c},
7833merges them together into a single GIMPLE representation and optimizes
7834them as usual to produce @file{myprog}.
7835
7836The only important thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time
7837optimizations the @option{-flto} flag needs to be passed to both the
7838compile and the link commands.
7839
7840To make whole program optimization effective, it is necessary to make
7841certain whole program assumptions.  The compiler needs to know
7842what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries and runtime
7843outside of the link-time optimized unit.  When supported by the linker,
7844the linker plugin (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}) passes information
7845to the compiler about used and externally visible symbols.  When
7846the linker plugin is not available, @option{-fwhole-program} should be
7847used to allow the compiler to make these assumptions, which leads
7848to more aggressive optimization decisions.
7849
7850Note that when a file is compiled with @option{-flto}, the generated
7851object file is larger than a regular object file because it
7852contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code.  This means that
7853object files with LTO information can be linked as normal object
7854files; if @option{-flto} is not passed to the linker, no
7855interprocedural optimizations are applied.
7856
7857Additionally, the optimization flags used to compile individual files
7858are not necessarily related to those used at link time.  For instance,
7859
7860@smallexample
7861gcc -c -O0 -flto foo.c
7862gcc -c -O0 -flto bar.c
7863gcc -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o
7864@end smallexample
7865
7866This produces individual object files with unoptimized assembler
7867code, but the resulting binary @file{myprog} is optimized at
7868@option{-O3}.  If, instead, the final binary is generated without
7869@option{-flto}, then @file{myprog} is not optimized.
7870
7871When producing the final binary with @option{-flto}, GCC only
7872applies link-time optimizations to those files that contain bytecode.
7873Therefore, you can mix and match object files and libraries with
7874GIMPLE bytecodes and final object code.  GCC automatically selects
7875which files to optimize in LTO mode and which files to link without
7876further processing.
7877
7878There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when
7879generating bytecodes, as they need to be used during the final link
7880stage.  Currently, the following options are saved into the GIMPLE
7881bytecode files: @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fcommon} and all the
7882@option{-m} target flags.
7883
7884At link time, these options are read in and reapplied.  Note that the
7885current implementation makes no attempt to recognize conflicting
7886values for these options.  If different files have conflicting option
7887values (e.g., one file is compiled with @option{-fPIC} and another
7888isn't), the compiler simply uses the last value read from the
7889bytecode files.  It is recommended, then, that you compile all the files
7890participating in the same link with the same options.
7891
7892If LTO encounters objects with C linkage declared with incompatible
7893types in separate translation units to be linked together (undefined
7894behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a non-fatal diagnostic may be
7895issued.  The behavior is still undefined at run time.
7896
7897Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural
7898optimizations on files written in different languages.  This requires
7899support in the language front end.  Currently, the C, C++ and
7900Fortran front ends are capable of emitting GIMPLE bytecodes, so
7901something like this should work:
7902
7903@smallexample
7904gcc -c -flto foo.c
7905g++ -c -flto bar.cc
7906gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
7907g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran
7908@end smallexample
7909
7910Notice that the final link is done with @command{g++} to get the C++
7911runtime libraries and @option{-lgfortran} is added to get the Fortran
7912runtime libraries.  In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you
7913should use the same link command options as when mixing languages in a
7914regular (non-LTO) compilation; all you need to add is @option{-flto} to
7915all the compile and link commands.
7916
7917If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a library archive, say
7918@file{libfoo.a}, it is possible to extract and use them in an LTO link if you
7919are using a linker with plugin support.  To enable this feature, use
7920the flag @option{-fuse-linker-plugin} at link time:
7921
7922@smallexample
7923gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo
7924@end smallexample
7925
7926With the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed
7927GIMPLE files from @file{libfoo.a} and passes them on to the running GCC
7928to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.
7929
7930If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not
7931enable the linker plugin, then the objects inside @file{libfoo.a}
7932are extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate
7933in the LTO optimization process.
7934
7935Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to
7936operate.  If the program does not require any symbols to be exported, it is
7937possible to combine @option{-flto} and @option{-fwhole-program} to allow
7938the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may
7939lead to improved optimization opportunities.
7940Use of @option{-fwhole-program} is not needed when linker plugin is
7941active (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}).
7942
7943The current implementation of LTO makes no
7944attempt to generate bytecode that is portable between different
7945types of hosts.  The bytecode files are versioned and there is a
7946strict version check, so bytecode files generated in one version of
7947GCC will not work with an older/newer version of GCC.
7948
7949Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging
7950information.  Combining @option{-flto} with
7951@option{-g} is currently experimental and expected to produce wrong
7952results.
7953
7954If you specify the optional @var{n}, the optimization and code
7955generation done at link time is executed in parallel using @var{n}
7956parallel jobs by utilizing an installed @command{make} program.  The
7957environment variable @env{MAKE} may be used to override the program
7958used.  The default value for @var{n} is 1.
7959
7960You can also specify @option{-flto=jobserver} to use GNU make's
7961job server mode to determine the number of parallel jobs. This
7962is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.
7963You must prepend a @samp{+} to the command recipe in the parent Makefile
7964for this to work.  This option likely only works if @env{MAKE} is
7965GNU make.
7966
7967This option is disabled by default
7968
7969@item -flto-partition=@var{alg}
7970@opindex flto-partition
7971Specify the partitioning algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.
7972The value is either @code{1to1} to specify a partitioning mirroring
7973the original source files or @code{balanced} to specify partitioning
7974into equally sized chunks (whenever possible).  Specifying @code{none}
7975as an algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely. The
7976default value is @code{balanced}.
7977
7978@item -flto-compression-level=@var{n}
7979This option specifies the level of compression used for intermediate
7980language written to LTO object files, and is only meaningful in
7981conjunction with LTO mode (@option{-flto}).  Valid
7982values are 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression).  Values
7983outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9.  If the option is not
7984given, a default balanced compression setting is used.
7985
7986@item -flto-report
7987Prints a report with internal details on the workings of the link-time
7988optimizer.  The contents of this report vary from version to version.
7989It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing object
7990files in LTO mode (via @option{-flto}).
7991
7992Disabled by default.
7993
7994@item -fuse-linker-plugin
7995Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization.  This
7996option relies on plugin support in the linker, which is available in gold
7997or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.
7998
7999This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out
8000of library archives. This improves the quality of optimization by exposing
8001more code to the link-time optimizer.  This information specifies what
8002symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object or during dynamic
8003linking).  Resulting code quality improvements on binaries (and shared
8004libraries that use hidden visibility) are similar to @code{-fwhole-program}.
8005See @option{-flto} for a description of the effect of this flag and how to
8006use it.
8007
8008This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled
8009and GCC was configured for use with
8010a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).
8011
8012@item -ffat-lto-objects
8013@opindex ffat-lto-objects
8014Fat LTO objects are object files that contain both the intermediate language
8015and the object code. This makes them usable for both LTO linking and normal
8016linking. This option is effective only when compiling with @option{-flto}
8017and is ignored at link time.
8018
8019@option{-fno-fat-lto-objects} improves compilation time over plain LTO, but
8020requires the complete toolchain to be aware of LTO. It requires a linker with
8021linker plugin support for basic functionality.  Additionally, nm, ar and ranlib
8022need to support linker plugins to allow a full-featured build environment
8023(capable of building static libraries etc).
8024
8025The default is @option{-ffat-lto-objects} but this default is intended to
8026change in future releases when linker plugin enabled environments become more
8027common.
8028
8029@item -fcompare-elim
8030@opindex fcompare-elim
8031After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8032identify arithmetic instructions that compute processor flags similar to a
8033comparison operation based on that arithmetic.  If possible, eliminate the
8034explicit comparison operation.
8035
8036This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent
8037the comparison operation before register allocation is complete.
8038
8039Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8040
8041@item -fcprop-registers
8042@opindex fcprop-registers
8043After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8044we perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
8045and occasionally eliminate the copy.
8046
8047Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8048
8049@item -fprofile-correction
8050@opindex fprofile-correction
8051Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may
8052be inconsistent due to missed counter updates. When this option is specified,
8053GCC will use heuristics to correct or smooth out such inconsistencies. By
8054default, GCC will emit an error message when an inconsistent profile is detected.
8055
8056@item -fprofile-dir=@var{path}
8057@opindex fprofile-dir
8058
8059Set the directory to search for the profile data files in to @var{path}.
8060This option affects only the profile data generated by
8061@option{-fprofile-generate}, @option{-ftest-coverage}, @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8062and used by @option{-fprofile-use} and @option{-fbranch-probabilities}
8063and its related options.  Both absolute and relative paths can be used.
8064By default, GCC will use the current directory as @var{path}, thus the
8065profile data file will appear in the same directory as the object file.
8066
8067@item -fprofile-generate
8068@itemx -fprofile-generate=@var{path}
8069@opindex fprofile-generate
8070
8071Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to produce
8072profile useful for later recompilation with profile feedback based
8073optimization.  You must use @option{-fprofile-generate} both when
8074compiling and when linking your program.
8075
8076The following options are enabled: @code{-fprofile-arcs}, @code{-fprofile-values}, @code{-fvpt}.
8077
8078If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8079the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8080
8081@item -fprofile-use
8082@itemx -fprofile-use=@var{path}
8083@opindex fprofile-use
8084Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and optimizations
8085generally profitable only with profile feedback available.
8086
8087The following options are enabled: @code{-fbranch-probabilities}, @code{-fvpt},
8088@code{-funroll-loops}, @code{-fpeel-loops}, @code{-ftracer}
8089
8090By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not
8091match the source code.  This error can be turned into a warning by using
8092@option{-Wcoverage-mismatch}.  Note this may result in poorly optimized
8093code.
8094
8095If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8096the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8097@end table
8098
8099The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-point
8100arithmetic.  These options trade off between speed and
8101correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.
8102
8103@table @gcctabopt
8104@item -ffloat-store
8105@opindex ffloat-store
8106Do not store floating-point variables in registers, and inhibit other
8107options that might change whether a floating-point value is taken from a
8108register or memory.
8109
8110@cindex floating-point precision
8111This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
8112the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
8113precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have.  Similarly for the
8114x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only
8115good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
8116point.  Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
8117them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
8118
8119@item -fexcess-precision=@var{style}
8120@opindex fexcess-precision
8121This option allows further control over excess precision on machines
8122where floating-point registers have more precision than the IEEE
8123@code{float} and @code{double} types and the processor does not
8124support operations rounding to those types.  By default,
8125@option{-fexcess-precision=fast} is in effect; this means that
8126operations are carried out in the precision of the registers and that
8127it is unpredictable when rounding to the types specified in the source
8128code takes place.  When compiling C, if
8129@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is specified then excess
8130precision will follow the rules specified in ISO C99; in particular,
8131both casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their
8132semantic types (whereas @option{-ffloat-store} only affects
8133assignments).  This option is enabled by default for C if a strict
8134conformance option such as @option{-std=c99} is used.
8135
8136@opindex mfpmath
8137@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is not implemented for languages
8138other than C, and has no effect if
8139@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} or @option{-ffast-math} is
8140specified.  On the x86, it also has no effect if @option{-mfpmath=sse}
8141or @option{-mfpmath=sse+387} is specified; in the former case, IEEE
8142semantics apply without excess precision, and in the latter, rounding
8143is unpredictable.
8144
8145@item -ffast-math
8146@opindex ffast-math
8147Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
8148@option{-ffinite-math-only}, @option{-fno-rounding-math},
8149@option{-fno-signaling-nans} and @option{-fcx-limited-range}.
8150
8151This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
8152
8153This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option besides
8154@option{-Ofast} since it can result in incorrect output for programs
8155that depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications
8156for math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8157that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8158
8159@item -fno-math-errno
8160@opindex fno-math-errno
8161Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed
8162with a single instruction, e.g., sqrt.  A program that relies on
8163IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
8164for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
8165
8166This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8167it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8168an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8169math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8170that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8171
8172The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
8173
8174On Darwin systems, the math library never sets @code{errno}.  There is
8175therefore no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility that
8176it might, and @option{-fno-math-errno} is the default.
8177
8178@item -funsafe-math-optimizations
8179@opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
8180
8181Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
8182that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
8183ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may include libraries
8184or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
8185similar optimizations.
8186
8187This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8188it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8189an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8190math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8191that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8192Enables @option{-fno-signed-zeros}, @option{-fno-trapping-math},
8193@option{-fassociative-math} and @option{-freciprocal-math}.
8194
8195The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
8196
8197@item -fassociative-math
8198@opindex fassociative-math
8199
8200Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.
8201This violates the ISO C and C++ language standard by possibly changing
8202computation result.  NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign of zero as
8203well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and
8204thus cannot be used on code that relies on rounding behavior like
8205@code{(x + 2**52) - 2**52}.  May also reorder floating-point comparisons
8206and thus may not be used when ordered comparisons are required.
8207This option requires that both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8208@option{-fno-trapping-math} be in effect.  Moreover, it doesn't make
8209much sense with @option{-frounding-math}. For Fortran the option
8210is automatically enabled when both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8211@option{-fno-trapping-math} are in effect.
8212
8213The default is @option{-fno-associative-math}.
8214
8215@item -freciprocal-math
8216@opindex freciprocal-math
8217
8218Allow the reciprocal of a value to be used instead of dividing by
8219the value if this enables optimizations.  For example @code{x / y}
8220can be replaced with @code{x * (1/y)}, which is useful if @code{(1/y)}
8221is subject to common subexpression elimination.  Note that this loses
8222precision and increases the number of flops operating on the value.
8223
8224The default is @option{-fno-reciprocal-math}.
8225
8226@item -ffinite-math-only
8227@opindex ffinite-math-only
8228Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
8229that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
8230
8231This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8232it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8233an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8234math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8235that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8236
8237The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
8238
8239@item -fno-signed-zeros
8240@opindex fno-signed-zeros
8241Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that ignore the
8242signedness of zero.  IEEE arithmetic specifies the behavior of
8243distinct +0.0 and @minus{}0.0 values, which then prohibits simplification
8244of expressions such as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with @option{-ffinite-math-only}).
8245This option implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.
8246
8247The default is @option{-fsigned-zeros}.
8248
8249@item -fno-trapping-math
8250@opindex fno-trapping-math
8251Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
8252user-visible traps.  These traps include division by zero, overflow,
8253underflow, inexact result and invalid operation.  This option requires
8254that @option{-fno-signaling-nans} be in effect.  Setting this option may
8255allow faster code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
8256
8257This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8258it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8259an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8260math functions.
8261
8262The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8263
8264@item -frounding-math
8265@opindex frounding-math
8266Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating-point
8267rounding behavior.  This is round-to-zero for all floating point
8268to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all other arithmetic
8269truncations.  This option should be specified for programs that change
8270the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a
8271non-default rounding mode.  This option disables constant folding of
8272floating-point expressions at compile time (which may be affected by
8273rounding mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe in the
8274presence of sign-dependent rounding modes.
8275
8276The default is @option{-fno-rounding-math}.
8277
8278This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8279disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
8280Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
8281using C99's @code{FENV_ACCESS} pragma.  This command-line option
8282will be used to specify the default state for @code{FENV_ACCESS}.
8283
8284@item -fsignaling-nans
8285@opindex fsignaling-nans
8286Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
8287traps during floating-point operations.  Setting this option disables
8288optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
8289signaling NaNs.  This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8290
8291This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
8292be defined.
8293
8294The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
8295
8296This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8297disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
8298
8299@item -fsingle-precision-constant
8300@opindex fsingle-precision-constant
8301Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of
8302implicitly converting them to double-precision constants.
8303
8304@item -fcx-limited-range
8305@opindex fcx-limited-range
8306When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
8307needed when performing complex division.  Also, there is no checking
8308whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8309+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.  The
8310default is @option{-fno-cx-limited-range}, but is enabled by
8311@option{-ffast-math}.
8312
8313This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
8314@code{CX_LIMITED_RANGE} pragma.  Nevertheless, the option applies to
8315all languages.
8316
8317@item -fcx-fortran-rules
8318@opindex fcx-fortran-rules
8319Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules.  Range
8320reduction is done as part of complex division, but there is no checking
8321whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8322+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.
8323
8324The default is @option{-fno-cx-fortran-rules}.
8325
8326@end table
8327
8328The following options control optimizations that may improve
8329performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options.  This
8330section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
8331
8332@table @gcctabopt
8333@item -fbranch-probabilities
8334@opindex fbranch-probabilities
8335After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8336(@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
8337@command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
8338@option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
8339the number of times each branch was taken.  When the program
8340compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits it saves arc execution
8341counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.gcda} for each source
8342file.  The information in this data file is very dependent on the
8343structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
8344and the same optimization options for both compilations.
8345
8346With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a
8347@samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
8348These can be used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only
8349used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
8350branch is most likely to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
8351exactly determine which path is taken more often.
8352
8353@item -fprofile-values
8354@opindex fprofile-values
8355If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it adds code so that some
8356data about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
8357
8358With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8359from profiling values of expressions for usage in optimizations.
8360
8361Enabled with @option{-fprofile-generate} and @option{-fprofile-use}.
8362
8363@item -fvpt
8364@opindex fvpt
8365If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it instructs the compiler to add
8366a code to gather information about values of expressions.
8367
8368With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8369and actually performs the optimizations based on them.
8370Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operation
8371using the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
8372
8373@item -frename-registers
8374@opindex frename-registers
8375Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
8376of registers left over after register allocation.  This optimization
8377will most benefit processors with lots of registers.  Depending on the
8378debug information format adopted by the target, however, it can
8379make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in
8380a ``home register''.
8381
8382Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops} and @option{-fpeel-loops}.
8383
8384@item -ftracer
8385@opindex ftracer
8386Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
8387simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
8388better job.
8389
8390Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8391
8392@item -funroll-loops
8393@opindex funroll-loops
8394Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or
8395upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
8396@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}, @option{-fweb} and @option{-frename-registers}.
8397It also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with
8398small constant number of iterations).  This option makes code larger, and may
8399or may not make it run faster.
8400
8401Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8402
8403@item -funroll-all-loops
8404@opindex funroll-all-loops
8405Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
8406the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
8407@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
8408@option{-funroll-loops}.
8409
8410@item -fpeel-loops
8411@opindex fpeel-loops
8412Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not
8413roll much (from profile feedback).  It also turns on complete loop peeling
8414(i.e.@: complete removal of loops with small constant number of iterations).
8415
8416Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8417
8418@item -fmove-loop-invariants
8419@opindex fmove-loop-invariants
8420Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled
8421at level @option{-O1}
8422
8423@item -funswitch-loops
8424@opindex funswitch-loops
8425Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates
8426of the loop on both branches (modified according to result of the condition).
8427
8428@item -ffunction-sections
8429@itemx -fdata-sections
8430@opindex ffunction-sections
8431@opindex fdata-sections
8432Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
8433file if the target supports arbitrary sections.  The name of the
8434function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
8435in the output file.
8436
8437Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
8438to improve locality of reference in the instruction space.  Most systems
8439using the ELF object format and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
8440linkers with such optimizations.  AIX may have these optimizations in
8441the future.
8442
8443Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
8444so.  When you specify these options, the assembler and linker will
8445create larger object and executable files and will also be slower.
8446You will not be able to use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
8447specify this option and you may have problems with debugging if
8448you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
8449
8450@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize
8451@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize
8452Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue
8453threading.
8454The use of target registers can typically be exposed only during reload,
8455thus hoisting loads out of loops and doing inter-block scheduling needs
8456a separate optimization pass.
8457
8458@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8459@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8460Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue
8461threading.
8462
8463@item -fbtr-bb-exclusive
8464@opindex fbtr-bb-exclusive
8465When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse
8466branch target registers in within any basic block.
8467
8468@item -fstack-protector
8469@opindex fstack-protector
8470Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack smashing
8471attacks.  This is done by adding a guard variable to functions with
8472vulnerable objects.  This includes functions that call alloca, and
8473functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized
8474when a function is entered and then checked when the function exits.
8475If a guard check fails, an error message is printed and the program exits.
8476
8477@item -fstack-protector-all
8478@opindex fstack-protector-all
8479Like @option{-fstack-protector} except that all functions are protected.
8480
8481@item -fsection-anchors
8482@opindex fsection-anchors
8483Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
8484shared ``anchor'' symbols to address nearby objects.  This transformation
8485can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on some
8486targets.
8487
8488For example, the implementation of the following function @code{foo}:
8489
8490@smallexample
8491static int a, b, c;
8492int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
8493@end smallexample
8494
8495would usually calculate the addresses of all three variables, but if you
8496compile it with @option{-fsection-anchors}, it will access the variables
8497from a common anchor point instead.  The effect is similar to the
8498following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
8499
8500@smallexample
8501int foo (void)
8502@{
8503  register int *xr = &x;
8504  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
8505@}
8506@end smallexample
8507
8508Not all targets support this option.
8509
8510@item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
8511@opindex param
8512In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
8513optimization that is done.  For example, GCC will not inline functions
8514that contain more than a certain number of instructions.  You can
8515control some of these constants on the command line using the
8516@option{--param} option.
8517
8518The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are
8519tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to change
8520without notice in future releases.
8521
8522In each case, the @var{value} is an integer.  The allowable choices for
8523@var{name} are given in the following table:
8524
8525@table @gcctabopt
8526@item predictable-branch-outcome
8527When branch is predicted to be taken with probability lower than this threshold
8528(in percent), then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.
8529
8530@item max-crossjump-edges
8531The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for crossjumping.
8532The algorithm used by @option{-fcrossjumping} is @math{O(N^2)} in
8533the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
8534more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with
8535probably small improvement in executable size.
8536
8537@item min-crossjump-insns
8538The minimum number of instructions that must be matched at the end
8539of two blocks before crossjumping will be performed on them.  This
8540value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the block being
8541crossjumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.
8542
8543@item max-grow-copy-bb-insns
8544The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic blocks
8545instead of jumping.  The expansion is relative to a jump instruction.
8546The default value is 8.
8547
8548@item max-goto-duplication-insns
8549The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps
8550to a computed goto.  To avoid @math{O(N^2)} behavior in a number of
8551passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation process,
8552and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps at the
8553end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are
8554unfactored.  The default value is 8.
8555
8556@item max-delay-slot-insn-search
8557The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
8558instruction to fill a delay slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of
8559instructions is searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
8560will be minimal so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more
8561aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably
8562small improvement in execution time.
8563
8564@item max-delay-slot-live-search
8565When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
8566consider when searching for a block with valid live register
8567information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
8568aggressive optimization, increasing the compilation time.  This parameter
8569should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
8570control-flow graph.
8571
8572@item max-gcse-memory
8573The approximate maximum amount of memory that will be allocated in
8574order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
8575optimization.  If more memory than specified is required, the
8576optimization will not be done.
8577
8578@item max-gcse-insertion-ratio
8579If the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value
8580for any expression, then RTL PRE will insert or remove the expression and thus
8581leave partially redundant computations in the instruction stream.  The default value is 20.
8582
8583@item max-pending-list-length
8584The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will allow
8585before flushing the current state and starting over.  Large functions
8586with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
8587needlessly consume memory and resources.
8588
8589@item max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
8590The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should make
8591when modulo scheduling a loop.  Larger values can exponentially increase
8592compilation time.
8593
8594@item max-inline-insns-single
8595Several parameters control the tree inliner used in gcc.
8596This number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in GCC's
8597internal representation) in a single function that the tree inliner
8598will consider for inlining.  This only affects functions declared
8599inline and methods implemented in a class declaration (C++).
8600The default value is 400.
8601
8602@item max-inline-insns-auto
8603When you use @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}),
8604a lot of functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
8605by the compiler will be investigated.  To those functions, a different
8606(more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can
8607be applied.
8608The default value is 40.
8609
8610@item large-function-insns
8611The limit specifying really large functions.  For functions larger than this
8612limit after inlining, inlining is constrained by
8613@option{--param large-function-growth}.  This parameter is useful primarily
8614to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the
8615back end.
8616The default value is 2700.
8617
8618@item large-function-growth
8619Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.
8620The default value is 100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times
8621the original size.
8622
8623@item large-unit-insns
8624The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of
8625units larger than this limit is limited by @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.
8626For small units this might be too tight (consider unit consisting of function A
8627that is inline and B that just calls A three time.  If B is small relative to
8628A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane.  For very
8629large units consisting of small inlineable functions however the overall unit
8630growth limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.  Thus for
8631smaller units, the size is increased to @option{--param large-unit-insns}
8632before applying @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.  The default is 10000
8633
8634@item inline-unit-growth
8635Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.
8636The default value is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original
8637size.
8638
8639@item ipcp-unit-growth
8640Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by
8641interprocedural constant propagation.  The default value is 10 which limits
8642unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.
8643
8644@item large-stack-frame
8645The limit specifying large stack frames.  While inlining the algorithm is trying
8646to not grow past this limit too much.  Default value is 256 bytes.
8647
8648@item large-stack-frame-growth
8649Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.
8650The default value is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times
8651the original size.
8652
8653@item max-inline-insns-recursive
8654@itemx max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
8655Specifies maximum number of instructions out-of-line copy of self recursive inline
8656function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.
8657
8658For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive} is
8659taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8660happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8661enabled and @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto} is used.  The
8662default value is 450.
8663
8664@item max-inline-recursive-depth
8665@itemx max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
8666Specifies maximum recursion depth used by the recursive inlining.
8667
8668For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth} is
8669taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8670happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8671enabled and @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto} is used.  The
8672default value is 8.
8673
8674@item min-inline-recursive-probability
8675Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion
8676in average and can hurt for function having little recursion depth by
8677increasing the prologue size or complexity of function body to other
8678optimizers.
8679
8680When profile feedback is available (see @option{-fprofile-generate}) the actual
8681recursion depth can be guessed from probability that function will recurse via
8682given call expression.  This parameter limits inlining only to call expression
8683whose probability exceeds given threshold (in percents).  The default value is
868410.
8685
8686@item early-inlining-insns
8687Specify growth that early inliner can make.  In effect it increases amount of
8688inlining for code having large abstraction penalty.  The default value is 10.
8689
8690@item max-early-inliner-iterations
8691@itemx max-early-inliner-iterations
8692Limit of iterations of early inliner.  This basically bounds number of nested
8693indirect calls early inliner can resolve.  Deeper chains are still handled by
8694late inlining.
8695
8696@item comdat-sharing-probability
8697@itemx comdat-sharing-probability
8698Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat visibility
8699will be shared across multiple compilation units.  The default value is 20.
8700
8701@item min-vect-loop-bound
8702The minimum number of iterations under which a loop will not get vectorized
8703when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is used.  The number of iterations after
8704vectorization needs to be greater than the value specified by this option
8705to allow vectorization.  The default value is 0.
8706
8707@item gcse-cost-distance-ratio
8708Scaling factor in calculation of maximum distance an expression
8709can be moved by GCSE optimizations.  This is currently supported only in the
8710code hoisting pass.  The bigger the ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting
8711will be with simple expressions, i.e., the expressions that have cost
8712less than @option{gcse-unrestricted-cost}.  Specifying 0 will disable
8713hoisting of simple expressions.  The default value is 10.
8714
8715@item gcse-unrestricted-cost
8716Cost, roughly measured as the cost of a single typical machine
8717instruction, at which GCSE optimizations will not constrain
8718the distance an expression can travel.  This is currently
8719supported only in the code hoisting pass.  The lesser the cost,
8720the more aggressive code hoisting will be.  Specifying 0 will
8721allow all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.
8722The default value is 3.
8723
8724@item max-hoist-depth
8725The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions to hoist.
8726This is used to avoid quadratic behavior in hoisting algorithm.
8727The value of 0 will avoid limiting the search, but may slow down compilation
8728of huge functions.  The default value is 30.
8729
8730@item max-tail-merge-comparisons
8731The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with.  This is used to
8732avoid quadratic behavior in tree tail merging.  The default value is 10.
8733
8734@item max-tail-merge-iterations
8735The maximum amount of iterations of the pass over the function.  This is used to
8736limit compilation time in tree tail merging.  The default value is 2.
8737
8738@item max-unrolled-insns
8739The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8740is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times
8741the loop code is unrolled.
8742
8743@item max-average-unrolled-insns
8744The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution
8745that a loop should have if that loop is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled,
8746it determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
8747
8748@item max-unroll-times
8749The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
8750
8751@item max-peeled-insns
8752The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8753is peeled, and if the loop is peeled, it determines how many times
8754the loop code is peeled.
8755
8756@item max-peel-times
8757The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
8758
8759@item max-completely-peeled-insns
8760The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
8761
8762@item max-completely-peel-times
8763The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.
8764
8765@item max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
8766The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.
8767
8768@item max-unswitch-insns
8769The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
8770
8771@item max-unswitch-level
8772The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
8773
8774@item lim-expensive
8775The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.
8776
8777@item iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
8778Bound on number of candidates for induction variables below that
8779all candidates are considered for each use in induction variable
8780optimizations.  Only the most relevant candidates are considered
8781if there are more candidates, to avoid quadratic time complexity.
8782
8783@item iv-max-considered-uses
8784The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more
8785induction variable uses.
8786
8787@item iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
8788If number of candidates in the set is smaller than this value,
8789we always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set during its
8790optimization when a new iv is added to the set.
8791
8792@item scev-max-expr-size
8793Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8794Large expressions slow the analyzer.
8795
8796@item scev-max-expr-complexity
8797Bound on the complexity of the expressions in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8798Complex expressions slow the analyzer.
8799
8800@item omega-max-vars
8801The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.
8802The default value is 128.
8803
8804@item omega-max-geqs
8805The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.
8806The default value is 256.
8807
8808@item omega-max-eqs
8809The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.
8810The default value is 128.
8811
8812@item omega-max-wild-cards
8813The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver will
8814be able to insert.  The default value is 18.
8815
8816@item omega-hash-table-size
8817The size of the hash table in the Omega solver.  The default value is
8818550.
8819
8820@item omega-max-keys
8821The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver.  The default
8822value is 500.
8823
8824@item omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
8825When set to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant
8826constraints.  The default value is 0.
8827
8828@item vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
8829The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8830doing loop versioning for alignment in the vectorizer.  See option
8831ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8832
8833@item vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
8834The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8835doing loop versioning for alias in the vectorizer.  See option
8836ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8837
8838@item max-iterations-to-track
8839
8840The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute force algorithm
8841for analysis of # of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.
8842
8843@item hot-bb-count-fraction
8844Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program
8845given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8846
8847@item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
8848Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in
8849function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8850
8851@item max-predicted-iterations
8852The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.  This is useful
8853in cases where function contain single loop with known bound and other loop
8854with unknown.  We predict the known number of iterations correctly, while
8855the unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10.  This means that the
8856loop without bounds would appear artificially cold relative to the other one.
8857
8858@item align-threshold
8859
8860Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of basic block in
8861function given basic block will get aligned.
8862
8863@item align-loop-iterations
8864
8865A loop expected to iterate at lest the selected number of iterations will get
8866aligned.
8867
8868@item tracer-dynamic-coverage
8869@itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
8870
8871This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
8872executed instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size
8873expansion.
8874
8875The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
8876feedback is available.  The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
8877ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
8878
8879@item tracer-max-code-growth
8880Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage.  This is
8881rather hokey argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in
8882cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
8883growth.
8884
8885@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8886
8887Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
8888threshold (in percent).
8889
8890@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8891@itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
8892
8893Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this
8894threshold.
8895
8896Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
8897compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without.  The value
8898for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
8899order to make tracer effective.
8900
8901@item max-cse-path-length
8902
8903Maximum number of basic blocks on path that cse considers.  The default is 10.
8904
8905@item max-cse-insns
8906The maximum instructions CSE process before flushing. The default is 1000.
8907
8908@item ggc-min-expand
8909
8910GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This
8911parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
8912collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
8913Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
8914generation.
8915
8916The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when
8917RAM >= 1GB@.  If @code{getrlimit} is available, the notion of "RAM" is
8918the smallest of actual RAM and @code{RLIMIT_DATA} or @code{RLIMIT_AS}.  If
8919GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower
8920bound of 30% is used.  Setting this parameter and
8921@option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
8922every opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
8923debugging.
8924
8925@item ggc-min-heapsize
8926
8927Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
8928to collect garbage.  The first collection occurs after the heap expands
8929by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}.  Again,
8930tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
8931generation.
8932
8933The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit that
8934tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but
8935with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound of
8936131072 (128 megabytes).  If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
8937particular platform, the lower bound is used.  Setting this parameter
8938very large effectively disables garbage collection.  Setting this
8939parameter and @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection
8940to occur at every opportunity.
8941
8942@item max-reload-search-insns
8943The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward for equivalent
8944register.  Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
8945compilation time increase with probably slightly better performance.
8946The default value is 100.
8947
8948@item max-cselib-memory-locations
8949The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.
8950Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time
8951increase with probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 500.
8952
8953@item reorder-blocks-duplicate
8954@itemx reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
8955
8956Used by basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional
8957branch or duplicate the code on its destination.  Code is duplicated when its
8958estimated size is smaller than this value multiplied by the estimated size of
8959unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.
8960
8961The @option{reorder-block-duplicate-feedback} is used only when profile
8962feedback is available and may be set to higher values than
8963@option{reorder-block-duplicate} since information about the hot spots is more
8964accurate.
8965
8966@item max-sched-ready-insns
8967The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should
8968consider at any given time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing
8969values mean more thorough searches, making the compilation time increase
8970with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.
8971
8972@item max-sched-region-blocks
8973The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8974interblock scheduling.  The default value is 10.
8975
8976@item max-pipeline-region-blocks
8977The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8978pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 15.
8979
8980@item max-sched-region-insns
8981The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8982interblock scheduling.  The default value is 100.
8983
8984@item max-pipeline-region-insns
8985The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8986pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 200.
8987
8988@item min-spec-prob
8989The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source block
8990for interblock speculative scheduling.  The default value is 40.
8991
8992@item max-sched-extend-regions-iters
8993The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
89940 - disable region extension,
8995N - do at most N iterations.
8996The default value is 0.
8997
8998@item max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
8999The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for speculative motion.
9000The default value is 3.
9001
9002@item sched-spec-prob-cutoff
9003The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents), so that
9004speculative insn will be scheduled.
9005The default value is 40.
9006
9007@item sched-mem-true-dep-cost
9008Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load targeting same
9009memory locations.  The default value is 1.
9010
9011@item selsched-max-lookahead
9012The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective scheduling.  It is a
9013depth of search for available instructions.
9014The default value is 50.
9015
9016@item selsched-max-sched-times
9017The maximum number of times that an instruction will be scheduled during
9018selective scheduling.  This is the limit on the number of iterations
9019through which the instruction may be pipelined.  The default value is 2.
9020
9021@item selsched-max-insns-to-rename
9022The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered
9023for renaming in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 2.
9024
9025@item sms-min-sc
9026The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler will
9027generate.  The default value is 2.
9028
9029@item max-last-value-rtl
9030The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression
9031in combiner for a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default
9032is 10000.
9033
9034@item integer-share-limit
9035Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the
9036compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed.  This sets the maximum
9037value of a shared integer constant.  The default value is 256.
9038
9039@item min-virtual-mappings
9040Specifies the minimum number of virtual mappings in the incremental
9041SSA updater that should be registered to trigger the virtual mappings
9042heuristic defined by virtual-mappings-ratio.  The default value is
9043100.
9044
9045@item virtual-mappings-ratio
9046If the number of virtual mappings is virtual-mappings-ratio bigger
9047than the number of virtual symbols to be updated, then the incremental
9048SSA updater switches to a full update for those symbols.  The default
9049ratio is 3.
9050
9051@item ssp-buffer-size
9052The minimum size of buffers (i.e.@: arrays) that will receive stack smashing
9053protection when @option{-fstack-protection} is used.
9054
9055@item max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
9056Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be
9057duplicated when threading jumps.
9058
9059@item max-fields-for-field-sensitive
9060Maximum number of fields in a structure we will treat in
9061a field sensitive manner during pointer analysis.  The default is zero
9062for -O0, and -O1 and 100 for -Os, -O2, and -O3.
9063
9064@item prefetch-latency
9065Estimate on average number of instructions that are executed before
9066prefetch finishes.  The distance we prefetch ahead is proportional
9067to this constant.  Increasing this number may also lead to less
9068streams being prefetched (see @option{simultaneous-prefetches}).
9069
9070@item simultaneous-prefetches
9071Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.
9072
9073@item l1-cache-line-size
9074The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.
9075
9076@item l1-cache-size
9077The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.
9078
9079@item l2-cache-size
9080The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.
9081
9082@item min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
9083The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9084number of prefetches to enable prefetching in a loop.
9085
9086@item prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
9087The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9088number of memory references to enable prefetching in a loop.
9089
9090@item use-canonical-types
9091Whether the compiler should use the ``canonical'' type system.  By
9092default, this should always be 1, which uses a more efficient internal
9093mechanism for comparing types in C++ and Objective-C++.  However, if
9094bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures,
9095set this value to 0 to disable canonical types.
9096
9097@item switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
9098Switch initialization conversion will refuse to create arrays that are
9099bigger than @option{switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio} times the number of
9100branches in the switch.
9101
9102@item max-partial-antic-length
9103Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the tree
9104partial redundancy elimination optimization (@option{-ftree-pre}) when
9105optimizing at @option{-O3} and above.  For some sorts of source code
9106the enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization can run away,
9107consuming all of the memory available on the host machine.  This
9108parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets that are computed,
9109which prevents the runaway behavior.  Setting a value of 0 for
9110this parameter will allow an unlimited set length.
9111
9112@item sccvn-max-scc-size
9113Maximum size of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN
9114processing.  If this limit is hit, SCCVN processing for the whole
9115function will not be done and optimizations depending on it will
9116be disabled.  The default maximum SCC size is 10000.
9117
9118@item ira-max-loops-num
9119IRA uses regional register allocation by default.  If a function
9120contains more loops than the number given by this parameter, only at most
9121the given number of the most frequently-executed loops form regions
9122for regional register allocation.  The default value of the
9123parameter is 100.
9124
9125@item ira-max-conflict-table-size
9126Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the conflict
9127table, the table can still require excessive amounts of memory for
9128huge functions.  If the conflict table for a function could be more
9129than the size in MB given by this parameter, the register allocator
9130instead uses a faster, simpler, and lower-quality
9131algorithm that does not require building a pseudo-register conflict table.
9132The default value of the parameter is 2000.
9133
9134@item ira-loop-reserved-regs
9135IRA can be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops
9136for decisions to move loop invariants (see @option{-O3}).  The number
9137of available registers reserved for some other purposes is given
9138by this parameter.  The default value of the parameter is 2, which is
9139the minimal number of registers needed by typical instructions.
9140This value is the best found from numerous experiments.
9141
9142@item loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
9143Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compilation time and
9144in amount of needed compile-time memory, with very large loops.  Loops
9145with more basic blocks than this parameter won't have loop invariant
9146motion optimization performed on them.  The default value of the
9147parameter is 1000 for -O1 and 10000 for -O2 and above.
9148
9149@item loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
9150Building data dapendencies is expensive for very large loops.  This
9151parameter limits the number of data references in loops that are
9152considered for data dependence analysis.  These large loops will not
9153be handled then by the optimizations using loop data dependencies.
9154The default value is 1000.
9155
9156@item max-vartrack-size
9157Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during variable
9158tracking dataflow analysis of any function.  If this limit is exceeded
9159with variable tracking at assignments enabled, analysis for that
9160function is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from
9161the function.  If the limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var
9162tracking analysis is completely disabled for the function.  Setting
9163the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.
9164
9165@item max-vartrack-expr-depth
9166Sets a maximum number of recursion levels when attempting to map
9167variable names or debug temporaries to value expressions.  This trades
9168compilation time for more complete debug information.  If this is set too
9169low, value expressions that are available and could be represented in
9170debug information may end up not being used; setting this higher may
9171enable the compiler to find more complex debug expressions, but compile
9172time and memory use may grow.  The default is 12.
9173
9174@item min-nondebug-insn-uid
9175Use uids starting at this parameter for nondebug insns.  The range below
9176the parameter is reserved exclusively for debug insns created by
9177@option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, but debug insns may get
9178(non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.
9179
9180@item ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
9181IPA-SRA will replace a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new
9182parameters only when their cumulative size is less or equal to
9183@option{ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor} times the size of the original
9184pointer parameter.
9185
9186@item tm-max-aggregate-size
9187When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction, this
9188parameter specifies the size in bytes after which variables will be
9189saved with the logging functions as opposed to save/restore code
9190sequence pairs.  This option only applies when using
9191@option{-fgnu-tm}.
9192
9193@item graphite-max-nb-scop-params
9194To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms, the
9195number of parameters in a Static Control Part (SCoP) is bounded.  The
9196default value is 10 parameters.  A variable whose value is unknown at
9197compilation time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.
9198
9199@item graphite-max-bbs-per-function
9200To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of
9201the functions analyzed by Graphite is bounded.  The default value is
9202100 basic blocks.
9203
9204@item loop-block-tile-size
9205Loop blocking or strip mining transforms, enabled with
9206@option{-floop-block} or @option{-floop-strip-mine}, strip mine each
9207loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations.  The strip
9208length can be changed using the @option{loop-block-tile-size}
9209parameter.  The default value is 51 iterations.
9210
9211@item ipa-cp-value-list-size
9212IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed to a function's
9213parameter in order to propagate them and perform devirtualization.
9214@option{ipa-cp-value-list-size} is the maximum number of values and types it
9215stores per one formal parameter of a function.
9216
9217@item lto-partitions
9218Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.
9219The number of partitions should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.
9220The default value is 32.
9221
9222@item lto-minpartition
9223Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in estimated instructions).
9224This prevents expenses of splitting very small programs into too many
9225partitions.
9226
9227@item cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
9228The maximum number of namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++
9229name lookup fails for an identifier.  The default is 1000.
9230
9231@item sink-frequency-threshold
9232The maximum relative execution frequency (in percents) of the target block
9233relative to a statement's original block to allow statement sinking of a
9234statement.  Larger numbers result in more aggressive statement sinking.
9235The default value is 75.  A small positive adjustment is applied for
9236statements with memory operands as those are even more profitable so sink.
9237
9238@item max-stores-to-sink
9239The maximum number of conditional stores paires that can be sunk.  Set to 0
9240if either vectorization (@option{-ftree-vectorize}) or if-conversion
9241(@option{-ftree-loop-if-convert}) is disabled.  The default is 2.
9242
9243@item allow-load-data-races
9244Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on loads.
9245Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9246unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9247
9248@item allow-store-data-races
9249Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores.
9250Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9251unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9252
9253@item allow-packed-load-data-races
9254Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data loads.
9255Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9256unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9257
9258@item allow-packed-store-data-races
9259Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data stores.
9260Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9261unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9262
9263@item case-values-threshold
9264The smallest number of different values for which it is best to use a
9265jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.  If the value is
92660, use the default for the machine.  The default is 0.
9267
9268@item tree-reassoc-width
9269Set the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in
9270reassociated tree. This parameter overrides target dependent
9271heuristics used by default if has non zero value.
9272
9273@end table
9274@end table
9275
9276@node Preprocessor Options
9277@section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
9278@cindex preprocessor options
9279@cindex options, preprocessor
9280
9281These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
9282file before actual compilation.
9283
9284If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
9285Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
9286they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
9287compilation.
9288
9289@table @gcctabopt
9290@item -Wp,@var{option}
9291@opindex Wp
9292You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
9293and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor.  If
9294@var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
9295commas.  However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
9296by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
9297@option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase.  The preprocessor's direct
9298interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
9299you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
9300options instead.
9301
9302@item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
9303@opindex Xpreprocessor
9304Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor.  You can use this to
9305supply system-specific preprocessor options that GCC does not know how to
9306recognize.
9307
9308If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9309@option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9310@end table
9311
9312@include cppopts.texi
9313
9314@node Assembler Options
9315@section Passing Options to the Assembler
9316
9317@c prevent bad page break with this line
9318You can pass options to the assembler.
9319
9320@table @gcctabopt
9321@item -Wa,@var{option}
9322@opindex Wa
9323Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  If @var{option}
9324contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
9325
9326@item -Xassembler @var{option}
9327@opindex Xassembler
9328Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  You can use this to
9329supply system-specific assembler options that GCC does not know how to
9330recognize.
9331
9332If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9333@option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9334
9335@end table
9336
9337@node Link Options
9338@section Options for Linking
9339@cindex link options
9340@cindex options, linking
9341
9342These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
9343an executable output file.  They are meaningless if the compiler is
9344not doing a link step.
9345
9346@table @gcctabopt
9347@cindex file names
9348@item @var{object-file-name}
9349A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
9350considered to name an object file or library.  (Object files are
9351distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
9352contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input
9353to the linker.
9354
9355@item -c
9356@itemx -S
9357@itemx -E
9358@opindex c
9359@opindex S
9360@opindex E
9361If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
9362object file names should not be used as arguments.  @xref{Overall
9363Options}.
9364
9365@cindex Libraries
9366@item -l@var{library}
9367@itemx -l @var{library}
9368@opindex l
9369Search the library named @var{library} when linking.  (The second
9370alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
9371POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
9372
9373It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
9374linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
9375are specified.  Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
9376after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}.  If @file{bar.o} refers
9377to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
9378
9379The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
9380which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}.  The linker
9381then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
9382
9383The directories searched include several standard system directories
9384plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
9385
9386Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
9387whose members are object files.  The linker handles an archive file by
9388scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
9389been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an
9390ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion.  The only
9391difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
9392is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
9393and searches several directories.
9394
9395@item -lobjc
9396@opindex lobjc
9397You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
9398link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
9399
9400@item -nostartfiles
9401@opindex nostartfiles
9402Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
9403The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
9404or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
9405
9406@item -nodefaultlibs
9407@opindex nodefaultlibs
9408Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
9409Only the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker, options
9410specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as @code{-static-libgcc}
9411or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9412The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
9413is used.  The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp},
9414@code{memset}, @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9415These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9416libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9417mechanism when this option is specified.
9418
9419@item -nostdlib
9420@opindex nostdlib
9421Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
9422No startup files and only the libraries you specify will be passed to
9423the linker, options specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as
9424@code{-static-libgcc} or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9425The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp}, @code{memset},
9426@code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9427These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9428libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9429mechanism when this option is specified.
9430
9431@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
9432@cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
9433@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
9434@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9435@cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
9436@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9437One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
9438@option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
9439which GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
9440needs for some languages.
9441(@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
9442Collection (GCC) Internals},
9443for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
9444In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
9445other standard libraries.  In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
9446or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
9447This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
9448library subroutines.  (For example, @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
9449constructors will be called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
9450GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
9451
9452@item -pie
9453@opindex pie
9454Produce a position independent executable on targets that support it.
9455For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
9456that were used to generate code (@option{-fpie}, @option{-fPIE},
9457or model suboptions) when you specify this option.
9458
9459@item -rdynamic
9460@opindex rdynamic
9461Pass the flag @option{-export-dynamic} to the ELF linker, on targets
9462that support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not
9463only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed
9464for some uses of @code{dlopen} or to allow obtaining backtraces
9465from within a program.
9466
9467@item -s
9468@opindex s
9469Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
9470
9471@item -static
9472@opindex static
9473On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
9474libraries.  On other systems, this option has no effect.
9475
9476@item -shared
9477@opindex shared
9478Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
9479form an executable.  Not all systems support this option.  For predictable
9480results, you must also specify the same set of options that were used to
9481generate code (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions)
9482when you specify this option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
9483needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
9484multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
9485libraries to link against.  Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
9486to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
9487is innocuous.}
9488
9489@item -shared-libgcc
9490@itemx -static-libgcc
9491@opindex shared-libgcc
9492@opindex static-libgcc
9493On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
9494force the use of either the shared or static version respectively.
9495If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
9496configured, these options have no effect.
9497
9498There are several situations in which an application should use the
9499shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version.  The most common
9500of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
9501across different shared libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries
9502as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
9503
9504Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
9505@option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
9506executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
9507this is the right thing to do.
9508
9509If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
9510find that they will not always be linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
9511If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU linker
9512or a GNU linker that does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr},
9513it will link the shared version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries
9514by default.  Otherwise, it will take advantage of the linker and optimize
9515away the linking with the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with
9516the static version of libgcc by default.  This allows exceptions to
9517propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring relocation
9518costs at library load time.
9519
9520However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
9521exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
9522for the languages used in the program, or using the option
9523@option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
9524@file{libgcc}.
9525
9526@item -static-libstdc++
9527When the @command{g++} program is used to link a C++ program, it will
9528normally automatically link against @option{libstdc++}.  If
9529@file{libstdc++} is available as a shared library, and the
9530@option{-static} option is not used, then this will link against the
9531shared version of @file{libstdc++}.  That is normally fine.  However, it
9532is sometimes useful to freeze the version of @file{libstdc++} used by
9533the program without going all the way to a fully static link.  The
9534@option{-static-libstdc++} option directs the @command{g++} driver to
9535link @file{libstdc++} statically, without necessarily linking other
9536libraries statically.
9537
9538@item -symbolic
9539@opindex symbolic
9540Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object.  Warn
9541about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
9542option @samp{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}).  Only a few systems support
9543this option.
9544
9545@item -T @var{script}
9546@opindex T
9547@cindex linker script
9548Use @var{script} as the linker script.  This option is supported by most
9549systems using the GNU linker.  On some targets, such as bare-board
9550targets without an operating system, the @option{-T} option may be required
9551when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.
9552
9553@item -Xlinker @var{option}
9554@opindex Xlinker
9555Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  You can use this to
9556supply system-specific linker options that GCC does not recognize.
9557
9558If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use
9559@option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9560For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
9561@samp{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}.  It does not work to write
9562@option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
9563string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
9564
9565When using the GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass
9566arguments to linker options using the @option{@var{option}=@var{value}}
9567syntax than as separate arguments.  For example, you can specify
9568@samp{-Xlinker -Map=output.map} rather than
9569@samp{-Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map}.  Other linkers may not support
9570this syntax for command-line options.
9571
9572@item -Wl,@var{option}
9573@opindex Wl
9574Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  If @var{option} contains
9575commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.  You can use this
9576syntax to pass an argument to the option.
9577For example, @samp{-Wl,-Map,output.map} passes @samp{-Map output.map} to the
9578linker.  When using the GNU linker, you can also get the same effect with
9579@samp{-Wl,-Map=output.map}.
9580
9581@item -u @var{symbol}
9582@opindex u
9583Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
9584library modules to define it.  You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
9585different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
9586@end table
9587
9588@node Directory Options
9589@section Options for Directory Search
9590@cindex directory options
9591@cindex options, directory search
9592@cindex search path
9593
9594These options specify directories to search for header files, for
9595libraries and for parts of the compiler:
9596
9597@table @gcctabopt
9598@item -I@var{dir}
9599@opindex I
9600Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
9601searched for header files.  This can be used to override a system header
9602file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
9603searched before the system header file directories.  However, you should
9604not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
9605system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that).  If you use more than
9606one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
9607order; the standard system directories come after.
9608
9609If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
9610@option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
9611option will be ignored.  The directory will still be searched but as a
9612system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
9613This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
9614the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently changed.
9615If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
9616use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
9617
9618@item -iplugindir=@var{dir}
9619Set the directory to search for plugins that are passed
9620by @option{-fplugin=@var{name}} instead of
9621@option{-fplugin=@var{path}/@var{name}.so}.  This option is not meant
9622to be used by the user, but only passed by the driver.
9623
9624@item -iquote@var{dir}
9625@opindex iquote
9626Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to
9627be searched for header files only for the case of @samp{#include
9628"@var{file}"}; they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>},
9629otherwise just like @option{-I}.
9630
9631@item -L@var{dir}
9632@opindex L
9633Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
9634for @option{-l}.
9635
9636@item -B@var{prefix}
9637@opindex B
9638This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
9639include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
9640
9641The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
9642@file{cpp}, @file{cc1}, @file{as} and @file{ld}.  It tries
9643@var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
9644without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
9645
9646For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
9647@option{-B} prefix, if any.  If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
9648was not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes,
9649@file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc/}.  If neither of
9650those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
9651name is searched for using the directories specified in your
9652@env{PATH} environment variable.
9653
9654The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
9655refers to a directory, and if necessary it will add a directory
9656separator character at the end of the path.
9657
9658@option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
9659to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
9660options into @option{-L} options for the linker.  They also apply to
9661includes files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
9662options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor.  In this case,
9663the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
9664
9665The runtime support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
9666the @option{-B} prefix, if needed.  If it is not found there, the two
9667standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left
9668out of the link if it is not found by those means.
9669
9670Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
9671the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @xref{Environment
9672Variables}.
9673
9674As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
9675@file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
96769, then it will be replaced by @file{[dir/]include}.  This is to help
9677with boot-strapping the compiler.
9678
9679@item -specs=@var{file}
9680@opindex specs
9681Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
9682file, in order to override the defaults which the @file{gcc} driver
9683program uses when determining what switches to pass to @file{cc1},
9684@file{cc1plus}, @file{as}, @file{ld}, etc.  More than one
9685@option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
9686are processed in order, from left to right.
9687
9688@item --sysroot=@var{dir}
9689@opindex sysroot
9690Use @var{dir} as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
9691For example, if the compiler would normally search for headers in
9692@file{/usr/include} and libraries in @file{/usr/lib}, it will instead
9693search @file{@var{dir}/usr/include} and @file{@var{dir}/usr/lib}.
9694
9695If you use both this option and the @option{-isysroot} option, then
9696the @option{--sysroot} option will apply to libraries, but the
9697@option{-isysroot} option will apply to header files.
9698
9699The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support
9700for this option.  If your linker does not support this option, the
9701header file aspect of @option{--sysroot} will still work, but the
9702library aspect will not.
9703
9704@item -I-
9705@opindex I-
9706This option has been deprecated.  Please use @option{-iquote} instead for
9707@option{-I} directories before the @option{-I-} and remove the @option{-I-}.
9708Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
9709option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
9710they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
9711
9712If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
9713the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
9714directives.  (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
9715this way.)
9716
9717In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
9718directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
9719directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}.  There is no way to
9720override this effect of @option{-I-}.  With @option{-I.} you can specify
9721searching the directory that was current when the compiler was
9722invoked.  That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
9723by default, but it is often satisfactory.
9724
9725@option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
9726for header files.  Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
9727independent.
9728@end table
9729
9730@c man end
9731
9732@node Spec Files
9733@section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
9734@cindex Spec Files
9735
9736@command{gcc} is a driver program.  It performs its job by invoking a
9737sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
9738linking.  GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
9739deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
9740it ought to place on their command lines.  This behavior is controlled
9741by @dfn{spec strings}.  In most cases there is one spec string for each
9742program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
9743strings to control their behavior.  The spec strings built into GCC can
9744be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
9745a spec file.
9746
9747@dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
9748strings.  They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
9749lines.  The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
9750character on the line, which can be one of the following:
9751
9752@table @code
9753@item %@var{command}
9754Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor.  The commands that can
9755appear here are:
9756
9757@table @code
9758@item %include <@var{file}>
9759@cindex @code{%include}
9760Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
9761specs file.
9762
9763@item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
9764@cindex @code{%include_noerr}
9765Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
9766file cannot be found.
9767
9768@item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
9769@cindex @code{%rename}
9770Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
9771
9772@end table
9773
9774@item *[@var{spec_name}]:
9775This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
9776string.  All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
9777blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string.  If this
9778results in an empty string then the spec will be deleted.  (Or, if the
9779spec did not exist, then nothing will happen.)  Otherwise, if the spec
9780does not currently exist a new spec will be created.  If the spec does
9781exist then its contents will be overridden by the text of this
9782directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
9783character, in which case the text will be appended to the spec.
9784
9785@item [@var{suffix}]:
9786Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair.  All lines after this directive
9787and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
9788spec string for the indicated suffix.  When the compiler encounters an
9789input file with the named suffix, it will processes the spec string in
9790order to work out how to compile that file.  For example:
9791
9792@smallexample
9793.ZZ:
9794z-compile -input %i
9795@end smallexample
9796
9797This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
9798passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
9799command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
9800@samp{%i} substitution.  (See below.)
9801
9802As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text that follows a
9803suffix directive can be one of the following:
9804
9805@table @code
9806@item @@@var{language}
9807This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}.  This is
9808similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
9809language explicitly.  For example:
9810
9811@smallexample
9812.ZZ:
9813@@c++
9814@end smallexample
9815
9816Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
9817
9818@item #@var{name}
9819This causes an error messages saying:
9820
9821@smallexample
9822@var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
9823@end smallexample
9824@end table
9825
9826GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
9827This directive will add an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
9828since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
9829possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
9830
9831@end table
9832
9833GCC has the following spec strings built into it.  Spec files can
9834override these strings or create their own.  Note that individual
9835targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
9836
9837@smallexample
9838asm          Options to pass to the assembler
9839asm_final    Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
9840cpp          Options to pass to the C preprocessor
9841cc1          Options to pass to the C compiler
9842cc1plus      Options to pass to the C++ compiler
9843endfile      Object files to include at the end of the link
9844link         Options to pass to the linker
9845lib          Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
9846libgcc       Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
9847linker       Sets the name of the linker
9848predefines   Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
9849signed_char  Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
9850             by default
9851startfile    Object files to include at the start of the link
9852@end smallexample
9853
9854Here is a small example of a spec file:
9855
9856@smallexample
9857%rename lib                 old_lib
9858
9859*lib:
9860--start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
9861@end smallexample
9862
9863This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
9864then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
9865The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
9866including the text of the old definition.
9867
9868@dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
9869corresponding program.  In addition, the spec strings can contain
9870@samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
9871conditionally insert text into the command line.  Using these constructs
9872it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
9873
9874Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
9875strings.  Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
9876results of expanding these sequences.  Therefore you can concatenate them
9877together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
9878
9879@table @code
9880@item %%
9881Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
9882
9883@item %i
9884Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
9885
9886@item %b
9887Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
9888This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
9889and not including the directory.
9890
9891@item %B
9892This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
9893the last period).
9894
9895@item %d
9896Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
9897temporary file name, so that that file will be deleted if GCC exits
9898successfully.  Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
9899argument.
9900
9901@item %g@var{suffix}
9902Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
9903once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
9904@samp{%d}.  To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
9905name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
9906chosen file names are known.  For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
9907might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}.  @var{suffix} matches
9908the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
9909treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed.  Previously, @samp{%g}
9910was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
9911without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
9912just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
9913
9914@item %u@var{suffix}
9915Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name even if
9916@samp{%u@var{suffix}} was already seen.
9917
9918@item %U@var{suffix}
9919Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
9920new one if there is no such last file name.  In the absence of any
9921@samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
9922the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
9923would involve the generation of two distinct file names, one
9924for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}.  Previously, @samp{%U} was
9925simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
9926without regard to any appended suffix.
9927
9928@item %j@var{suffix}
9929Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
9930writable, and if save-temps is off; otherwise, substitute the name
9931of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}.  This temporary file is not
9932meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
9933disposal mechanism.
9934
9935@item %|@var{suffix}
9936@itemx %m@var{suffix}
9937Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect.  In that case
9938@samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
9939all.  These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
9940should read from standard input or write to standard output.  If you
9941need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
9942construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
9943
9944@item %.@var{SUFFIX}
9945Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
9946when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}.  @var{SUFFIX} is
9947terminated by the next space or %.
9948
9949@item %w
9950Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
9951designated output file of this compilation.  This puts the argument
9952into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} will substitute later.
9953
9954@item %o
9955Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
9956automatically placed around them.  You should write spaces
9957around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
9958@samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
9959Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
9960at all, but they are included among the output files, so they will
9961be linked.
9962
9963@item %O
9964Substitutes the suffix for object files.  Note that this is
9965handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
9966because of the need for those to form complete file names.  The
9967handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
9968been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
9969support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they would
9970following, for example, @samp{.o}.
9971
9972@item %p
9973Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
9974current target machine.  Use this when running @code{cpp}.
9975
9976@item %P
9977Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
9978predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
9979@samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter.  This is for ISO
9980C@.
9981
9982@item %I
9983Substitute any of @option{-iprefix} (made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}),
9984@option{-isysroot} (made from @env{TARGET_SYSTEM_ROOT}),
9985@option{-isystem} (made from @env{COMPILER_PATH} and @option{-B} options)
9986and @option{-imultilib} as necessary.
9987
9988@item %s
9989Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
9990Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
9991the full name found.  The current working directory is included in the
9992list of directories scanned.
9993
9994@item %T
9995Current argument is the name of a linker script.  Search for that file
9996in the current list of directories to scan for libraries. If the file
9997is located insert a @option{--script} option into the command line
9998followed by the full path name found.  If the file is not found then
9999generate an error message.  Note: the current working directory is not
10000searched.
10001
10002@item %e@var{str}
10003Print @var{str} as an error message.  @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
10004Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
10005
10006@item %(@var{name})
10007Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
10008
10009@item %x@{@var{option}@}
10010Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
10011
10012@item %X
10013Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
10014spec string.
10015
10016@item %Y
10017Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
10018
10019@item %Z
10020Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
10021
10022@item %a
10023Process the @code{asm} spec.  This is used to compute the
10024switches to be passed to the assembler.
10025
10026@item %A
10027Process the @code{asm_final} spec.  This is a spec string for
10028passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
10029needed.
10030
10031@item %l
10032Process the @code{link} spec.  This is the spec for computing the
10033command line passed to the linker.  Typically it will make use of the
10034@samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
10035
10036@item %D
10037Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
10038contain startup files.  If the target supports multilibs then the
10039current multilib directory will be prepended to each of these paths.
10040
10041@item %L
10042Process the @code{lib} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding which
10043libraries should be included on the command line to the linker.
10044
10045@item %G
10046Process the @code{libgcc} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding
10047which GCC support library should be included on the command line to the linker.
10048
10049@item %S
10050Process the @code{startfile} spec.  This is a spec for deciding which
10051object files should be the first ones passed to the linker.  Typically
10052this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
10053
10054@item %E
10055Process the @code{endfile} spec.  This is a spec string that specifies
10056the last object files that will be passed to the linker.
10057
10058@item %C
10059Process the @code{cpp} spec.  This is used to construct the arguments
10060to be passed to the C preprocessor.
10061
10062@item %1
10063Process the @code{cc1} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10064passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
10065
10066@item %2
10067Process the @code{cc1plus} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10068passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
10069
10070@item %*
10071Substitute the variable part of a matched option.  See below.
10072Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
10073a single space.
10074
10075@item %<@code{S}
10076Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line.  Note---this
10077command is position dependent.  @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10078before this one will see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10079after this one will not.
10080
10081@item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
10082Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
10083@var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
10084into an argument vector in the usual fashion.  The function returns
10085a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
10086of the current spec.
10087
10088The following built-in spec functions are provided:
10089
10090@table @code
10091@item @code{getenv}
10092The @code{getenv} spec function takes two arguments: an environment
10093variable name and a string.  If the environment variable is not
10094defined, a fatal error is issued.  Otherwise, the return value is the
10095value of the environment variable concatenated with the string.  For
10096example, if @env{TOPDIR} is defined as @file{/path/to/top}, then:
10097
10098@smallexample
10099%:getenv(TOPDIR /include)
10100@end smallexample
10101
10102expands to @file{/path/to/top/include}.
10103
10104@item @code{if-exists}
10105The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
10106pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
10107pathname.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10108
10109@smallexample
10110*startfile:
10111crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
10112@end smallexample
10113
10114@item @code{if-exists-else}
10115The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
10116spec function, except that it takes two arguments.  The first argument is
10117an absolute pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
10118returns the pathname.  If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
10119This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
10120based on the existence of the first.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10121
10122@smallexample
10123*startfile:
10124crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) \
10125%:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
10126@end smallexample
10127
10128@item @code{replace-outfile}
10129The @code{replace-outfile} spec function takes two arguments.  It looks for the
10130first argument in the outfiles array and replaces it with the second argument.  Here
10131is a small example of its usage:
10132
10133@smallexample
10134%@{fgnu-runtime:%:replace-outfile(-lobjc -lobjc-gnu)@}
10135@end smallexample
10136
10137@item @code{remove-outfile}
10138The @code{remove-outfile} spec function takes one argument.  It looks for the
10139first argument in the outfiles array and removes it.  Here is a small example
10140its usage:
10141
10142@smallexample
10143%:remove-outfile(-lm)
10144@end smallexample
10145
10146@item @code{pass-through-libs}
10147The @code{pass-through-libs} spec function takes any number of arguments.  It
10148finds any @option{-l} options and any non-options ending in ".a" (which it
10149assumes are the names of linker input library archive files) and returns a
10150result containing all the found arguments each prepended by
10151@option{-plugin-opt=-pass-through=} and joined by spaces.  This list is
10152intended to be passed to the LTO linker plugin.
10153
10154@smallexample
10155%:pass-through-libs(%G %L %G)
10156@end smallexample
10157
10158@item @code{print-asm-header}
10159The @code{print-asm-header} function takes no arguments and simply
10160prints a banner like:
10161
10162@smallexample
10163Assembler options
10164=================
10165
10166Use "-Wa,OPTION" to pass "OPTION" to the assembler.
10167@end smallexample
10168
10169It is used to separate compiler options from assembler options
10170in the @option{--target-help} output.
10171@end table
10172
10173@item %@{@code{S}@}
10174Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch was given to GCC@.
10175If that switch was not specified, this substitutes nothing.  Note that
10176the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
10177automatically inserted if the substitution is performed.  Thus the spec
10178string @samp{%@{foo@}} would match the command-line option @option{-foo}
10179and would output the command-line option @option{-foo}.
10180
10181@item %W@{@code{S}@}
10182Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
10183deleted on failure.
10184
10185@item %@{@code{S}*@}
10186Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
10187with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument.  This is used for
10188switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
10189GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
10190one switch whose names starts with @samp{o}.  %@{o*@} would substitute this
10191text, including the space.  Thus two arguments would be generated.
10192
10193@item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
10194Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
10195(the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
10196There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
10197wild card is optional.  Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
10198
10199@item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10200Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was given to GCC@.
10201
10202@item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10203Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was @emph{not} given to GCC@.
10204
10205@item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
10206Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
10207@code{-S} are specified to GCC@.  Normally @code{X} is substituted only
10208once, no matter how many such switches appeared.  However, if @code{%*}
10209appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} will be substituted once
10210for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
10211that switch that matched the @code{*}.
10212
10213@item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10214Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10215
10216@item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10217Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10218
10219@item %@{,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10220Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file for language @code{S}.
10221
10222@item %@{!,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10223Substitutes @code{X}, if not processing a file for language @code{S}.
10224
10225@item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
10226Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} was given to
10227GCC@.  This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, @samp{,}, and
10228@code{*} sequences as well, although they have a stronger binding than
10229the @samp{|}.  If @code{%*} appears in @code{X}, all of the
10230alternatives must be starred, and only the first matching alternative
10231is substituted.
10232
10233For example, a spec string like this:
10234
10235@smallexample
10236%@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
10237@end smallexample
10238
10239will output the following command-line options from the following input
10240command-line options:
10241
10242@smallexample
10243fred.c        -foo -baz
10244jim.d         -bar -boggle
10245-d fred.c     -foo -baz -boggle
10246-d jim.d      -bar -baz -boggle
10247@end smallexample
10248
10249@item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
10250
10251If @code{S} was given to GCC, substitutes @code{X}; else if @code{T} was
10252given to GCC, substitutes @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}.  There can
10253be as many clauses as you need.  This may be combined with @code{.},
10254@code{,}, @code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
10255
10256
10257@end table
10258
10259The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
10260construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
10261even newlines.  They are processed as usual, as described above.
10262Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored.  White space may also
10263appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
10264except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
10265
10266The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
10267handled specifically in these constructs.  If another value of
10268@option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
10269@option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
10270switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
10271just one letter, which passes all matching options.
10272
10273The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
10274indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
10275only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
10276
10277It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
10278(You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
10279compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments.  But this cannot
10280be done in a consistent fashion.  GCC cannot even decide which input
10281files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
10282and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
10283compilers to run).
10284
10285GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
10286treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
10287proper position among the other output files.
10288
10289@c man begin OPTIONS
10290
10291@node Target Options
10292@section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
10293@cindex target options
10294@cindex cross compiling
10295@cindex specifying machine version
10296@cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
10297@cindex compiler version, specifying
10298@cindex target machine, specifying
10299
10300The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @command{gcc}, or
10301@command{@var{machine}-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
10302@command{@var{machine}-gcc-@var{version}} to run a version other than the
10303one that was installed last.
10304
10305@node Submodel Options
10306@section Hardware Models and Configurations
10307@cindex submodel options
10308@cindex specifying hardware config
10309@cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
10310@cindex machine dependent options
10311
10312Each target machine types can have its own
10313special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
10314hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
10315floating coprocessor or none.  A single installed version of the
10316compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
10317options specified.
10318
10319Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
10320options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
10321platform.
10322
10323@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
10324@c It should be the same order and spelling as these options are listed
10325@c in Machine Dependent Options
10326
10327@menu
10328* Adapteva Epiphany Options::
10329* ARM Options::
10330* AVR Options::
10331* Blackfin Options::
10332* C6X Options::
10333* CRIS Options::
10334* CR16 Options::
10335* Darwin Options::
10336* DEC Alpha Options::
10337* DEC Alpha/VMS Options::
10338* FR30 Options::
10339* FRV Options::
10340* GNU/Linux Options::
10341* H8/300 Options::
10342* HPPA Options::
10343* i386 and x86-64 Options::
10344* i386 and x86-64 Windows Options::
10345* IA-64 Options::
10346* IA-64/VMS Options::
10347* LM32 Options::
10348* M32C Options::
10349* M32R/D Options::
10350* M680x0 Options::
10351* MCore Options::
10352* MeP Options::
10353* MicroBlaze Options::
10354* MIPS Options::
10355* MMIX Options::
10356* MN10300 Options::
10357* PDP-11 Options::
10358* picoChip Options::
10359* PowerPC Options::
10360* RL78 Options::
10361* RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
10362* RX Options::
10363* S/390 and zSeries Options::
10364* Score Options::
10365* SH Options::
10366* Solaris 2 Options::
10367* SPARC Options::
10368* SPU Options::
10369* System V Options::
10370* TILE-Gx Options::
10371* TILEPro Options::
10372* V850 Options::
10373* VAX Options::
10374* VxWorks Options::
10375* x86-64 Options::
10376* Xstormy16 Options::
10377* Xtensa Options::
10378* zSeries Options::
10379@end menu
10380
10381@node Adapteva Epiphany Options
10382@subsection Adapteva Epiphany Options
10383
10384These @samp{-m} options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:
10385
10386@table @gcctabopt
10387@item -mhalf-reg-file
10388@opindex mhalf-reg-file
10389Don't allocate any register in the range @code{r32}@dots{}@code{r63}.
10390That allows code to run on hardware variants that lack these registers.
10391
10392@item -mprefer-short-insn-regs
10393@opindex mprefer-short-insn-regs
10394Preferrentially allocate registers that allow short instruction generation.
10395This can result in increasesd instruction count, so if this reduces or
10396increases code size might vary from case to case.
10397
10398@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
10399@opindex mbranch-cost
10400Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
10401This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
10402consistent results across releases.
10403
10404@item -mcmove
10405@opindex mcmove
10406Enable the generation of conditional moves.
10407
10408@item -mnops=@var{num}
10409@opindex mnops
10410Emit @var{num} nops before every other generated instruction.
10411
10412@item -mno-soft-cmpsf
10413@opindex mno-soft-cmpsf
10414For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an fsub instruction
10415and test the flags.  This is faster than a software comparison, but can
10416get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs, or when two different small
10417numbers are compared such that their difference is calculated as zero.
10418The default is @option{-msoft-cmpsf}, which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant,
10419software comparisons.
10420
10421@item -mstack-offset=@var{num}
10422@opindex mstack-offset
10423Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.
10424E.g., a value of 8 means that the eight bytes in the range sp+0@dots{}sp+7
10425can be used by leaf functions without stack allocation.
10426Values other than @samp{8} or @samp{16} are untested and unlikely to work.
10427Note also that this option changes the ABI, compiling a program with a
10428different stack offset than the libraries have been compiled with
10429will generally not work.
10430This option can be useful if you want to evaluate if a different stack
10431offset would give you better code, but to actually use a different stack
10432offset to build working programs, it is recommended to configure the
10433toolchain with the appropriate @samp{--with-stack-offset=@var{num}} option.
10434
10435@item -mno-round-nearest
10436@opindex mno-round-nearest
10437Make the scheduler assume that the rounding mode has been set to
10438truncating.  The default is @option{-mround-nearest}.
10439
10440@item -mlong-calls
10441@opindex mlong-calls
10442If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might be beyond
10443the offset range of the b / bl instructions, and therefore load the
10444function address into a register before performing a (otherwise direct) call.
10445This is the default.
10446
10447@item -mshort-calls
10448@opindex short-calls
10449If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls are
10450in the range of the b / bl instructions, so use these instructions
10451for direct calls.  The default is @option{-mlong-calls}.
10452
10453@item -msmall16
10454@opindex msmall16
10455Assume addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values.  This does not
10456apply to function addresses for which @option{-mlong-calls} semantics
10457are in effect.
10458
10459@item -mfp-mode=@var{mode}
10460@opindex mfp-mode
10461Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit.
10462This determines the floating-point mode that is provided and expected
10463at function call and return time.  Making this mode match the mode you
10464predominantly need at function start can make your programs smaller and
10465faster by avoiding unnecessary mode switches.
10466
10467@var{mode} can be set to one the following values:
10468
10469@table @samp
10470@item caller
10471Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored when
10472the function returns, and when it calls other functions.
10473This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other compilation units
10474you might want to incorporate into different programs with different
10475prevailing FPU modes, and the convenience of being able to use a single
10476object file outweighs the size and speed overhead for any extra
10477mode switching that might be needed, compared with what would be needed
10478with a more specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.
10479
10480@item truncate
10481This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10482truncating (i.e.@: round towards zero) rounding mode.  That includes
10483conversion from floating point to integer.
10484
10485@item round-nearest
10486This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10487round-to-nearest-or-even rounding mode.
10488
10489@item int
10490This is the mode used to perform integer calculations in the FPU, e.g.@:
10491integer multiply, or integer multiply-and-accumulate.
10492@end table
10493
10494The default is @option{-mfp-mode=caller}
10495
10496@item -mnosplit-lohi
10497@opindex mnosplit-lohi
10498@item -mno-postinc
10499@opindex mno-postinc
10500@item -mno-postmodify
10501@opindex mno-postmodify
10502Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of 32-bit
10503loads, generation of post-increment addresses, and generation of
10504post-modify addresses.  The defaults are @option{msplit-lohi},
10505@option{-mpost-inc}, and @option{-mpost-modify}.
10506
10507@item -mnovect-double
10508@opindex mno-vect-double
10509Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode.  The default is
10510@option{-mvect-double}, which uses DImode as preferred SIMD mode.
10511
10512@item -max-vect-align=@var{num}
10513@opindex max-vect-align
10514The maximum alignment for SIMD vector mode types.
10515@var{num} may be 4 or 8.  The default is 8.
10516Note that this is an ABI change, even though many library function
10517interfaces will be unaffected, if they don't use SIMD vector modes
10518in places where they affect size and/or alignment of relevant types.
10519
10520@item -msplit-vecmove-early
10521@opindex msplit-vecmove-early
10522Split vector moves into single word moves before reload.  In theory this
10523could give better register allocation, but so far the reverse seems to be
10524generally the case.
10525
10526@item -m1reg-@var{reg}
10527@opindex m1reg-
10528Specify a register to hold the constant @minus{}1, which makes loading small negative
10529constants and certain bitmasks faster.
10530Allowable values for reg are r43 and r63, which specify to use that register
10531as a fixed register, and none, which means that no register is used for this
10532purpose.  The default is @option{-m1reg-none}.
10533
10534@end table
10535
10536@node ARM Options
10537@subsection ARM Options
10538@cindex ARM options
10539
10540These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
10541architectures:
10542
10543@table @gcctabopt
10544@item -mabi=@var{name}
10545@opindex mabi
10546Generate code for the specified ABI@.  Permissible values are: @samp{apcs-gnu},
10547@samp{atpcs}, @samp{aapcs}, @samp{aapcs-linux} and @samp{iwmmxt}.
10548
10549@item -mapcs-frame
10550@opindex mapcs-frame
10551Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
10552Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
10553correct execution of the code.  Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
10554with this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for
10555leaf functions.  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
10556
10557@item -mapcs
10558@opindex mapcs
10559This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
10560
10561@ignore
10562@c not currently implemented
10563@item -mapcs-stack-check
10564@opindex mapcs-stack-check
10565Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
10566every function (that actually uses some stack space).  If there is
10567insufficient space available then either the function
10568@samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} will be
10569called, depending upon the amount of stack space required.  The runtime
10570system is required to provide these functions.  The default is
10571@option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
10572
10573@c not currently implemented
10574@item -mapcs-float
10575@opindex mapcs-float
10576Pass floating-point arguments using the floating-point registers.  This is
10577one of the variants of the APCS@.  This option is recommended if the
10578target hardware has a floating-point unit or if a lot of floating-point
10579arithmetic is going to be performed by the code.  The default is
10580@option{-mno-apcs-float}, since integer only code is slightly increased in
10581size if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
10582
10583@c not currently implemented
10584@item -mapcs-reentrant
10585@opindex mapcs-reentrant
10586Generate reentrant, position independent code.  The default is
10587@option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
10588@end ignore
10589
10590@item -mthumb-interwork
10591@opindex mthumb-interwork
10592Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
10593instruction sets.  Without this option, on pre-v5 architectures, the
10594two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside one program.  The
10595default is @option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code
10596is generated when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified.  In AAPCS
10597configurations this option is meaningless.
10598
10599@item -mno-sched-prolog
10600@opindex mno-sched-prolog
10601Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or the
10602merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
10603body.  This means that all functions will start with a recognizable set
10604of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
10605different function prologues), and this information can be used to
10606locate the start if functions inside an executable piece of code.  The
10607default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
10608
10609@item -mfloat-abi=@var{name}
10610@opindex mfloat-abi
10611Specifies which floating-point ABI to use.  Permissible values
10612are: @samp{soft}, @samp{softfp} and @samp{hard}.
10613
10614Specifying @samp{soft} causes GCC to generate output containing
10615library calls for floating-point operations.
10616@samp{softfp} allows the generation of code using hardware floating-point
10617instructions, but still uses the soft-float calling conventions.
10618@samp{hard} allows generation of floating-point instructions
10619and uses FPU-specific calling conventions.
10620
10621The default depends on the specific target configuration.  Note that
10622the hard-float and soft-float ABIs are not link-compatible; you must
10623compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
10624compatible set of libraries.
10625
10626@item -mlittle-endian
10627@opindex mlittle-endian
10628Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is
10629the default for all standard configurations.
10630
10631@item -mbig-endian
10632@opindex mbig-endian
10633Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
10634to compile code for a little-endian processor.
10635
10636@item -mwords-little-endian
10637@opindex mwords-little-endian
10638This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
10639Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
10640order.  That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}.  Note: this
10641option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
10642big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
106432.8.  This option is now deprecated.
10644
10645@item -mcpu=@var{name}
10646@opindex mcpu
10647This specifies the name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name
10648to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
10649assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
10650@samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
10651@samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
10652@samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
10653@samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
10654@samp{arm720},
10655@samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm7tdmi-s},
10656@samp{arm710t}, @samp{arm720t}, @samp{arm740t},
10657@samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
10658@samp{strongarm1110},
10659@samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
10660@samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm922t}, @samp{arm946e-s}, @samp{arm966e-s},
10661@samp{arm968e-s}, @samp{arm926ej-s}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi},
10662@samp{arm10tdmi}, @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{arm1026ej-s},
10663@samp{arm10e}, @samp{arm1020e}, @samp{arm1022e},
10664@samp{arm1136j-s}, @samp{arm1136jf-s}, @samp{mpcore}, @samp{mpcorenovfp},
10665@samp{arm1156t2-s}, @samp{arm1156t2f-s}, @samp{arm1176jz-s}, @samp{arm1176jzf-s},
10666@samp{cortex-a5}, @samp{cortex-a7}, @samp{cortex-a8}, @samp{cortex-a9},
10667@samp{cortex-a15}, @samp{cortex-r4}, @samp{cortex-r4f}, @samp{cortex-r5},
10668@samp{cortex-m4}, @samp{cortex-m3},
10669@samp{cortex-m1},
10670@samp{cortex-m0},
10671@samp{xscale}, @samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312},
10672@samp{fa526}, @samp{fa626},
10673@samp{fa606te}, @samp{fa626te}, @samp{fmp626}, @samp{fa726te}.
10674
10675
10676@option{-mcpu=generic-@var{arch}} is also permissible, and is
10677equivalent to @option{-march=@var{arch} -mtune=generic-@var{arch}}.
10678See @option{-mtune} for more information.
10679
10680@option{-mcpu=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10681of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10682Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10683unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10684
10685@item -mtune=@var{name}
10686@opindex mtune
10687This option is very similar to the @option{-mcpu=} option, except that
10688instead of specifying the actual target processor type, and hence
10689restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies that GCC should
10690tune the performance of the code as if the target were of the type
10691specified in this option, but still choosing the instructions that it
10692will generate based on the CPU specified by a @option{-mcpu=} option.
10693For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
10694this option.
10695
10696@option{-mtune=generic-@var{arch}} specifies that GCC should tune the
10697performance for a blend of processors within architecture @var{arch}.
10698The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular
10699processors, balancing between optimizations that benefit some CPUs in the
10700range, and avoiding performance pitfalls of other CPUs.  The effects of
10701this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models come and go.
10702
10703@option{-mtune=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10704of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10705Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10706unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10707
10708@item -march=@var{name}
10709@opindex march
10710This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this
10711name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
10712assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
10713of the @option{-mcpu=} option.  Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
10714@samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
10715@samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5e}, @samp{armv5te},
10716@samp{armv6}, @samp{armv6j},
10717@samp{armv6t2}, @samp{armv6z}, @samp{armv6zk}, @samp{armv6-m},
10718@samp{armv7}, @samp{armv7-a}, @samp{armv7-r}, @samp{armv7-m},
10719@samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312}.
10720
10721@option{-march=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture
10722of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10723Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10724unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10725
10726@item -mfpu=@var{name}
10727@itemx -mfpe=@var{number}
10728@itemx -mfp=@var{number}
10729@opindex mfpu
10730@opindex mfpe
10731@opindex mfp
10732This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware emulation) is
10733available on the target.  Permissible names are: @samp{fpa}, @samp{fpe2},
10734@samp{fpe3}, @samp{maverick}, @samp{vfp}, @samp{vfpv3}, @samp{vfpv3-fp16},
10735@samp{vfpv3-d16}, @samp{vfpv3-d16-fp16}, @samp{vfpv3xd}, @samp{vfpv3xd-fp16},
10736@samp{neon}, @samp{neon-fp16}, @samp{vfpv4}, @samp{vfpv4-d16},
10737@samp{fpv4-sp-d16} and @samp{neon-vfpv4}.
10738@option{-mfp} and @option{-mfpe} are synonyms for
10739@option{-mfpu}=@samp{fpe}@var{number}, for compatibility with older versions
10740of GCC@.
10741
10742If @option{-msoft-float} is specified this specifies the format of
10743floating-point values.
10744
10745If the selected floating-point hardware includes the NEON extension
10746(e.g. @option{-mfpu}=@samp{neon}), note that floating-point
10747operations will not be used by GCC's auto-vectorization pass unless
10748@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also specified.  This is
10749because NEON hardware does not fully implement the IEEE 754 standard for
10750floating-point arithmetic (in particular denormal values are treated as
10751zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.
10752
10753@item -mfp16-format=@var{name}
10754@opindex mfp16-format
10755Specify the format of the @code{__fp16} half-precision floating-point type.
10756Permissible names are @samp{none}, @samp{ieee}, and @samp{alternative};
10757the default is @samp{none}, in which case the @code{__fp16} type is not
10758defined.  @xref{Half-Precision}, for more information.
10759
10760@item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
10761@opindex mstructure-size-boundary
10762The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple
10763of the number of bits set by this option.  Permissible values are 8, 32
10764and 64.  The default value varies for different toolchains.  For the COFF
10765targeted toolchain the default value is 8.  A value of 64 is only allowed
10766if the underlying ABI supports it.
10767
10768Specifying the larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but
10769can also increase the size of the program.  Different values are potentially
10770incompatible.  Code compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to
10771work with code or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
10772information using structures or unions.
10773
10774@item -mabort-on-noreturn
10775@opindex mabort-on-noreturn
10776Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
10777@code{noreturn} function.  It will be executed if the function tries to
10778return.
10779
10780@item -mlong-calls
10781@itemx -mno-long-calls
10782@opindex mlong-calls
10783@opindex mno-long-calls
10784Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
10785address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
10786call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
10787will lie outside of the 64 megabyte addressing range of the offset based
10788version of subroutine call instruction.
10789
10790Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned
10791into long calls.  The heuristic is that static functions, functions
10792that have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
10793the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive and functions whose
10794definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
10795unit, will not be turned into long calls.  The exception to this rule is
10796that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
10797attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
10798the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive, will always be
10799turned into long calls.
10800
10801This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
10802@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior, as will
10803placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
10804long_calls_off} directive.  Note these switches have no effect on how
10805the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
10806pointers.
10807
10808@item -msingle-pic-base
10809@opindex msingle-pic-base
10810Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
10811loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
10812responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
10813before execution begins.
10814
10815@item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
10816@opindex mpic-register
10817Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.  The default is R10
10818unless stack-checking is enabled, when R9 is used.
10819
10820@item -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10821@opindex mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10822@opindex mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10823Insert NOPs into the instruction stream to in order to work around
10824problems with invalid Maverick instruction combinations.  This option
10825is only valid if the @option{-mcpu=ep9312} option has been used to
10826enable generation of instructions for the Cirrus Maverick floating-point
10827co-processor.  This option is not enabled by default, since the
10828problem is only present in older Maverick implementations.  The default
10829can be re-enabled by use of the @option{-mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns}
10830switch.
10831
10832@item -mpoke-function-name
10833@opindex mpoke-function-name
10834Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
10835preceding the function prologue.  The generated code is similar to this:
10836
10837@smallexample
10838     t0
10839         .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
10840         .align
10841     t1
10842         .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
10843     arm_poke_function_name
10844         mov     ip, sp
10845         stmfd   sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
10846         sub     fp, ip, #4
10847@end smallexample
10848
10849When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
10850@code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}.  If the trace function then looks at
10851location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
10852there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
10853and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
10854
10855@item -mthumb
10856@itemx -marm
10857@opindex marm
10858@opindex mthumb
10859
10860Select between generating code that executes in ARM and Thumb
10861states.  The default for most configurations is to generate code
10862that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
10863configuring GCC with the @option{--with-mode=}@var{state}
10864configure option.
10865
10866@item -mtpcs-frame
10867@opindex mtpcs-frame
10868Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10869Standard for all non-leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10870not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
10871
10872@item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
10873@opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
10874Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10875Standard for all leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10876not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
10877
10878@item -mcallee-super-interworking
10879@opindex mcallee-super-interworking
10880Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
10881instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
10882rest of the function.  This allows these functions to be called from
10883non-interworking code.  This option is not valid in AAPCS configurations
10884because interworking is enabled by default.
10885
10886@item -mcaller-super-interworking
10887@opindex mcaller-super-interworking
10888Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
10889execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
10890compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the cost
10891of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.  This option
10892is not valid in AAPCS configurations because interworking is enabled
10893by default.
10894
10895@item -mtp=@var{name}
10896@opindex mtp
10897Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer.  The valid
10898models are @option{soft}, which generates calls to @code{__aeabi_read_tp},
10899@option{cp15}, which fetches the thread pointer from @code{cp15} directly
10900(supported in the arm6k architecture), and @option{auto}, which uses the
10901best available method for the selected processor.  The default setting is
10902@option{auto}.
10903
10904@item -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect}
10905@opindex mtls-dialect
10906Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage.  Two
10907dialects are supported --- @option{gnu} and @option{gnu2}.  The
10908@option{gnu} dialect selects the original GNU scheme for supporting
10909local and global dynamic TLS models.  The @option{gnu2} dialect
10910selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which provides better performance
10911for shared libraries.  The GNU descriptor scheme is compatible with
10912the original scheme, but does require new assembler, linker and
10913library support.  Initial and local exec TLS models are unaffected by
10914this option and always use the original scheme.
10915
10916@item -mword-relocations
10917@opindex mword-relocations
10918Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values (i.e. R_ARM_ABS32).
10919This is enabled by default on targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime
10920loader imposes this restriction, and when @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}
10921is specified.
10922
10923@item -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10924@opindex mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10925Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when @code{ldrd} instructions
10926with overlapping destination and base registers are used.  This option avoids
10927generating these instructions.  This option is enabled by default when
10928@option{-mcpu=cortex-m3} is specified.
10929
10930@item -munaligned-access
10931@itemx -mno-unaligned-access
10932@opindex munaligned-access
10933@opindex mno-unaligned-access
10934Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values
10935from addresses that are not 16- or 32- bit aligned.  By default
10936unaligned access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6 and all ARMv6-M
10937architectures, and enabled for all other architectures.  If unaligned
10938access is not enabled then words in packed data structures will be
10939accessed a byte at a time.
10940
10941The ARM attribute @code{Tag_CPU_unaligned_access} will be set in the
10942generated object file to either true or false, depending upon the
10943setting of this option.  If unaligned access is enabled then the
10944preprocessor symbol @code{__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED} will also be
10945defined.
10946
10947@end table
10948
10949@node AVR Options
10950@subsection AVR Options
10951@cindex AVR Options
10952
10953@table @gcctabopt
10954@item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
10955@opindex mmcu
10956Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.
10957
10958For a complete list of @var{mcu} values that are supported by @command{avr-gcc},
10959see the compiler output when called with the @option{--help=target}
10960command line option.
10961The default for this option is@tie{}@code{avr2}.
10962
10963GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:
10964
10965@table @code
10966
10967@item avr2
10968``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10969@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90c8534}, @code{at90s2313},
10970@code{at90s2323}, @code{at90s2333}, @code{at90s2343},
10971@code{at90s4414}, @code{at90s4433}, @code{at90s4434},
10972@code{at90s8515}, @code{at90s8535}, @code{attiny22}, @code{attiny26}.
10973
10974@item avr25
10975``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory and with
10976the @code{MOVW} instruction.
10977@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at86rf401}, @code{ata6289}, @code{attiny13},
10978@code{attiny13a}, @code{attiny2313}, @code{attiny2313a},
10979@code{attiny24}, @code{attiny24a}, @code{attiny25}, @code{attiny261},
10980@code{attiny261a}, @code{attiny4313}, @code{attiny43u},
10981@code{attiny44}, @code{attiny44a}, @code{attiny45}, @code{attiny461},
10982@code{attiny461a}, @code{attiny48}, @code{attiny84}, @code{attiny84a},
10983@code{attiny85}, @code{attiny861}, @code{attiny861a}, @code{attiny87},
10984@code{attiny88}.
10985
10986@item avr3
10987``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of  program memory.
10988@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at43usb355}, @code{at76c711}.
10989
10990@item avr31
10991``Classic'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10992@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at43usb320}, @code{atmega103}.
10993
10994@item avr35
10995``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program
10996memory and with the @code{MOVW} instruction.
10997@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90usb162}, @code{at90usb82},
10998@code{atmega16u2}, @code{atmega32u2}, @code{atmega8u2},
10999@code{attiny167}.
11000
11001@item avr4
11002``Enhanced'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11003@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90pwm1}, @code{at90pwm2}, @code{at90pwm2b},
11004@code{at90pwm3}, @code{at90pwm3b}, @code{at90pwm81}, @code{atmega48},
11005@code{atmega48a}, @code{atmega48p}, @code{atmega8}, @code{atmega8515},
11006@code{atmega8535}, @code{atmega88}, @code{atmega88a},
11007@code{atmega88p}, @code{atmega88pa}, @code{atmega8hva}.
11008
11009@item avr5
11010``Enhanced'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11011@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90can32}, @code{at90can64},
11012@code{at90pwm216}, @code{at90pwm316}, @code{at90scr100},
11013@code{at90usb646}, @code{at90usb647}, @code{at94k}, @code{atmega16},
11014@code{atmega161}, @code{atmega162}, @code{atmega163},
11015@code{atmega164a}, @code{atmega164p}, @code{atmega165},
11016@code{atmega165a}, @code{atmega165p}, @code{atmega168},
11017@code{atmega168a}, @code{atmega168p}, @code{atmega169},
11018@code{atmega169a}, @code{atmega169p}, @code{atmega169pa},
11019@code{atmega16a}, @code{atmega16hva}, @code{atmega16hva2},
11020@code{atmega16hvb}, @code{atmega16m1}, @code{atmega16u4},
11021@code{atmega32}, @code{atmega323}, @code{atmega324a},
11022@code{atmega324p}, @code{atmega324pa}, @code{atmega325},
11023@code{atmega3250}, @code{atmega3250a}, @code{atmega3250p},
11024@code{atmega325a}, @code{atmega325p}, @code{atmega328},
11025@code{atmega328p}, @code{atmega329}, @code{atmega3290},
11026@code{atmega3290a}, @code{atmega3290p}, @code{atmega329a},
11027@code{atmega329p}, @code{atmega329pa}, @code{atmega32c1},
11028@code{atmega32hvb}, @code{atmega32m1}, @code{atmega32u4},
11029@code{atmega32u6}, @code{atmega406}, @code{atmega64},
11030@code{atmega640}, @code{atmega644}, @code{atmega644a},
11031@code{atmega644p}, @code{atmega644pa}, @code{atmega645},
11032@code{atmega6450}, @code{atmega6450a}, @code{atmega6450p},
11033@code{atmega645a}, @code{atmega645p}, @code{atmega649},
11034@code{atmega6490}, @code{atmega649a}, @code{atmega649p},
11035@code{atmega64c1}, @code{atmega64hve}, @code{atmega64m1},
11036@code{m3000}.
11037
11038@item avr51
11039``Enhanced'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11040@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90can128}, @code{at90usb1286},
11041@code{at90usb1287}, @code{atmega128}, @code{atmega1280},
11042@code{atmega1281}, @code{atmega1284p}, @code{atmega128rfa1}.
11043
11044@item avr6
11045``Enhanced'' devices with 3-byte PC, i.e.@: with more than
11046128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11047@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega2560}, @code{atmega2561}.
11048
11049@item avrxmega2
11050``XMEGA'' devices with more than 8@tie{}KiB and up to 64@tie{}KiB of
11051program memory.
11052@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega16a4}, @code{atxmega16d4},
11053@code{atxmega16x1}, @code{atxmega32a4}, @code{atxmega32d4},
11054@code{atxmega32x1}.
11055
11056@item avrxmega4
11057``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11058program memory.
11059@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a3}, @code{atxmega64d3}.
11060
11061@item avrxmega5
11062``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11063program memory and more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11064@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a1}, @code{atxmega64a1u}.
11065
11066@item avrxmega6
11067``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11068@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a3}, @code{atxmega128d3},
11069@code{atxmega192a3}, @code{atxmega192d3}, @code{atxmega256a3},
11070@code{atxmega256a3b}, @code{atxmega256a3bu}, @code{atxmega256d3}.
11071
11072@item avrxmega7
11073``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and
11074more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11075@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a1}, @code{atxmega128a1u}.
11076
11077@item avr1
11078This ISA is implemented by the minimal AVR core and supported for
11079assembler only.
11080@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at90s1200}, @code{attiny11}, @code{attiny12},
11081@code{attiny15}, @code{attiny28}.
11082
11083@end table
11084
11085@item -maccumulate-args
11086@opindex maccumulate-args
11087Accumulate outgoing function arguments and acquire/release the needed
11088stack space for outgoing function arguments once in function
11089prologue/epilogue.  Without this option, outgoing arguments are pushed
11090before calling a function and popped afterwards.
11091
11092Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on
11093AVR so that accumulating the stack space might lead to smaller
11094executables because arguments need not to be removed from the
11095stack after such a function call.
11096
11097This option can lead to reduced code size for functions that perform
11098several calls to functions that get their arguments on the stack like
11099calls to printf-like functions.
11100
11101@item -mbranch-cost=@var{cost}
11102@opindex mbranch-cost
11103Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to
11104@var{cost}.  Reasonable values for @var{cost} are small, non-negative
11105integers. The default branch cost is 0.
11106
11107@item -mcall-prologues
11108@opindex mcall-prologues
11109Functions prologues/epilogues are expanded as calls to appropriate
11110subroutines.  Code size is smaller.
11111
11112@item -mint8
11113@opindex mint8
11114Assume @code{int} to be 8-bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: a
11115@code{char} is 1 byte, an @code{int} is 1 byte, a @code{long} is 2 bytes,
11116and @code{long long} is 4 bytes.  Please note that this option does not
11117conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code
11118size.
11119
11120@item -mno-interrupts
11121@opindex mno-interrupts
11122Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
11123Code size is smaller.
11124
11125@item -mrelax
11126@opindex mrelax
11127Try to replace @code{CALL} resp.@: @code{JMP} instruction by the shorter
11128@code{RCALL} resp.@: @code{RJMP} instruction if applicable.
11129Setting @code{-mrelax} just adds the @code{--relax} option to the
11130linker command line when the linker is called.
11131
11132Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are not
11133known before code is located. Therefore, the assembler code generated by the
11134compiler is the same, but the instructions in the executable may
11135differ from instructions in the assembler code.
11136
11137Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the
11138section on @code{EIND} and linker stubs below.
11139
11140@item -mshort-calls
11141@opindex mshort-calls
11142Use @code{RCALL}/@code{RJMP} instructions even on devices with
1114316@tie{}KiB or more of program memory, i.e.@: on devices that
11144have the @code{CALL} and @code{JMP} instructions.
11145See also the @code{-mrelax} command line option.
11146
11147@item -msp8
11148@opindex msp8
11149Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register,
11150i.e.@: assume the high byte of the stack pointer is zero.
11151In general, you don't need to set this option by hand.
11152
11153This option is used internally by the compiler to select and
11154build multilibs for architectures @code{avr2} and @code{avr25}.
11155These architectures mix devices with and without @code{SPH}.
11156For any setting other than @code{-mmcu=avr2} or @code{-mmcu=avr25}
11157the compiler driver will add or remove this option from the compiler
11158proper's command line, because the compiler then knows if the device
11159or architecture has an 8-bit stack pointer and thus no @code{SPH}
11160register or not.
11161
11162@item -mstrict-X
11163@opindex mstrict-X
11164Use address register @code{X} in a way proposed by the hardware.  This means
11165that @code{X} is only used in indirect, post-increment or
11166pre-decrement addressing.
11167
11168Without this option, the @code{X} register may be used in the same way
11169as @code{Y} or @code{Z} which then is emulated by additional
11170instructions.
11171For example, loading a value with @code{X+const} addressing with a
11172small non-negative @code{const < 64} to a register @var{Rn} is
11173performed as
11174
11175@example
11176adiw r26, const   ; X += const
11177ld   @var{Rn}, X        ; @var{Rn} = *X
11178sbiw r26, const   ; X -= const
11179@end example
11180
11181@item -mtiny-stack
11182@opindex mtiny-stack
11183Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.
11184@end table
11185
11186@subsubsection @code{EIND} and Devices with more than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash
11187@cindex @code{EIND}
11188Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide.
11189The address of a function or label is represented as word address so
11190that indirect jumps and calls can target any code address in the
11191range of 64@tie{}Ki words.
11192
11193In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than 128@tie{}Ki
11194bytes of program memory space, there is a special function register called
11195@code{EIND} that serves as most significant part of the target address
11196when @code{EICALL} or @code{EIJMP} instructions are used.
11197
11198Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by
11199the compiler and are subject to some limitations:
11200
11201@itemize @bullet
11202
11203@item
11204The compiler never sets @code{EIND}.
11205
11206@item
11207The compiler uses @code{EIND} implicitely in @code{EICALL}/@code{EIJMP}
11208instructions or might read @code{EIND} directly in order to emulate an
11209indirect call/jump by means of a @code{RET} instruction.
11210
11211@item
11212The compiler assumes that @code{EIND} never changes during the startup
11213code or during the application. In particular, @code{EIND} is not
11214saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine
11215prologue/epilogue.
11216
11217@item
11218For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker
11219generates @emph{stubs}. Stubs are jump pads sometimes also called
11220@emph{trampolines}. Thus, the indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.
11221The stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.
11222
11223@item
11224Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker will generate
11225the stubs correctly an all situaltion. See the compiler option
11226@code{-mrelax} and the linler option @code{--relax}.
11227There are corner cases where the linker is supposed to generate stubs
11228but aborts without relaxation and without a helpful error message.
11229
11230@item
11231The default linker script is arranged for code with @code{EIND = 0}.
11232If code is supposed to work for a setup with @code{EIND != 0}, a custom
11233linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
11234name start with @code{.trampolines} into the segment where @code{EIND}
11235points to.
11236
11237@item
11238The startup code from libgcc never sets @code{EIND}.
11239Notice that startup code is a blend of code from libgcc and AVR-LibC.
11240For the impact of AVR-LibC on @code{EIND}, see the
11241@w{@uref{http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual,AVR-LibC user manual}}.
11242
11243@item
11244It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up @code{EIND}
11245early, for example by means of initialization code located in
11246section @code{.init3}. Such code runs prior to general startup code
11247that initializes RAM and calls constructors, but after the bit
11248of startup code from AVR-LibC that sets @code{EIND} to the segment
11249where the vector table is located.
11250@example
11251#include <avr/io.h>
11252
11253static void
11254__attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
11255init3_set_eind (void)
11256@{
11257  __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
11258                  "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
11259@}
11260@end example
11261
11262@noindent
11263The @code{__trampolines_start} symbol is defined in the linker script.
11264
11265@item
11266Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if
11267the following two conditions are met:
11268@itemize @minus
11269
11270@item The address of a label is taken by means of the @code{gs} modifier
11271(short for @emph{generate stubs}) like so:
11272@example
11273LDI r24, lo8(gs(@var{func}))
11274LDI r25, hi8(gs(@var{func}))
11275@end example
11276@item The final location of that label is in a code segment
11277@emph{outside} the segment where the stubs are located.
11278@end itemize
11279
11280@item
11281The compiler emits such @code{gs} modifiers for code labels in the
11282following situations:
11283@itemize @minus
11284@item Taking address of a function or code label.
11285@item Computed goto.
11286@item If prologue-save function is used, see @option{-mcall-prologues}
11287command-line option.
11288@item Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch
11289tables you can specify the @option{-fno-jump-tables} command-line option.
11290@item C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.
11291@item If the tools hit a @code{gs()} modifier explained above.
11292@end itemize
11293
11294@item
11295Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is @emph{not} supported:
11296
11297@example
11298int main (void)
11299@{
11300    /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
11301    return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
11302@}
11303@end example
11304
11305Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e.@: the function has to be called
11306through a symbol (@code{func_4} in the example):
11307
11308@example
11309int main (void)
11310@{
11311    extern int func_4 (void);
11312
11313    /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
11314    return func_4();
11315@}
11316@end example
11317
11318and the application be linked with @code{-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4}.
11319Alternatively, @code{func_4} can be defined in the linker script.
11320@end itemize
11321
11322@subsubsection Handling of the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY} and @code{RAMPZ} Special Function Registers
11323@cindex @code{RAMPD}
11324@cindex @code{RAMPX}
11325@cindex @code{RAMPY}
11326@cindex @code{RAMPZ}
11327Some AVR devices support memories larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range
11328that can be accessed with 16-bit pointers.  To access memory locations
11329outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the contentent of a @code{RAMP}
11330register is used as high part of the address:
11331The @code{X}, @code{Y}, @code{Z} address register is concatenated
11332with the @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY}, @code{RAMPZ} special function
11333register, respectively, to get a wide address. Similarly,
11334@code{RAMPD} is used together with direct addressing.
11335
11336@itemize
11337@item
11338The startup code initializes the @code{RAMP} special function
11339registers with zero.
11340
11341@item
11342If a @ref{AVR Named Address Spaces,named address space} other than
11343generic or @code{__flash} is used, then @code{RAMPZ} is set
11344as needed before the operation.
11345
11346@item
11347If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} and the compiler
11348needs to change @code{RAMPZ} to accomplish an operation, @code{RAMPZ}
11349is reset to zero after the operation.
11350
11351@item
11352If the device comes with a specific @code{RAMP} register, the ISR
11353prologue/epilogue saves/restores that SFR and initializes it with
11354zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.
11355
11356@item
11357RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} is not supported by GCC for AVR targets.
11358If you use inline assembler to read from locations outside the
1135916-bit address range and change one of the @code{RAMP} registers,
11360you must reset it to zero after the access.
11361
11362@end itemize
11363
11364@subsubsection AVR Built-in Macros
11365
11366GCC defines several built-in macros so that the user code can test
11367for the presence or absence of features.  Almost any of the following
11368built-in macros are deduced from device capabilities and thus
11369triggered by the @code{-mmcu=} command-line option.
11370
11371For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see
11372@ref{AVR Named Address Spaces} and @ref{AVR Built-in Functions}.
11373
11374@table @code
11375
11376@item __AVR_@var{Device}__
11377Setting @code{-mmcu=@var{device}} defines this built-in macro which reflects
11378the device's name. For example, @code{-mmcu=atmega8} defines the
11379built-in macro @code{__AVR_ATmega8__}, @code{-mmcu=attiny261a} defines
11380@code{__AVR_ATtiny261A__}, etc.
11381
11382The built-in macros' names follow
11383the scheme @code{__AVR_@var{Device}__} where @var{Device} is
11384the device name as from the AVR user manual. The difference between
11385@var{Device} in the built-in macro and @var{device} in
11386@code{-mmcu=@var{device}} is that the latter is always lowercase.
11387
11388@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPM__
11389The device has the the @code{ELPM} instruction.
11390
11391@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__
11392The device has the @code{ELPM R@var{n},Z} and @code{ELPM
11393R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11394
11395@item __AVR_HAVE_MOVW__
11396The device has the @code{MOVW} instruction to perform 16-bit
11397register-register moves.
11398
11399@item __AVR_HAVE_LPMX__
11400The device has the @code{LPM R@var{n},Z} and
11401@code{LPM R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11402
11403@item __AVR_HAVE_MUL__
11404The device has a hardware multiplier.
11405
11406@item __AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__
11407The device has the @code{JMP} and @code{CALL} instructions.
11408This is the case for devices with at least 16@tie{}KiB of program
11409memory and if @code{-mshort-calls} is not set.
11410
11411@item __AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__
11412@item __AVR_3_BYTE_PC__
11413The device has the @code{EIJMP} and @code{EICALL} instructions.
11414This is the case for devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11415This also means that the program counter
11416(PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.
11417
11418@item __AVR_2_BYTE_PC__
11419The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for devices
11420with up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11421
11422@item __AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__
11423@item __AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__
11424The stack pointer (SP) register is treated as 8-bit respectively
1142516-bit register by the compiler.
11426The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mtiny-stack}.
11427
11428@item __AVR_HAVE_SPH__
11429@item __AVR_SP8__
11430The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special function
11431register or has an 8-bit stack pointer, respectively.
11432The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mmcu=} and
11433in the cases of @code{-mmcu=avr2} and @code{-mmcu=avr25} also
11434by @code{-msp8}.
11435
11436@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__
11437@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__
11438@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__
11439@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__
11440The device has the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY},
11441@code{RAMPZ} special function register, respectively.
11442
11443@item __NO_INTERRUPTS__
11444This macro reflects the @code{-mno-interrupts} command line option.
11445
11446@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__
11447@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__
11448Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip 32-bit
11449instructions because of a hardware erratum.  Skip instructions are
11450@code{SBRS}, @code{SBRC}, @code{SBIS}, @code{SBIC} and @code{CPSE}.
11451The second macro is only defined if @code{__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__} is also
11452set.
11453
11454@item __AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=@var{offset}
11455Instructions that can address I/O special function registers directly
11456like @code{IN}, @code{OUT}, @code{SBI}, etc.@: may use a different
11457address as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like @code{LD}
11458or @code{STS}. This offset depends on the device architecture and has
11459to be subtracted from the RAM address in order to get the
11460respective I/O@tie{}address.
11461
11462@item __WITH_AVRLIBC__
11463The compiler is configured to be used together with AVR-Libc.
11464See the @code{--with-avrlibc} configure option.
11465
11466@end table
11467
11468@node Blackfin Options
11469@subsection Blackfin Options
11470@cindex Blackfin Options
11471
11472@table @gcctabopt
11473@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}
11474@opindex mcpu=
11475Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor.  Currently, @var{cpu}
11476can be one of @samp{bf512}, @samp{bf514}, @samp{bf516}, @samp{bf518},
11477@samp{bf522}, @samp{bf523}, @samp{bf524}, @samp{bf525}, @samp{bf526},
11478@samp{bf527}, @samp{bf531}, @samp{bf532}, @samp{bf533},
11479@samp{bf534}, @samp{bf536}, @samp{bf537}, @samp{bf538}, @samp{bf539},
11480@samp{bf542}, @samp{bf544}, @samp{bf547}, @samp{bf548}, @samp{bf549},
11481@samp{bf542m}, @samp{bf544m}, @samp{bf547m}, @samp{bf548m}, @samp{bf549m},
11482@samp{bf561}, @samp{bf592}.
11483The optional @var{sirevision} specifies the silicon revision of the target
11484Blackfin processor.  Any workarounds available for the targeted silicon revision
11485will be enabled.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, no workarounds are enabled.
11486If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, all workarounds for the targeted processor
11487will be enabled.  The @code{__SILICON_REVISION__} macro is defined to two
11488hexadecimal digits representing the major and minor numbers in the silicon
11489revision.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, the @code{__SILICON_REVISION__}
11490is not defined.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, the
11491@code{__SILICON_REVISION__} is defined to be @code{0xffff}.
11492If this optional @var{sirevision} is not used, GCC assumes the latest known
11493silicon revision of the targeted Blackfin processor.
11494
11495Support for @samp{bf561} is incomplete.  For @samp{bf561},
11496Only the processor macro is defined.
11497Without this option, @samp{bf532} is used as the processor by default.
11498The corresponding predefined processor macros for @var{cpu} is to
11499be defined.  And for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain, this causes the hardware BSP
11500provided by libgloss to be linked in if @option{-msim} is not given.
11501
11502@item -msim
11503@opindex msim
11504Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
11505the simulator BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in.  This option
11506has effect only for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain.
11507Certain other options, such as @option{-mid-shared-library} and
11508@option{-mfdpic}, imply @option{-msim}.
11509
11510@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11511@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11512Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
11513avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
11514makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
11515@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
11516which might make debugging harder.
11517
11518@item -mspecld-anomaly
11519@opindex mspecld-anomaly
11520When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11521contain speculative loads after jump instructions. If this option is used,
11522@code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS} is defined.
11523
11524@item -mno-specld-anomaly
11525@opindex mno-specld-anomaly
11526Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.
11527
11528@item -mcsync-anomaly
11529@opindex mcsync-anomaly
11530When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11531contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional branches.
11532If this option is used, @code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS} is defined.
11533
11534@item -mno-csync-anomaly
11535@opindex mno-csync-anomaly
11536Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from
11537occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
11538
11539@item -mlow-64k
11540@opindex mlow-64k
11541When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that
11542the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
11543
11544@item -mno-low-64k
11545@opindex mno-low-64k
11546Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.
11547
11548@item -mstack-check-l1
11549@opindex mstack-check-l1
11550Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the
11551uClinux kernel.
11552
11553@item -mid-shared-library
11554@opindex mid-shared-library
11555Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
11556This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
11557without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
11558With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
11559
11560@item -mno-id-shared-library
11561@opindex mno-id-shared-library
11562Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
11563This is the default.
11564
11565@item -mleaf-id-shared-library
11566@opindex mleaf-id-shared-library
11567Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method,
11568but assumes that this library or executable won't link against any other
11569ID shared libraries.  That allows the compiler to use faster code for jumps
11570and calls.
11571
11572@item -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11573@opindex mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11574Do not assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared
11575libraries.  Slower code will be generated for jump and call insns.
11576
11577@item -mshared-library-id=n
11578@opindex mshared-library-id
11579Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
11580compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
11581other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
11582library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
11583
11584@item -msep-data
11585@opindex msep-data
11586Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
11587area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
11588an environment without virtual memory management by eliminating relocations
11589against the text section.
11590
11591@item -mno-sep-data
11592@opindex mno-sep-data
11593Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
11594This is the default.
11595
11596@item -mlong-calls
11597@itemx -mno-long-calls
11598@opindex mlong-calls
11599@opindex mno-long-calls
11600Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
11601address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
11602call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
11603lies outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the offset-based
11604version of subroutine call instruction.
11605
11606This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
11607@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior.  Note these
11608switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle
11609function calls via function pointers.
11610
11611@item -mfast-fp
11612@opindex mfast-fp
11613Link with the fast floating-point library. This library relaxes some of
11614the IEEE floating-point standard's rules for checking inputs against
11615Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.
11616
11617@item -minline-plt
11618@opindex minline-plt
11619Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
11620not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
11621
11622@item -mmulticore
11623@opindex mmulticore
11624Build standalone application for multicore Blackfin processor. Proper
11625start files and link scripts will be used to support multicore.
11626This option defines @code{__BFIN_MULTICORE}. It can only be used with
11627@option{-mcpu=bf561@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}}. It can be used with
11628@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}. If it's used without
11629@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}, single application/dual core
11630programming model is used. In this model, the main function of Core B
11631should be named as coreb_main. If it's used with @option{-mcorea} or
11632@option{-mcoreb}, one application per core programming model is used.
11633If this option is not used, single core application programming
11634model is used.
11635
11636@item -mcorea
11637@opindex mcorea
11638Build standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using
11639one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11640and link scripts will be used to support Core A. This option
11641defines @code{__BFIN_COREA}. It must be used with @option{-mmulticore}.
11642
11643@item -mcoreb
11644@opindex mcoreb
11645Build standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using
11646one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11647and link scripts will be used to support Core B. This option
11648defines @code{__BFIN_COREB}. When this option is used, coreb_main
11649should be used instead of main. It must be used with
11650@option{-mmulticore}.
11651
11652@item -msdram
11653@opindex msdram
11654Build standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and
11655link scripts will be used to put the application into SDRAM.
11656Loader should initialize SDRAM before loading the application
11657into SDRAM. This option defines @code{__BFIN_SDRAM}.
11658
11659@item -micplb
11660@opindex micplb
11661Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time.  This has an effect on certain
11662anomaly workarounds.  For Linux targets, the default is to assume ICPLBs
11663are enabled; for standalone applications the default is off.
11664@end table
11665
11666@node C6X Options
11667@subsection C6X Options
11668@cindex C6X Options
11669
11670@table @gcctabopt
11671@item -march=@var{name}
11672@opindex march
11673This specifies the name of the target architecture.  GCC uses this
11674name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
11675assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{c62x},
11676@samp{c64x}, @samp{c64x+}, @samp{c67x}, @samp{c67x+}, @samp{c674x}.
11677
11678@item -mbig-endian
11679@opindex mbig-endian
11680Generate code for a big-endian target.
11681
11682@item -mlittle-endian
11683@opindex mlittle-endian
11684Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default.
11685
11686@item -msim
11687@opindex msim
11688Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
11689
11690@item -msdata=default
11691@opindex msdata=default
11692Put small global and static data in the @samp{.neardata} section,
11693which is pointed to by register @code{B14}.  Put small uninitialized
11694global and static data in the @samp{.bss} section, which is adjacent
11695to the @samp{.neardata} section.  Put small read-only data into the
11696@samp{.rodata} section.  The corresponding sections used for large
11697pieces of data are @samp{.fardata}, @samp{.far} and @samp{.const}.
11698
11699@item -msdata=all
11700@opindex msdata=all
11701Put all data, not just small objets, into the sections reserved for
11702small data, and use addressing relative to the @code{B14} register to
11703access them.
11704
11705@item -msdata=none
11706@opindex msdata=none
11707Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use absolute
11708addresses to access all data.  Put all initialized global and static
11709data in the @samp{.fardata} section, and all uninitialized data in the
11710@samp{.far} section.  Put all constant data into the @samp{.const}
11711section.
11712@end table
11713
11714@node CRIS Options
11715@subsection CRIS Options
11716@cindex CRIS Options
11717
11718These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
11719
11720@table @gcctabopt
11721@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
11722@itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
11723@opindex march
11724@opindex mcpu
11725Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
11726@var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
11727respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX@.
11728Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
11729@samp{v10}.
11730
11731@item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
11732@opindex mtune
11733Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
11734code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The
11735choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
11736@option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
11737
11738@item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
11739@opindex mmax-stack-frame
11740Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
11741
11742@item -metrax4
11743@itemx -metrax100
11744@opindex metrax4
11745@opindex metrax100
11746The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
11747@option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
11748
11749@item -mmul-bug-workaround
11750@itemx -mno-mul-bug-workaround
11751@opindex mmul-bug-workaround
11752@opindex mno-mul-bug-workaround
11753Work around a bug in the @code{muls} and @code{mulu} instructions for CPU
11754models where it applies.  This option is active by default.
11755
11756@item -mpdebug
11757@opindex mpdebug
11758Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
11759code.  This option also has the effect to turn off the @samp{#NO_APP}
11760formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
11761assembly file.
11762
11763@item -mcc-init
11764@opindex mcc-init
11765Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
11766compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
11767
11768@item -mno-side-effects
11769@opindex mno-side-effects
11770Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than
11771post-increment.
11772
11773@item -mstack-align
11774@itemx -mno-stack-align
11775@itemx -mdata-align
11776@itemx -mno-data-align
11777@itemx -mconst-align
11778@itemx -mno-const-align
11779@opindex mstack-align
11780@opindex mno-stack-align
11781@opindex mdata-align
11782@opindex mno-data-align
11783@opindex mconst-align
11784@opindex mno-const-align
11785These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the
11786stack-frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
11787single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The default is to
11788arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are
11789not affected by these options.
11790
11791@item -m32-bit
11792@itemx -m16-bit
11793@itemx -m8-bit
11794@opindex m32-bit
11795@opindex m16-bit
11796@opindex m8-bit
11797Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
11798arrange for stack-frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
1179916-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit alignment.
11800
11801@item -mno-prologue-epilogue
11802@itemx -mprologue-epilogue
11803@opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
11804@opindex mprologue-epilogue
11805With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
11806epilogue which set up the stack frame are omitted and no return
11807instructions or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
11808option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
11809warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
11810or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.
11811
11812@item -mno-gotplt
11813@itemx -mgotplt
11814@opindex mno-gotplt
11815@opindex mgotplt
11816With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
11817instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
11818of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
11819PLT@.  The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
11820
11821@item -melf
11822@opindex melf
11823Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
11824cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
11825
11826@item -mlinux
11827@opindex mlinux
11828Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
11829
11830@item -sim
11831@opindex sim
11832This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf arranges
11833to link with input-output functions from a simulator library.  Code,
11834initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
11835
11836@item -sim2
11837@opindex sim2
11838Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
118390x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
11840@end table
11841
11842@node CR16 Options
11843@subsection CR16 Options
11844@cindex CR16 Options
11845
11846These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.
11847
11848@table @gcctabopt
11849
11850@item -mmac
11851@opindex mmac
11852Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
11853
11854@item -mcr16cplus
11855@itemx -mcr16c
11856@opindex mcr16cplus
11857@opindex mcr16c
11858Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture
11859is default.
11860
11861@item -msim
11862@opindex msim
11863Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator. Applicable
11864to elf compiler only.
11865
11866@item -mint32
11867@opindex mint32
11868Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.
11869
11870@item -mbit-ops
11871@opindex mbit-ops
11872Generates sbit/cbit instructions for bit manipulations.
11873
11874@item -mdata-model=@var{model}
11875@opindex mdata-model
11876Choose a data model. The choices for @var{model} are @samp{near},
11877@samp{far} or @samp{medium}. @samp{medium} is default.
11878However, @samp{far} is not valid when -mcr16c option is chosen as
11879CR16C architecture does not support far data model.
11880@end table
11881
11882@node Darwin Options
11883@subsection Darwin Options
11884@cindex Darwin options
11885
11886These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating
11887system.
11888
11889FSF GCC on Darwin does not create ``fat'' object files; it will create
11890an object file for the single architecture that it was built to
11891target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create ``fat'' files if multiple
11892@option{-arch} options are used; it does so by running the compiler or
11893linker multiple times and joining the results together with
11894@file{lipo}.
11895
11896The subtype of the file created (like @samp{ppc7400} or @samp{ppc970} or
11897@samp{i686}) is determined by the flags that specify the ISA
11898that GCC is targetting, like @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march}.  The
11899@option{-force_cpusubtype_ALL} option can be used to override this.
11900
11901The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
11902mismatch.  The assembler, @file{as}, will only permit instructions to
11903be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,
11904so you cannot put 64-bit instructions in a @samp{ppc750} object file.
11905The linker for shared libraries, @file{/usr/bin/libtool}, will fail
11906and print an error if asked to create a shared library with a less
11907restrictive subtype than its input files (for instance, trying to put
11908a @samp{ppc970} object file in a @samp{ppc7400} library).  The linker
11909for executables, @file{ld}, will quietly give the executable the most
11910restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
11911
11912@table @gcctabopt
11913@item -F@var{dir}
11914@opindex F
11915Add the framework directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of
11916directories to be searched for header files.  These directories are
11917interleaved with those specified by @option{-I} options and are
11918scanned in a left-to-right order.
11919
11920A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it.  A
11921framework is a directory with a @samp{"Headers"} and/or
11922@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} directory contained directly in it that ends
11923in @samp{".framework"}.  The name of a framework is the name of this
11924directory excluding the @samp{".framework"}.  Headers associated with
11925the framework are found in one of those two directories, with
11926@samp{"Headers"} being searched first.  A subframework is a framework
11927directory that is in a framework's @samp{"Frameworks"} directory.
11928Includes of subframework headers can only appear in a header of a
11929framework that contains the subframework, or in a sibling subframework
11930header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same
11931framework.  A subframework should not have the same name as a
11932framework, a warning will be issued if this is violated.  Currently a
11933subframework cannot have subframeworks, in the future, the mechanism
11934may be extended to support this.  The standard frameworks can be found
11935in @samp{"/System/Library/Frameworks"} and
11936@samp{"/Library/Frameworks"}.  An example include looks like
11937@code{#include <Framework/header.h>}, where @samp{Framework} denotes
11938the name of the framework and header.h is found in the
11939@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} or @samp{"Headers"} directory.
11940
11941@item -iframework@var{dir}
11942@opindex iframework
11943Like @option{-F} except the directory is a treated as a system
11944directory.  The main difference between this @option{-iframework} and
11945@option{-F} is that with @option{-iframework} the compiler does not
11946warn about constructs contained within header files found via
11947@var{dir}.  This option is valid only for the C family of languages.
11948
11949@item -gused
11950@opindex gused
11951Emit debugging information for symbols that are used.  For STABS
11952debugging format, this enables @option{-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols}.
11953This is by default ON@.
11954
11955@item -gfull
11956@opindex gfull
11957Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
11958
11959@item -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version}
11960The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on
11961is @var{version}.  Typical values of @var{version} include @code{10.1},
11962@code{10.2}, and @code{10.3.9}.
11963
11964If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default,
11965then the default for this option is the system version on which the
11966compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices that
11967are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.
11968
11969@item -mkernel
11970@opindex mkernel
11971Enable kernel development mode.  The @option{-mkernel} option sets
11972@option{-static}, @option{-fno-common}, @option{-fno-cxa-atexit},
11973@option{-fno-exceptions}, @option{-fno-non-call-exceptions},
11974@option{-fapple-kext}, @option{-fno-weak} and @option{-fno-rtti} where
11975applicable.  This mode also sets @option{-mno-altivec},
11976@option{-msoft-float}, @option{-fno-builtin} and
11977@option{-mlong-branch} for PowerPC targets.
11978
11979@item -mone-byte-bool
11980@opindex mone-byte-bool
11981Override the defaults for @samp{bool} so that @samp{sizeof(bool)==1}.
11982By default @samp{sizeof(bool)} is @samp{4} when compiling for
11983Darwin/PowerPC and @samp{1} when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this
11984option has no effect on x86.
11985
11986@strong{Warning:} The @option{-mone-byte-bool} switch causes GCC
11987to generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated
11988without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all
11989other modules in a program, including system libraries.  Use this
11990switch to conform to a non-default data model.
11991
11992@item -mfix-and-continue
11993@itemx -ffix-and-continue
11994@itemx -findirect-data
11995@opindex mfix-and-continue
11996@opindex ffix-and-continue
11997@opindex findirect-data
11998Generate code suitable for fast turn around development.  Needed to
11999enable gdb to dynamically load @code{.o} files into already running
12000programs.  @option{-findirect-data} and @option{-ffix-and-continue}
12001are provided for backwards compatibility.
12002
12003@item -all_load
12004@opindex all_load
12005Loads all members of static archive libraries.
12006See man ld(1) for more information.
12007
12008@item -arch_errors_fatal
12009@opindex arch_errors_fatal
12010Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
12011to be fatal.
12012
12013@item -bind_at_load
12014@opindex bind_at_load
12015Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
12016bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
12017
12018@item -bundle
12019@opindex bundle
12020Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
12021See man ld(1) for more information.
12022
12023@item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
12024@opindex bundle_loader
12025This option specifies the @var{executable} that will be loading the build
12026output file being linked.  See man ld(1) for more information.
12027
12028@item -dynamiclib
12029@opindex dynamiclib
12030When passed this option, GCC will produce a dynamic library instead of
12031an executable when linking, using the Darwin @file{libtool} command.
12032
12033@item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
12034@opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
12035This causes GCC's output file to have the @var{ALL} subtype, instead of
12036one controlled by the @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march} option.
12037
12038@item -allowable_client  @var{client_name}
12039@itemx -client_name
12040@itemx -compatibility_version
12041@itemx -current_version
12042@itemx -dead_strip
12043@itemx -dependency-file
12044@itemx -dylib_file
12045@itemx -dylinker_install_name
12046@itemx -dynamic
12047@itemx -exported_symbols_list
12048@itemx -filelist
12049@need 800
12050@itemx -flat_namespace
12051@itemx -force_flat_namespace
12052@itemx -headerpad_max_install_names
12053@itemx -image_base
12054@itemx -init
12055@itemx -install_name
12056@itemx -keep_private_externs
12057@itemx -multi_module
12058@itemx -multiply_defined
12059@itemx -multiply_defined_unused
12060@need 800
12061@itemx -noall_load
12062@itemx -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12063@itemx -nofixprebinding
12064@itemx -nomultidefs
12065@itemx -noprebind
12066@itemx -noseglinkedit
12067@itemx -pagezero_size
12068@itemx -prebind
12069@itemx -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12070@itemx -private_bundle
12071@need 800
12072@itemx -read_only_relocs
12073@itemx -sectalign
12074@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12075@itemx -whyload
12076@itemx -seg1addr
12077@itemx -sectcreate
12078@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12079@itemx -sectorder
12080@itemx -segaddr
12081@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12082@need 800
12083@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12084@itemx -seg_addr_table
12085@itemx -seg_addr_table_filename
12086@itemx -seglinkedit
12087@itemx -segprot
12088@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12089@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12090@itemx -single_module
12091@itemx -static
12092@itemx -sub_library
12093@need 800
12094@itemx -sub_umbrella
12095@itemx -twolevel_namespace
12096@itemx -umbrella
12097@itemx -undefined
12098@itemx -unexported_symbols_list
12099@itemx -weak_reference_mismatches
12100@itemx -whatsloaded
12101@opindex allowable_client
12102@opindex client_name
12103@opindex compatibility_version
12104@opindex current_version
12105@opindex dead_strip
12106@opindex dependency-file
12107@opindex dylib_file
12108@opindex dylinker_install_name
12109@opindex dynamic
12110@opindex exported_symbols_list
12111@opindex filelist
12112@opindex flat_namespace
12113@opindex force_flat_namespace
12114@opindex headerpad_max_install_names
12115@opindex image_base
12116@opindex init
12117@opindex install_name
12118@opindex keep_private_externs
12119@opindex multi_module
12120@opindex multiply_defined
12121@opindex multiply_defined_unused
12122@opindex noall_load
12123@opindex no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12124@opindex nofixprebinding
12125@opindex nomultidefs
12126@opindex noprebind
12127@opindex noseglinkedit
12128@opindex pagezero_size
12129@opindex prebind
12130@opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12131@opindex private_bundle
12132@opindex read_only_relocs
12133@opindex sectalign
12134@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12135@opindex whyload
12136@opindex seg1addr
12137@opindex sectcreate
12138@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12139@opindex sectorder
12140@opindex segaddr
12141@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12142@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12143@opindex seg_addr_table
12144@opindex seg_addr_table_filename
12145@opindex seglinkedit
12146@opindex segprot
12147@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12148@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12149@opindex single_module
12150@opindex static
12151@opindex sub_library
12152@opindex sub_umbrella
12153@opindex twolevel_namespace
12154@opindex umbrella
12155@opindex undefined
12156@opindex unexported_symbols_list
12157@opindex weak_reference_mismatches
12158@opindex whatsloaded
12159These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page
12160describes them in detail.
12161@end table
12162
12163@node DEC Alpha Options
12164@subsection DEC Alpha Options
12165
12166These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
12167
12168@table @gcctabopt
12169@item -mno-soft-float
12170@itemx -msoft-float
12171@opindex mno-soft-float
12172@opindex msoft-float
12173Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
12174floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
12175functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
12176operations.  Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
12177floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
12178emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point
12179operations.   If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
12180operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
12181them.
12182
12183Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
12184required to have floating-point registers.
12185
12186@item -mfp-reg
12187@itemx -mno-fp-regs
12188@opindex mfp-reg
12189@opindex mno-fp-regs
12190Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
12191@option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}.  If the floating-point
12192register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed in integer
12193registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
12194in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}.  This is a non-standard calling sequence,
12195so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
12196compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
12197option.
12198
12199A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
12200and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
12201
12202@item -mieee
12203@opindex mieee
12204The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
12205maximum performance.  It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating-point
12206standard.  However, for full compliance, software assistance is
12207required.  This option generates code fully IEEE-compliant code
12208@emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
12209If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
12210defined during compilation.  The resulting code is less efficient but is
12211able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
12212values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha
12213compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
12214
12215@item -mieee-with-inexact
12216@opindex mieee-with-inexact
12217This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
12218the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}.  Turning on this option causes the
12219generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to
12220@code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
12221macro.  On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
12222significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is
12223very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
12224normally not specify this option.  Other Alpha compilers call this
12225option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
12226
12227@item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
12228@opindex mfp-trap-mode
12229This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
12230Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
12231The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
12232
12233@table @samp
12234@item n
12235This is the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled
12236are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
12237trap).
12238
12239@item u
12240In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
12241as well.
12242
12243@item su
12244Like @samp{u}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
12245completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
12246
12247@item sui
12248Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
12249@end table
12250
12251@item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
12252@opindex mfp-rounding-mode
12253Selects the IEEE rounding mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this option
12254@option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}.  The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
12255of:
12256
12257@table @samp
12258@item n
12259Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards
12260the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
12261of a tie.
12262
12263@item m
12264Round towards minus infinity.
12265
12266@item c
12267Chopped rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards zero.
12268
12269@item d
12270Dynamic rounding mode.  A field in the floating-point control register
12271(@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
12272rounding mode in effect.  The C library initializes this register for
12273rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the
12274@var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
12275@end table
12276
12277@item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
12278@opindex mtrap-precision
12279In the Alpha architecture, floating-point traps are imprecise.  This
12280means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
12281floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
12282GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
12283in determining the exact location that caused a floating-point trap.
12284Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
12285precisions can be selected:
12286
12287@table @samp
12288@item p
12289Program precision.  This option is the default and means a trap handler
12290can only identify which program caused a floating-point exception.
12291
12292@item f
12293Function precision.  The trap handler can determine the function that
12294caused a floating-point exception.
12295
12296@item i
12297Instruction precision.  The trap handler can determine the exact
12298instruction that caused a floating-point exception.
12299@end table
12300
12301Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
12302@option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
12303
12304@item -mieee-conformant
12305@opindex mieee-conformant
12306This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not
12307use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
12308@option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}.  Its only effect
12309is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
12310generated assembly file.  Under DEC Unix, this has the effect that
12311IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.
12312
12313@item -mbuild-constants
12314@opindex mbuild-constants
12315Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
12316see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
12317instructions.  If it cannot, it will output the constant as a literal and
12318generate code to load it from the data segment at run time.
12319
12320Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
12321using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
12322
12323You would typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
12324loader.  Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
12325before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
12326
12327@item -malpha-as
12328@itemx -mgas
12329@opindex malpha-as
12330@opindex mgas
12331Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied
12332assembler (@option{-malpha-as}) or by the GNU assembler @option{-mgas}.
12333
12334@item -mbwx
12335@itemx -mno-bwx
12336@itemx -mcix
12337@itemx -mno-cix
12338@itemx -mfix
12339@itemx -mno-fix
12340@itemx -mmax
12341@itemx -mno-max
12342@opindex mbwx
12343@opindex mno-bwx
12344@opindex mcix
12345@opindex mno-cix
12346@opindex mfix
12347@opindex mno-fix
12348@opindex mmax
12349@opindex mno-max
12350Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
12351CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.  The default is to use the instruction
12352sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
12353of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.
12354
12355@item -mfloat-vax
12356@itemx -mfloat-ieee
12357@opindex mfloat-vax
12358@opindex mfloat-ieee
12359Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point
12360arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
12361
12362@item -mexplicit-relocs
12363@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
12364@opindex mexplicit-relocs
12365@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
12366Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
12367except via assembler macros.  Use of these macros does not allow
12368optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of version 2.12
12369supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
12370which relocations should apply to which instructions.  This option
12371is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
12372the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
12373
12374@item -msmall-data
12375@itemx -mlarge-data
12376@opindex msmall-data
12377@opindex mlarge-data
12378When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
12379accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12380is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
12381(the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
1238216-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register.  This limits the
12383size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
12384directly accessed via a single instruction.
12385
12386The default is @option{-mlarge-data}.  With this option the data area
12387is limited to just below 2GB@.  Programs that require more than 2GB of
12388data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
12389heap instead of in the program's data segment.
12390
12391When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
12392@option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
12393
12394@item -msmall-text
12395@itemx -mlarge-text
12396@opindex msmall-text
12397@opindex mlarge-text
12398When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
12399code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
12400thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12401is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
12402same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
12403required for a function call from 4 to 1.
12404
12405The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
12406
12407@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
12408@opindex mcpu
12409Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
12410machine type @var{cpu_type}.  You can specify either the @samp{EV}
12411style name or the corresponding chip number.  GCC supports scheduling
12412parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will
12413choose the default values for the instruction set from the processor
12414you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will default
12415to the processor on which the compiler was built.
12416
12417Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
12418
12419@table @samp
12420@item ev4
12421@itemx ev45
12422@itemx 21064
12423Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
12424
12425@item ev5
12426@itemx 21164
12427Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
12428
12429@item ev56
12430@itemx 21164a
12431Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
12432
12433@item pca56
12434@itemx 21164pc
12435@itemx 21164PC
12436Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
12437
12438@item ev6
12439@itemx 21264
12440Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12441
12442@item ev67
12443@itemx 21264a
12444Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12445@end table
12446
12447Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12448which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12449@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12450the processor.
12451
12452@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
12453@opindex mtune
12454Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
12455@var{cpu_type}.  The instruction set is not changed.
12456
12457Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12458which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12459@option{-mtune=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12460the processor.
12461
12462@item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
12463@opindex mmemory-latency
12464Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
12465references as seen by the application.  This number is highly
12466dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
12467and the size of the external cache on the machine.
12468
12469Valid options for @var{time} are
12470
12471@table @samp
12472@item @var{number}
12473A decimal number representing clock cycles.
12474
12475@item L1
12476@itemx L2
12477@itemx L3
12478@itemx main
12479The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
12480``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
12481(also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
12482Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
12483
12484@end table
12485@end table
12486
12487@node DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12488@subsection DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12489
12490These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:
12491
12492@table @gcctabopt
12493@item -mvms-return-codes
12494@opindex mvms-return-codes
12495Return VMS condition codes from main.  The default is to return POSIX
12496style condition (e.g.@: error) codes.
12497
12498@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12499@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12500Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
12501routine for the debugger.
12502
12503@item -mmalloc64
12504@opindex mmalloc64
12505Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
12506@end table
12507
12508@node FR30 Options
12509@subsection FR30 Options
12510@cindex FR30 Options
12511
12512These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.
12513
12514@table @gcctabopt
12515
12516@item -msmall-model
12517@opindex msmall-model
12518Use the small address space model.  This can produce smaller code, but
12519it does assume that all symbolic values and addresses will fit into a
1252020-bit range.
12521
12522@item -mno-lsim
12523@opindex mno-lsim
12524Assume that runtime support has been provided and so there is no need
12525to include the simulator library (@file{libsim.a}) on the linker
12526command line.
12527
12528@end table
12529
12530@node FRV Options
12531@subsection FRV Options
12532@cindex FRV Options
12533
12534@table @gcctabopt
12535@item -mgpr-32
12536@opindex mgpr-32
12537
12538Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.
12539
12540@item -mgpr-64
12541@opindex mgpr-64
12542
12543Use all 64 general-purpose registers.
12544
12545@item -mfpr-32
12546@opindex mfpr-32
12547
12548Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.
12549
12550@item -mfpr-64
12551@opindex mfpr-64
12552
12553Use all 64 floating-point registers.
12554
12555@item -mhard-float
12556@opindex mhard-float
12557
12558Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.
12559
12560@item -msoft-float
12561@opindex msoft-float
12562
12563Use library routines for floating-point operations.
12564
12565@item -malloc-cc
12566@opindex malloc-cc
12567
12568Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
12569
12570@item -mfixed-cc
12571@opindex mfixed-cc
12572
12573Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
12574use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
12575
12576@item -mdword
12577@opindex mdword
12578
12579Change ABI to use double word insns.
12580
12581@item -mno-dword
12582@opindex mno-dword
12583
12584Do not use double word instructions.
12585
12586@item -mdouble
12587@opindex mdouble
12588
12589Use floating-point double instructions.
12590
12591@item -mno-double
12592@opindex mno-double
12593
12594Do not use floating-point double instructions.
12595
12596@item -mmedia
12597@opindex mmedia
12598
12599Use media instructions.
12600
12601@item -mno-media
12602@opindex mno-media
12603
12604Do not use media instructions.
12605
12606@item -mmuladd
12607@opindex mmuladd
12608
12609Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12610
12611@item -mno-muladd
12612@opindex mno-muladd
12613
12614Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12615
12616@item -mfdpic
12617@opindex mfdpic
12618
12619Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent
12620pointers to functions.  Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
12621implies @option{-fPIE}.  With @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}, it
12622assumes GOT entries and small data are within a 12-bit range from the
12623GOT base address; with @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, GOT offsets
12624are computed with 32 bits.
12625With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
12626
12627@item -minline-plt
12628@opindex minline-plt
12629
12630Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
12631not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
12632It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
12633shared libraries (i.e., @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fpic}), or when an
12634optimization option such as @option{-O3} or above is present in the
12635command line.
12636
12637@item -mTLS
12638@opindex mTLS
12639
12640Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12641
12642@item -mtls
12643@opindex mtls
12644
12645Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12646
12647@item -mgprel-ro
12648@opindex mgprel-ro
12649
12650Enable the use of @code{GPREL} relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
12651that is known to be in read-only sections.  It's enabled by default,
12652except for @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}: even though it may help
12653make the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
12654With @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, it trades 3 instructions for 4,
12655one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need
12656for a GOT entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a
12657win.  If it is not, @option{-mno-gprel-ro} can be used to disable it.
12658
12659@item -multilib-library-pic
12660@opindex multilib-library-pic
12661
12662Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by
12663@option{-mlibrary-pic}, as well as by @option{-fPIC} and
12664@option{-fpic} without @option{-mfdpic}.  You should never have to use
12665it explicitly.
12666
12667@item -mlinked-fp
12668@opindex mlinked-fp
12669
12670Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever
12671a stack frame is allocated.  This option is enabled by default and can
12672be disabled with @option{-mno-linked-fp}.
12673
12674@item -mlong-calls
12675@opindex mlong-calls
12676
12677Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
12678compilation unit.  This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
12679within the 32-bit address space.
12680
12681@item -malign-labels
12682@opindex malign-labels
12683
12684Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting nops into the
12685previous packet.  This option only has an effect when VLIW packing
12686is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds nops to
12687existing ones.
12688
12689@item -mlibrary-pic
12690@opindex mlibrary-pic
12691
12692Generate position-independent EABI code.
12693
12694@item -macc-4
12695@opindex macc-4
12696
12697Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
12698
12699@item -macc-8
12700@opindex macc-8
12701
12702Use all eight media accumulator registers.
12703
12704@item -mpack
12705@opindex mpack
12706
12707Pack VLIW instructions.
12708
12709@item -mno-pack
12710@opindex mno-pack
12711
12712Do not pack VLIW instructions.
12713
12714@item -mno-eflags
12715@opindex mno-eflags
12716
12717Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
12718
12719@item -mcond-move
12720@opindex mcond-move
12721
12722Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
12723
12724This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12725in a future version.
12726
12727@item -mno-cond-move
12728@opindex mno-cond-move
12729
12730Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
12731
12732This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12733in a future version.
12734
12735@item -mscc
12736@opindex mscc
12737
12738Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
12739
12740This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12741in a future version.
12742
12743@item -mno-scc
12744@opindex mno-scc
12745
12746Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
12747
12748This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12749in a future version.
12750
12751@item -mcond-exec
12752@opindex mcond-exec
12753
12754Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
12755
12756This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12757in a future version.
12758
12759@item -mno-cond-exec
12760@opindex mno-cond-exec
12761
12762Disable the use of conditional execution.
12763
12764This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12765in a future version.
12766
12767@item -mvliw-branch
12768@opindex mvliw-branch
12769
12770Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
12771
12772This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12773in a future version.
12774
12775@item -mno-vliw-branch
12776@opindex mno-vliw-branch
12777
12778Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
12779
12780This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12781in a future version.
12782
12783@item -mmulti-cond-exec
12784@opindex mmulti-cond-exec
12785
12786Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
12787(default).
12788
12789This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12790in a future version.
12791
12792@item -mno-multi-cond-exec
12793@opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
12794
12795Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
12796
12797This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12798in a future version.
12799
12800@item -mnested-cond-exec
12801@opindex mnested-cond-exec
12802
12803Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
12804
12805This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12806in a future version.
12807
12808@item -mno-nested-cond-exec
12809@opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
12810
12811Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
12812
12813This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12814in a future version.
12815
12816@item -moptimize-membar
12817@opindex moptimize-membar
12818
12819This switch removes redundant @code{membar} instructions from the
12820compiler generated code.  It is enabled by default.
12821
12822@item -mno-optimize-membar
12823@opindex mno-optimize-membar
12824
12825This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant @code{membar}
12826instructions from the generated code.
12827
12828@item -mtomcat-stats
12829@opindex mtomcat-stats
12830
12831Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
12832
12833@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
12834@opindex mcpu
12835
12836Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are
12837@samp{frv}, @samp{fr550}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr450},
12838@samp{fr405}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300} and @samp{simple}.
12839
12840@end table
12841
12842@node GNU/Linux Options
12843@subsection GNU/Linux Options
12844
12845These @samp{-m} options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
12846
12847@table @gcctabopt
12848@item -mglibc
12849@opindex mglibc
12850Use the GNU C library.  This is the default except
12851on @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} and @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12852
12853@item -muclibc
12854@opindex muclibc
12855Use uClibc C library.  This is the default on
12856@samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
12857
12858@item -mbionic
12859@opindex mbionic
12860Use Bionic C library.  This is the default on
12861@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12862
12863@item -mandroid
12864@opindex mandroid
12865Compile code compatible with Android platform.  This is the default on
12866@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12867
12868When compiling, this option enables @option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC},
12869@option{-fno-exceptions} and @option{-fno-rtti} by default.  When linking,
12870this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.
12871Finally, this option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__ANDROID__}
12872to be defined.
12873
12874@item -tno-android-cc
12875@opindex tno-android-cc
12876Disable compilation effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., do not enable
12877@option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fno-exceptions} and
12878@option{-fno-rtti} by default.
12879
12880@item -tno-android-ld
12881@opindex tno-android-ld
12882Disable linking effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., pass standard Linux
12883linking options to the linker.
12884
12885@end table
12886
12887@node H8/300 Options
12888@subsection H8/300 Options
12889
12890These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
12891
12892@table @gcctabopt
12893@item -mrelax
12894@opindex mrelax
12895Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
12896linker option @option{-relax}.  @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
12897ld, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
12898
12899@item -mh
12900@opindex mh
12901Generate code for the H8/300H@.
12902
12903@item -ms
12904@opindex ms
12905Generate code for the H8S@.
12906
12907@item -mn
12908@opindex mn
12909Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch
12910must be used either with @option{-mh} or @option{-ms}.
12911
12912@item -ms2600
12913@opindex ms2600
12914Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
12915
12916@item -mint32
12917@opindex mint32
12918Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
12919
12920@item -malign-300
12921@opindex malign-300
12922On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
12923The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on
129244-byte boundaries.
12925@option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2-byte boundaries.
12926This option has no effect on the H8/300.
12927@end table
12928
12929@node HPPA Options
12930@subsection HPPA Options
12931@cindex HPPA Options
12932
12933These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
12934
12935@table @gcctabopt
12936@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
12937@opindex march
12938Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
12939@var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
129401.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to
12941@file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
12942architecture option for your machine.  Code compiled for lower numbered
12943architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the
12944other way around.
12945
12946@item -mpa-risc-1-0
12947@itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
12948@itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
12949@opindex mpa-risc-1-0
12950@opindex mpa-risc-1-1
12951@opindex mpa-risc-2-0
12952Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
12953
12954@item -mbig-switch
12955@opindex mbig-switch
12956Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
12957the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
12958table.
12959
12960@item -mjump-in-delay
12961@opindex mjump-in-delay
12962Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
12963by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
12964of the conditional jump.
12965
12966@item -mdisable-fpregs
12967@opindex mdisable-fpregs
12968Prevent floating-point registers from being used in any manner.  This is
12969necessary for compiling kernels that perform lazy context switching of
12970floating-point registers.  If you use this option and attempt to perform
12971floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.
12972
12973@item -mdisable-indexing
12974@opindex mdisable-indexing
12975Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes.  This avoids some
12976rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
12977
12978@item -mno-space-regs
12979@opindex mno-space-regs
12980Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers.  This allows
12981GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
12982
12983Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
12984
12985@item -mfast-indirect-calls
12986@opindex mfast-indirect-calls
12987Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.  This
12988allows GCC to emit code that performs faster indirect calls.
12989
12990This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
12991functions.
12992
12993@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
12994@opindex mfixed-range
12995Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
12996A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
12997useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
12998two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
12999specified separated by a comma.
13000
13001@item -mlong-load-store
13002@opindex mlong-load-store
13003Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
13004the HP-UX 10 linker.  This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
13005the HP compilers.
13006
13007@item -mportable-runtime
13008@opindex mportable-runtime
13009Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
13010
13011@item -mgas
13012@opindex mgas
13013Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
13014
13015@item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
13016@opindex mschedule
13017Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
13018@var{cpu-type}.  The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
13019@samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}.  Refer
13020to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
13021proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is
13022@samp{8000}.
13023
13024@item -mlinker-opt
13025@opindex mlinker-opt
13026Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic
13027debugging impossible.  It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
13028linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
13029
13030@item -msoft-float
13031@opindex msoft-float
13032Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13033@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
13034targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
13035used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
13036your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13037cross-compilation.
13038
13039@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
13040therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
13041this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
13042library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
13043this to work.
13044
13045@item -msio
13046@opindex msio
13047Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO@.  The default is
13048@option{-mwsio}.  This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
13049@code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO@.  These
13050options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX@.
13051
13052@item -mgnu-ld
13053@opindex mgnu-ld
13054Use GNU ld specific options.  This passes @option{-shared} to ld when
13055building a shared library.  It is the default when GCC is configured,
13056explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
13057have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters
13058are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the
13059@option{--with-ld} configure option, GCC's program search path, and
13060finally by the user's @env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed
13061using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available
13062on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13063
13064@item -mhp-ld
13065@opindex mhp-ld
13066Use HP ld specific options.  This passes @option{-b} to ld when building
13067a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to ld on all
13068links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
13069implicitly, with the HP linker.  This option does not have any affect on
13070which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that
13071ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
13072configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's
13073@env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
13074`gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available on the 64-bit
13075HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13076
13077@item -mlong-calls
13078@opindex mno-long-calls
13079Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call
13080is always able to reach linker generated stubs.  The default is to generate
13081long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
13082of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
13083predefined limit set by the branch type being used.  The limits for
13084normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
13085PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at
13086240,000 bytes.
13087
13088Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
13089@option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
13090and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
13091the SOM linker.
13092
13093It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade
13094performance.  However, it may be useful in large applications,
13095particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
13096
13097The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
13098assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated.  The
13099impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
13100symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
13101However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
13102and it is quite long.
13103
13104@item -munix=@var{unix-std}
13105@opindex march
13106Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified
13107UNIX standard.  The choices for @var{unix-std} are @samp{93}, @samp{95}
13108and @samp{98}.  @samp{93} is supported on all HP-UX versions.  @samp{95}
13109is available on HP-UX 10.10 and later.  @samp{98} is available on HP-UX
1311011.11 and later.  The default values are @samp{93} for HP-UX 10.00,
13111@samp{95} for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and @samp{98} for HP-UX 11.11
13112and later.
13113
13114@option{-munix=93} provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
13115@option{-munix=95} provides additional predefines for @code{XOPEN_UNIX}
13116and @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, and the startfile @file{unix95.o}.
13117@option{-munix=98} provides additional predefines for @code{_XOPEN_UNIX},
13118@code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, @code{_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE} and
13119@code{_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500}, and the startfile @file{unix98.o}.
13120
13121It is @emph{important} to note that this option changes the interfaces
13122for various library routines.  It also affects the operational behavior
13123of the C library.  Thus, @emph{extreme} care is needed in using this
13124option.
13125
13126Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
13127standard must test, set and restore the variable @var{__xpg4_extended_mask}
13128as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.
13129
13130@item -nolibdld
13131@opindex nolibdld
13132Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the
13133@option{-static} option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
13134
13135@item -static
13136@opindex static
13137The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
13138libdld.sl.  There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl.  Thus,
13139when the @option{-static} option is specified, special link options
13140are needed to resolve this dependency.
13141
13142On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
13143link with libdld.sl when the @option{-static} option is specified.
13144This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On the 64-bit port,
13145the linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The
13146@option{-nolibdld} option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from
13147adding these link options.
13148
13149@item -threads
13150@opindex threads
13151Add support for multithreading with the @dfn{dce thread} library
13152under HP-UX@.  This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
13153linker.
13154@end table
13155
13156@node i386 and x86-64 Options
13157@subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
13158@cindex i386 Options
13159@cindex x86-64 Options
13160@cindex Intel 386 Options
13161@cindex AMD x86-64 Options
13162
13163These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
13164computers:
13165
13166@table @gcctabopt
13167@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
13168@opindex mtune
13169Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
13170for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The choices for
13171@var{cpu-type} are:
13172@table @emph
13173@item generic
13174Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/@/AMD64/@/EM64T processors.
13175If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
13176the corresponding @option{-mtune} option instead of
13177@option{-mtune=generic}.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users
13178of your application will have, then you should use this option.
13179
13180As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this
13181option will change.  Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
13182GCC, the code generated option will change to reflect the processors
13183that were most common when that version of GCC was released.
13184
13185There is no @option{-march=generic} option because @option{-march}
13186indicates the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no
13187generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In contrast,
13188@option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
13189processors) for which the code is optimized.
13190@item native
13191This selects the CPU to tune for at compilation time by determining
13192the processor type of the compiling machine.  Using @option{-mtune=native}
13193will produce code optimized for the local machine under the constraints
13194of the selected instruction set.  Using @option{-march=native} will
13195enable all instruction subsets supported by the local machine (hence
13196the result might not run on different machines).
13197@item i386
13198Original Intel's i386 CPU@.
13199@item i486
13200Intel's i486 CPU@.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
13201@item i586, pentium
13202Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
13203@item pentium-mmx
13204Intel PentiumMMX CPU based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.
13205@item pentiumpro
13206Intel PentiumPro CPU@.
13207@item i686
13208Same as @code{generic}, but when used as @code{march} option, PentiumPro
13209instruction set will be used, so the code will run on all i686 family chips.
13210@item pentium2
13211Intel Pentium2 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX instruction set support.
13212@item pentium3, pentium3m
13213Intel Pentium3 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX and SSE instruction set
13214support.
13215@item pentium-m
13216Low power version of Intel Pentium3 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set
13217support.  Used by Centrino notebooks.
13218@item pentium4, pentium4m
13219Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.
13220@item prescott
13221Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
13222set support.
13223@item nocona
13224Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE,
13225SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
13226@item core2
13227Intel Core2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13228instruction set support.
13229@item corei7
13230Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1
13231and SSE4.2 instruction set support.
13232@item corei7-avx
13233Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13234SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.
13235@item core-avx-i
13236Intel Core CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13237SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction
13238set support.
13239@item atom
13240Intel Atom CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13241instruction set support.
13242@item k6
13243AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
13244@item k6-2, k6-3
13245Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13246@item athlon, athlon-tbird
13247AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and SSE prefetch instructions
13248support.
13249@item athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp
13250Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and full SSE
13251instruction set support.
13252@item k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx
13253AMD K8 core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets
13254MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13255@item k8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3
13256Improved versions of k8, opteron and athlon64 with SSE3 instruction set support.
13257@item amdfam10, barcelona
13258AMD Family 10h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13259supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit
13260instruction set extensions.)
13261@item bdver1
13262AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13263supersets FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A,
13264SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13265@item bdver2
13266AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13267supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE,
13268SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set
13269extensions.)
13270@item btver1
13271AMD Family 14h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13272supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A, CX16, ABM and 64-bit
13273instruction set extensions.)
13274@item winchip-c6
13275IDT Winchip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction
13276set support.
13277@item winchip2
13278IDT Winchip2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX and 3DNow!@:
13279instruction set support.
13280@item c3
13281Via C3 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13282implemented for this chip.)
13283@item c3-2
13284Via C3-2 CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13285implemented for this chip.)
13286@item geode
13287Embedded AMD CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13288@end table
13289
13290While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} will schedule things appropriately
13291for that particular chip, the compiler will not generate any code that
13292does not run on the default machine type without the @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}
13293option being used. For example, if GCC is configured for i686-pc-linux-gnu
13294then @option{-mtune=pentium4} will generate code that is tuned for Pentium4
13295but will still run on i686 machines.
13296
13297@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
13298@opindex march
13299Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}.  The choices
13300for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-mtune}.  Moreover,
13301specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}.
13302
13303@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
13304@opindex mcpu
13305A deprecated synonym for @option{-mtune}.
13306
13307@item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
13308@opindex mfpmath
13309Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit @var{unit}.  The choices
13310for @var{unit} are:
13311
13312@table @samp
13313@item 387
13314Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the majority of chips and
13315emulated otherwise.  Code compiled with this option runs almost everywhere.
13316The temporary results are computed in 80-bit precision instead of the precision
13317specified by the type, resulting in slightly different results compared to most
13318of other chips.  See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
13319
13320This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
13321
13322@item sse
13323Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
13324This instruction set is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line
13325by Athlon-4, Athlon-xp and Athlon-mp chips.  The earlier version of SSE
13326instruction set supports only single-precision arithmetic, thus the double and
13327extended-precision arithmetic are still done using 387.  A later version, present
13328only in Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips, supports double-precision
13329arithmetic too.
13330
13331For the i386 compiler, you need to use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse}
13332or @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
13333effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
13334
13335The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid
13336the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
13337code that expects temporaries to be 80 bits.
13338
13339This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.
13340
13341@item sse,387
13342@itemx sse+387
13343@itemx both
13344Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once.  This effectively double the
13345amount of available registers and on chips with separate execution units for
13346387 and SSE the execution resources too.  Use this option with care, as it is
13347still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not model separate
13348functional units well resulting in instable performance.
13349@end table
13350
13351@item -masm=@var{dialect}
13352@opindex masm=@var{dialect}
13353Output asm instructions using selected @var{dialect}.  Supported
13354choices are @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default one).  Darwin does
13355not support @samp{intel}.
13356
13357@item -mieee-fp
13358@itemx -mno-ieee-fp
13359@opindex mieee-fp
13360@opindex mno-ieee-fp
13361Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point
13362comparisons.  These handle correctly the case where the result of a
13363comparison is unordered.
13364
13365@item -msoft-float
13366@opindex msoft-float
13367Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13368@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
13369Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
13370this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your
13371own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13372cross-compilation.
13373
13374On machines where a function returns floating-point results in the 80387
13375register stack, some floating-point opcodes may be emitted even if
13376@option{-msoft-float} is used.
13377
13378@item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
13379@opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
13380Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
13381
13382The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
13383@code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
13384is no FPU@.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate
13385an FPU@.
13386
13387The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
13388in ordinary CPU registers instead.
13389
13390@item -mno-fancy-math-387
13391@opindex mno-fancy-math-387
13392Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
13393@code{sqrt} instructions for the 387.  Specify this option to avoid
13394generating those instructions.  This option is the default on FreeBSD,
13395OpenBSD and NetBSD@.  This option is overridden when @option{-march}
13396indicates that the target CPU will always have an FPU and so the
13397instruction will not need emulation.  As of revision 2.6.1, these
13398instructions are not generated unless you also use the
13399@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
13400
13401@item -malign-double
13402@itemx -mno-align-double
13403@opindex malign-double
13404@opindex mno-align-double
13405Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
13406@code{long long} variables on a two-word boundary or a one-word
13407boundary.  Aligning @code{double} variables on a two-word boundary
13408produces code that runs somewhat faster on a @samp{Pentium} at the
13409expense of more memory.
13410
13411On x86-64, @option{-malign-double} is enabled by default.
13412
13413@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
13414structures containing the above types will be aligned differently than
13415the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
13416and will not be binary compatible with structures in code compiled
13417without that switch.
13418
13419@item -m96bit-long-double
13420@itemx -m128bit-long-double
13421@opindex m96bit-long-double
13422@opindex m128bit-long-double
13423These switches control the size of @code{long double} type.  The i386
13424application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits,
13425so @option{-m96bit-long-double} is the default in 32-bit mode.
13426
13427Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer @code{long double}
13428to be aligned to an 8- or 16-byte boundary.  In arrays or structures
13429conforming to the ABI, this is not possible.  So specifying
13430@option{-m128bit-long-double} aligns @code{long double}
13431to a 16-byte boundary by padding the @code{long double} with an additional
1343232-bit zero.
13433
13434In the x86-64 compiler, @option{-m128bit-long-double} is the default choice as
13435its ABI specifies that @code{long double} is to be aligned on 16-byte boundary.
13436
13437Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87
13438standard of 80 bits for a @code{long double}.
13439
13440@strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, the
13441structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables will change
13442their size as well as function calling convention for function taking
13443@code{long double} will be modified.  Hence they will not be binary
13444compatible with arrays or structures in code compiled without that switch.
13445
13446@item -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13447@opindex mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13448When @option{-mcmodel=medium} is specified, the data greater than
13449@var{threshold} are placed in large data section.  This value must be the
13450same across all object linked into the binary and defaults to 65535.
13451
13452@item -mrtd
13453@opindex mrtd
13454Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
13455take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret} @var{num}
13456instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This saves one
13457instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
13458there.
13459
13460You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
13461sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}.  You can also
13462override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
13463@samp{cdecl}.  @xref{Function Attributes}.
13464
13465@strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
13466normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
13467libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
13468
13469Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
13470take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
13471otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
13472functions.
13473
13474In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
13475function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
13476harmlessly ignored.)
13477
13478@item -mregparm=@var{num}
13479@opindex mregparm
13480Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By
13481default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
13482registers can be used.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13483function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
13484@xref{Function Attributes}.
13485
13486@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
13487@var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
13488value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and
13489startup modules.
13490
13491@item -msseregparm
13492@opindex msseregparm
13493Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
13494and return values.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13495function by using the function attribute @samp{sseregparm}.
13496@xref{Function Attributes}.
13497
13498@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch then you must build all
13499modules with the same value, including any libraries.  This includes
13500the system libraries and startup modules.
13501
13502@item -mvect8-ret-in-mem
13503@opindex mvect8-ret-in-mem
13504Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers.  This is the
13505default on Solaris@tie{}8 and 9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun
13506Studio compilers until version 12.  Later compiler versions (starting
13507with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used by other x86 targets, which
13508is the default on Solaris@tie{}10 and later.  @emph{Only} use this option if
13509you need to remain compatible with existing code produced by those
13510previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC.
13511
13512@item -mpc32
13513@itemx -mpc64
13514@itemx -mpc80
13515@opindex mpc32
13516@opindex mpc64
13517@opindex mpc80
13518
13519Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits.  When @option{-mpc32}
13520is specified, the significands of results of floating-point operations are
13521rounded to 24 bits (single precision); @option{-mpc64} rounds the
13522significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double
13523precision) and @option{-mpc80} rounds the significands of results of
13524floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision), which is
13525the default.  When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher
13526precisions are not available to the programmer without setting the FPU
13527control word explicitly.
13528
13529Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the default
1353080 bits can speed some programs by 2% or more.  Note that some mathematical
13531libraries assume that extended-precision (80-bit) floating-point operations
13532are enabled by default; routines in such libraries could suffer significant
13533loss of accuracy, typically through so-called "catastrophic cancellation",
13534when this option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.
13535
13536@item -mstackrealign
13537@opindex mstackrealign
13538Realign the stack at entry.  On the Intel x86, the @option{-mstackrealign}
13539option will generate an alternate prologue and epilogue that realigns the
13540run-time stack if necessary.  This supports mixing legacy codes that keep
13541a 4-byte aligned stack with modern codes that keep a 16-byte stack for
13542SSE compatibility.  See also the attribute @code{force_align_arg_pointer},
13543applicable to individual functions.
13544
13545@item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13546@opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
13547Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
13548byte boundary.  If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13549the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
13550
13551@item -mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13552@opindex mincoming-stack-boundary
13553Assume the incoming stack is aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num} byte
13554boundary.  If @option{-mincoming-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13555the one specified by @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} will be used.
13556
13557On Pentium and PentiumPro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
13558should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
13559suffer significant run time performance penalties.  On Pentium III, the
13560Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} may not work
13561properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.
13562
13563To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
13564must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
13565Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
13566aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
13567stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
13568boundary will most likely misalign the stack.  It is recommended that
13569libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
13570
13571This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
13572increases code size.  Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
13573as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
13574preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
13575
13576@item -mmmx
13577@itemx -mno-mmx
13578@itemx -msse
13579@itemx -mno-sse
13580@itemx -msse2
13581@itemx -mno-sse2
13582@itemx -msse3
13583@itemx -mno-sse3
13584@itemx -mssse3
13585@itemx -mno-ssse3
13586@itemx -msse4.1
13587@need 800
13588@itemx -mno-sse4.1
13589@itemx -msse4.2
13590@itemx -mno-sse4.2
13591@itemx -msse4
13592@itemx -mno-sse4
13593@itemx -mavx
13594@itemx -mno-avx
13595@itemx -mavx2
13596@itemx -mno-avx2
13597@itemx -maes
13598@itemx -mno-aes
13599@itemx -mpclmul
13600@need 800
13601@itemx -mno-pclmul
13602@itemx -mfsgsbase
13603@itemx -mno-fsgsbase
13604@itemx -mrdrnd
13605@itemx -mno-rdrnd
13606@itemx -mf16c
13607@itemx -mno-f16c
13608@itemx -mfma
13609@itemx -mno-fma
13610@itemx -msse4a
13611@itemx -mno-sse4a
13612@itemx -mfma4
13613@need 800
13614@itemx -mno-fma4
13615@itemx -mxop
13616@itemx -mno-xop
13617@itemx -mlwp
13618@itemx -mno-lwp
13619@itemx -m3dnow
13620@itemx -mno-3dnow
13621@itemx -mpopcnt
13622@itemx -mno-popcnt
13623@itemx -mabm
13624@itemx -mno-abm
13625@itemx -mbmi
13626@itemx -mbmi2
13627@itemx -mno-bmi
13628@itemx -mno-bmi2
13629@itemx -mlzcnt
13630@itemx -mno-lzcnt
13631@itemx -mtbm
13632@itemx -mno-tbm
13633@opindex mmmx
13634@opindex mno-mmx
13635@opindex msse
13636@opindex mno-sse
13637@opindex m3dnow
13638@opindex mno-3dnow
13639These switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE,
13640SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, F16C,
13641FMA, SSE4A, FMA4, XOP, LWP, ABM, BMI, BMI2, LZCNT or 3DNow!
13642@: extended instruction sets.
13643These extensions are also available as built-in functions: see
13644@ref{X86 Built-in Functions}, for details of the functions enabled and
13645disabled by these switches.
13646
13647To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point
13648code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
13649
13650GCC depresses SSEx instructions when @option{-mavx} is used. Instead, it
13651generates new AVX instructions or AVX equivalence for all SSEx instructions
13652when needed.
13653
13654These options will enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
13655generated code, even without @option{-mfpmath=sse}.  Applications that
13656perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
13657supported architecture, using the appropriate flags.  In particular,
13658the file containing the CPU detection code should be compiled without
13659these options.
13660
13661@item -mcld
13662@opindex mcld
13663This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{cld} instruction in the prologue
13664of functions that use string instructions.  String instructions depend on
13665the DF flag to select between autoincrement or autodecrement mode.  While the
13666ABI specifies the DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some operating
13667systems violate this specification by not clearing the DF flag in their
13668exception dispatchers.  The exception handler can be invoked with the DF flag
13669set, which leads to wrong direction mode when string instructions are used.
13670This option can be enabled by default on 32-bit x86 targets by configuring
13671GCC with the @option{--enable-cld} configure option.  Generation of @code{cld}
13672instructions can be suppressed with the @option{-mno-cld} compiler option
13673in this case.
13674
13675@item -mvzeroupper
13676@opindex mvzeroupper
13677This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{vzeroupper} instruction
13678before a transfer of control flow out of the function to minimize
13679AVX to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary zeroupper
13680intrinsics.
13681
13682@item -mcx16
13683@opindex mcx16
13684This option will enable GCC to use CMPXCHG16B instruction in generated code.
13685CMPXCHG16B allows for atomic operations on 128-bit double quadword (or oword)
13686data types.  This is useful for high resolution counters that could be updated
13687by multiple processors (or cores).  This instruction is generated as part of
13688atomic built-in functions: see @ref{__sync Builtins} or
13689@ref{__atomic Builtins} for details.
13690
13691@item -msahf
13692@opindex msahf
13693This option will enable GCC to use SAHF instruction in generated 64-bit code.
13694Early Intel CPUs with Intel 64 lacked LAHF and SAHF instructions supported
13695by AMD64 until introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December 2005.  LAHF and
13696SAHF are load and store instructions, respectively, for certain status flags.
13697In 64-bit mode, SAHF instruction is used to optimize @code{fmod}, @code{drem}
13698or @code{remainder} built-in functions: see @ref{Other Builtins} for details.
13699
13700@item -mmovbe
13701@opindex mmovbe
13702This option will enable GCC to use movbe instruction to implement
13703@code{__builtin_bswap32} and @code{__builtin_bswap64}.
13704
13705@item -mcrc32
13706@opindex mcrc32
13707This option will enable built-in functions, @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32qi},
13708@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32hi}. @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32si} and
13709@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32di} to generate the crc32 machine instruction.
13710
13711@item -mrecip
13712@opindex mrecip
13713This option will enable GCC to use RCPSS and RSQRTSS instructions (and their
13714vectorized variants RCPPS and RSQRTPS) with an additional Newton-Raphson step
13715to increase precision instead of DIVSS and SQRTSS (and their vectorized
13716variants) for single-precision floating-point arguments.  These instructions
13717are generated only when @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is enabled
13718together with @option{-finite-math-only} and @option{-fno-trapping-math}.
13719Note that while the throughput of the sequence is higher than the throughput
13720of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
13721decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).
13722
13723Note that GCC implements @code{1.0f/sqrtf(@var{x})} in terms of RSQRTSS
13724(or RSQRTPS) already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option
13725combination), and doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13726
13727Also note that GCC emits the above sequence with additional Newton-Raphson step
13728for vectorized single-float division and vectorized @code{sqrtf(@var{x})}
13729already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option combination), and
13730doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13731
13732@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
13733@opindex mrecip=opt
13734This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
13735may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
13736be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
13737@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
13738@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
13739@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip},
13740@code{div}: enable the approximation for scalar division,
13741@code{vec-div}: enable the approximation for vectorized division,
13742@code{sqrt}: enable the approximation for scalar square root,
13743@code{vec-sqrt}: enable the approximation for vectorized square root.
13744
13745So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!sqrt} would enable
13746all of the reciprocal approximations, except for square root.
13747
13748@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
13749@opindex mveclibabi
13750Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
13751external library.  Supported types are @code{svml} for the Intel short
13752vector math library and @code{acml} for the AMD math core library style
13753of interfacing.  GCC will currently emit calls to @code{vmldExp2},
13754@code{vmldLn2}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldPow2},
13755@code{vmldTanh2}, @code{vmldTan2}, @code{vmldAtan2}, @code{vmldAtanh2},
13756@code{vmldCbrt2}, @code{vmldSinh2}, @code{vmldSin2}, @code{vmldAsinh2},
13757@code{vmldAsin2}, @code{vmldCosh2}, @code{vmldCos2}, @code{vmldAcosh2},
13758@code{vmldAcos2}, @code{vmlsExp4}, @code{vmlsLn4}, @code{vmlsLog104},
13759@code{vmlsLog104}, @code{vmlsPow4}, @code{vmlsTanh4}, @code{vmlsTan4},
13760@code{vmlsAtan4}, @code{vmlsAtanh4}, @code{vmlsCbrt4}, @code{vmlsSinh4},
13761@code{vmlsSin4}, @code{vmlsAsinh4}, @code{vmlsAsin4}, @code{vmlsCosh4},
13762@code{vmlsCos4}, @code{vmlsAcosh4} and @code{vmlsAcos4} for corresponding
13763function type when @option{-mveclibabi=svml} is used and @code{__vrd2_sin},
13764@code{__vrd2_cos}, @code{__vrd2_exp}, @code{__vrd2_log}, @code{__vrd2_log2},
13765@code{__vrd2_log10}, @code{__vrs4_sinf}, @code{__vrs4_cosf},
13766@code{__vrs4_expf}, @code{__vrs4_logf}, @code{__vrs4_log2f},
13767@code{__vrs4_log10f} and @code{__vrs4_powf} for corresponding function type
13768when @option{-mveclibabi=acml} is used. Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
13769@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled. A SVML or ACML ABI
13770compatible library will have to be specified at link time.
13771
13772@item -mabi=@var{name}
13773@opindex mabi
13774Generate code for the specified calling convention.  Permissible values
13775are: @samp{sysv} for the ABI used on GNU/Linux and other systems and
13776@samp{ms} for the Microsoft ABI.  The default is to use the Microsoft
13777ABI when targeting Windows.  On all other systems, the default is the
13778SYSV ABI.  You can control this behavior for a specific function by
13779using the function attribute @samp{ms_abi}/@samp{sysv_abi}.
13780@xref{Function Attributes}.
13781
13782@item -mtls-dialect=@var{type}
13783@opindex mtls-dialect
13784Generate code to access thread-local storage using the @samp{gnu} or
13785@samp{gnu2} conventions.  @samp{gnu} is the conservative default;
13786@samp{gnu2} is more efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time
13787requirements that cannot be satisfied on all systems.
13788
13789@item -mpush-args
13790@itemx -mno-push-args
13791@opindex mpush-args
13792@opindex mno-push-args
13793Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter
13794and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
13795by default.  In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
13796improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
13797
13798@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
13799@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
13800If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments will be
13801computed in the function prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs
13802because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
13803when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is a notable
13804increase in code size.  This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
13805
13806@item -mthreads
13807@opindex mthreads
13808Support thread-safe exception handling on @samp{Mingw32}.  Code that relies
13809on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
13810@option{-mthreads} option.  When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
13811@option{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
13812@option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per thread exception handling data.
13813
13814@item -mno-align-stringops
13815@opindex mno-align-stringops
13816Do not align destination of inlined string operations.  This switch reduces
13817code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
13818but GCC doesn't know about it.
13819
13820@item -minline-all-stringops
13821@opindex minline-all-stringops
13822By default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination is
13823known to be aligned to least a 4-byte boundary.
13824This enables more inlining, increase code
13825size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast memcpy, strlen
13826and memset for short lengths.
13827
13828@item -minline-stringops-dynamically
13829@opindex minline-stringops-dynamically
13830For string operations of unknown size, use run-time checks with
13831inline code for small blocks and a library call for large blocks.
13832
13833@item -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13834@opindex mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13835Overwrite internal decision heuristic about particular algorithm to inline
13836string operation with.  The allowed values are @code{rep_byte},
13837@code{rep_4byte}, @code{rep_8byte} for expanding using i386 @code{rep} prefix
13838of specified size, @code{byte_loop}, @code{loop}, @code{unrolled_loop} for
13839expanding inline loop, @code{libcall} for always expanding library call.
13840
13841@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13842@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13843Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
13844avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
13845makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
13846@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
13847which might make debugging harder.
13848
13849@item -mtls-direct-seg-refs
13850@itemx -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
13851@opindex mtls-direct-seg-refs
13852Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from the
13853TLS segment register (@code{%gs} for 32-bit, @code{%fs} for 64-bit),
13854or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or not this
13855is legal depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
13856segment to cover the entire TLS area.
13857
13858For systems that use GNU libc, the default is on.
13859
13860@item -msse2avx
13861@itemx -mno-sse2avx
13862@opindex msse2avx
13863Specify that the assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX
13864prefix.  The option @option{-mavx} turns this on by default.
13865
13866@item -mfentry
13867@itemx -mno-fentry
13868@opindex mfentry
13869If profiling is active @option{-pg} put the profiling
13870counter call before prologue.
13871Note: On x86 architectures the attribute @code{ms_hook_prologue}
13872isn't possible at the moment for @option{-mfentry} and @option{-pg}.
13873
13874@item -m8bit-idiv
13875@itemx -mno-8bit-idiv
13876@opindex 8bit-idiv
13877On some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is
13878much faster than 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.  This option generates a
13879run-time check.  If both dividend and divisor are within range of 0
13880to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used instead of
1388132-bit/64-bit integer divide.
13882
13883@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
13884@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
13885@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-load
13886@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-store
13887Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.
13888
13889@end table
13890
13891These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
13892on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
13893
13894@table @gcctabopt
13895@item -m32
13896@itemx -m64
13897@itemx -mx32
13898@opindex m32
13899@opindex m64
13900@opindex mx32
13901Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
13902The @option{-m32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13903generates code that runs on any i386 system.
13904The @option{-m64} option sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
13905to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13906The @option{-mx32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13907generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13908For darwin only the @option{-m64} option turns off the @option{-fno-pic}
13909and @option{-mdynamic-no-pic} options.
13910
13911@item -mno-red-zone
13912@opindex mno-red-zone
13913Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated
13914by the x86-64 ABI, it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
13915stack pointer that will not be modified by signal or interrupt handlers
13916and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
13917pointer.  The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
13918
13919@item -mcmodel=small
13920@opindex mcmodel=small
13921Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
13922be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.
13923Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This is the default
13924code model.
13925
13926@item -mcmodel=kernel
13927@opindex mcmodel=kernel
13928Generate code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the
13929negative 2 GB of the address space.
13930This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
13931
13932@item -mcmodel=medium
13933@opindex mcmodel=medium
13934Generate code for the medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2
13935GB of the address space.  Small symbols are also placed there.  Symbols
13936with sizes larger than @option{-mlarge-data-threshold} are put into
13937large data or bss sections and can be located above 2GB.  Programs can
13938be statically or dynamically linked.
13939
13940@item -mcmodel=large
13941@opindex mcmodel=large
13942Generate code for the large model: This model makes no assumptions
13943about addresses and sizes of sections.
13944@end table
13945
13946@node i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13947@subsection i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13948@cindex i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13949
13950These additional options are available for Windows targets:
13951
13952@table @gcctabopt
13953@item -mconsole
13954@opindex mconsole
13955This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13956specifies that a console application is to be generated, by
13957instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
13958required for console applications.
13959This is the default behavior for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
13960
13961@item -mdll
13962@opindex mdll
13963This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13964specifies that a DLL - a dynamic link library - is to be
13965generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime
13966startup object and entry point.
13967
13968@item -mnop-fun-dllimport
13969@opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
13970This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13971specifies that the dllimport attribute should be ignored.
13972
13973@item -mthread
13974@opindex mthread
13975This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies
13976that MinGW-specific thread support is to be used.
13977
13978@item -municode
13979@opindex municode
13980This option is available for mingw-w64 targets.  It specifies
13981that the UNICODE macro is getting pre-defined and that the
13982unicode capable runtime startup code is chosen.
13983
13984@item -mwin32
13985@opindex mwin32
13986This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13987specifies that the typical Windows pre-defined macros are to
13988be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice
13989of runtime library/startup code.
13990
13991@item -mwindows
13992@opindex mwindows
13993This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13994specifies that a GUI application is to be generated by
13995instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
13996appropriately.
13997
13998@item -fno-set-stack-executable
13999@opindex fno-set-stack-executable
14000This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that
14001the executable flag for stack used by nested functions isn't
14002set. This is necessary for binaries running in kernel mode of
14003Windows, as there the user32 API, which is used to set executable
14004privileges, isn't available.
14005
14006@item -mpe-aligned-commons
14007@opindex mpe-aligned-commons
14008This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14009specifies that the GNU extension to the PE file format that
14010permits the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be
14011used when generating code.  It will be enabled by default if
14012GCC detects that the target assembler found during configuration
14013supports the feature.
14014@end table
14015
14016See also under @ref{i386 and x86-64 Options} for standard options.
14017
14018@node IA-64 Options
14019@subsection IA-64 Options
14020@cindex IA-64 Options
14021
14022These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
14023
14024@table @gcctabopt
14025@item -mbig-endian
14026@opindex mbig-endian
14027Generate code for a big-endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX@.
14028
14029@item -mlittle-endian
14030@opindex mlittle-endian
14031Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default for AIX5
14032and GNU/Linux.
14033
14034@item -mgnu-as
14035@itemx -mno-gnu-as
14036@opindex mgnu-as
14037@opindex mno-gnu-as
14038Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.
14039@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
14040@c is used.
14041
14042@item -mgnu-ld
14043@itemx -mno-gnu-ld
14044@opindex mgnu-ld
14045@opindex mno-gnu-ld
14046Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.
14047@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
14048@c is used.
14049
14050@item -mno-pic
14051@opindex mno-pic
14052Generate code that does not use a global pointer register.  The result
14053is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
14054
14055@item -mvolatile-asm-stop
14056@itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
14057@opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
14058@opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
14059Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
14060statements.
14061
14062@item -mregister-names
14063@itemx -mno-register-names
14064@opindex mregister-names
14065@opindex mno-register-names
14066Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
14067the stacked registers.  This may make assembler output more readable.
14068
14069@item -mno-sdata
14070@itemx -msdata
14071@opindex mno-sdata
14072@opindex msdata
14073Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.  This may
14074be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
14075
14076@item -mconstant-gp
14077@opindex mconstant-gp
14078Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is
14079useful when compiling kernel code.
14080
14081@item -mauto-pic
14082@opindex mauto-pic
14083Generate code that is self-relocatable.  This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
14084This is useful when compiling firmware code.
14085
14086@item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
14087@opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
14088Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14089using the minimum latency algorithm.
14090
14091@item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14092@opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14093Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14094using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14095
14096@item -mno-inline-float-divide
14097@opindex mno-inline-float-divide
14098Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.
14099
14100@item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
14101@opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
14102Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14103using the minimum latency algorithm.
14104
14105@item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14106@opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14107Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14108using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14109
14110@item -mno-inline-int-divide
14111@opindex mno-inline-int-divide
14112Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.
14113
14114@item -minline-sqrt-min-latency
14115@opindex minline-sqrt-min-latency
14116Generate code for inline square roots
14117using the minimum latency algorithm.
14118
14119@item -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14120@opindex minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14121Generate code for inline square roots
14122using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14123
14124@item -mno-inline-sqrt
14125@opindex mno-inline-sqrt
14126Do not generate inline code for sqrt.
14127
14128@item -mfused-madd
14129@itemx -mno-fused-madd
14130@opindex mfused-madd
14131@opindex mno-fused-madd
14132Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add or multiply/subtract
14133instructions.  The default is to use these instructions.
14134
14135@item -mno-dwarf2-asm
14136@itemx -mdwarf2-asm
14137@opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
14138@opindex mdwarf2-asm
14139Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging
14140info.  This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
14141
14142@item -mearly-stop-bits
14143@itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
14144@opindex mearly-stop-bits
14145@opindex mno-early-stop-bits
14146Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
14147instruction that triggered the stop bit.  This can improve instruction
14148scheduling, but does not always do so.
14149
14150@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
14151@opindex mfixed-range
14152Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
14153A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
14154useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
14155two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
14156specified separated by a comma.
14157
14158@item -mtls-size=@var{tls-size}
14159@opindex mtls-size
14160Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and
1416164.
14162
14163@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
14164@opindex mtune
14165Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values are
14166itanium, itanium1, merced, itanium2, and mckinley.
14167
14168@item -milp32
14169@itemx -mlp64
14170@opindex milp32
14171@opindex mlp64
14172Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
14173The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
14174The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
14175to 64 bits.  These are HP-UX specific flags.
14176
14177@item -mno-sched-br-data-spec
14178@itemx -msched-br-data-spec
14179@opindex mno-sched-br-data-spec
14180@opindex msched-br-data-spec
14181(Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload.
14182This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14183the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14184The default is 'disable'.
14185
14186@item -msched-ar-data-spec
14187@itemx -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14188@opindex msched-ar-data-spec
14189@opindex mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14190(En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.
14191This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14192the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14193The default is 'enable'.
14194
14195@item -mno-sched-control-spec
14196@itemx -msched-control-spec
14197@opindex mno-sched-control-spec
14198@opindex msched-control-spec
14199(Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is
14200available only during region scheduling (i.e.@: before reload).
14201This will result in generation of the ld.s instructions and
14202the corresponding check instructions chk.s .
14203The default is 'disable'.
14204
14205@item -msched-br-in-data-spec
14206@itemx -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14207@opindex msched-br-in-data-spec
14208@opindex mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14209(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14210are dependent on the data speculative loads before reload.
14211This is effective only with @option{-msched-br-data-spec} enabled.
14212The default is 'enable'.
14213
14214@item -msched-ar-in-data-spec
14215@itemx -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14216@opindex msched-ar-in-data-spec
14217@opindex mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14218(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14219are dependent on the data speculative loads after reload.
14220This is effective only with @option{-msched-ar-data-spec} enabled.
14221The default is 'enable'.
14222
14223@item -msched-in-control-spec
14224@itemx -mno-sched-in-control-spec
14225@opindex msched-in-control-spec
14226@opindex mno-sched-in-control-spec
14227(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14228are dependent on the control speculative loads.
14229This is effective only with @option{-msched-control-spec} enabled.
14230The default is 'enable'.
14231
14232@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14233@itemx -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14234@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14235@opindex msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14236If enabled, data speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14237only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14238the use of the data speculation much more conservative.
14239The default is 'disable'.
14240
14241@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14242@itemx -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14243@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14244@opindex msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14245If enabled, control speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14246only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14247the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
14248The default is 'disable'.
14249
14250@item -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14251@itemx -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14252@opindex mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14253@opindex msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14254If enabled, speculative dependencies will be considered during
14255computation of the instructions priorities.  This will make the use of the
14256speculation a bit more conservative.
14257The default is 'disable'.
14258
14259@item -msched-spec-ldc
14260@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14261Use a simple data speculation check.  This option is on by default.
14262
14263@item -msched-control-spec-ldc
14264@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14265Use a simple check for control speculation.  This option is on by default.
14266
14267@item -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14268@opindex msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14269Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling.  This option is on
14270by default.
14271
14272@item -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14273@opindex msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14274Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict
14275when placed into the same instruction group.  This option is disabled by
14276default.
14277
14278@item -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14279@opindex msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14280Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.
14281This flag is disabled by default.
14282
14283@item -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}
14284@opindex msched-max-memory-insns
14285Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower
14286priority to subsequent memory insns attempting to schedule in the same
14287instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank conflicts.
14288The default value is 1.
14289
14290@item -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14291@opindex msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14292Disallow more than `msched-max-memory-insns' in instruction group.
14293Otherwise, limit is `soft' meaning that we would prefer non-memory operations
14294when limit is reached but may still schedule memory operations.
14295
14296@end table
14297
14298@node IA-64/VMS Options
14299@subsection IA-64/VMS Options
14300
14301These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IA-64/VMS implementations:
14302
14303@table @gcctabopt
14304@item -mvms-return-codes
14305@opindex mvms-return-codes
14306Return VMS condition codes from main. The default is to return POSIX
14307style condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
14308
14309@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14310@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14311Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
14312routine for the debugger.
14313
14314@item -mmalloc64
14315@opindex mmalloc64
14316Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
14317@end table
14318
14319@node LM32 Options
14320@subsection LM32 Options
14321@cindex LM32 options
14322
14323These @option{-m} options are defined for the Lattice Mico32 architecture:
14324
14325@table @gcctabopt
14326@item -mbarrel-shift-enabled
14327@opindex mbarrel-shift-enabled
14328Enable barrel-shift instructions.
14329
14330@item -mdivide-enabled
14331@opindex mdivide-enabled
14332Enable divide and modulus instructions.
14333
14334@item -mmultiply-enabled
14335@opindex multiply-enabled
14336Enable multiply instructions.
14337
14338@item -msign-extend-enabled
14339@opindex msign-extend-enabled
14340Enable sign extend instructions.
14341
14342@item -muser-enabled
14343@opindex muser-enabled
14344Enable user-defined instructions.
14345
14346@end table
14347
14348@node M32C Options
14349@subsection M32C Options
14350@cindex M32C options
14351
14352@table @gcctabopt
14353@item -mcpu=@var{name}
14354@opindex mcpu=
14355Select the CPU for which code is generated.  @var{name} may be one of
14356@samp{r8c} for the R8C/Tiny series, @samp{m16c} for the M16C (up to
14357/60) series, @samp{m32cm} for the M16C/80 series, or @samp{m32c} for
14358the M32C/80 series.
14359
14360@item -msim
14361@opindex msim
14362Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
14363an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports, for
14364example, file I/O@.  You must not use this option when generating
14365programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own
14366runtime library for whatever I/O functions are needed.
14367
14368@item -memregs=@var{number}
14369@opindex memregs=
14370Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC will use
14371during code generation.  These pseudo-registers will be used like real
14372registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
14373code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
14374memory instead of registers.  Note that all modules in a program must
14375be compiled with the same value for this option.  Because of that, you
14376must not use this option with the default runtime libraries gcc
14377builds.
14378
14379@end table
14380
14381@node M32R/D Options
14382@subsection M32R/D Options
14383@cindex M32R/D options
14384
14385These @option{-m} options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
14386
14387@table @gcctabopt
14388@item -m32r2
14389@opindex m32r2
14390Generate code for the M32R/2@.
14391
14392@item -m32rx
14393@opindex m32rx
14394Generate code for the M32R/X@.
14395
14396@item -m32r
14397@opindex m32r
14398Generate code for the M32R@.  This is the default.
14399
14400@item -mmodel=small
14401@opindex mmodel=small
14402Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
14403can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
14404are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14405This is the default.
14406
14407The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
14408@code{model} attribute.
14409
14410@item -mmodel=medium
14411@opindex mmodel=medium
14412Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14413will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14414assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14415
14416@item -mmodel=large
14417@opindex mmodel=large
14418Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14419will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14420assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
14421(the compiler will generate the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
14422instruction sequence).
14423
14424@item -msdata=none
14425@opindex msdata=none
14426Disable use of the small data area.  Variables will be put into
14427one of @samp{.data}, @samp{bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
14428@code{section} attribute has been specified).
14429This is the default.
14430
14431The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
14432Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
14433@code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
14434
14435@item -msdata=sdata
14436@opindex msdata=sdata
14437Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
14438generate special code to reference them.
14439
14440@item -msdata=use
14441@opindex msdata=use
14442Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
14443special instructions to reference them.
14444
14445@item -G @var{num}
14446@opindex G
14447@cindex smaller data references
14448Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
14449into the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
14450sections.  The default value of @var{num} is 8.
14451The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
14452for this option to have any effect.
14453
14454All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
14455Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
14456doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
14457generated.
14458
14459@item -mdebug
14460@opindex mdebug
14461Makes the M32R specific code in the compiler display some statistics
14462that might help in debugging programs.
14463
14464@item -malign-loops
14465@opindex malign-loops
14466Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
14467
14468@item -mno-align-loops
14469@opindex mno-align-loops
14470Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.
14471
14472@item -missue-rate=@var{number}
14473@opindex missue-rate=@var{number}
14474Issue @var{number} instructions per cycle.  @var{number} can only be 1
14475or 2.
14476
14477@item -mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14478@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14479@var{number} can only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches will be
14480preferred over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite will
14481apply.
14482
14483@item -mflush-trap=@var{number}
14484@opindex mflush-trap=@var{number}
14485Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is
1448612.  Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
14487
14488@item -mno-flush-trap
14489@opindex mno-flush-trap
14490Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
14491
14492@item -mflush-func=@var{name}
14493@opindex mflush-func=@var{name}
14494Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to flush
14495the cache.  The default is @emph{_flush_cache}, but a function call
14496will only be used if a trap is not available.
14497
14498@item -mno-flush-func
14499@opindex mno-flush-func
14500Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
14501
14502@end table
14503
14504@node M680x0 Options
14505@subsection M680x0 Options
14506@cindex M680x0 options
14507
14508These are the @samp{-m} options defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.
14509The default settings depend on which architecture was selected when
14510the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices
14511are given below.
14512
14513@table @gcctabopt
14514@item -march=@var{arch}
14515@opindex march
14516Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set
14517architecture.  Permissible values of @var{arch} for M680x0
14518architectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14519@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060} and @samp{cpu32}.  ColdFire
14520architectures are selected according to Freescale's ISA classification
14521and the permissible values are: @samp{isaa}, @samp{isaaplus},
14522@samp{isab} and @samp{isac}.
14523
14524gcc defines a macro @samp{__mcf@var{arch}__} whenever it is generating
14525code for a ColdFire target.  The @var{arch} in this macro is one of the
14526@option{-march} arguments given above.
14527
14528When used together, @option{-march} and @option{-mtune} select code
14529that runs on a family of similar processors but that is optimized
14530for a particular microarchitecture.
14531
14532@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
14533@opindex mcpu
14534Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.
14535The M680x0 @var{cpu}s are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14536@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}, @samp{68302}, @samp{68332}
14537and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire @var{cpu}s are given by the table
14538below, which also classifies the CPUs into families:
14539
14540@multitable @columnfractions 0.20 0.80
14541@item @strong{Family} @tab @strong{@samp{-mcpu} arguments}
14542@item @samp{51} @tab @samp{51} @samp{51ac} @samp{51cn} @samp{51em} @samp{51qe}
14543@item @samp{5206} @tab @samp{5202} @samp{5204} @samp{5206}
14544@item @samp{5206e} @tab @samp{5206e}
14545@item @samp{5208} @tab @samp{5207} @samp{5208}
14546@item @samp{5211a} @tab @samp{5210a} @samp{5211a}
14547@item @samp{5213} @tab @samp{5211} @samp{5212} @samp{5213}
14548@item @samp{5216} @tab @samp{5214} @samp{5216}
14549@item @samp{52235} @tab @samp{52230} @samp{52231} @samp{52232} @samp{52233} @samp{52234} @samp{52235}
14550@item @samp{5225} @tab @samp{5224} @samp{5225}
14551@item @samp{52259} @tab @samp{52252} @samp{52254} @samp{52255} @samp{52256} @samp{52258} @samp{52259}
14552@item @samp{5235} @tab @samp{5232} @samp{5233} @samp{5234} @samp{5235} @samp{523x}
14553@item @samp{5249} @tab @samp{5249}
14554@item @samp{5250} @tab @samp{5250}
14555@item @samp{5271} @tab @samp{5270} @samp{5271}
14556@item @samp{5272} @tab @samp{5272}
14557@item @samp{5275} @tab @samp{5274} @samp{5275}
14558@item @samp{5282} @tab @samp{5280} @samp{5281} @samp{5282} @samp{528x}
14559@item @samp{53017} @tab @samp{53011} @samp{53012} @samp{53013} @samp{53014} @samp{53015} @samp{53016} @samp{53017}
14560@item @samp{5307} @tab @samp{5307}
14561@item @samp{5329} @tab @samp{5327} @samp{5328} @samp{5329} @samp{532x}
14562@item @samp{5373} @tab @samp{5372} @samp{5373} @samp{537x}
14563@item @samp{5407} @tab @samp{5407}
14564@item @samp{5475} @tab @samp{5470} @samp{5471} @samp{5472} @samp{5473} @samp{5474} @samp{5475} @samp{547x} @samp{5480} @samp{5481} @samp{5482} @samp{5483} @samp{5484} @samp{5485}
14565@end multitable
14566
14567@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu}} overrides @option{-march=@var{arch}} if
14568@var{arch} is compatible with @var{cpu}.  Other combinations of
14569@option{-mcpu} and @option{-march} are rejected.
14570
14571gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcf_cpu_@var{cpu}} when ColdFire target
14572@var{cpu} is selected.  It also defines @samp{__mcf_family_@var{family}},
14573where the value of @var{family} is given by the table above.
14574
14575@item -mtune=@var{tune}
14576@opindex mtune
14577Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture, within the
14578constraints set by @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu}.
14579The M680x0 microarchitectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010},
14580@samp{68020}, @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}
14581and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire microarchitectures
14582are: @samp{cfv1}, @samp{cfv2}, @samp{cfv3}, @samp{cfv4} and @samp{cfv4e}.
14583
14584You can also use @option{-mtune=68020-40} for code that needs
14585to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040 targets.
14586@option{-mtune=68020-60} is similar but includes 68060 targets
14587as well.  These two options select the same tuning decisions as
14588@option{-m68020-40} and @option{-m68020-60} respectively.
14589
14590gcc defines the macros @samp{__mc@var{arch}} and @samp{__mc@var{arch}__}
14591when tuning for 680x0 architecture @var{arch}.  It also defines
14592@samp{mc@var{arch}} unless either @option{-ansi} or a non-GNU @option{-std}
14593option is used.  If gcc is tuning for a range of architectures,
14594as selected by @option{-mtune=68020-40} or @option{-mtune=68020-60},
14595it defines the macros for every architecture in the range.
14596
14597gcc also defines the macro @samp{__m@var{uarch}__} when tuning for
14598ColdFire microarchitecture @var{uarch}, where @var{uarch} is one
14599of the arguments given above.
14600
14601@item -m68000
14602@itemx -mc68000
14603@opindex m68000
14604@opindex mc68000
14605Generate output for a 68000.  This is the default
14606when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
14607It is equivalent to @option{-march=68000}.
14608
14609Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
14610including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
14611
14612@item -m68010
14613@opindex m68010
14614Generate output for a 68010.  This is the default
14615when the compiler is configured for 68010-based systems.
14616It is equivalent to @option{-march=68010}.
14617
14618@item -m68020
14619@itemx -mc68020
14620@opindex m68020
14621@opindex mc68020
14622Generate output for a 68020.  This is the default
14623when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
14624It is equivalent to @option{-march=68020}.
14625
14626@item -m68030
14627@opindex m68030
14628Generate output for a 68030.  This is the default when the compiler is
14629configured for 68030-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14630@option{-march=68030}.
14631
14632@item -m68040
14633@opindex m68040
14634Generate output for a 68040.  This is the default when the compiler is
14635configured for 68040-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14636@option{-march=68040}.
14637
14638This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
14639emulated by software on the 68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not
14640have code to emulate those instructions.
14641
14642@item -m68060
14643@opindex m68060
14644Generate output for a 68060.  This is the default when the compiler is
14645configured for 68060-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14646@option{-march=68060}.
14647
14648This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
14649have to be emulated by software on the 68060.  Use this option if your 68060
14650does not have code to emulate those instructions.
14651
14652@item -mcpu32
14653@opindex mcpu32
14654Generate output for a CPU32.  This is the default
14655when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
14656It is equivalent to @option{-march=cpu32}.
14657
14658Use this option for microcontrollers with a
14659CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
1466068336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
14661
14662@item -m5200
14663@opindex m5200
14664Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU@.  This is the default
14665when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
14666It is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=5206}, and is now deprecated
14667in favor of that option.
14668
14669Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
14670the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5206.
14671
14672@item -m5206e
14673@opindex m5206e
14674Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU@.  The option is now
14675deprecated in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14676
14677@item -m528x
14678@opindex m528x
14679Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.
14680The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
14681@option{-mcpu=528x}.
14682
14683@item -m5307
14684@opindex m5307
14685Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14686in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5307}.
14687
14688@item -m5407
14689@opindex m5407
14690Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14691in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5407}.
14692
14693@item -mcfv4e
14694@opindex mcfv4e
14695Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU (e.g.@: 547x/548x).
14696This includes use of hardware floating-point instructions.
14697The option is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=547x}, and is now
14698deprecated in favor of that option.
14699
14700@item -m68020-40
14701@opindex m68020-40
14702Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
14703This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1470468020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1470568881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
14706
14707The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-40}.
14708
14709@item -m68020-60
14710@opindex m68020-60
14711Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
14712This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1471368020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1471468881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
14715
14716The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-60}.
14717
14718@item -mhard-float
14719@itemx -m68881
14720@opindex mhard-float
14721@opindex m68881
14722Generate floating-point instructions.  This is the default for 68020
14723and above, and for ColdFire devices that have an FPU@.  It defines the
14724macro @samp{__HAVE_68881__} on M680x0 targets and @samp{__mcffpu__}
14725on ColdFire targets.
14726
14727@item -msoft-float
14728@opindex msoft-float
14729Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls instead.
14730This is the default for 68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.  It is also
14731the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.
14732
14733@item -mdiv
14734@itemx -mno-div
14735@opindex mdiv
14736@opindex mno-div
14737Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder
14738instructions.  If @option{-march} is used without @option{-mcpu},
14739the default is ``on'' for ColdFire architectures and ``off'' for M680x0
14740architectures.  Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU
14741(either the default CPU, or the one specified by @option{-mcpu}).  For
14742example, the default is ``off'' for @option{-mcpu=5206} and ``on'' for
14743@option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14744
14745gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcfhwdiv__} when this option is enabled.
14746
14747@item -mshort
14748@opindex mshort
14749Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
14750Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
1475116-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.
14752
14753@item -mno-short
14754@opindex mno-short
14755Do not consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide.  This is the default.
14756
14757@item -mnobitfield
14758@itemx -mno-bitfield
14759@opindex mnobitfield
14760@opindex mno-bitfield
14761Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
14762and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
14763
14764@item -mbitfield
14765@opindex mbitfield
14766Do use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68020} option implies
14767@option{-mbitfield}.  This is the default if you use a configuration
14768designed for a 68020.
14769
14770@item -mrtd
14771@opindex mrtd
14772Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
14773that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
14774instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This
14775saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
14776the arguments there.
14777
14778This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
14779used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
14780compiled with the Unix compiler.
14781
14782Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
14783take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
14784otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
14785functions.
14786
14787In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
14788function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
14789harmlessly ignored.)
14790
14791The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
1479268040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
14793
14794@item -mno-rtd
14795@opindex mno-rtd
14796Do not use the calling conventions selected by @option{-mrtd}.
14797This is the default.
14798
14799@item -malign-int
14800@itemx -mno-align-int
14801@opindex malign-int
14802@opindex mno-align-int
14803Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
14804@code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
14805boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
14806Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
14807faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
14808
14809@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC will
14810align structures containing the above types  differently than
14811most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
14812
14813@item -mpcrel
14814@opindex mpcrel
14815Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
14816using a global offset table.  At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
14817allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.  @option{-fPIC} is
14818not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
1481968020 and higher processors.
14820
14821@item -mno-strict-align
14822@itemx -mstrict-align
14823@opindex mno-strict-align
14824@opindex mstrict-align
14825Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by
14826the system.
14827
14828@item -msep-data
14829Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
14830area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
14831an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
14832@option{-fPIC}.
14833
14834@item -mno-sep-data
14835Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
14836This is the default.
14837
14838@item -mid-shared-library
14839Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
14840This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
14841without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
14842
14843@item -mno-id-shared-library
14844Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
14845This is the default.
14846
14847@item -mshared-library-id=n
14848Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
14849compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
14850other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
14851library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
14852
14853@item -mxgot
14854@itemx -mno-xgot
14855@opindex mxgot
14856@opindex mno-xgot
14857When generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code
14858that works if the GOT has more than 8192 entries.  This code is
14859larger and slower than code generated without this option.  On M680x0
14860processors, this option is not needed; @option{-fPIC} suffices.
14861
14862GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
14863While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT
14864is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker
14865to report an error such as:
14866
14867@cindex relocation truncated to fit (ColdFire)
14868@smallexample
14869relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar
14870@end smallexample
14871
14872If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
14873It should then work with very large GOTs.  However, code generated with
14874@option{-mxgot} is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to fetch
14875the value of a global symbol.
14876
14877Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker,
14878can create multiple GOTs and sort GOT entries.  If you have such a linker,
14879you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when compiling a single
14880object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries.  Very few do.
14881
14882These options have no effect unless GCC is generating
14883position-independent code.
14884
14885@end table
14886
14887@node MCore Options
14888@subsection MCore Options
14889@cindex MCore options
14890
14891These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
14892processors.
14893
14894@table @gcctabopt
14895
14896@item -mhardlit
14897@itemx -mno-hardlit
14898@opindex mhardlit
14899@opindex mno-hardlit
14900Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
14901instructions or less.
14902
14903@item -mdiv
14904@itemx -mno-div
14905@opindex mdiv
14906@opindex mno-div
14907Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).
14908
14909@item -mrelax-immediate
14910@itemx -mno-relax-immediate
14911@opindex mrelax-immediate
14912@opindex mno-relax-immediate
14913Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.
14914
14915@item -mwide-bitfields
14916@itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
14917@opindex mwide-bitfields
14918@opindex mno-wide-bitfields
14919Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.
14920
14921@item -m4byte-functions
14922@itemx -mno-4byte-functions
14923@opindex m4byte-functions
14924@opindex mno-4byte-functions
14925Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.
14926
14927@item -mcallgraph-data
14928@itemx -mno-callgraph-data
14929@opindex mcallgraph-data
14930@opindex mno-callgraph-data
14931Emit callgraph information.
14932
14933@item -mslow-bytes
14934@itemx -mno-slow-bytes
14935@opindex mslow-bytes
14936@opindex mno-slow-bytes
14937Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
14938
14939@item -mlittle-endian
14940@itemx -mbig-endian
14941@opindex mlittle-endian
14942@opindex mbig-endian
14943Generate code for a little-endian target.
14944
14945@item -m210
14946@itemx -m340
14947@opindex m210
14948@opindex m340
14949Generate code for the 210 processor.
14950
14951@item -mno-lsim
14952@opindex mno-lsim
14953Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the
14954simulator library (@file{libsim.a)} from the linker command line.
14955
14956@item -mstack-increment=@var{size}
14957@opindex mstack-increment
14958Set the maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.  Large
14959values can increase the speed of programs that contain functions
14960that need a large amount of stack space, but they can also trigger a
14961segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much.  The default
14962value is 0x1000.
14963
14964@end table
14965
14966@node MeP Options
14967@subsection MeP Options
14968@cindex MeP options
14969
14970@table @gcctabopt
14971
14972@item -mabsdiff
14973@opindex mabsdiff
14974Enables the @code{abs} instruction, which is the absolute difference
14975between two registers.
14976
14977@item -mall-opts
14978@opindex mall-opts
14979Enables all the optional instructions - average, multiply, divide, bit
14980operations, leading zero, absolute difference, min/max, clip, and
14981saturation.
14982
14983
14984@item -maverage
14985@opindex maverage
14986Enables the @code{ave} instruction, which computes the average of two
14987registers.
14988
14989@item -mbased=@var{n}
14990@opindex mbased=
14991Variables of size @var{n} bytes or smaller will be placed in the
14992@code{.based} section by default.  Based variables use the @code{$tp}
14993register as a base register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the
14994@code{.based} section.
14995
14996@item -mbitops
14997@opindex mbitops
14998Enables the bit operation instructions - bit test (@code{btstm}), set
14999(@code{bsetm}), clear (@code{bclrm}), invert (@code{bnotm}), and
15000test-and-set (@code{tas}).
15001
15002@item -mc=@var{name}
15003@opindex mc=
15004Selects which section constant data will be placed in.  @var{name} may
15005be @code{tiny}, @code{near}, or @code{far}.
15006
15007@item -mclip
15008@opindex mclip
15009Enables the @code{clip} instruction.  Note that @code{-mclip} is not
15010useful unless you also provide @code{-mminmax}.
15011
15012@item -mconfig=@var{name}
15013@opindex mconfig=
15014Selects one of the build-in core configurations.  Each MeP chip has
15015one or more modules in it; each module has a core CPU and a variety of
15016coprocessors, optional instructions, and peripherals.  The
15017@code{MeP-Integrator} tool, not part of GCC, provides these
15018configurations through this option; using this option is the same as
15019using all the corresponding command-line options.  The default
15020configuration is @code{default}.
15021
15022@item -mcop
15023@opindex mcop
15024Enables the coprocessor instructions.  By default, this is a 32-bit
15025coprocessor.  Note that the coprocessor is normally enabled via the
15026@code{-mconfig=} option.
15027
15028@item -mcop32
15029@opindex mcop32
15030Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15031
15032@item -mcop64
15033@opindex mcop64
15034Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15035
15036@item -mivc2
15037@opindex mivc2
15038Enables IVC2 scheduling.  IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.
15039
15040@item -mdc
15041@opindex mdc
15042Causes constant variables to be placed in the @code{.near} section.
15043
15044@item -mdiv
15045@opindex mdiv
15046Enables the @code{div} and @code{divu} instructions.
15047
15048@item -meb
15049@opindex meb
15050Generate big-endian code.
15051
15052@item -mel
15053@opindex mel
15054Generate little-endian code.
15055
15056@item -mio-volatile
15057@opindex mio-volatile
15058Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the @code{io}
15059attribute is to be considered volatile.
15060
15061@item -ml
15062@opindex ml
15063Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.far} section by default.
15064
15065@item -mleadz
15066@opindex mleadz
15067Enables the @code{leadz} (leading zero) instruction.
15068
15069@item -mm
15070@opindex mm
15071Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.near} section by default.
15072
15073@item -mminmax
15074@opindex mminmax
15075Enables the @code{min} and @code{max} instructions.
15076
15077@item -mmult
15078@opindex mmult
15079Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.
15080
15081@item -mno-opts
15082@opindex mno-opts
15083Disables all the optional instructions enabled by @code{-mall-opts}.
15084
15085@item -mrepeat
15086@opindex mrepeat
15087Enables the @code{repeat} and @code{erepeat} instructions, used for
15088low-overhead looping.
15089
15090@item -ms
15091@opindex ms
15092Causes all variables to default to the @code{.tiny} section.  Note
15093that there is a 65536-byte limit to this section.  Accesses to these
15094variables use the @code{%gp} base register.
15095
15096@item -msatur
15097@opindex msatur
15098Enables the saturation instructions.  Note that the compiler does not
15099currently generate these itself, but this option is included for
15100compatibility with other tools, like @code{as}.
15101
15102@item -msdram
15103@opindex msdram
15104Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.
15105
15106@item -msim
15107@opindex msim
15108Link the simulator runtime libraries.
15109
15110@item -msimnovec
15111@opindex msimnovec
15112Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support
15113for reset and exception vectors and tables.
15114
15115@item -mtf
15116@opindex mtf
15117Causes all functions to default to the @code{.far} section.  Without
15118this option, functions default to the @code{.near} section.
15119
15120@item -mtiny=@var{n}
15121@opindex mtiny=
15122Variables that are @var{n} bytes or smaller will be allocated to the
15123@code{.tiny} section.  These variables use the @code{$gp} base
15124register.  The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a
1512565536-byte limit to the @code{.tiny} section.
15126
15127@end table
15128
15129@node MicroBlaze Options
15130@subsection MicroBlaze Options
15131@cindex MicroBlaze Options
15132
15133@table @gcctabopt
15134
15135@item -msoft-float
15136@opindex msoft-float
15137Use software emulation for floating point (default).
15138
15139@item -mhard-float
15140@opindex mhard-float
15141Use hardware floating-point instructions.
15142
15143@item -mmemcpy
15144@opindex mmemcpy
15145Do not optimize block moves, use @code{memcpy}.
15146
15147@item -mno-clearbss
15148@opindex mno-clearbss
15149This option is deprecated.  Use @option{-fno-zero-initialized-in-bss} instead.
15150
15151@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
15152@opindex mcpu=
15153Use features of and schedule code for given CPU.
15154Supported values are in the format @samp{v@var{X}.@var{YY}.@var{Z}},
15155where @var{X} is a major version, @var{YY} is the minor version, and
15156@var{Z} is compatibility code.  Example values are @samp{v3.00.a},
15157@samp{v4.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.a}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v6.00.a}.
15158
15159@item -mxl-soft-mul
15160@opindex mxl-soft-mul
15161Use software multiply emulation (default).
15162
15163@item -mxl-soft-div
15164@opindex mxl-soft-div
15165Use software emulation for divides (default).
15166
15167@item -mxl-barrel-shift
15168@opindex mxl-barrel-shift
15169Use the hardware barrel shifter.
15170
15171@item -mxl-pattern-compare
15172@opindex mxl-pattern-compare
15173Use pattern compare instructions.
15174
15175@item -msmall-divides
15176@opindex msmall-divides
15177Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.
15178
15179@item -mxl-stack-check
15180@opindex mxl-stack-check
15181This option is deprecated.  Use -fstack-check instead.
15182
15183@item -mxl-gp-opt
15184@opindex mxl-gp-opt
15185Use GP relative sdata/sbss sections.
15186
15187@item -mxl-multiply-high
15188@opindex mxl-multiply-high
15189Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.
15190
15191@item -mxl-float-convert
15192@opindex mxl-float-convert
15193Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.
15194
15195@item -mxl-float-sqrt
15196@opindex mxl-float-sqrt
15197Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.
15198
15199@item -mxl-mode-@var{app-model}
15200Select application model @var{app-model}.  Valid models are
15201@table @samp
15202@item executable
15203normal executable (default), uses startup code @file{crt0.o}.
15204
15205@item xmdstub
15206for use with Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based
15207software intrusive debug agent called xmdstub. This uses startup file
15208@file{crt1.o} and sets the start address of the program to be 0x800.
15209
15210@item bootstrap
15211for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.
15212This model uses startup file @file{crt2.o} which does not contain a processor
15213reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
15214processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.
15215
15216@item novectors
15217for applications that do not require any of the
15218MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for applications running
15219within a monitoring application. This model uses @file{crt3.o} as a startup file.
15220@end table
15221
15222Option @option{-xl-mode-@var{app-model}} is a deprecated alias for
15223@option{-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}.
15224
15225@end table
15226
15227@node MIPS Options
15228@subsection MIPS Options
15229@cindex MIPS options
15230
15231@table @gcctabopt
15232
15233@item -EB
15234@opindex EB
15235Generate big-endian code.
15236
15237@item -EL
15238@opindex EL
15239Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for @samp{mips*el-*-*}
15240configurations.
15241
15242@item -march=@var{arch}
15243@opindex march
15244Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
15245generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
15246The ISA names are:
15247@samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
15248@samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, @samp{mips64} and @samp{mips64r2}.
15249The processor names are:
15250@samp{4kc}, @samp{4km}, @samp{4kp}, @samp{4ksc},
15251@samp{4kec}, @samp{4kem}, @samp{4kep}, @samp{4ksd},
15252@samp{5kc}, @samp{5kf},
15253@samp{20kc},
15254@samp{24kc}, @samp{24kf2_1}, @samp{24kf1_1},
15255@samp{24kec}, @samp{24kef2_1}, @samp{24kef1_1},
15256@samp{34kc}, @samp{34kf2_1}, @samp{34kf1_1},
15257@samp{74kc}, @samp{74kf2_1}, @samp{74kf1_1}, @samp{74kf3_2},
15258@samp{1004kc}, @samp{1004kf2_1}, @samp{1004kf1_1},
15259@samp{loongson2e}, @samp{loongson2f}, @samp{loongson3a},
15260@samp{m4k},
15261@samp{octeon}, @samp{octeon+}, @samp{octeon2},
15262@samp{orion},
15263@samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
15264@samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
15265@samp{rm7000}, @samp{rm9000},
15266@samp{r10000}, @samp{r12000}, @samp{r14000}, @samp{r16000},
15267@samp{sb1},
15268@samp{sr71000},
15269@samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4111}, @samp{vr4120}, @samp{vr4130}, @samp{vr4300},
15270@samp{vr5000}, @samp{vr5400}, @samp{vr5500}
15271and @samp{xlr}.
15272The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
15273most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
15274@samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
15275
15276Native Linux/GNU and IRIX toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
15277which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
15278@option{-march=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
15279the processor.
15280
15281In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
15282(for example, @samp{-march=r2k}).  Prefixes are optional, and
15283@samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
15284
15285Names of the form @samp{@var{n}f2_1} refer to processors with
15286FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of the form
15287@samp{@var{n}f1_1} refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same
15288rate as the core, and names of the form @samp{@var{n}f3_2} refer to
15289processors with FPUs clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.
15290For compatibility reasons, @samp{@var{n}f} is accepted as a synonym
15291for @samp{@var{n}f2_1} while @samp{@var{n}x} and @samp{@var{b}fx} are
15292accepted as synonyms for @samp{@var{n}f1_1}.
15293
15294GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option.  The first
15295is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
15296a string.  The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
15297where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
15298For example, @samp{-march=r2000} will set @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
15299to @samp{"r2000"} and define the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
15300
15301Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
15302above.  In other words, it will have the full prefix and will not
15303abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}.  In the case of @samp{from-abi},
15304the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
15305@samp{"mips3"}).  It names the default architecture when no
15306@option{-march} option is given.
15307
15308@item -mtune=@var{arch}
15309@opindex mtune
15310Optimize for @var{arch}.  Among other things, this option controls
15311the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
15312operations.  The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
15313@option{-march}.
15314
15315When this option is not used, GCC will optimize for the processor
15316specified by @option{-march}.  By using @option{-march} and
15317@option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that will
15318run on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
15319particular member of that family.
15320
15321@samp{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
15322@samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
15323@samp{-march} ones described above.
15324
15325@item -mips1
15326@opindex mips1
15327Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips1}.
15328
15329@item -mips2
15330@opindex mips2
15331Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips2}.
15332
15333@item -mips3
15334@opindex mips3
15335Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips3}.
15336
15337@item -mips4
15338@opindex mips4
15339Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips4}.
15340
15341@item -mips32
15342@opindex mips32
15343Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32}.
15344
15345@item -mips32r2
15346@opindex mips32r2
15347Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32r2}.
15348
15349@item -mips64
15350@opindex mips64
15351Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64}.
15352
15353@item -mips64r2
15354@opindex mips64r2
15355Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64r2}.
15356
15357@item -mips16
15358@itemx -mno-mips16
15359@opindex mips16
15360@opindex mno-mips16
15361Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code.  If GCC is targetting a
15362MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it will make use of the MIPS16e ASE@.
15363
15364MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis
15365by means of @code{mips16} and @code{nomips16} attributes.
15366@xref{Function Attributes}, for more information.
15367
15368@item -mflip-mips16
15369@opindex mflip-mips16
15370Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions.  This option is provided
15371for regression testing of mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is
15372not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.
15373
15374@item -minterlink-mips16
15375@itemx -mno-interlink-mips16
15376@opindex minterlink-mips16
15377@opindex mno-interlink-mips16
15378Require (do not require) that non-MIPS16 code be link-compatible with
15379MIPS16 code.
15380
15381For example, non-MIPS16 code cannot jump directly to MIPS16 code;
15382it must either use a call or an indirect jump.  @option{-minterlink-mips16}
15383therefore disables direct jumps unless GCC knows that the target of the
15384jump is not MIPS16.
15385
15386@item -mabi=32
15387@itemx -mabi=o64
15388@itemx -mabi=n32
15389@itemx -mabi=64
15390@itemx -mabi=eabi
15391@opindex mabi=32
15392@opindex mabi=o64
15393@opindex mabi=n32
15394@opindex mabi=64
15395@opindex mabi=eabi
15396Generate code for the given ABI@.
15397
15398Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally
15399generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
15400can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
15401
15402For information about the O64 ABI, see
15403@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/projects/@/mipso64-abi.html}.
15404
15405GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers
15406are 64 rather than 32 bits wide.  You can select this combination with
15407@option{-mabi=32} @option{-mfp64}.  This ABI relies on the @samp{mthc1}
15408and @samp{mfhc1} instructions and is therefore only supported for
15409MIPS32R2 processors.
15410
15411The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the
15412same, but each scalar value is passed in a single 64-bit register
15413rather than a pair of 32-bit registers.  For example, scalar
15414floating-point values are returned in @samp{$f0} only, not a
15415@samp{$f0}/@samp{$f1} pair.  The set of call-saved registers also
15416remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.
15417
15418@item -mabicalls
15419@itemx -mno-abicalls
15420@opindex mabicalls
15421@opindex mno-abicalls
15422Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
15423dynamic objects.  @option{-mabicalls} is the default for SVR4-based
15424systems.
15425
15426@item -mshared
15427@itemx -mno-shared
15428Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
15429and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries.  This option
15430only affects @option{-mabicalls}.
15431
15432All @option{-mabicalls} code has traditionally been position-independent,
15433regardless of options like @option{-fPIC} and @option{-fpic}.  However,
15434as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
15435accesses for locally-binding symbols.  It can also use shorter GP
15436initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-defined
15437functions.  This mode is selected by @option{-mno-shared}.
15438
15439@option{-mno-shared} depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
15440objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker.  However, the option
15441does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the ABI
15442of relocatable objects.  Using @option{-mno-shared} will generally make
15443executables both smaller and quicker.
15444
15445@option{-mshared} is the default.
15446
15447@item -mplt
15448@itemx -mno-plt
15449@opindex mplt
15450@opindex mno-plt
15451Assume (do not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers
15452support PLTs and copy relocations.  This option only affects
15453@samp{-mno-shared -mabicalls}.  For the n64 ABI, this option
15454has no effect without @samp{-msym32}.
15455
15456You can make @option{-mplt} the default by configuring
15457GCC with @option{--with-mips-plt}.  The default is
15458@option{-mno-plt} otherwise.
15459
15460@item -mxgot
15461@itemx -mno-xgot
15462@opindex mxgot
15463@opindex mno-xgot
15464Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
15465offset table.
15466
15467GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
15468While this is relatively efficient, it will only work if the GOT
15469is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger will cause the linker
15470to report an error such as:
15471
15472@cindex relocation truncated to fit (MIPS)
15473@smallexample
15474relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
15475@end smallexample
15476
15477If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
15478It should then work with very large GOTs, although it will also be
15479less efficient, since it will take three instructions to fetch the
15480value of a global symbol.
15481
15482Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a
15483linker, you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when a single object
15484file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.
15485
15486These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
15487independent code.
15488
15489@item -mgp32
15490@opindex mgp32
15491Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
15492
15493@item -mgp64
15494@opindex mgp64
15495Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
15496
15497@item -mfp32
15498@opindex mfp32
15499Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
15500
15501@item -mfp64
15502@opindex mfp64
15503Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
15504
15505@item -mhard-float
15506@opindex mhard-float
15507Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
15508
15509@item -msoft-float
15510@opindex msoft-float
15511Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions.  Implement
15512floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
15513
15514@item -msingle-float
15515@opindex msingle-float
15516Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision
15517operations.
15518
15519@item -mdouble-float
15520@opindex mdouble-float
15521Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-precision
15522operations.  This is the default.
15523
15524@item -mllsc
15525@itemx -mno-llsc
15526@opindex mllsc
15527@opindex mno-llsc
15528Use (do not use) @samp{ll}, @samp{sc}, and @samp{sync} instructions to
15529implement atomic memory built-in functions.  When neither option is
15530specified, GCC will use the instructions if the target architecture
15531supports them.
15532
15533@option{-mllsc} is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the
15534instructions and @option{-mno-llsc} can be useful when compiling for
15535nonstandard ISAs.  You can make either option the default by
15536configuring GCC with @option{--with-llsc} and @option{--without-llsc}
15537respectively.  @option{--with-llsc} is the default for some
15538configurations; see the installation documentation for details.
15539
15540@item -mdsp
15541@itemx -mno-dsp
15542@opindex mdsp
15543@opindex mno-dsp
15544Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15545@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15546preprocessor macro @samp{__mips_dsp}.  It also defines
15547@samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 1.
15548
15549@item -mdspr2
15550@itemx -mno-dspr2
15551@opindex mdspr2
15552@opindex mno-dspr2
15553Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15554@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15555preprocessor macros @samp{__mips_dsp} and @samp{__mips_dspr2}.
15556It also defines @samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 2.
15557
15558@item -msmartmips
15559@itemx -mno-smartmips
15560@opindex msmartmips
15561@opindex mno-smartmips
15562Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.
15563
15564@item -mpaired-single
15565@itemx -mno-paired-single
15566@opindex mpaired-single
15567@opindex mno-paired-single
15568Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
15569@xref{MIPS Paired-Single Support}.  This option requires
15570hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15571
15572@item -mdmx
15573@itemx -mno-mdmx
15574@opindex mdmx
15575@opindex mno-mdmx
15576Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions.
15577This option can only be used when generating 64-bit code and requires
15578hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15579
15580@item -mips3d
15581@itemx -mno-mips3d
15582@opindex mips3d
15583@opindex mno-mips3d
15584Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE@.  @xref{MIPS-3D Built-in Functions}.
15585The option @option{-mips3d} implies @option{-mpaired-single}.
15586
15587@item -mmt
15588@itemx -mno-mt
15589@opindex mmt
15590@opindex mno-mt
15591Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.
15592
15593@item -mlong64
15594@opindex mlong64
15595Force @code{long} types to be 64 bits wide.  See @option{-mlong32} for
15596an explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
15597determined.
15598
15599@item -mlong32
15600@opindex mlong32
15601Force @code{long}, @code{int}, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
15602
15603The default size of @code{int}s, @code{long}s and pointers depends on
15604the ABI@.  All the supported ABIs use 32-bit @code{int}s.  The n64 ABI
15605uses 64-bit @code{long}s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use
1560632-bit @code{long}s.  Pointers are the same size as @code{long}s,
15607or the same size as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
15608
15609@item -msym32
15610@itemx -mno-sym32
15611@opindex msym32
15612@opindex mno-sym32
15613Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless
15614of the selected ABI@.  This option is useful in combination with
15615@option{-mabi=64} and @option{-mno-abicalls} because it allows GCC
15616to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
15617
15618@item -G @var{num}
15619@opindex G
15620Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
15621if that data is no bigger than @var{num} bytes.  GCC can then access
15622the data more efficiently; see @option{-mgpopt} for details.
15623
15624The default @option{-G} option depends on the configuration.
15625
15626@item -mlocal-sdata
15627@itemx -mno-local-sdata
15628@opindex mlocal-sdata
15629@opindex mno-local-sdata
15630Extend (do not extend) the @option{-G} behavior to local data too,
15631such as to static variables in C@.  @option{-mlocal-sdata} is the
15632default for all configurations.
15633
15634If the linker complains that an application is using too much small data,
15635you might want to try rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with
15636@option{-mno-local-sdata}.  You might also want to build large
15637libraries with @option{-mno-local-sdata}, so that the libraries leave
15638more room for the main program.
15639
15640@item -mextern-sdata
15641@itemx -mno-extern-sdata
15642@opindex mextern-sdata
15643@opindex mno-extern-sdata
15644Assume (do not assume) that externally-defined data will be in
15645a small data section if that data is within the @option{-G} limit.
15646@option{-mextern-sdata} is the default for all configurations.
15647
15648If you compile a module @var{Mod} with @option{-mextern-sdata} @option{-G
15649@var{num}} @option{-mgpopt}, and @var{Mod} references a variable @var{Var}
15650that is no bigger than @var{num} bytes, you must make sure that @var{Var}
15651is placed in a small data section.  If @var{Var} is defined by another
15652module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough
15653@option{-G} setting or attach a @code{section} attribute to @var{Var}'s
15654definition.  If @var{Var} is common, you must link the application
15655with a high-enough @option{-G} setting.
15656
15657The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile
15658and link every module with the same @option{-G} option.  However,
15659you may wish to build a library that supports several different
15660small data limits.  You can do this by compiling the library with
15661the highest supported @option{-G} setting and additionally using
15662@option{-mno-extern-sdata} to stop the library from making assumptions
15663about externally-defined data.
15664
15665@item -mgpopt
15666@itemx -mno-gpopt
15667@opindex mgpopt
15668@opindex mno-gpopt
15669Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be
15670in a small data section; see @option{-G}, @option{-mlocal-sdata} and
15671@option{-mextern-sdata}.  @option{-mgpopt} is the default for all
15672configurations.
15673
15674@option{-mno-gpopt} is useful for cases where the @code{$gp} register
15675might not hold the value of @code{_gp}.  For example, if the code is
15676part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor, programs that
15677call boot monitor routines will pass an unknown value in @code{$gp}.
15678(In such situations, the boot monitor itself would usually be compiled
15679with @option{-G0}.)
15680
15681@option{-mno-gpopt} implies @option{-mno-local-sdata} and
15682@option{-mno-extern-sdata}.
15683
15684@item -membedded-data
15685@itemx -mno-embedded-data
15686@opindex membedded-data
15687@opindex mno-embedded-data
15688Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
15689next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data.  This gives
15690slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
15691when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
15692
15693@item -muninit-const-in-rodata
15694@itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15695@opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
15696@opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15697Put uninitialized @code{const} variables in the read-only data section.
15698This option is only meaningful in conjunction with @option{-membedded-data}.
15699
15700@item -mcode-readable=@var{setting}
15701@opindex mcode-readable
15702Specify whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.
15703There are three possible settings:
15704
15705@table @gcctabopt
15706@item -mcode-readable=yes
15707Instructions may freely access executable sections.  This is the
15708default setting.
15709
15710@item -mcode-readable=pcrel
15711MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections,
15712but other instructions must not do so.  This option is useful on 4KSc
15713and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read Inhibit bit set.
15714It is also useful on processors that can be configured to have a dual
15715instruction/data SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically
15716redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15717
15718@item -mcode-readable=no
15719Instructions must not access executable sections.  This option can be
15720useful on targets that are configured to have a dual instruction/data
15721SRAM interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not automatically redirect
15722PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15723@end table
15724
15725@item -msplit-addresses
15726@itemx -mno-split-addresses
15727@opindex msplit-addresses
15728@opindex mno-split-addresses
15729Enable (disable) use of the @code{%hi()} and @code{%lo()} assembler
15730relocation operators.  This option has been superseded by
15731@option{-mexplicit-relocs} but is retained for backwards compatibility.
15732
15733@item -mexplicit-relocs
15734@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
15735@opindex mexplicit-relocs
15736@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
15737Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with symbolic
15738addresses.  The alternative, selected by @option{-mno-explicit-relocs},
15739is to use assembler macros instead.
15740
15741@option{-mexplicit-relocs} is the default if GCC was configured
15742to use an assembler that supports relocation operators.
15743
15744@item -mcheck-zero-division
15745@itemx -mno-check-zero-division
15746@opindex mcheck-zero-division
15747@opindex mno-check-zero-division
15748Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.
15749
15750The default is @option{-mcheck-zero-division}.
15751
15752@item -mdivide-traps
15753@itemx -mdivide-breaks
15754@opindex mdivide-traps
15755@opindex mdivide-breaks
15756MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
15757conditional trap or a break instruction.  Using traps results in
15758smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also, some
15759versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from
15760generating the proper signal (@code{SIGFPE}).  Use @option{-mdivide-traps} to
15761allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
15762@option{-mdivide-breaks} to force the use of breaks.
15763
15764The default is usually @option{-mdivide-traps}, but this can be
15765overridden at configure time using @option{--with-divide=breaks}.
15766Divide-by-zero checks can be completely disabled using
15767@option{-mno-check-zero-division}.
15768
15769@item -mmemcpy
15770@itemx -mno-memcpy
15771@opindex mmemcpy
15772@opindex mno-memcpy
15773Force (do not force) the use of @code{memcpy()} for non-trivial block
15774moves.  The default is @option{-mno-memcpy}, which allows GCC to inline
15775most constant-sized copies.
15776
15777@item -mlong-calls
15778@itemx -mno-long-calls
15779@opindex mlong-calls
15780@opindex mno-long-calls
15781Disable (do not disable) use of the @code{jal} instruction.  Calling
15782functions using @code{jal} is more efficient but requires the caller
15783and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
15784
15785This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is
15786@option{-mno-long-calls}.
15787
15788@item -mmad
15789@itemx -mno-mad
15790@opindex mmad
15791@opindex mno-mad
15792Enable (disable) use of the @code{mad}, @code{madu} and @code{mul}
15793instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA@.
15794
15795@item -mfused-madd
15796@itemx -mno-fused-madd
15797@opindex mfused-madd
15798@opindex mno-fused-madd
15799Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate
15800instructions, when they are available.  The default is
15801@option{-mfused-madd}.
15802
15803When multiply-accumulate instructions are used, the intermediate
15804product is calculated to infinite precision and is not subject to
15805the FCSR Flush to Zero bit.  This may be undesirable in some
15806circumstances.
15807
15808@item -nocpp
15809@opindex nocpp
15810Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
15811assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
15812
15813@item -mfix-24k
15814@item -mno-fix-24k
15815@opindex mfix-24k
15816@opindex mno-fix-24k
15817Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.
15818The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC.
15819
15820@item -mfix-r4000
15821@itemx -mno-fix-r4000
15822@opindex mfix-r4000
15823@opindex mno-fix-r4000
15824Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
15825@itemize @minus
15826@item
15827A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15828immediately after starting an integer division.
15829@item
15830A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15831while an integer multiplication is in progress.
15832@item
15833An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot
15834of a taken branch or a jump.
15835@end itemize
15836
15837@item -mfix-r4400
15838@itemx -mno-fix-r4400
15839@opindex mfix-r4400
15840@opindex mno-fix-r4400
15841Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
15842@itemize @minus
15843@item
15844A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15845immediately after starting an integer division.
15846@end itemize
15847
15848@item -mfix-r10000
15849@itemx -mno-fix-r10000
15850@opindex mfix-r10000
15851@opindex mno-fix-r10000
15852Work around certain R10000 errata:
15853@itemize @minus
15854@item
15855@code{ll}/@code{sc} sequences may not behave atomically on revisions
15856prior to 3.0.  They may deadlock on revisions 2.6 and earlier.
15857@end itemize
15858
15859This option can only be used if the target architecture supports
15860branch-likely instructions.  @option{-mfix-r10000} is the default when
15861@option{-march=r10000} is used; @option{-mno-fix-r10000} is the default
15862otherwise.
15863
15864@item -mfix-vr4120
15865@itemx -mno-fix-vr4120
15866@opindex mfix-vr4120
15867Work around certain VR4120 errata:
15868@itemize @minus
15869@item
15870@code{dmultu} does not always produce the correct result.
15871@item
15872@code{div} and @code{ddiv} do not always produce the correct result if one
15873of the operands is negative.
15874@end itemize
15875The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in
15876@file{libgcc.a}.  At present, these functions are only provided by
15877the @code{mips64vr*-elf} configurations.
15878
15879Other VR4120 errata require a nop to be inserted between certain pairs of
15880instructions.  These errata are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.
15881
15882@item -mfix-vr4130
15883@opindex mfix-vr4130
15884Work around the VR4130 @code{mflo}/@code{mfhi} errata.  The
15885workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC,
15886although GCC will avoid using @code{mflo} and @code{mfhi} if the
15887VR4130 @code{macc}, @code{macchi}, @code{dmacc} and @code{dmacchi}
15888instructions are available instead.
15889
15890@item -mfix-sb1
15891@itemx -mno-fix-sb1
15892@opindex mfix-sb1
15893Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.
15894(This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2
15895``F1'' and ``F2'' floating-point errata.)
15896
15897@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}
15898@opindex mr10k-cache-barrier
15899Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the
15900side-effects of speculation on R10K processors.
15901
15902In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome
15903of a conditional branch and speculatively executes instructions from
15904the ``taken'' branch.  It later aborts these instructions if the
15905predicted outcome was wrong.  However, on the R10K, even aborted
15906instructions can have side effects.
15907
15908This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system,
15909kernel loads.  As an example, a speculatively-executed store may load
15910the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as dirty, even if
15911the store itself is later aborted.  If a DMA operation writes to the
15912same area of memory before the ``dirty'' line is flushed, the cached
15913data will overwrite the DMA-ed data.  See the R10K processor manual
15914for a full description, including other potential problems.
15915
15916One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before every memory
15917access that might be speculatively executed and that might have side
15918effects even if aborted.  @option{-mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}}
15919controls GCC's implementation of this workaround.  It assumes that
15920aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions will not have
15921side effects:
15922
15923@enumerate
15924@item
15925the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;
15926
15927@item
15928the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;
15929
15930@item
15931the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.
15932@end enumerate
15933
15934It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative
15935accesses to these regions are indeed safe.
15936
15937If the input program contains a function declaration such as:
15938
15939@smallexample
15940void foo (void);
15941@end smallexample
15942
15943then the implementation of @code{foo} must allow @code{j foo} and
15944@code{jal foo} to be executed speculatively.  GCC honors this
15945restriction for functions it compiles itself.  It expects non-GCC
15946functions (such as hand-written assembly code) to do the same.
15947
15948The option has three forms:
15949
15950@table @gcctabopt
15951@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
15952Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be
15953speculatively executed and that might have side effects even
15954if aborted.
15955
15956@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
15957Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be speculatively
15958executed and that might have side effects even if aborted.
15959
15960@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
15961Disable the insertion of cache barriers.  This is the default setting.
15962@end table
15963
15964@item -mflush-func=@var{func}
15965@itemx -mno-flush-func
15966@opindex mflush-func
15967Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
15968call any such function.  If called, the function must take the same
15969arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
15970memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
15971memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches).  The default
15972depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly is either
15973@samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
15974
15975@item mbranch-cost=@var{num}
15976@opindex mbranch-cost
15977Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
15978This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
15979consistent results across releases.  A zero cost redundantly selects
15980the default, which is based on the @option{-mtune} setting.
15981
15982@item -mbranch-likely
15983@itemx -mno-branch-likely
15984@opindex mbranch-likely
15985@opindex mno-branch-likely
15986Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
15987default for the selected architecture.  By default, Branch Likely
15988instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
15989architecture.  An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
15990and processors that implement those architectures; for those, Branch
15991Likely instructions will not be generated by default because the MIPS32
15992and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
15993
15994@item -mfp-exceptions
15995@itemx -mno-fp-exceptions
15996@opindex mfp-exceptions
15997Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how we schedule
15998FP instructions for some processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are
15999enabled.
16000
16001For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting
1600264-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one
16003FP pipe.
16004
16005@item -mvr4130-align
16006@itemx -mno-vr4130-align
16007@opindex mvr4130-align
16008The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
16009instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned.  When this
16010option is enabled, GCC will align pairs of instructions that it
16011thinks should execute in parallel.
16012
16013This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.
16014It normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
16015It is enabled by default at optimization level @option{-O3}.
16016
16017@item -msynci
16018@itemx -mno-synci
16019@opindex msynci
16020Enable (disable) generation of @code{synci} instructions on
16021architectures that support it.  The @code{synci} instructions (if
16022enabled) will be generated when @code{__builtin___clear_cache()} is
16023compiled.
16024
16025This option defaults to @code{-mno-synci}, but the default can be
16026overridden by configuring with @code{--with-synci}.
16027
16028When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally safe
16029to use @code{synci}.  However, on many multi-core (SMP) systems, it
16030will not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may lead
16031to undefined behavior.
16032
16033@item -mrelax-pic-calls
16034@itemx -mno-relax-pic-calls
16035@opindex mrelax-pic-calls
16036Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register
16037@code{$25} into direct calls.  This is only possible if the linker can
16038resolve the destination at link-time and if the destination is within
16039range for a direct call.
16040
16041@option{-mrelax-pic-calls} is the default if GCC was configured to use
16042an assembler and a linker that supports the @code{.reloc} assembly
16043directive and @code{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect.  With
16044@code{-mno-explicit-relocs}, this optimization can be performed by the
16045assembler and the linker alone without help from the compiler.
16046
16047@item -mmcount-ra-address
16048@itemx -mno-mcount-ra-address
16049@opindex mmcount-ra-address
16050@opindex mno-mcount-ra-address
16051Emit (do not emit) code that allows @code{_mcount} to modify the
16052calling function's return address.  When enabled, this option extends
16053the usual @code{_mcount} interface with a new @var{ra-address}
16054parameter, which has type @code{intptr_t *} and is passed in register
16055@code{$12}.  @code{_mcount} can then modify the return address by
16056doing both of the following:
16057@itemize
16058@item
16059Returning the new address in register @code{$31}.
16060@item
16061Storing the new address in @code{*@var{ra-address}},
16062if @var{ra-address} is nonnull.
16063@end itemize
16064
16065The default is @option{-mno-mcount-ra-address}.
16066
16067@end table
16068
16069@node MMIX Options
16070@subsection MMIX Options
16071@cindex MMIX Options
16072
16073These options are defined for the MMIX:
16074
16075@table @gcctabopt
16076@item -mlibfuncs
16077@itemx -mno-libfuncs
16078@opindex mlibfuncs
16079@opindex mno-libfuncs
16080Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
16081values in registers, no matter the size.
16082
16083@item -mepsilon
16084@itemx -mno-epsilon
16085@opindex mepsilon
16086@opindex mno-epsilon
16087Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
16088to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
16089
16090@item -mabi=mmixware
16091@itemx -mabi=gnu
16092@opindex mabi=mmixware
16093@opindex mabi=gnu
16094Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
16095the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
16096the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
16097
16098@item -mzero-extend
16099@itemx -mno-zero-extend
16100@opindex mzero-extend
16101@opindex mno-zero-extend
16102When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
16103use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
16104sign-extending ones.
16105
16106@item -mknuthdiv
16107@itemx -mno-knuthdiv
16108@opindex mknuthdiv
16109@opindex mno-knuthdiv
16110Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
16111the divisor.  With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
16112remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
16113arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
16114
16115@item -mtoplevel-symbols
16116@itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
16117@opindex mtoplevel-symbols
16118@opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
16119Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
16120code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
16121
16122@item -melf
16123@opindex melf
16124Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
16125@samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
16126
16127@item -mbranch-predict
16128@itemx -mno-branch-predict
16129@opindex mbranch-predict
16130@opindex mno-branch-predict
16131Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
16132prediction indicates a probable branch.
16133
16134@item -mbase-addresses
16135@itemx -mno-base-addresses
16136@opindex mbase-addresses
16137@opindex mno-base-addresses
16138Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}.  Using a
16139base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
16140and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register.  The
16141register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
16142to 255 from the value held in the register.  The generally leads to short
16143and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
16144addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses lots of static
16145data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
16146
16147@item -msingle-exit
16148@itemx -mno-single-exit
16149@opindex msingle-exit
16150@opindex mno-single-exit
16151Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
16152function.
16153@end table
16154
16155@node MN10300 Options
16156@subsection MN10300 Options
16157@cindex MN10300 options
16158
16159These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
16160
16161@table @gcctabopt
16162@item -mmult-bug
16163@opindex mmult-bug
16164Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
16165processors.  This is the default.
16166
16167@item -mno-mult-bug
16168@opindex mno-mult-bug
16169Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
16170MN10300 processors.
16171
16172@item -mam33
16173@opindex mam33
16174Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
16175
16176@item -mno-am33
16177@opindex mno-am33
16178Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.  This
16179is the default.
16180
16181@item -mam33-2
16182@opindex mam33-2
16183Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.
16184
16185@item -mam34
16186@opindex mam34
16187Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.
16188
16189@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
16190@opindex mtune
16191Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when
16192scheduling instructions.  This does not change the targeted processor
16193type.  The CPU type must be one of @samp{mn10300}, @samp{am33},
16194@samp{am33-2} or @samp{am34}.
16195
16196@item -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16197@opindex mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16198When generating a function that returns a pointer, return the pointer
16199in both @code{a0} and @code{d0}.  Otherwise, the pointer is returned
16200only in a0, and attempts to call such functions without a prototype
16201would result in errors.  Note that this option is on by default; use
16202@option{-mno-return-pointer-on-d0} to disable it.
16203
16204@item -mno-crt0
16205@opindex mno-crt0
16206Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
16207
16208@item -mrelax
16209@opindex mrelax
16210Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
16211to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses.  This option only
16212has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
16213
16214This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
16215
16216@item -mliw
16217@opindex mliw
16218Allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16219instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16220default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__LIW__}.
16221
16222@item -mnoliw
16223@opindex mnoliw
16224Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16225instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16226@samp{__NO_LIW__}.
16227
16228@item -msetlb
16229@opindex msetlb
16230Allow the compiler to generate the @emph{SETLB} and @emph{Lcc}
16231instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16232default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__SETLB__}.
16233
16234@item -mnosetlb
16235@opindex mnosetlb
16236Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{SETLB} or @emph{Lcc}
16237instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16238@samp{__NO_SETLB__}.
16239
16240@end table
16241
16242@node PDP-11 Options
16243@subsection PDP-11 Options
16244@cindex PDP-11 Options
16245
16246These options are defined for the PDP-11:
16247
16248@table @gcctabopt
16249@item -mfpu
16250@opindex mfpu
16251Use hardware FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating
16252point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
16253
16254@item -msoft-float
16255@opindex msoft-float
16256Do not use hardware floating point.
16257
16258@item -mac0
16259@opindex mac0
16260Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
16261
16262@item -mno-ac0
16263@opindex mno-ac0
16264Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.
16265
16266@item -m40
16267@opindex m40
16268Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
16269
16270@item -m45
16271@opindex m45
16272Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.
16273
16274@item -m10
16275@opindex m10
16276Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
16277
16278@item -mbcopy-builtin
16279@opindex mbcopy-builtin
16280Use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.  This is the
16281default.
16282
16283@item -mbcopy
16284@opindex mbcopy
16285Do not use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.
16286
16287@item -mint16
16288@itemx -mno-int32
16289@opindex mint16
16290@opindex mno-int32
16291Use 16-bit @code{int}.  This is the default.
16292
16293@item -mint32
16294@itemx -mno-int16
16295@opindex mint32
16296@opindex mno-int16
16297Use 32-bit @code{int}.
16298
16299@item -mfloat64
16300@itemx -mno-float32
16301@opindex mfloat64
16302@opindex mno-float32
16303Use 64-bit @code{float}.  This is the default.
16304
16305@item -mfloat32
16306@itemx -mno-float64
16307@opindex mfloat32
16308@opindex mno-float64
16309Use 32-bit @code{float}.
16310
16311@item -mabshi
16312@opindex mabshi
16313Use @code{abshi2} pattern.  This is the default.
16314
16315@item -mno-abshi
16316@opindex mno-abshi
16317Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
16318
16319@item -mbranch-expensive
16320@opindex mbranch-expensive
16321Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with
16322code generation only.
16323
16324@item -mbranch-cheap
16325@opindex mbranch-cheap
16326Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.
16327
16328@item -munix-asm
16329@opindex munix-asm
16330Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for
16331@samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16332
16333@item -mdec-asm
16334@opindex mdec-asm
16335Use DEC assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for any
16336PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16337@end table
16338
16339@node picoChip Options
16340@subsection picoChip Options
16341@cindex picoChip options
16342
16343These @samp{-m} options are defined for picoChip implementations:
16344
16345@table @gcctabopt
16346
16347@item -mae=@var{ae_type}
16348@opindex mcpu
16349Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
16350parameters for array element type @var{ae_type}.  Supported values
16351for @var{ae_type} are @samp{ANY}, @samp{MUL}, and @samp{MAC}.
16352
16353@option{-mae=ANY} selects a completely generic AE type.  Code
16354generated with this option will run on any of the other AE types.  The
16355code will not be as efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific
16356AE type, and some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) will not
16357work properly on all types of AE.
16358
16359@option{-mae=MUL} selects a MUL AE type.  This is the most useful AE type
16360for compiled code, and is the default.
16361
16362@option{-mae=MAC} selects a DSP-style MAC AE.  Code compiled with this
16363option may suffer from poor performance of byte (char) manipulation,
16364since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.
16365
16366@item -msymbol-as-address
16367Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a
16368load/store instruction, without first loading it into a
16369register.  Typically, the use of this option will generate larger
16370programs, which run faster than when the option isn't used.  However, the
16371results vary from program to program, so it is left as a user option,
16372rather than being permanently enabled.
16373
16374@item -mno-inefficient-warnings
16375Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code.  These
16376warnings can be generated, for example, when compiling code that
16377performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type.  The MAC AE has
16378no hardware support for byte-level memory operations, so all byte
16379load/stores must be synthesized from word load/store operations.  This is
16380inefficient and a warning will be generated indicating to the programmer
16381that they should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target
16382an AE type that has the necessary hardware support.  This option enables
16383the warning to be turned off.
16384
16385@end table
16386
16387@node PowerPC Options
16388@subsection PowerPC Options
16389@cindex PowerPC options
16390
16391These are listed under @xref{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}.
16392
16393@node RL78 Options
16394@subsection RL78 Options
16395@cindex RL78 Options
16396
16397@table @gcctabopt
16398
16399@item -msim
16400@opindex msim
16401Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a
16402simulator.
16403
16404@item -mmul=none
16405@itemx -mmul=g13
16406@itemx -mmul=rl78
16407@opindex mmul
16408Specifies the type of hardware multiplication support to be used.  The
16409default is @code{none}, which uses software multiplication functions.
16410The @code{g13} option is for the hardware multiply/divide peripheral
16411only on the RL78/G13 targets.  The @code{rl78} option is for the
16412standard hardware multiplication defined in the RL78 software manual.
16413
16414@end table
16415
16416@node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16417@subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16418@cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16419@cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16420
16421These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
16422@table @gcctabopt
16423@item -mpower
16424@itemx -mno-power
16425@itemx -mpower2
16426@itemx -mno-power2
16427@itemx -mpowerpc
16428@itemx -mno-powerpc
16429@itemx -mpowerpc-gpopt
16430@itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
16431@itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
16432@itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16433@need 800
16434@itemx -mpowerpc64
16435@itemx -mno-powerpc64
16436@itemx -mmfcrf
16437@itemx -mno-mfcrf
16438@itemx -mpopcntb
16439@itemx -mno-popcntb
16440@itemx -mpopcntd
16441@itemx -mno-popcntd
16442@itemx -mfprnd
16443@itemx -mno-fprnd
16444@need 800
16445@itemx -mcmpb
16446@itemx -mno-cmpb
16447@itemx -mmfpgpr
16448@itemx -mno-mfpgpr
16449@itemx -mhard-dfp
16450@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
16451@opindex mpower
16452@opindex mno-power
16453@opindex mpower2
16454@opindex mno-power2
16455@opindex mpowerpc
16456@opindex mno-powerpc
16457@opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
16458@opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
16459@opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
16460@opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16461@opindex mpowerpc64
16462@opindex mno-powerpc64
16463@opindex mmfcrf
16464@opindex mno-mfcrf
16465@opindex mpopcntb
16466@opindex mno-popcntb
16467@opindex mpopcntd
16468@opindex mno-popcntd
16469@opindex mfprnd
16470@opindex mno-fprnd
16471@opindex mcmpb
16472@opindex mno-cmpb
16473@opindex mmfpgpr
16474@opindex mno-mfpgpr
16475@opindex mhard-dfp
16476@opindex mno-hard-dfp
16477GCC supports two related instruction set architectures for the
16478RS/6000 and PowerPC@.  The @dfn{POWER} instruction set are those
16479instructions supported by the @samp{rios} chip set used in the original
16480RS/6000 systems and the @dfn{PowerPC} instruction set is the
16481architecture of the Freescale MPC5xx, MPC6xx, MPC8xx microprocessors, and
16482the IBM 4xx, 6xx, and follow-on microprocessors.
16483
16484Neither architecture is a subset of the other.  However there is a
16485large common subset of instructions supported by both.  An MQ
16486register is included in processors supporting the POWER architecture.
16487
16488You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
16489processor you are using.  The default value of these options is
16490determined when configuring GCC@.  Specifying the
16491@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
16492options.  We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
16493rather than the options listed above.
16494
16495The @option{-mpower} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16496are found only in the POWER architecture and to use the MQ register.
16497Specifying @option{-mpower2} implies @option{-power} and also allows GCC
16498to generate instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but
16499not the original POWER architecture.
16500
16501The @option{-mpowerpc} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16502are found only in the 32-bit subset of the PowerPC architecture.
16503Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows
16504GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
16505General Purpose group, including floating-point square root.  Specifying
16506@option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows GCC to
16507use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
16508group, including floating-point select.
16509
16510The @option{-mmfcrf} option allows GCC to generate the move from
16511condition register field instruction implemented on the POWER4
16512processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01
16513architecture.
16514The @option{-mpopcntb} option allows GCC to generate the popcount and
16515double-precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
16516POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.02
16517architecture.
16518The @option{-mpopcntd} option allows GCC to generate the popcount
16519instruction implemented on the POWER7 processor and other processors
16520that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.
16521The @option{-mfprnd} option allows GCC to generate the FP round to
16522integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
16523processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.
16524The @option{-mcmpb} option allows GCC to generate the compare bytes
16525instruction implemented on the POWER6 processor and other processors
16526that support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.
16527The @option{-mmfpgpr} option allows GCC to generate the FP move to/from
16528general-purpose register instructions implemented on the POWER6X
16529processor and other processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05
16530architecture.
16531The @option{-mhard-dfp} option allows GCC to generate the decimal
16532floating-point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.
16533
16534The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
1653564-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
16536and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
16537@option{-mno-powerpc64}.
16538
16539If you specify both @option{-mno-power} and @option{-mno-powerpc}, GCC
16540will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16541architectures plus some special AIX common-mode calls, and will not use
16542the MQ register.  Specifying both @option{-mpower} and @option{-mpowerpc}
16543permits GCC to use any instruction from either architecture and to
16544allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.
16545
16546@item -mnew-mnemonics
16547@itemx -mold-mnemonics
16548@opindex mnew-mnemonics
16549@opindex mold-mnemonics
16550Select which mnemonics to use in the generated assembler code.  With
16551@option{-mnew-mnemonics}, GCC uses the assembler mnemonics defined for
16552the PowerPC architecture.  With @option{-mold-mnemonics} it uses the
16553assembler mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture.  Instructions
16554defined in only one architecture have only one mnemonic; GCC uses that
16555mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.
16556
16557GCC defaults to the mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in
16558use.  Specifying @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} sometimes overrides the
16559value of these option.  Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you
16560should normally not specify either @option{-mnew-mnemonics} or
16561@option{-mold-mnemonics}, but should instead accept the default.
16562
16563@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
16564@opindex mcpu
16565Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and
16566instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
16567Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{401}, @samp{403},
16568@samp{405}, @samp{405fp}, @samp{440}, @samp{440fp}, @samp{464}, @samp{464fp},
16569@samp{476}, @samp{476fp}, @samp{505}, @samp{601}, @samp{602}, @samp{603},
16570@samp{603e}, @samp{604}, @samp{604e}, @samp{620}, @samp{630}, @samp{740},
16571@samp{7400}, @samp{7450}, @samp{750}, @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823},
16572@samp{860}, @samp{970}, @samp{8540}, @samp{a2}, @samp{e300c2},
16573@samp{e300c3}, @samp{e500mc}, @samp{e500mc64}, @samp{ec603e}, @samp{G3},
16574@samp{G4}, @samp{G5}, @samp{titan}, @samp{power}, @samp{power2}, @samp{power3},
16575@samp{power4}, @samp{power5}, @samp{power5+}, @samp{power6}, @samp{power6x},
16576@samp{power7}, @samp{common}, @samp{powerpc}, @samp{powerpc64}, @samp{rios},
16577@samp{rios1}, @samp{rios2}, @samp{rsc}, and @samp{rs64}.
16578
16579@option{-mcpu=common} selects a completely generic processor.  Code
16580generated under this option will run on any POWER or PowerPC processor.
16581GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16582architectures, and will not use the MQ register.  GCC assumes a generic
16583processor model for scheduling purposes.
16584
16585@option{-mcpu=power}, @option{-mcpu=power2}, @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and
16586@option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure 32-bit
16587PowerPC (i.e., not MPC601), and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
16588types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
16589scheduling purposes.
16590
16591The other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under
16592those options will run best on that processor, and may not run at all on
16593others.
16594
16595The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable the
16596following options:
16597
16598@gccoptlist{-maltivec  -mfprnd  -mhard-float  -mmfcrf  -mmultiple @gol
16599-mnew-mnemonics  -mpopcntb -mpopcntd  -mpower  -mpower2  -mpowerpc64 @gol
16600-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mpowerpc-gfxopt  -msingle-float -mdouble-float @gol
16601-msimple-fpu -mstring  -mmulhw  -mdlmzb  -mmfpgpr -mvsx}
16602
16603The particular options set for any particular CPU will vary between
16604compiler versions, depending on what setting seems to produce optimal
16605code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual hardware's
16606capabilities.  If you wish to set an individual option to a particular
16607value, you may specify it after the @option{-mcpu} option, like
16608@samp{-mcpu=970 -mno-altivec}.
16609
16610On AIX, the @option{-maltivec} and @option{-mpowerpc64} options are
16611not enabled or disabled by the @option{-mcpu} option at present because
16612AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still
16613enable or disable them individually if you're sure it'll work in your
16614environment.
16615
16616@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
16617@opindex mtune
16618Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
16619@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type, register usage, or
16620choice of mnemonics, as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.  The same
16621values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
16622@option{-mcpu}.  If both are specified, the code generated will use the
16623architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
16624scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
16625
16626@item -mcmodel=small
16627@opindex mcmodel=small
16628Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to
1662964k.
16630
16631@item -mcmodel=medium
16632@opindex mcmodel=medium
16633Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static
16634data may be up to a total of 4G in size.
16635
16636@item -mcmodel=large
16637@opindex mcmodel=large
16638Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G
16639in size.  Other data and code is only limited by the 64-bit address
16640space.
16641
16642@item -maltivec
16643@itemx -mno-altivec
16644@opindex maltivec
16645@opindex mno-altivec
16646Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and also
16647enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
16648the AltiVec instruction set.  You may also need to set
16649@option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
16650enhancements.
16651
16652@item -mvrsave
16653@itemx -mno-vrsave
16654@opindex mvrsave
16655@opindex mno-vrsave
16656Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
16657
16658@item -mgen-cell-microcode
16659@opindex mgen-cell-microcode
16660Generate Cell microcode instructions
16661
16662@item -mwarn-cell-microcode
16663@opindex mwarn-cell-microcode
16664Warning when a Cell microcode instruction is going to emitted.  An example
16665of a Cell microcode instruction is a variable shift.
16666
16667@item -msecure-plt
16668@opindex msecure-plt
16669Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared
16670libraries with non-exec .plt and .got sections.  This is a PowerPC
1667132-bit SYSV ABI option.
16672
16673@item -mbss-plt
16674@opindex mbss-plt
16675Generate code that uses a BSS .plt section that ld.so fills in, and
16676requires .plt and .got sections that are both writable and executable.
16677This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
16678
16679@item -misel
16680@itemx -mno-isel
16681@opindex misel
16682@opindex mno-isel
16683This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
16684
16685@item -misel=@var{yes/no}
16686This switch has been deprecated.  Use @option{-misel} and
16687@option{-mno-isel} instead.
16688
16689@item -mspe
16690@itemx -mno-spe
16691@opindex mspe
16692@opindex mno-spe
16693This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd
16694instructions.
16695
16696@item -mpaired
16697@itemx -mno-paired
16698@opindex mpaired
16699@opindex mno-paired
16700This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd
16701instructions.
16702
16703@item -mspe=@var{yes/no}
16704This option has been deprecated.  Use @option{-mspe} and
16705@option{-mno-spe} instead.
16706
16707@item -mvsx
16708@itemx -mno-vsx
16709@opindex mvsx
16710@opindex mno-vsx
16711Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX)
16712instructions, and also enable the use of built-in functions that allow
16713more direct access to the VSX instruction set.
16714
16715@item -mfloat-gprs=@var{yes/single/double/no}
16716@itemx -mfloat-gprs
16717@opindex mfloat-gprs
16718This switch enables or disables the generation of floating-point
16719operations on the general-purpose registers for architectures that
16720support it.
16721
16722The argument @var{yes} or @var{single} enables the use of
16723single-precision floating-point operations.
16724
16725The argument @var{double} enables the use of single and
16726double-precision floating-point operations.
16727
16728The argument @var{no} disables floating-point operations on the
16729general-purpose registers.
16730
16731This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.
16732
16733@item -m32
16734@itemx -m64
16735@opindex m32
16736@opindex m64
16737Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
16738targets (including GNU/Linux).  The 32-bit environment sets int, long
16739and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any PowerPC
16740variant.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and
16741pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as for
16742@option{-mpowerpc64}.
16743
16744@item -mfull-toc
16745@itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
16746@itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
16747@itemx -mminimal-toc
16748@opindex mfull-toc
16749@opindex mno-fp-in-toc
16750@opindex mno-sum-in-toc
16751@opindex mminimal-toc
16752Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
16753every executable file.  The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
16754default.  In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
16755each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program.  GCC
16756will also place floating-point constants in the TOC@.  However, only
1675716,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
16758
16759If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
16760the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
16761with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
16762@option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
16763constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
16764generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
16765run time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@.  You may specify one
16766or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
16767slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
16768
16769If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
16770these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead.  This option causes
16771GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you specify this
16772option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which
16773uses extremely little TOC space.  You may wish to use this option
16774only on files that contain less frequently executed code.
16775
16776@item -maix64
16777@itemx -maix32
16778@opindex maix64
16779@opindex maix32
16780Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
16781@code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
16782Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64} and
16783@option{-mpowerpc}, while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
16784implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}.  GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
16785
16786@item -mxl-compat
16787@itemx -mno-xl-compat
16788@opindex mxl-compat
16789@opindex mno-xl-compat
16790Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics
16791when using AIX-compatible ABI@.  Pass floating-point arguments to
16792prototyped functions beyond the register save area (RSA) on the stack
16793in addition to argument FPRs.  Do not assume that most significant
16794double in 128-bit long double value is properly rounded when comparing
16795values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names for long double
16796support routines.
16797
16798The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
16799handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
16800address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.  IBM XL
16801compilers access floating-point arguments that do not fit in the
16802RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
16803optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
16804stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
16805default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by IBM
16806XL compilers without optimization.
16807
16808@item -mpe
16809@opindex mpe
16810Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@.  Link an
16811application written to use message passing with special startup code to
16812enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
16813standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
16814must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
16815appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not
16816support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
16817option are incompatible.
16818
16819@item -malign-natural
16820@itemx -malign-power
16821@opindex malign-natural
16822@opindex malign-power
16823On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
16824@option{-malign-natural} overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
16825types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based boundary.
16826The option @option{-malign-power} instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified
16827alignment rules.  GCC defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI@.
16828
16829On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and @option{-malign-power}
16830is not supported.
16831
16832@item -msoft-float
16833@itemx -mhard-float
16834@opindex msoft-float
16835@opindex mhard-float
16836Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
16837Software floating-point emulation is provided if you use the
16838@option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
16839
16840@item -msingle-float
16841@itemx -mdouble-float
16842@opindex msingle-float
16843@opindex mdouble-float
16844Generate code for single- or double-precision floating-point operations.
16845@option{-mdouble-float} implies @option{-msingle-float}.
16846
16847@item -msimple-fpu
16848@opindex msimple-fpu
16849Do not generate sqrt and div instructions for hardware floating-point unit.
16850
16851@item -mfpu
16852@opindex mfpu
16853Specify type of floating-point unit.  Valid values are @var{sp_lite}
16854(equivalent to -msingle-float -msimple-fpu), @var{dp_lite} (equivalent
16855to -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu), @var{sp_full} (equivalent to -msingle-float),
16856and @var{dp_full} (equivalent to -mdouble-float).
16857
16858@item -mxilinx-fpu
16859@opindex mxilinx-fpu
16860Perform optimizations for the floating-point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.
16861
16862@item -mmultiple
16863@itemx -mno-multiple
16864@opindex mmultiple
16865@opindex mno-multiple
16866Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
16867instructions and the store multiple word instructions.  These
16868instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
16869generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little-endian
16870PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
16871processor is in little-endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and
16872PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.
16873
16874@item -mstring
16875@itemx -mno-string
16876@opindex mstring
16877@opindex mno-string
16878Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
16879and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
16880do small block moves.  These instructions are generated by default on
16881POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use
16882@option{-mstring} on little-endian PowerPC systems, since those
16883instructions do not work when the processor is in little-endian mode.
16884The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit these instructions
16885in little-endian mode.
16886
16887@item -mupdate
16888@itemx -mno-update
16889@opindex mupdate
16890@opindex mno-update
16891Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
16892that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
16893location.  These instructions are generated by default.  If you use
16894@option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
16895stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
16896stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
16897signals may get corrupted data.
16898
16899@item -mavoid-indexed-addresses
16900@itemx -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16901@opindex mavoid-indexed-addresses
16902@opindex mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16903Generate code that tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load
16904or store instructions. These instructions can incur a performance
16905penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
16906stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary.  This option
16907is enabled by default when targetting Power6 and disabled otherwise.
16908
16909@item -mfused-madd
16910@itemx -mno-fused-madd
16911@opindex mfused-madd
16912@opindex mno-fused-madd
16913Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
16914accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default
16915if hardware floating point is used.  The machine-dependent
16916@option{-mfused-madd} option is now mapped to the machine-independent
16917@option{-ffp-contract=fast} option, and @option{-mno-fused-madd} is
16918mapped to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
16919
16920@item -mmulhw
16921@itemx -mno-mulhw
16922@opindex mmulhw
16923@opindex mno-mulhw
16924Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
16925multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.
16926These instructions are generated by default when targetting those
16927processors.
16928
16929@item -mdlmzb
16930@itemx -mno-dlmzb
16931@opindex mdlmzb
16932@opindex mno-dlmzb
16933Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search @samp{dlmzb}
16934instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.  This instruction is
16935generated by default when targetting those processors.
16936
16937@item -mno-bit-align
16938@itemx -mbit-align
16939@opindex mno-bit-align
16940@opindex mbit-align
16941On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
16942and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
16943bit-field.
16944
16945For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
16946@code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 is aligned to a 4-byte
16947boundary and has a size of 4 bytes.  By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
16948the structure is aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in
16949size.
16950
16951@item -mno-strict-align
16952@itemx -mstrict-align
16953@opindex mno-strict-align
16954@opindex mstrict-align
16955On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
16956unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
16957
16958@item -mrelocatable
16959@itemx -mno-relocatable
16960@opindex mrelocatable
16961@opindex mno-relocatable
16962Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be
16963relocated to a different address at run time.  A simple embedded
16964PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of
16965@code{.got2} and 4-byte locations listed in the @code{.fixup} section,
16966a table of 32-bit addresses generated by this option.  For this to
16967work, all objects linked together must be compiled with
16968@option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
16969@option{-mrelocatable} code aligns the stack to an 8-byte boundary.
16970
16971@item -mrelocatable-lib
16972@itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
16973@opindex mrelocatable-lib
16974@opindex mno-relocatable-lib
16975Like @option{-mrelocatable}, @option{-mrelocatable-lib} generates a
16976@code{.fixup} section to allow static executables to be relocated at
16977run time, but @option{-mrelocatable-lib} does not use the smaller stack
16978alignment of @option{-mrelocatable}.  Objects compiled with
16979@option{-mrelocatable-lib} may be linked with objects compiled with
16980any combination of the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
16981
16982@item -mno-toc
16983@itemx -mtoc
16984@opindex mno-toc
16985@opindex mtoc
16986On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
16987register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
16988used in the program.
16989
16990@item -mlittle
16991@itemx -mlittle-endian
16992@opindex mlittle
16993@opindex mlittle-endian
16994On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
16995processor in little-endian mode.  The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
16996the same as @option{-mlittle}.
16997
16998@item -mbig
16999@itemx -mbig-endian
17000@opindex mbig
17001@opindex mbig-endian
17002On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17003processor in big-endian mode.  The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
17004the same as @option{-mbig}.
17005
17006@item -mdynamic-no-pic
17007@opindex mdynamic-no-pic
17008On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
17009relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable.  The
17010resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
17011libraries.
17012
17013@item -msingle-pic-base
17014@opindex msingle-pic-base
17015Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
17016loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
17017responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
17018before execution begins.
17019
17020@item -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority}
17021@opindex mprioritize-restricted-insns
17022This option controls the priority that is assigned to
17023dispatch-slot restricted instructions during the second scheduling
17024pass.  The argument @var{priority} takes the value @var{0/1/2} to assign
17025@var{no/highest/second-highest} priority to dispatch slot restricted
17026instructions.
17027
17028@item -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type}
17029@opindex msched-costly-dep
17030This option controls which dependences are considered costly
17031by the target during instruction scheduling.  The argument
17032@var{dependence_type} takes one of the following values:
17033@var{no}: no dependence is costly,
17034@var{all}: all dependences are costly,
17035@var{true_store_to_load}: a true dependence from store to load is costly,
17036@var{store_to_load}: any dependence from store to load is costly,
17037@var{number}: any dependence for which latency >= @var{number} is costly.
17038
17039@item -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme}
17040@opindex minsert-sched-nops
17041This option controls which nop insertion scheme will be used during
17042the second scheduling pass.  The argument @var{scheme} takes one of the
17043following values:
17044@var{no}: Don't insert nops.
17045@var{pad}: Pad with nops any dispatch group that has vacant issue slots,
17046according to the scheduler's grouping.
17047@var{regroup_exact}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17048separate groups.  Insert exactly as many nops as needed to force an insn
17049to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
17050@var{number}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17051separate groups.  Insert @var{number} nops to force an insn to a new group.
17052
17053@item -mcall-sysv
17054@opindex mcall-sysv
17055On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
17056conventions that adheres to the March 1995 draft of the System V
17057Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is the
17058default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
17059
17060@item -mcall-sysv-eabi
17061@itemx -mcall-eabi
17062@opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
17063@opindex mcall-eabi
17064Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
17065
17066@item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
17067@opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
17068Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
17069
17070@item -mcall-aixdesc
17071@opindex m
17072On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX
17073operating system.
17074
17075@item -mcall-linux
17076@opindex mcall-linux
17077On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17078Linux-based GNU system.
17079
17080@item -mcall-freebsd
17081@opindex mcall-freebsd
17082On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17083FreeBSD operating system.
17084
17085@item -mcall-netbsd
17086@opindex mcall-netbsd
17087On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17088NetBSD operating system.
17089
17090@item -mcall-openbsd
17091@opindex mcall-netbsd
17092On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17093OpenBSD operating system.
17094
17095@item -maix-struct-return
17096@opindex maix-struct-return
17097Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
17098
17099@item -msvr4-struct-return
17100@opindex msvr4-struct-return
17101Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
17102SVR4 ABI)@.
17103
17104@item -mabi=@var{abi-type}
17105@opindex mabi
17106Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such extension.
17107Valid values are @var{altivec}, @var{no-altivec}, @var{spe},
17108@var{no-spe}, @var{ibmlongdouble}, @var{ieeelongdouble}@.
17109
17110@item -mabi=spe
17111@opindex mabi=spe
17112Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change
17113the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
17114ABI@.
17115
17116@item -mabi=no-spe
17117@opindex mabi=no-spe
17118Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI@.
17119
17120@item -mabi=ibmlongdouble
17121@opindex mabi=ibmlongdouble
17122Change the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.
17123This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
17124
17125@item -mabi=ieeelongdouble
17126@opindex mabi=ieeelongdouble
17127Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.
17128This is a PowerPC 32-bit Linux ABI option.
17129
17130@item -mprototype
17131@itemx -mno-prototype
17132@opindex mprototype
17133@opindex mno-prototype
17134On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
17135variable argument functions are properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the
17136compiler must insert an instruction before every non prototyped call to
17137set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
17138indicate whether floating-point values were passed in the floating-point
17139registers in case the function takes variable arguments.  With
17140@option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
17141will set or clear the bit.
17142
17143@item -msim
17144@opindex msim
17145On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17146@file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
17147@file{libc.a}.  This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}
17148configurations.
17149
17150@item -mmvme
17151@opindex mmvme
17152On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17153@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
17154@file{libc.a}.
17155
17156@item -mads
17157@opindex mads
17158On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17159@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
17160@file{libc.a}.
17161
17162@item -myellowknife
17163@opindex myellowknife
17164On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17165@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
17166@file{libc.a}.
17167
17168@item -mvxworks
17169@opindex mvxworks
17170On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
17171compiling for a VxWorks system.
17172
17173@item -memb
17174@opindex memb
17175On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
17176header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
17177
17178@item -meabi
17179@itemx -mno-eabi
17180@opindex meabi
17181@opindex mno-eabi
17182On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
17183Embedded Applications Binary Interface (eabi) which is a set of
17184modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting @option{-meabi}
17185means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a function
17186@code{__eabi} is called to from @code{main} to set up the eabi
17187environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
17188@code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas.  Selecting
17189@option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16-byte boundary,
17190do not call an initialization function from @code{main}, and the
17191@option{-msdata} option will only use @code{r13} to point to a single
17192small data area.  The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
17193configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
17194
17195@item -msdata=eabi
17196@opindex msdata=eabi
17197On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
17198@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
17199is pointed to by register @code{r2}.  Put small initialized
17200non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
17201which is pointed to by register @code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized
17202global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
17203the @samp{.sdata} section.  The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
17204incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option.  The
17205@option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
17206
17207@item -msdata=sysv
17208@opindex msdata=sysv
17209On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
17210data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
17211@code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
17212@samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
17213The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
17214@option{-mrelocatable} option.
17215
17216@item -msdata=default
17217@itemx -msdata
17218@opindex msdata=default
17219@opindex msdata
17220On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
17221compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
17222same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
17223
17224@item -msdata=data
17225@opindex msdata=data
17226On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global
17227data in the @samp{.sdata} section.  Put small uninitialized global
17228data in the @samp{.sbss} section.  Do not use register @code{r13}
17229to address small data however.  This is the default behavior unless
17230other @option{-msdata} options are used.
17231
17232@item -msdata=none
17233@itemx -mno-sdata
17234@opindex msdata=none
17235@opindex mno-sdata
17236On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
17237in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
17238@samp{.bss} section.
17239
17240@item -mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num}
17241@opindex mblock-move-inline-limit
17242Inline all block moves (such as calls to @code{memcpy} or structure
17243copies) less than or equal to @var{num} bytes.  The minimum value for
17244@var{num} is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit
17245targets.  The default value is target-specific.
17246
17247@item -G @var{num}
17248@opindex G
17249@cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
17250@cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
17251On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
17252equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or bss sections instead of
17253the normal data or bss section.  By default, @var{num} is 8.  The
17254@option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
17255All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
17256
17257@item -mregnames
17258@itemx -mno-regnames
17259@opindex mregnames
17260@opindex mno-regnames
17261On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
17262names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
17263
17264@item -mlongcall
17265@itemx -mno-longcall
17266@opindex mlongcall
17267@opindex mno-longcall
17268By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer more
17269expensive calling sequence is required.  This is required for calls
17270further than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current location.
17271A short call will be generated if the compiler knows
17272the call cannot be that far away.  This setting can be overridden by
17273the @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma
17274longcall(0)}.
17275
17276Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
17277glue code on the fly.  On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
17278generate slower code.  As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
17279as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature
17280to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
17281
17282On Darwin/PPC systems, @code{#pragma longcall} will generate ``jbsr
17283callee, L42'', plus a ``branch island'' (glue code).  The two target
17284addresses represent the callee and the ``branch island''.  The
17285Darwin/PPC linker will prefer the first address and generate a ``bl
17286callee'' if the PPC ``bl'' instruction will reach the callee directly;
17287otherwise, the linker will generate ``bl L42'' to call the ``branch
17288island''.  The ``branch island'' is appended to the body of the
17289calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the callee
17290and jumps to it.
17291
17292On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to
17293the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides whether
17294to use or discard it.
17295
17296In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications
17297when the linker is known to generate glue.
17298
17299@item -mtls-markers
17300@itemx -mno-tls-markers
17301@opindex mtls-markers
17302@opindex mno-tls-markers
17303Mark (do not mark) calls to @code{__tls_get_addr} with a relocation
17304specifying the function argument.  The relocation allows ld to
17305reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for
17306TLS optimization, which in turn allows gcc to better schedule the
17307sequence.
17308
17309@item -pthread
17310@opindex pthread
17311Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
17312This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
17313
17314@item -mrecip
17315@itemx -mno-recip
17316@opindex mrecip
17317This option will enable GCC to use the reciprocal estimate and
17318reciprocal square root estimate instructions with additional
17319Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or
17320square root and divide for floating-point arguments.  You should use
17321the @option{-ffast-math} option when using @option{-mrecip} (or at
17322least @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
17323@option{-finite-math-only}, @option{-freciprocal-math} and
17324@option{-fno-trapping-math}).  Note that while the throughput of the
17325sequence is generally higher than the throughput of the non-reciprocal
17326instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to 2
17327ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square
17328roots.
17329
17330@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
17331@opindex mrecip=opt
17332This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
17333may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
17334be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
17335@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
17336@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
17337@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip};
17338@code{div}: enable the reciprocal approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17339@code{divf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17340@code{divd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17341@code{rsqrt}: enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17342@code{rsqrtf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17343@code{rsqrtd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17344
17345So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!rsqrtd} would enable the
17346all of the reciprocal estimate instructions, except for the
17347@code{FRSQRTE}, @code{XSRSQRTEDP}, and @code{XVRSQRTEDP} instructions
17348which handle the double-precision reciprocal square root calculations.
17349
17350@item -mrecip-precision
17351@itemx -mno-recip-precision
17352@opindex mrecip-precision
17353Assume (do not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions
17354provide higher-precision estimates than is mandated by the PowerPC
17355ABI.  Selecting @option{-mcpu=power6} or @option{-mcpu=power7}
17356automatically selects @option{-mrecip-precision}.  The double-precision
17357square root estimate instructions are not generated by
17358default on low-precision machines, since they do not provide an
17359estimate that converges after three steps.
17360
17361@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
17362@opindex mveclibabi
17363Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
17364external library.  The only type supported at present is @code{mass},
17365which specifies to use IBM's Mathematical Acceleration Subsystem
17366(MASS) libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.
17367GCC will currently emit calls to @code{acosd2}, @code{acosf4},
17368@code{acoshd2}, @code{acoshf4}, @code{asind2}, @code{asinf4},
17369@code{asinhd2}, @code{asinhf4}, @code{atan2d2}, @code{atan2f4},
17370@code{atand2}, @code{atanf4}, @code{atanhd2}, @code{atanhf4},
17371@code{cbrtd2}, @code{cbrtf4}, @code{cosd2}, @code{cosf4},
17372@code{coshd2}, @code{coshf4}, @code{erfcd2}, @code{erfcf4},
17373@code{erfd2}, @code{erff4}, @code{exp2d2}, @code{exp2f4},
17374@code{expd2}, @code{expf4}, @code{expm1d2}, @code{expm1f4},
17375@code{hypotd2}, @code{hypotf4}, @code{lgammad2}, @code{lgammaf4},
17376@code{log10d2}, @code{log10f4}, @code{log1pd2}, @code{log1pf4},
17377@code{log2d2}, @code{log2f4}, @code{logd2}, @code{logf4},
17378@code{powd2}, @code{powf4}, @code{sind2}, @code{sinf4}, @code{sinhd2},
17379@code{sinhf4}, @code{sqrtd2}, @code{sqrtf4}, @code{tand2},
17380@code{tanf4}, @code{tanhd2}, and @code{tanhf4} when generating code
17381for power7.  Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
17382@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled.  The MASS
17383libraries will have to be specified at link time.
17384
17385@item -mfriz
17386@itemx -mno-friz
17387@opindex mfriz
17388Generate (do not generate) the @code{friz} instruction when the
17389@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} option is used to optimize
17390rounding of floating-point values to 64-bit integer and back to floating
17391point.  The @code{friz} instruction does not return the same value if
17392the floating-point number is too large to fit in an integer.
17393
17394@item -mpointers-to-nested-functions
17395@itemx -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
17396@opindex mpointers-to-nested-functions
17397Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain register
17398(@var{r11}) when calling through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux
17399systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word descriptor giving
17400the function address, TOC value to be loaded in register @var{r2}, and
17401static chain value to be loaded in register @var{r11}.  The
17402@option{-mpointers-to-nested-functions} is on by default.  You will
17403not be able to call through pointers to nested functions or pointers
17404to functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
17405you use the @option{-mno-pointers-to-nested-functions}.
17406
17407@item -msave-toc-indirect
17408@itemx -mno-save-toc-indirect
17409@opindex msave-toc-indirect
17410Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the reserved
17411stack location in the function prologue if the function calls through
17412a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems.  If the TOC value is not
17413saved in the prologue, it is saved just before the call through the
17414pointer.  The @option{-mno-save-toc-indirect} option is the default.
17415@end table
17416
17417@node RX Options
17418@subsection RX Options
17419@cindex RX Options
17420
17421These command-line options are defined for RX targets:
17422
17423@table @gcctabopt
17424@item -m64bit-doubles
17425@itemx -m32bit-doubles
17426@opindex m64bit-doubles
17427@opindex m32bit-doubles
17428Make the @code{double} data type be 64 bits (@option{-m64bit-doubles})
17429or 32 bits (@option{-m32bit-doubles}) in size.  The default is
17430@option{-m32bit-doubles}.  @emph{Note} RX floating-point hardware only
17431works on 32-bit values, which is why the default is
17432@option{-m32bit-doubles}.
17433
17434@item -fpu
17435@itemx -nofpu
17436@opindex fpu
17437@opindex nofpu
17438Enables (@option{-fpu}) or disables (@option{-nofpu}) the use of RX
17439floating-point hardware.  The default is enabled for the @var{RX600}
17440series and disabled for the @var{RX200} series.
17441
17442Floating-point instructions will only be generated for 32-bit floating-point
17443values however, so if the @option{-m64bit-doubles} option is in
17444use then the FPU hardware will not be used for doubles.
17445
17446@emph{Note} If the @option{-fpu} option is enabled then
17447@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also enabled automatically.
17448This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.
17449
17450@item -mcpu=@var{name}
17451@opindex -mcpu
17452Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted.  Currently three types are
17453supported, the generic @var{RX600} and @var{RX200} series hardware and
17454the specific @var{RX610} CPU.  The default is @var{RX600}.
17455
17456The only difference between @var{RX600} and @var{RX610} is that the
17457@var{RX610} does not support the @code{MVTIPL} instruction.
17458
17459The @var{RX200} series does not have a hardware floating-point unit
17460and so @option{-nofpu} is enabled by default when this type is
17461selected.
17462
17463@item -mbig-endian-data
17464@itemx -mlittle-endian-data
17465@opindex mbig-endian-data
17466@opindex mlittle-endian-data
17467Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format.  The default is
17468@option{-mlittle-endian-data}, i.e.@: to store data in the little-endian
17469format.
17470
17471@item -msmall-data-limit=@var{N}
17472@opindex msmall-data-limit
17473Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables
17474which can be placed into the small data area.  Using the small data
17475area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
17476limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does
17477not overflow.  Also when the small data area is used one of the RX's
17478registers (usually @code{r13}) is reserved for use pointing to this
17479area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler.  This
17480could result in slower and/or larger code if variables which once
17481could have been held in the reserved register are now pushed onto the
17482stack.
17483
17484Note, common variables (variables that have not been initialized) and
17485constants are not placed into the small data area as they are assigned
17486to other sections in the output executable.
17487
17488The default value is zero, which disables this feature.  Note, this
17489feature is not enabled by default with higher optimization levels
17490(@option{-O2} etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of
17491reserving a register.  It is up to the programmer to experiment and
17492discover whether this feature is of benefit to their program.  See the
17493description of the @option{-mpid} option for a description of how the
17494actual register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.
17495
17496@item -msim
17497@itemx -mno-sim
17498@opindex msim
17499@opindex mno-sim
17500Use the simulator runtime.  The default is to use the libgloss board
17501specific runtime.
17502
17503@item -mas100-syntax
17504@itemx -mno-as100-syntax
17505@opindex mas100-syntax
17506@opindex mno-as100-syntax
17507When generating assembler output use a syntax that is compatible with
17508Renesas's AS100 assembler.  This syntax can also be handled by the GAS
17509assembler but it has some restrictions so generating it is not the
17510default option.
17511
17512@item -mmax-constant-size=@var{N}
17513@opindex mmax-constant-size
17514Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a constant that can be used as
17515an operand in a RX instruction.  Although the RX instruction set does
17516allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to be used in instructions,
17517a longer value equates to a longer instruction.  Thus in some
17518circumstances it can be beneficial to restrict the size of constants
17519that are used in instructions.  Constants that are too big are instead
17520placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.
17521
17522The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 0 (the default)
17523or 4 means that constants of any size are allowed.
17524
17525@item -mrelax
17526@opindex mrelax
17527Enable linker relaxation.  Linker relaxation is a process whereby the
17528linker will attempt to reduce the size of a program by finding shorter
17529versions of various instructions.  Disabled by default.
17530
17531@item -mint-register=@var{N}
17532@opindex mint-register
17533Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler
17534functions.  The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 1
17535means that register @code{r13} will be reserved for the exclusive use
17536of fast interrupt handlers.  A value of 2 reserves @code{r13} and
17537@code{r12}.  A value of 3 reserves @code{r13}, @code{r12} and
17538@code{r11}, and a value of 4 reserves @code{r13} through @code{r10}.
17539A value of 0, the default, does not reserve any registers.
17540
17541@item -msave-acc-in-interrupts
17542@opindex msave-acc-in-interrupts
17543Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the
17544accumulator register.  This is only necessary if normal code might use
17545the accumulator register, for example because it performs 64-bit
17546multiplications.  The default is to ignore the accumulator as this
17547makes the interrupt handlers faster.
17548
17549@item -mpid
17550@itemx -mno-pid
17551@opindex mpid
17552@opindex mno-pid
17553Enables the generation of position independent data.  When enabled any
17554access to constant data will done via an offset from a base address
17555held in a register.  This allows the location of constant data to be
17556determined at run time without requiring the executable to be
17557relocated, which is a benefit to embedded applications with tight
17558memory constraints.  Data that can be modified is not affected by this
17559option.
17560
17561Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually @code{r13}, for
17562the constant data base address.  This can result in slower and/or
17563larger code, especially in complicated functions.
17564
17565The actual register chosen to hold the constant data base address
17566depends upon whether the @option{-msmall-data-limit} and/or the
17567@option{-mint-register} command-line options are enabled.  Starting
17568with register @code{r13} and proceeding downwards, registers are
17569allocated first to satisfy the requirements of @option{-mint-register},
17570then @option{-mpid} and finally @option{-msmall-data-limit}.  Thus it
17571is possible for the small data area register to be @code{r8} if both
17572@option{-mint-register=4} and @option{-mpid} are specified on the
17573command line.
17574
17575By default this feature is not enabled.  The default can be restored
17576via the @option{-mno-pid} command-line option.
17577
17578@end table
17579
17580@emph{Note:} The generic GCC command-line option @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}
17581has special significance to the RX port when used with the
17582@code{interrupt} function attribute.  This attribute indicates a
17583function intended to process fast interrupts.  GCC will will ensure
17584that it only uses the registers @code{r10}, @code{r11}, @code{r12}
17585and/or @code{r13} and only provided that the normal use of the
17586corresponding registers have been restricted via the
17587@option{-ffixed-@var{reg}} or @option{-mint-register} command-line
17588options.
17589
17590@node S/390 and zSeries Options
17591@subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
17592@cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
17593
17594These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
17595
17596@table @gcctabopt
17597@item -mhard-float
17598@itemx -msoft-float
17599@opindex mhard-float
17600@opindex msoft-float
17601Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
17602for floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
17603functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
17604operations.  When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
17605generates IEEE floating-point instructions.  This is the default.
17606
17607@item -mhard-dfp
17608@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
17609@opindex mhard-dfp
17610@opindex mno-hard-dfp
17611Use (do not use) the hardware decimal-floating-point instructions for
17612decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mno-hard-dfp} is
17613specified, functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform
17614decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mhard-dfp} is
17615specified, the compiler generates decimal-floating-point hardware
17616instructions.  This is the default for @option{-march=z9-ec} or higher.
17617
17618@item -mlong-double-64
17619@itemx -mlong-double-128
17620@opindex mlong-double-64
17621@opindex mlong-double-128
17622These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
17623of 64 bits makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
17624type. This is the default.
17625
17626@item -mbackchain
17627@itemx -mno-backchain
17628@opindex mbackchain
17629@opindex mno-backchain
17630Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer
17631into the callee's stack frame.
17632A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand
17633DWARF-2 call frame information.
17634When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is in effect, the backchain pointer is stored
17635at the bottom of the stack frame; when @option{-mpacked-stack} is in effect,
17636the backchain is placed into the topmost word of the 96/160 byte register
17637save area.
17638
17639In general, code compiled with @option{-mbackchain} is call-compatible with
17640code compiled with @option{-mmo-backchain}; however, use of the backchain
17641for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is built with
17642@option{-mbackchain}.  Note that the combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17643@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17644to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17645
17646The default is to not maintain the backchain.
17647
17648@item -mpacked-stack
17649@itemx -mno-packed-stack
17650@opindex mpacked-stack
17651@opindex mno-packed-stack
17652Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is
17653specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte register save
17654area only for their default purpose; unused fields still take up stack space.
17655When @option{-mpacked-stack} is specified, register save slots are densely
17656packed at the top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other
17657purposes, allowing for more efficient use of the available stack space.
17658However, when @option{-mbackchain} is also in effect, the topmost word of
17659the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address
17660register is always saved two words below the backchain.
17661
17662As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated with
17663@option{-mpacked-stack} is call-compatible with code generated with
17664@option{-mno-packed-stack}.  Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
17665S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run
17666time, not just for debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible
17667with code compiled with @option{-mpacked-stack}.  Also, note that the
17668combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17669@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17670to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17671
17672The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
17673
17674@item -msmall-exec
17675@itemx -mno-small-exec
17676@opindex msmall-exec
17677@opindex mno-small-exec
17678Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
17679to do subroutine calls.
17680This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
17681exceed 64k.  The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
17682which does not have this limitation.
17683
17684@item -m64
17685@itemx -m31
17686@opindex m64
17687@opindex m31
17688When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
17689GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI@.  When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
17690code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI@.  This allows GCC in
17691particular to generate 64-bit instructions.  For the @samp{s390}
17692targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
17693targets default to @option{-m64}.
17694
17695@item -mzarch
17696@itemx -mesa
17697@opindex mzarch
17698@opindex mesa
17699When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
17700instructions available on z/Architecture.
17701When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
17702instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that @option{-mesa} is
17703not possible with @option{-m64}.
17704When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,
17705the default is @option{-mesa}.  When generating code compliant
17706to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is @option{-mzarch}.
17707
17708@item -mmvcle
17709@itemx -mno-mvcle
17710@opindex mmvcle
17711@opindex mno-mvcle
17712Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
17713to perform block moves.  When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
17714use a @code{mvc} loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for
17715size.
17716
17717@item -mdebug
17718@itemx -mno-debug
17719@opindex mdebug
17720@opindex mno-debug
17721Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
17722The default is to not print debug information.
17723
17724@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
17725@opindex march
17726Generate code that will run on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
17727representing a certain processor type.  Possible values for
17728@var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6}, @samp{z900}, @samp{z990},
17729@samp{z9-109}, @samp{z9-ec} and @samp{z10}.
17730When generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture,
17731the default is @option{-march=z900}.  Otherwise, the default is
17732@option{-march=g5}.
17733
17734@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
17735@opindex mtune
17736Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
17737except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
17738The list of @var{cpu-type} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
17739The default is the value used for @option{-march}.
17740
17741@item -mtpf-trace
17742@itemx -mno-tpf-trace
17743@opindex mtpf-trace
17744@opindex mno-tpf-trace
17745Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace
17746routines in the operating system.  This option is off by default, even
17747when compiling for the TPF OS@.
17748
17749@item -mfused-madd
17750@itemx -mno-fused-madd
17751@opindex mfused-madd
17752@opindex mno-fused-madd
17753Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
17754accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default if
17755hardware floating point is used.
17756
17757@item -mwarn-framesize=@var{framesize}
17758@opindex mwarn-framesize
17759Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because
17760this is a compile-time check it doesn't need to be a real problem when the program
17761runs.  It is intended to identify functions that most probably cause
17762a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with limited stack
17763size e.g.@: the linux kernel.
17764
17765@item -mwarn-dynamicstack
17766@opindex mwarn-dynamicstack
17767Emit a warning if the function calls alloca or uses dynamically
17768sized arrays.  This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack size.
17769
17770@item -mstack-guard=@var{stack-guard}
17771@itemx -mstack-size=@var{stack-size}
17772@opindex mstack-guard
17773@opindex mstack-size
17774If these options are provided the s390 back end emits additional instructions in
17775the function prologue which trigger a trap if the stack size is @var{stack-guard}
17776bytes above the @var{stack-size} (remember that the stack on s390 grows downward).
17777If the @var{stack-guard} option is omitted the smallest power of 2 larger than
17778the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.
17779These options are intended to be used to help debugging stack overflow problems.
17780The additionally emitted code causes only little overhead and hence can also be
17781used in production like systems without greater performance degradation.  The given
17782values have to be exact powers of 2 and @var{stack-size} has to be greater than
17783@var{stack-guard} without exceeding 64k.
17784In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
17785at an address aligned to the value given by @var{stack-size}.
17786The @var{stack-guard} option can only be used in conjunction with @var{stack-size}.
17787@end table
17788
17789@node Score Options
17790@subsection Score Options
17791@cindex Score Options
17792
17793These options are defined for Score implementations:
17794
17795@table @gcctabopt
17796@item -meb
17797@opindex meb
17798Compile code for big-endian mode.  This is the default.
17799
17800@item -mel
17801@opindex mel
17802Compile code for little-endian mode.
17803
17804@item -mnhwloop
17805@opindex mnhwloop
17806Disable generate bcnz instruction.
17807
17808@item -muls
17809@opindex muls
17810Enable generate unaligned load and store instruction.
17811
17812@item -mmac
17813@opindex mmac
17814Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
17815
17816@item -mscore5
17817@opindex mscore5
17818Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
17819
17820@item -mscore5u
17821@opindex mscore5u
17822Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
17823
17824@item -mscore7
17825@opindex mscore7
17826Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
17827
17828@item -mscore7d
17829@opindex mscore7d
17830Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
17831@end table
17832
17833@node SH Options
17834@subsection SH Options
17835
17836These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
17837
17838@table @gcctabopt
17839@item -m1
17840@opindex m1
17841Generate code for the SH1.
17842
17843@item -m2
17844@opindex m2
17845Generate code for the SH2.
17846
17847@item -m2e
17848Generate code for the SH2e.
17849
17850@item -m2a-nofpu
17851@opindex m2a-nofpu
17852Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way
17853that the floating-point unit is not used.
17854
17855@item -m2a-single-only
17856@opindex m2a-single-only
17857Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision
17858floating-point operations are used.
17859
17860@item -m2a-single
17861@opindex m2a-single
17862Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17863single-precision mode by default.
17864
17865@item -m2a
17866@opindex m2a
17867Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17868double-precision mode by default.
17869
17870@item -m3
17871@opindex m3
17872Generate code for the SH3.
17873
17874@item -m3e
17875@opindex m3e
17876Generate code for the SH3e.
17877
17878@item -m4-nofpu
17879@opindex m4-nofpu
17880Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
17881
17882@item -m4-single-only
17883@opindex m4-single-only
17884Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
17885supports single-precision arithmetic.
17886
17887@item -m4-single
17888@opindex m4-single
17889Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
17890single-precision mode by default.
17891
17892@item -m4
17893@opindex m4
17894Generate code for the SH4.
17895
17896@item -m4a-nofpu
17897@opindex m4a-nofpu
17898Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that the
17899floating-point unit is not used.
17900
17901@item -m4a-single-only
17902@opindex m4a-single-only
17903Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
17904floating-point operations are used.
17905
17906@item -m4a-single
17907@opindex m4a-single
17908Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
17909single-precision mode by default.
17910
17911@item -m4a
17912@opindex m4a
17913Generate code for the SH4a.
17914
17915@item -m4al
17916@opindex m4al
17917Same as @option{-m4a-nofpu}, except that it implicitly passes
17918@option{-dsp} to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any DSP
17919instructions at the moment.
17920
17921@item -mb
17922@opindex mb
17923Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.
17924
17925@item -ml
17926@opindex ml
17927Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.
17928
17929@item -mdalign
17930@opindex mdalign
17931Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling
17932conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library will
17933not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
17934
17935@item -mrelax
17936@opindex mrelax
17937Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
17938linker option @option{-relax}.
17939
17940@item -mbigtable
17941@opindex mbigtable
17942Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables.  The default is to use
1794316-bit offsets.
17944
17945@item -mbitops
17946@opindex mbitops
17947Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.
17948
17949@item -mfmovd
17950@opindex mfmovd
17951Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}.  Check @option{-mdalign} for
17952alignment constraints.
17953
17954@item -mhitachi
17955@opindex mhitachi
17956Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17957
17958@item -mrenesas
17959@opindex mhitachi
17960Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17961
17962@item -mno-renesas
17963@opindex mhitachi
17964Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas
17965conventions were available.  This option is the default for all
17966targets of the SH toolchain.
17967
17968@item -mnomacsave
17969@opindex mnomacsave
17970Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
17971@option{-mhitachi} is given.
17972
17973@item -mieee
17974@item -mno-ieee
17975@opindex mieee
17976@opindex mnoieee
17977Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the
17978handling of cases where the result of a comparison is unordered.  By default
17979@option{-mieee} is implicitly enabled.  If @option{-ffinite-math-only} is
17980enabled @option{-mno-ieee} is implicitly set, which results in faster
17981floating-point greater-equal and less-equal comparisons.  The implcit settings
17982can be overridden by specifying either @option{-mieee} or @option{-mno-ieee}.
17983
17984@item -minline-ic_invalidate
17985@opindex minline-ic_invalidate
17986Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting up
17987nested function trampolines.
17988This option has no effect if -musermode is in effect and the selected
17989code generation option (e.g. -m4) does not allow the use of the icbi
17990instruction.
17991If the selected code generation option does not allow the use of the icbi
17992instruction, and -musermode is not in effect, the inlined code will
17993manipulate the instruction cache address array directly with an associative
17994write.  This not only requires privileged mode, but it will also
17995fail if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB and has become unmapped.
17996
17997@item -misize
17998@opindex misize
17999Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
18000
18001@item -mpadstruct
18002@opindex mpadstruct
18003This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
18004which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
18005
18006@item -msoft-atomic
18007@opindex msoft-atomic
18008Generate GNU/Linux compatible gUSA software atomic sequences for the atomic
18009built-in functions.  The generated atomic sequences require support from the
18010interrupt / exception handling code of the system and are only suitable for
18011single-core systems.  They will not perform correctly on multi-core systems.
18012This option is enabled by default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18013For details on the atomic built-in functions see @ref{__atomic Builtins}.
18014
18015@item -mspace
18016@opindex mspace
18017Optimize for space instead of speed.  Implied by @option{-Os}.
18018
18019@item -mprefergot
18020@opindex mprefergot
18021When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
18022the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
18023
18024@item -musermode
18025@opindex musermode
18026Don't generate privileged mode only code; implies -mno-inline-ic_invalidate
18027if the inlined code would not work in user mode.
18028This is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18029
18030@item -multcost=@var{number}
18031@opindex multcost=@var{number}
18032Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
18033
18034@item -mdiv=@var{strategy}
18035@opindex mdiv=@var{strategy}
18036Set the division strategy to use for SHmedia code.  @var{strategy} must be
18037one of: call, call2, fp, inv, inv:minlat, inv20u, inv20l, inv:call,
18038inv:call2, inv:fp .
18039"fp" performs the operation in floating point.  This has a very high latency,
18040but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice if
18041your code has enough easily-exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to
18042schedule the floating-point instructions together with other instructions.
18043Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.
18044"inv" uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor,
18045and then multiplies the dividend with the inverse.  This strategy allows
18046cse and hoisting of the inverse calculation.  Division by zero calculates
18047an unspecified result, but does not trap.
18048"inv:minlat" is a variant of "inv" where if no cse / hoisting opportunities
18049have been found, or if the entire operation has been hoisted to the same
18050place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the
18051final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a few
18052more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with
18053other code.
18054"call" calls a library function that usually implements the inv:minlat
18055strategy.
18056This gives high code density for m5-*media-nofpu compilations.
18057"call2" uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it
18058assumes that a pointer to a lookup table has already been set up, which
18059exposes the pointer load to cse / code hoisting optimizations.
18060"inv:call", "inv:call2" and "inv:fp" all use the "inv" algorithm for initial
18061code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the "call",
18062"call2", or "fp" strategies, respectively.  Note that the
18063potentially-trapping side effect of division by zero is carried by a
18064separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions
18065are hoisted out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.
18066A recombination to fp operations or a call is not possible in that case.
18067"inv20u" and "inv20l" are variants of the "inv:minlat" strategy.  In the case
18068that the inverse calculation was nor separated from the multiply, they speed
18069up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where applicable),
18070by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test
18071slows down the case of larger dividends.  inv20u assumes the case of a such
18072a small dividend to be unlikely, and inv20l assumes it to be likely.
18073
18074@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
18075@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
18076Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue rather
18077than around each call.  Generally beneficial for performance and size.  Also
18078needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack frame around conditional code.
18079
18080@item -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18081@opindex mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18082Set the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed division to
18083@var{name}.  This only affect the name used in the call and inv:call
18084division strategies, and the compiler will still expect the same
18085sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option was not present.
18086
18087@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18088@opindex mfixed-range
18089Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18090A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18091useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18092two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18093specified separated by a comma.
18094
18095@item -madjust-unroll
18096@opindex madjust-unroll
18097Throttle unrolling to avoid thrashing target registers.
18098This option only has an effect if the gcc code base supports the
18099TARGET_ADJUST_UNROLL_MAX target hook.
18100
18101@item -mindexed-addressing
18102@opindex mindexed-addressing
18103Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.
18104This is only safe if the hardware and/or OS implement 32-bit wrap-around
18105semantics for the indexed addressing mode.  The architecture allows the
18106implementation of processors with 64-bit MMU, which the OS could use to
18107get 32-bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports
18108this or any other way to make the indexed addressing mode safe to use in
18109the 32-bit ABI, the default is @option{-mno-indexed-addressing}.
18110
18111@item -mgettrcost=@var{number}
18112@opindex mgettrcost=@var{number}
18113Set the cost assumed for the gettr instruction to @var{number}.
18114The default is 2 if @option{-mpt-fixed} is in effect, 100 otherwise.
18115
18116@item -mpt-fixed
18117@opindex mpt-fixed
18118Assume pt* instructions won't trap.  This will generally generate better
18119scheduled code, but is unsafe on current hardware.  The current architecture
18120definition says that ptabs and ptrel trap when the target anded with 3 is 3.
18121This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe to schedule ptabs /
18122ptrel before a branch, or hoist it out of a loop.  For example,
18123__do_global_ctors, a part of libgcc that runs constructors at program
18124startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by @minus{}1.  With the
18125-mpt-fixed option, the ptabs will be done before testing against @minus{}1.
18126That means that all the constructors will be run a bit quicker, but when
18127the loop comes to the end of the list, the program crashes because ptabs
18128loads @minus{}1 into a target register.  Since this option is unsafe for any
18129hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the default
18130is -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless the user specifies a specific cost with
18131@option{-mgettrcost}, -mno-pt-fixed also implies @option{-mgettrcost=100};
18132this deters register allocation using target registers for storing
18133ordinary integers.
18134
18135@item -minvalid-symbols
18136@opindex minvalid-symbols
18137Assume symbols might be invalid.  Ordinary function symbols generated by
18138the compiler will always be valid to load with movi/shori/ptabs or
18139movi/shori/ptrel, but with assembler and/or linker tricks it is possible
18140to generate symbols that will cause ptabs / ptrel to trap.
18141This option is only meaningful when @option{-mno-pt-fixed} is in effect.
18142It will then prevent cross-basic-block cse, hoisting and most scheduling
18143of symbol loads.  The default is @option{-mno-invalid-symbols}.
18144
18145@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18146@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18147Assume @var{num} to be the cost for a branch instruction.  Higher numbers
18148will make the compiler try to generate more branch-free code if possible.
18149If not specified the value is selected depending on the processor type that
18150is being compiled for.
18151
18152@item -mcbranchdi
18153@opindex mcbranchdi
18154Enable the @code{cbranchdi4} instruction pattern.
18155
18156@item -mcmpeqdi
18157@opindex mcmpeqdi
18158Emit the @code{cmpeqdi_t} instruction pattern even when @option{-mcbranchdi}
18159is in effect.
18160
18161@item -mfused-madd
18162@opindex mfused-madd
18163Allow the usage of the @code{fmac} instruction (floating-point
18164multiply-accumulate) if the processor type supports it.  Enabling this
18165option might generate code that produces different numeric floating-point
18166results compared to strict IEEE 754 arithmetic.
18167
18168@item -mpretend-cmove
18169@opindex mpretend-cmove
18170Prefer zero-displacement conditional branches for conditional move instruction
18171patterns.  This can result in faster code on the SH4 processor.
18172
18173@end table
18174
18175@node Solaris 2 Options
18176@subsection Solaris 2 Options
18177@cindex Solaris 2 options
18178
18179These @samp{-m} options are supported on Solaris 2:
18180
18181@table @gcctabopt
18182@item -mimpure-text
18183@opindex mimpure-text
18184@option{-mimpure-text}, used in addition to @option{-shared}, tells
18185the compiler to not pass @option{-z text} to the linker when linking a
18186shared object.  Using this option, you can link position-dependent
18187code into a shared object.
18188
18189@option{-mimpure-text} suppresses the ``relocations remain against
18190allocatable but non-writable sections'' linker error message.
18191However, the necessary relocations will trigger copy-on-write, and the
18192shared object is not actually shared across processes.  Instead of
18193using @option{-mimpure-text}, you should compile all source code with
18194@option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}.
18195
18196@end table
18197
18198These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:
18199
18200@table @gcctabopt
18201@item -pthreads
18202@opindex pthreads
18203Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This
18204option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  This option does
18205not affect the thread safety of object code produced  by the compiler or
18206that of libraries supplied with it.
18207
18208@item -pthread
18209@opindex pthread
18210This is a synonym for @option{-pthreads}.
18211@end table
18212
18213@node SPARC Options
18214@subsection SPARC Options
18215@cindex SPARC options
18216
18217These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPARC:
18218
18219@table @gcctabopt
18220@item -mno-app-regs
18221@itemx -mapp-regs
18222@opindex mno-app-regs
18223@opindex mapp-regs
18224Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
182252 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications.  This
18226is the default.
18227
18228To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
18229specify @option{-mno-app-regs}.  You should compile libraries and system
18230software with this option.
18231
18232@item -mflat
18233@itemx -mno-flat
18234@opindex mflat
18235@opindex mno-flat
18236With @option{-mflat}, the compiler does not generate save/restore instructions
18237and uses a ``flat'' or single register window model.  This model is compatible
18238with the regular register window model.  The local registers and the input
18239registers (0--5) are still treated as ``call-saved'' registers and will be
18240saved on the stack as needed.
18241
18242With @option{-mno-flat} (the default), the compiler generates save/restore
18243instructions (except for leaf functions).  This is the normal operating mode.
18244
18245@item -mfpu
18246@itemx -mhard-float
18247@opindex mfpu
18248@opindex mhard-float
18249Generate output containing floating-point instructions.  This is the
18250default.
18251
18252@item -mno-fpu
18253@itemx -msoft-float
18254@opindex mno-fpu
18255@opindex msoft-float
18256Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
18257@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
18258targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
18259used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
18260your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
18261cross-compilation.  The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
18262@samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating-point support.
18263
18264@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
18265therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
18266this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
18267library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
18268this to work.
18269
18270@item -mhard-quad-float
18271@opindex mhard-quad-float
18272Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point
18273instructions.
18274
18275@item -msoft-quad-float
18276@opindex msoft-quad-float
18277Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
18278floating-point instructions.  The functions called are those specified
18279in the SPARC ABI@.  This is the default.
18280
18281As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware
18282support for the quad-word floating-point instructions.  They all invoke
18283a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
18284emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead,
18285this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines.  Thus the
18286@option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
18287
18288@item -mno-unaligned-doubles
18289@itemx -munaligned-doubles
18290@opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
18291@opindex munaligned-doubles
18292Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment.  This is the default.
18293
18294With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte
18295alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
18296absolute address.  Otherwise, it assumes they have 4-byte alignment.
18297Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
18298generated by other compilers.  It is not the default because it results
18299in a performance loss, especially for floating-point code.
18300
18301@item -mno-faster-structs
18302@itemx -mfaster-structs
18303@opindex mno-faster-structs
18304@opindex mfaster-structs
18305With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
18306should have 8-byte alignment.  This enables the use of pairs of
18307@code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
18308assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
18309However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
18310ABI@.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
18311acknowledges that their resulting code will not be directly in line with
18312the rules of the ABI@.
18313
18314@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
18315@opindex mcpu
18316Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
18317for machine type @var{cpu_type}.  Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
18318@samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc},
18319@samp{leon}, @samp{sparclite}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934}, @samp{sparclite86x},
18320@samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9}, @samp{ultrasparc},
18321@samp{ultrasparc3}, @samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3},
18322and @samp{niagara4}.
18323
18324Native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
18325which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
18326@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
18327the processor.
18328
18329Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
18330an architecture and not an implementation.  These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
18331@samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
18332
18333Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
18334implementations.
18335
18336@table @asis
18337@item v7
18338cypress
18339
18340@item v8
18341supersparc, hypersparc, leon
18342
18343@item sparclite
18344f930, f934, sparclite86x
18345
18346@item sparclet
18347tsc701
18348
18349@item v9
18350ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4
18351@end table
18352
18353By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for the V7
18354variant of the SPARC architecture.  With @option{-mcpu=cypress}, the compiler
18355additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the
18356SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
18357SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
18358
18359With @option{-mcpu=v8}, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
18360architecture.  The only difference from V7 code is that the compiler emits
18361the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which exist in SPARC-V8
18362but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=supersparc}, the compiler additionally
18363optimizes it for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and
183642000 series.
18365
18366With @option{-mcpu=sparclite}, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of
18367the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, integer divide step
18368and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC-V7.
18369With @option{-mcpu=f930}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18370Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original SPARClite, with no FPU@.  With
18371@option{-mcpu=f934}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu
18372MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU@.
18373
18374With @option{-mcpu=sparclet}, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
18375the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, multiply/accumulate,
18376integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClet
18377but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=tsc701}, the compiler additionally
18378optimizes it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.
18379
18380With @option{-mcpu=v9}, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
18381architecture.  This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move instructions,
183823 additional floating-point condition code registers and conditional move
18383instructions.  With @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc}, the compiler additionally
18384optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi chips.  With
18385@option{-mcpu=ultrasparc3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18386Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips.  With
18387@option{-mcpu=niagara}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
18388Sun UltraSPARC T1 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara2}, the compiler
18389additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With
18390@option{-mcpu=niagara3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
18391UltraSPARC T3 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara4}, the compiler
18392additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips.
18393
18394@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
18395@opindex mtune
18396Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
18397@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
18398option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.
18399
18400The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
18401@option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
18402that select a particular CPU implementation.  Those are @samp{cypress},
18403@samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{leon}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
18404@samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc}, @samp{ultrasparc3},
18405@samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3} and @samp{niagara4}.  With
18406native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, @samp{native} can also be used.
18407
18408@item -mv8plus
18409@itemx -mno-v8plus
18410@opindex mv8plus
18411@opindex mno-v8plus
18412With @option{-mv8plus}, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI@.  The
18413difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
18414considered 64 bits wide.  This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
18415mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
18416
18417@item -mvis
18418@itemx -mno-vis
18419@opindex mvis
18420@opindex mno-vis
18421With @option{-mvis}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18422Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The default is @option{-mno-vis}.
18423
18424@item -mvis2
18425@itemx -mno-vis2
18426@opindex mvis2
18427@opindex mno-vis2
18428With @option{-mvis2}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18429version 2.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18430default is @option{-mvis2} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18431instructions, such as UltraSPARC-III and later.  Setting @option{-mvis2}
18432also sets @option{-mvis}.
18433
18434@item -mvis3
18435@itemx -mno-vis3
18436@opindex mvis3
18437@opindex mno-vis3
18438With @option{-mvis3}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18439version 3.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18440default is @option{-mvis3} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18441instructions, such as niagara-3 and later.  Setting @option{-mvis3}
18442also sets @option{-mvis2} and @option{-mvis}.
18443
18444@item -mpopc
18445@itemx -mno-popc
18446@opindex mpopc
18447@opindex mno-popc
18448With @option{-mpopc}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18449population count instruction.  The default is @option{-mpopc}
18450when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-2 and
18451later.
18452
18453@item -mfmaf
18454@itemx -mno-fmaf
18455@opindex mfmaf
18456@opindex mno-fmaf
18457With @option{-mfmaf}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18458Fused Multiply-Add Floating-point extensions.  The default is @option{-mfmaf}
18459when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-3 and
18460later.
18461
18462@item -mfix-at697f
18463@opindex mfix-at697f
18464Enable the documented workaround for the single erratum of the Atmel AT697F
18465processor (which corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).
18466@end table
18467
18468These @samp{-m} options are supported in addition to the above
18469on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:
18470
18471@table @gcctabopt
18472@item -mlittle-endian
18473@opindex mlittle-endian
18474Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  It is only
18475available for a few configurations and most notably not on Solaris and Linux.
18476
18477@item -m32
18478@itemx -m64
18479@opindex m32
18480@opindex m64
18481Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
18482The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
18483The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
18484to 64 bits.
18485
18486@item -mcmodel=@var{which}
18487@opindex mcmodel
18488Set the code model to one of
18489
18490@table @samp
18491@item medlow
18492The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18493must be linked in the low 32 bits of memory.  Programs can be statically
18494or dynamically linked.
18495
18496@item medmid
18497The Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18498must be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must
18499be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of
18500the text segment.
18501
18502@item medany
18503The Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18504may be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must be less
18505than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of the
18506text segment.
18507
18508@item embmedany
18509The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
1851064-bit addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
18511size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time).  The
18512global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment.  Programs
18513are statically linked and PIC is not supported.
18514@end table
18515
18516@item -mmemory-model=@var{mem-model}
18517@opindex mmemory-model
18518Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of
18519
18520@table @samp
18521@item default
18522The default memory model for the processor and operating system.
18523
18524@item rmo
18525Relaxed Memory Order
18526
18527@item pso
18528Partial Store Order
18529
18530@item tso
18531Total Store Order
18532
18533@item sc
18534Sequential Consistency
18535@end table
18536
18537These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the Sparc V9
18538architecture manual, as set in the processor's @code{PSTATE.MM} field.
18539
18540@item -mstack-bias
18541@itemx -mno-stack-bias
18542@opindex mstack-bias
18543@opindex mno-stack-bias
18544With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
18545frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
18546when making stack frame references.  This is the default in 64-bit mode.
18547Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
18548@end table
18549
18550@node SPU Options
18551@subsection SPU Options
18552@cindex SPU options
18553
18554These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPU:
18555
18556@table @gcctabopt
18557@item -mwarn-reloc
18558@itemx -merror-reloc
18559@opindex mwarn-reloc
18560@opindex merror-reloc
18561
18562The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations.  By default, GCC
18563will give an error when it generates code that requires a dynamic
18564relocation.  @option{-mno-error-reloc} disables the error,
18565@option{-mwarn-reloc} will generate a warning instead.
18566
18567@item -msafe-dma
18568@itemx -munsafe-dma
18569@opindex msafe-dma
18570@opindex munsafe-dma
18571
18572Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be
18573reordered with respect to loads and stores of the memory that is being
18574accessed.  Users typically address this problem using the volatile
18575keyword, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the
18576memory is known to not change.  Rather than mark the memory as volatile
18577we treat the DMA instructions as potentially effecting all memory.  With
18578@option{-munsafe-dma} users must use the volatile keyword to protect
18579memory accesses.
18580
18581@item -mbranch-hints
18582@opindex mbranch-hints
18583
18584By default, GCC will generate a branch hint instruction to avoid
18585pipeline stalls for always taken or probably taken branches.  A hint
18586will not be generated closer than 8 instructions away from its branch.
18587There is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes,
18588or to make an object a little bit smaller.
18589
18590@item -msmall-mem
18591@itemx -mlarge-mem
18592@opindex msmall-mem
18593@opindex mlarge-mem
18594
18595By default, GCC generates code assuming that addresses are never larger
18596than 18 bits.  With @option{-mlarge-mem} code is generated that assumes
18597a full 32-bit address.
18598
18599@item -mstdmain
18600@opindex mstdmain
18601
18602By default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style
18603main function interface (which has an unconventional parameter list).
18604With @option{-mstdmain}, GCC will link your program against startup
18605code that assumes a C99-style interface to @code{main}, including a
18606local copy of @code{argv} strings.
18607
18608@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18609@opindex mfixed-range
18610Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18611A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18612useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18613two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18614specified separated by a comma.
18615
18616@item -mea32
18617@itemx -mea64
18618@opindex mea32
18619@opindex mea64
18620Compile code assuming that pointers to the PPU address space accessed
18621via the @code{__ea} named address space qualifier are either 32 or 64
18622bits wide.  The default is 32 bits.  As this is an ABI changing option,
18623all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.
18624
18625@item -maddress-space-conversion
18626@itemx -mno-address-space-conversion
18627@opindex maddress-space-conversion
18628@opindex mno-address-space-conversion
18629Allow/disallow treating the @code{__ea} address space as superset
18630of the generic address space.  This enables explicit type casts
18631between @code{__ea} and generic pointer as well as implicit
18632conversions of generic pointers to @code{__ea} pointers.  The
18633default is to allow address space pointer conversions.
18634
18635@item -mcache-size=@var{cache-size}
18636@opindex mcache-size
18637This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18638executable and selects a software-managed cache for accessing variables
18639in the @code{__ea} address space with a particular cache size.  Possible
18640options for @var{cache-size} are @samp{8}, @samp{16}, @samp{32}, @samp{64}
18641and @samp{128}.  The default cache size is 64KB.
18642
18643@item -matomic-updates
18644@itemx -mno-atomic-updates
18645@opindex matomic-updates
18646@opindex mno-atomic-updates
18647This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18648executable and selects whether atomic updates to the software-managed
18649cache of PPU-side variables are used.  If you use atomic updates, changes
18650to a PPU variable from SPU code using the @code{__ea} named address space
18651qualifier will not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing
18652in the same cache line from PPU code.  If you do not use atomic updates,
18653such interference may occur; however, writing back cache lines will be
18654more efficient.  The default behavior is to use atomic updates.
18655
18656@item -mdual-nops
18657@itemx -mdual-nops=@var{n}
18658@opindex mdual-nops
18659By default, GCC will insert nops to increase dual issue when it expects
18660it to increase performance.  @var{n} can be a value from 0 to 10.  A
18661smaller @var{n} will insert fewer nops.  10 is the default, 0 is the
18662same as @option{-mno-dual-nops}.  Disabled with @option{-Os}.
18663
18664@item -mhint-max-nops=@var{n}
18665@opindex mhint-max-nops
18666Maximum number of nops to insert for a branch hint.  A branch hint must
18667be at least 8 instructions away from the branch it is effecting.  GCC
18668will insert up to @var{n} nops to enforce this, otherwise it will not
18669generate the branch hint.
18670
18671@item -mhint-max-distance=@var{n}
18672@opindex mhint-max-distance
18673The encoding of the branch hint instruction limits the hint to be within
18674256 instructions of the branch it is effecting.  By default, GCC makes
18675sure it is within 125.
18676
18677@item -msafe-hints
18678@opindex msafe-hints
18679Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.
18680By default, GCC will insert the @code{hbrp} instruction to make sure
18681this stall won't happen.
18682
18683@end table
18684
18685@node System V Options
18686@subsection Options for System V
18687
18688These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
18689compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
18690
18691@table @gcctabopt
18692@item -G
18693@opindex G
18694Create a shared object.
18695It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
18696
18697@item -Qy
18698@opindex Qy
18699Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
18700@code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
18701
18702@item -Qn
18703@opindex Qn
18704Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
18705the default).
18706
18707@item -YP,@var{dirs}
18708@opindex YP
18709Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
18710specified with @option{-l}.
18711
18712@item -Ym,@var{dir}
18713@opindex Ym
18714Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
18715The assembler uses this option.
18716@c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
18717@c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
18718@end table
18719
18720@node TILE-Gx Options
18721@subsection TILE-Gx Options
18722@cindex TILE-Gx options
18723
18724These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILE-Gx:
18725
18726@table @gcctabopt
18727@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18728@opindex mcpu
18729Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18730type is @samp{tilegx}.
18731
18732@item -m32
18733@itemx -m64
18734@opindex m32
18735@opindex m64
18736Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit
18737environment sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits.  The 64-bit
18738environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
18739@end table
18740
18741@node TILEPro Options
18742@subsection TILEPro Options
18743@cindex TILEPro options
18744
18745These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILEPro:
18746
18747@table @gcctabopt
18748@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18749@opindex mcpu
18750Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18751type is @samp{tilepro}.
18752
18753@item -m32
18754@opindex m32
18755Generate code for a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and
18756pointer to 32 bits.  This is the only supported behavior so the flag
18757is essentially ignored.
18758@end table
18759
18760@node V850 Options
18761@subsection V850 Options
18762@cindex V850 Options
18763
18764These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
18765
18766@table @gcctabopt
18767@item -mlong-calls
18768@itemx -mno-long-calls
18769@opindex mlong-calls
18770@opindex mno-long-calls
18771Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be
18772far away, the compiler will always load the functions address up into a
18773register, and call indirect through the pointer.
18774
18775@item -mno-ep
18776@itemx -mep
18777@opindex mno-ep
18778@opindex mep
18779Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
18780pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
18781use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions.  The @option{-mep}
18782option is on by default if you optimize.
18783
18784@item -mno-prolog-function
18785@itemx -mprolog-function
18786@opindex mno-prolog-function
18787@opindex mprolog-function
18788Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers
18789at the prologue and epilogue of a function.  The external functions
18790are slower, but use less code space if more than one function saves
18791the same number of registers.  The @option{-mprolog-function} option
18792is on by default if you optimize.
18793
18794@item -mspace
18795@opindex mspace
18796Try to make the code as small as possible.  At present, this just turns
18797on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
18798
18799@item -mtda=@var{n}
18800@opindex mtda
18801Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18802the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to.  The tiny data
18803area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
18804
18805@item -msda=@var{n}
18806@opindex msda
18807Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18808the small data area that register @code{gp} points to.  The small data
18809area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
18810
18811@item -mzda=@var{n}
18812@opindex mzda
18813Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18814the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
18815
18816@item -mv850
18817@opindex mv850
18818Specify that the target processor is the V850.
18819
18820@item -mbig-switch
18821@opindex mbig-switch
18822Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
18823the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
18824table.
18825
18826@item -mapp-regs
18827@opindex mapp-regs
18828This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
18829the compiler.  This setting is the default.
18830
18831@item -mno-app-regs
18832@opindex mno-app-regs
18833This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
18834
18835@item -mv850e2v3
18836@opindex mv850e2v3
18837Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3.  The preprocessor
18838constants @samp{__v850e2v3__} will be defined if
18839this option is used.
18840
18841@item -mv850e2
18842@opindex mv850e2
18843Specify that the target processor is the V850E2.  The preprocessor
18844constants @samp{__v850e2__} will be defined if this option is used.
18845
18846@item -mv850e1
18847@opindex mv850e1
18848Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor
18849constants @samp{__v850e1__} and @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if
18850this option is used.
18851
18852@item -mv850es
18853@opindex mv850es
18854Specify that the target processor is the V850ES.  This is an alias for
18855the @option{-mv850e1} option.
18856
18857@item -mv850e
18858@opindex mv850e
18859Specify that the target processor is the V850E@.  The preprocessor
18860constant @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if this option is used.
18861
18862If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} nor @option{-mv850e1}
18863nor @option{-mv850e2} nor @option{-mv850e2v3}
18864are defined then a default target processor will be chosen and the
18865relevant @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant will be defined.
18866
18867The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
18868defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
18869
18870@item -mdisable-callt
18871@opindex mdisable-callt
18872This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction for the
18873v850e, v850e1, v850e2 and v850e2v3 flavors of the v850 architecture.  The default is
18874@option{-mno-disable-callt} which allows the CALLT instruction to be used.
18875
18876@end table
18877
18878@node VAX Options
18879@subsection VAX Options
18880@cindex VAX options
18881
18882These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
18883
18884@table @gcctabopt
18885@item -munix
18886@opindex munix
18887Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
18888that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
18889ranges.
18890
18891@item -mgnu
18892@opindex mgnu
18893Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you
18894will assemble with the GNU assembler.
18895
18896@item -mg
18897@opindex mg
18898Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of D-format.
18899@end table
18900
18901@node VxWorks Options
18902@subsection VxWorks Options
18903@cindex VxWorks Options
18904
18905The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.
18906Options specific to the target hardware are listed with the other
18907options for that target.
18908
18909@table @gcctabopt
18910@item -mrtp
18911@opindex mrtp
18912GCC can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes
18913(RTPs).  This option switches from the former to the latter.  It also
18914defines the preprocessor macro @code{__RTP__}.
18915
18916@item -non-static
18917@opindex non-static
18918Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static
18919libraries.  The options @option{-static} and @option{-shared} can
18920also be used for RTPs (@pxref{Link Options}); @option{-static}
18921is the default.
18922
18923@item -Bstatic
18924@itemx -Bdynamic
18925@opindex Bstatic
18926@opindex Bdynamic
18927These options are passed down to the linker.  They are defined for
18928compatibility with Diab.
18929
18930@item -Xbind-lazy
18931@opindex Xbind-lazy
18932Enable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is equivalent to
18933@option{-Wl,-z,now} and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
18934
18935@item -Xbind-now
18936@opindex Xbind-now
18937Disable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is the default and
18938is defined for compatibility with Diab.
18939@end table
18940
18941@node x86-64 Options
18942@subsection x86-64 Options
18943@cindex x86-64 options
18944
18945These are listed under @xref{i386 and x86-64 Options}.
18946
18947@node Xstormy16 Options
18948@subsection Xstormy16 Options
18949@cindex Xstormy16 Options
18950
18951These options are defined for Xstormy16:
18952
18953@table @gcctabopt
18954@item -msim
18955@opindex msim
18956Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
18957@end table
18958
18959@node Xtensa Options
18960@subsection Xtensa Options
18961@cindex Xtensa Options
18962
18963These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
18964
18965@table @gcctabopt
18966@item -mconst16
18967@itemx -mno-const16
18968@opindex mconst16
18969@opindex mno-const16
18970Enable or disable use of @code{CONST16} instructions for loading
18971constant values.  The @code{CONST16} instruction is currently not a
18972standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, @code{CONST16}
18973instructions are always used in place of the standard @code{L32R}
18974instructions.  The use of @code{CONST16} is enabled by default only if
18975the @code{L32R} instruction is not available.
18976
18977@item -mfused-madd
18978@itemx -mno-fused-madd
18979@opindex mfused-madd
18980@opindex mno-fused-madd
18981Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
18982instructions in the floating-point option.  This has no effect if the
18983floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused multiply/add
18984and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
18985instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations.  This may be
18986desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
18987required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
18988intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
18989precision than specified by the IEEE standard.  Disabling fused multiply
18990add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
18991sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
18992operations.
18993
18994@item -mserialize-volatile
18995@itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
18996@opindex mserialize-volatile
18997@opindex mno-serialize-volatile
18998When this option is enabled, GCC inserts @code{MEMW} instructions before
18999@code{volatile} memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
19000The default is @option{-mserialize-volatile}.  Use
19001@option{-mno-serialize-volatile} to omit the @code{MEMW} instructions.
19002
19003@item -mforce-no-pic
19004@opindex mforce-no-pic
19005For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be
19006position-independent code (PIC), this option disables PIC for compiling
19007kernel code.
19008
19009@item -mtext-section-literals
19010@itemx -mno-text-section-literals
19011@opindex mtext-section-literals
19012@opindex mno-text-section-literals
19013Control the treatment of literal pools.  The default is
19014@option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
19015section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be placed
19016in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
19017pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
19018improve code size.  With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
19019are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
19020possible to their references.  This may be necessary for large assembly
19021files.
19022
19023@item -mtarget-align
19024@itemx -mno-target-align
19025@opindex mtarget-align
19026@opindex mno-target-align
19027When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
19028automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
19029expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
19030instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
19031instructions.  If there are not enough preceding safe density
19032instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed.  The
19033default is @option{-mtarget-align}.  These options do not affect the
19034treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
19035assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or
19036by inserting no-op instructions.
19037
19038@item -mlongcalls
19039@itemx -mno-longcalls
19040@opindex mlongcalls
19041@opindex mno-longcalls
19042When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
19043direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
19044of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction.  This
19045translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
19046files.  Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
19047instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
19048The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}.  This option should be used in
19049programs where the call target can potentially be out of range.  This
19050option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
19051assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct call
19052instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
19053instructions.  Note that the assembler will use an indirect call for
19054every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.
19055@end table
19056
19057@node zSeries Options
19058@subsection zSeries Options
19059@cindex zSeries options
19060
19061These are listed under @xref{S/390 and zSeries Options}.
19062
19063@node Code Gen Options
19064@section Options for Code Generation Conventions
19065@cindex code generation conventions
19066@cindex options, code generation
19067@cindex run-time options
19068
19069These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
19070used in code generation.
19071
19072Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
19073of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table below, only
19074one of the forms is listed---the one that is not the default.  You
19075can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
19076it.
19077
19078@table @gcctabopt
19079@item -fbounds-check
19080@opindex fbounds-check
19081For front ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
19082indices used to access arrays are within the declared range.  This is
19083currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front ends, where
19084this option defaults to true and false respectively.
19085
19086@item -ftrapv
19087@opindex ftrapv
19088This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
19089multiplication operations.
19090
19091@item -fwrapv
19092@opindex fwrapv
19093This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
19094overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
19095using twos-complement representation.  This flag enables some optimizations
19096and disables others.  This option is enabled by default for the Java
19097front end, as required by the Java language specification.
19098
19099@item -fexceptions
19100@opindex fexceptions
19101Enable exception handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate
19102exceptions.  For some targets, this implies GCC will generate frame
19103unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
19104size overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not
19105specify this option, GCC will enable it by default for languages like
19106C++ that normally require exception handling, and disable it for
19107languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need
19108to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
19109properly with exception handlers written in C++.  You may also wish to
19110disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
19111use exception handling.
19112
19113@item -fnon-call-exceptions
19114@opindex fnon-call-exceptions
19115Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
19116Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
19117not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
19118instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating-point
19119instructions.  It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
19120arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
19121
19122@item -funwind-tables
19123@opindex funwind-tables
19124Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it will just generate any needed
19125static data, but will not affect the generated code in any other way.
19126You will normally not enable this option; instead, a language processor
19127that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.
19128
19129@item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19130@opindex fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19131Generate unwind table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine.  The
19132table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
19133unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
19134
19135@item -fpcc-struct-return
19136@opindex fpcc-struct-return
19137Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
19138longer ones, rather than in registers.  This convention is less
19139efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
19140GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
19141the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
19142
19143The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
19144on the target configuration macros.
19145
19146Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
19147that of some integer type.
19148
19149@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
19150switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19151@option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
19152Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19153
19154@item -freg-struct-return
19155@opindex freg-struct-return
19156Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
19157This is more efficient for small structures than
19158@option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
19159
19160If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
19161@option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
19162standard for the target.  If there is no standard convention, GCC
19163defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
19164the principal compiler.  In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
19165we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
19166
19167@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
19168switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19169@option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
19170Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19171
19172@item -fshort-enums
19173@opindex fshort-enums
19174Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
19175declared range of possible values.  Specifically, the @code{enum} type
19176will be equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.
19177
19178@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
19179code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19180Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19181
19182@item -fshort-double
19183@opindex fshort-double
19184Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
19185
19186@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
19187code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19188Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19189
19190@item -fshort-wchar
19191@opindex fshort-wchar
19192Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
19193unsigned int} instead of the default for the target.  This option is
19194useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
19195
19196@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
19197code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19198Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19199
19200@item -fno-common
19201@opindex fno-common
19202In C code, controls the placement of uninitialized global variables.
19203Unix C compilers have traditionally permitted multiple definitions of
19204such variables in different compilation units by placing the variables
19205in a common block.
19206This is the behavior specified by @option{-fcommon}, and is the default
19207for GCC on most targets.
19208On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on some
19209targets may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.
19210The @option{-fno-common} option specifies that the compiler should place
19211uninitialized global variables in the data section of the object file,
19212rather than generating them as common blocks.
19213This has the effect that if the same variable is declared
19214(without @code{extern}) in two different compilations,
19215you will get a multiple-definition error when you link them.
19216In this case, you must compile with @option{-fcommon} instead.
19217Compiling with @option{-fno-common} is useful on targets for which
19218it provides better performance, or if you wish to verify that the
19219program will work on other systems that always treat uninitialized
19220variable declarations this way.
19221
19222@item -fno-ident
19223@opindex fno-ident
19224Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
19225
19226@item -finhibit-size-directive
19227@opindex finhibit-size-directive
19228Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
19229would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
19230two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This option is
19231used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
19232for anything else.
19233
19234@item -fverbose-asm
19235@opindex fverbose-asm
19236Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
19237make it more readable.  This option is generally only of use to those
19238who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
19239debugging the compiler itself).
19240
19241@option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
19242extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
19243files.
19244
19245@item -frecord-gcc-switches
19246@opindex frecord-gcc-switches
19247This switch causes the command line that was used to invoke the
19248compiler to be recorded into the object file that is being created.
19249This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format
19250of the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it
19251usually takes the form of a section containing ASCII text.  This
19252switch is related to the @option{-fverbose-asm} switch, but that
19253switch only records information in the assembler output file as
19254comments, so it never reaches the object file.
19255See also @option{-grecord-gcc-switches} for another
19256way of storing compiler options into the object file.
19257
19258@item -fpic
19259@opindex fpic
19260@cindex global offset table
19261@cindex PIC
19262Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
19263library, if supported for the target machine.  Such code accesses all
19264constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@.  The dynamic
19265loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
19266loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system).  If
19267the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
19268maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
19269@option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
19270instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k
19271on the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)
19272
19273Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19274only on certain machines.  For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
19275but not for the Sun 386i.  Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
19276position-independent.
19277
19278When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19279are defined to 1.
19280
19281@item -fPIC
19282@opindex fPIC
19283If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
19284suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
19285global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the m68k,
19286PowerPC and SPARC@.
19287
19288Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19289only on certain machines.
19290
19291When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19292are defined to 2.
19293
19294@item -fpie
19295@itemx -fPIE
19296@opindex fpie
19297@opindex fPIE
19298These options are similar to @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, but
19299generated position independent code can be only linked into executables.
19300Usually these options are used when @option{-pie} GCC option will be
19301used during linking.
19302
19303@option{-fpie} and @option{-fPIE} both define the macros
19304@code{__pie__} and @code{__PIE__}.  The macros have the value 1
19305for @option{-fpie} and 2 for @option{-fPIE}.
19306
19307@item -fno-jump-tables
19308@opindex fno-jump-tables
19309Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
19310more efficient than other code generation strategies.  This option is
19311of use in conjunction with @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC} for
19312building code that forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot
19313reference the address of a jump table.  On some targets, jump tables
19314do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.
19315
19316@item -ffixed-@var{reg}
19317@opindex ffixed
19318Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
19319should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
19320pointer or in some other fixed role).
19321
19322@var{reg} must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted
19323are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
19324macro in the machine description macro file.
19325
19326This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19327three-way choice.
19328
19329@item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
19330@opindex fcall-used
19331Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
19332clobbered by function calls.  It may be allocated for temporaries or
19333variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled this way
19334will not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
19335
19336It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19337Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19338the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19339
19340This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19341three-way choice.
19342
19343@item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
19344@opindex fcall-saved
19345Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
19346functions.  It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
19347live across a call.  Functions compiled this way will save and restore
19348the register @var{reg} if they use it.
19349
19350It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19351Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19352the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19353
19354A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for
19355a register in which function values may be returned.
19356
19357This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19358three-way choice.
19359
19360@item -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]
19361@opindex fpack-struct
19362Without a value specified, pack all structure members together without
19363holes.  When a value is specified (which must be a small power of two), pack
19364structure members according to this value, representing the maximum
19365alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
19366this will be output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.
19367
19368@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
19369code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19370Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
19371Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19372
19373@item -finstrument-functions
19374@opindex finstrument-functions
19375Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just
19376after function entry and just before function exit, the following
19377profiling functions will be called with the address of the current
19378function and its call site.  (On some platforms,
19379@code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
19380function, so the call site information may not be available to the
19381profiling functions otherwise.)
19382
19383@smallexample
19384void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
19385                               void *call_site);
19386void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
19387                               void *call_site);
19388@end smallexample
19389
19390The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
19391which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
19392
19393This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
19394functions.  The profiling calls will indicate where, conceptually, the
19395inline function is entered and exited.  This means that addressable
19396versions of such functions must be available.  If all your uses of a
19397function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
19398code size.  If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
19399addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is
19400normally the case anyways, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
19401expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
19402providing static copies.)
19403
19404A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
19405which case this instrumentation will not be done.  This can be used, for
19406example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
19407interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
19408cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
19409routines generate output or allocate memory).
19410
19411@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{}
19412@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list
19413
19414Set the list of functions that are excluded from instrumentation (see
19415the description of @code{-finstrument-functions}).  If the file that
19416contains a function definition matches with one of @var{file}, then
19417that function is not instrumented.  The match is done on substrings:
19418if the @var{file} parameter is a substring of the file name, it is
19419considered to be a match.
19420
19421For example:
19422
19423@smallexample
19424-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys
19425@end smallexample
19426
19427@noindent
19428will exclude any inline function defined in files whose pathnames
19429contain @code{/bits/stl} or @code{include/sys}.
19430
19431If, for some reason, you want to include letter @code{','} in one of
19432@var{sym}, write @code{'\,'}. For example,
19433@code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list='\,\,tmp'}
19434(note the single quote surrounding the option).
19435
19436@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{}
19437@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list
19438
19439This is similar to @code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list},
19440but this option sets the list of function names to be excluded from
19441instrumentation.  The function name to be matched is its user-visible
19442name, such as @code{vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)}, not the
19443internal mangled name (e.g., @code{_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE}).  The
19444match is done on substrings: if the @var{sym} parameter is a substring
19445of the function name, it is considered to be a match.  For C99 and C++
19446extended identifiers, the function name must be given in UTF-8, not
19447using universal character names.
19448
19449@item -fstack-check
19450@opindex fstack-check
19451Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
19452stack.  You should specify this flag if you are running in an
19453environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to specify it in
19454a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
19455detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
19456
19457Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
19458operating system or the language runtime must do that.  The switch causes
19459generation of code to ensure that they see the stack being extended.
19460
19461You can additionally specify a string parameter: @code{no} means no
19462checking, @code{generic} means force the use of old-style checking,
19463@code{specific} means use the best checking method and is equivalent
19464to bare @option{-fstack-check}.
19465
19466Old-style checking is a generic mechanism that requires no specific
19467target support in the compiler but comes with the following drawbacks:
19468
19469@enumerate
19470@item
19471Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they will always be
19472allocated dynamically if their size exceeds a fixed threshold.
19473
19474@item
19475Fixed limit on the size of the static frame of functions: when it is
19476topped by a particular function, stack checking is not reliable and
19477a warning is issued by the compiler.
19478
19479@item
19480Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and the
19481generic implementation, the performances of the code are hampered.
19482@end enumerate
19483
19484Note that old-style stack checking is also the fallback method for
19485@code{specific} if no target support has been added in the compiler.
19486
19487@item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
19488@itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
19489@itemx -fno-stack-limit
19490@opindex fstack-limit-register
19491@opindex fstack-limit-symbol
19492@opindex fno-stack-limit
19493Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
19494either the value of a register or the address of a symbol.  If the stack
19495would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised.  For most targets,
19496the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
19497it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
19498
19499For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
19500and grows downwards, you can use the flags
19501@option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
19502@option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
19503of 128KB@.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
19504
19505@item -fsplit-stack
19506@opindex fsplit-stack
19507Generate code to automatically split the stack before it overflows.
19508The resulting program has a discontiguous stack which can only
19509overflow if the program is unable to allocate any more memory.  This
19510is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer
19511necessary to calculate a good stack size to use for each thread.  This
19512is currently only implemented for the i386 and x86_64 back ends running
19513GNU/Linux.
19514
19515When code compiled with @option{-fsplit-stack} calls code compiled
19516without @option{-fsplit-stack}, there may not be much stack space
19517available for the latter code to run.  If compiling all code,
19518including library code, with @option{-fsplit-stack} is not an option,
19519then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code compiled
19520without @option{-fsplit-stack} always has a large stack.  Support for
19521this is implemented in the gold linker in GNU binutils release 2.21
19522and later.
19523
19524@item -fleading-underscore
19525@opindex fleading-underscore
19526This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
19527change the way C symbols are represented in the object file.  One use
19528is to help link with legacy assembly code.
19529
19530@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
19531generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
19532switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19533Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
19534
19535@item -ftls-model=@var{model}
19536@opindex ftls-model
19537Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
19538The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
19539@code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
19540
19541The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
19542@option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
19543
19544@item -fvisibility=@var{default|internal|hidden|protected}
19545@opindex fvisibility
19546Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all
19547symbols will be marked with this unless overridden within the code.
19548Using this feature can very substantially improve linking and
19549load times of shared object libraries, produce more optimized
19550code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol clashes.
19551It is @strong{strongly} recommended that you use this in any shared objects
19552you distribute.
19553
19554Despite the nomenclature, @code{default} always means public; i.e.,
19555available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
19556@code{protected} and @code{internal} are pretty useless in real-world
19557usage so the only other commonly used option will be @code{hidden}.
19558The default if @option{-fvisibility} isn't specified is
19559@code{default}, i.e., make every
19560symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
19561GCC@.
19562
19563A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF
19564symbols have the correct visibility is given by ``How To Write
19565Shared Libraries'' by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
19566@w{@uref{http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/}})---however a superior
19567solution made possible by this option to marking things hidden when
19568the default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
19569public.  This is the norm with DLL's on Windows and with @option{-fvisibility=hidden}
19570and @code{__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))} instead of
19571@code{__declspec(dllexport)} you get almost identical semantics with
19572identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with
19573cross-platform projects.
19574
19575For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
19576@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} of use.  This works by you enclosing
19577the declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
19578@samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)} and
19579@samp{#pragma GCC visibility pop}.
19580Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed @strong{as
19581part of the API interface contract} and thus all new code should
19582always specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations
19583only for use within the local DSO should @strong{always} be marked explicitly
19584as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
19585abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.
19586Note that due to ISO C++ specification requirements, operator new and
19587operator delete must always be of default visibility.
19588
19589Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system
19590headers and headers from any other library you use, may not be
19591expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.  You
19592may need to explicitly say @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(default)}
19593before including any such headers.
19594
19595@samp{extern} declarations are not affected by @samp{-fvisibility}, so
19596a lot of code can be recompiled with @samp{-fvisibility=hidden} with
19597no modifications.  However, this means that calls to @samp{extern}
19598functions with no explicit visibility will use the PLT, so it is more
19599effective to use @samp{__attribute ((visibility))} and/or
19600@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} to tell the compiler which @samp{extern}
19601declarations should be treated as hidden.
19602
19603Note that @samp{-fvisibility} does affect C++ vague linkage
19604entities. This means that, for instance, an exception class that will
19605be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default
19606visibility so that the @samp{type_info} nodes will be unified between
19607the DSOs.
19608
19609An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
19610is at @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/wiki/@/Visibility}.
19611
19612@item -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19613@opindex fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19614This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or other
19615structure fields, although the compiler usually honors those types
19616anyway) should use a single access of the width of the
19617field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible.  For
19618example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral registers might require
19619all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag the user could
19620declare all peripheral bit-fields as ``unsigned short'' (assuming short
19621is 16 bits on these targets) to force GCC to use 16-bit accesses
19622instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.
19623
19624If this option is disabled, the compiler will use the most efficient
19625instruction.  In the previous example, that might be a 32-bit load
19626instruction, even though that will access bytes that do not contain
19627any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to
19628the one being updated.
19629
19630If the target requires strict alignment, and honoring the field
19631type would require violating this alignment, a warning is issued.
19632If the field has @code{packed} attribute, the access is done without
19633honoring the field type.  If the field doesn't have @code{packed}
19634attribute, the access is done honoring the field type.  In both cases,
19635GCC assumes that the user knows something about the target hardware
19636that it is unaware of.
19637
19638The default value of this option is determined by the application binary
19639interface for the target processor.
19640
19641@end table
19642
19643@c man end
19644
19645@node Environment Variables
19646@section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
19647@cindex environment variables
19648
19649@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
19650This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
19651operates.  Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
19652when searching for various kinds of files.  Some are used to specify other
19653aspects of the compilation environment.
19654
19655Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
19656@option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}).  These
19657take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
19658in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
19659@xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
19660GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
19661
19662@table @env
19663@item LANG
19664@itemx LC_CTYPE
19665@c @itemx LC_COLLATE
19666@itemx LC_MESSAGES
19667@c @itemx LC_MONETARY
19668@c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
19669@c @itemx LC_TIME
19670@itemx LC_ALL
19671@findex LANG
19672@findex LC_CTYPE
19673@c @findex LC_COLLATE
19674@findex LC_MESSAGES
19675@c @findex LC_MONETARY
19676@c @findex LC_NUMERIC
19677@c @findex LC_TIME
19678@findex LC_ALL
19679@cindex locale
19680These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
19681localization information which allows GCC to work with different
19682national conventions.  GCC inspects the locale categories
19683@env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
19684so.  These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
19685installation.  A typical value is @samp{en_GB.UTF-8} for English in the United
19686Kingdom encoded in UTF-8.
19687
19688The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
19689classification.  GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
19690a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
19691and escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string
19692end or escape.
19693
19694The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
19695use in diagnostic messages.
19696
19697If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
19698of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
19699and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
19700environment variable.  If none of these variables are set, GCC
19701defaults to traditional C English behavior.
19702
19703@item TMPDIR
19704@findex TMPDIR
19705If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
19706files.  GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
19707compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
19708the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
19709proper.
19710
19711@item GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19712@findex GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19713Setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is nearly equivalent to passing
19714@option{-fcompare-debug} to the compiler driver.  See the documentation
19715of this option for more details.
19716
19717@item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19718@findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19719If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
19720names of the subprograms executed by the compiler.  No slash is added
19721when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
19722specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
19723
19724If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out
19725an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it was invoked with.
19726
19727If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
19728tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
19729
19730The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
19731@file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc/} where @var{prefix} is the prefix to
19732the installed compiler. In many cases @var{prefix} is the value
19733of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
19734
19735Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
19736
19737This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
19738used for linking.
19739
19740In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
19741directories to search for header files.  For each of the standard
19742directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc}
19743(more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
19744replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
19745alternate directory name.  Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC will search
19746@file{foo/bar} where it would normally search @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
19747These alternate directories are searched first; the standard directories
19748come next. If a standard directory begins with the configured
19749@var{prefix} then the value of @var{prefix} is replaced by
19750@env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} when looking for header files.
19751
19752@item COMPILER_PATH
19753@findex COMPILER_PATH
19754The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19755directories, much like @env{PATH}.  GCC tries the directories thus
19756specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
19757subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
19758
19759@item LIBRARY_PATH
19760@findex LIBRARY_PATH
19761The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19762directories, much like @env{PATH}.  When configured as a native compiler,
19763GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
19764linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  Linking
19765using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
19766libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
19767@option{-L} come first).
19768
19769@item LANG
19770@findex LANG
19771@cindex locale definition
19772This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in
19773which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
19774when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
19775When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
19776the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
19777
19778@table @samp
19779@item C-JIS
19780Recognize JIS characters.
19781@item C-SJIS
19782Recognize SJIS characters.
19783@item C-EUCJP
19784Recognize EUCJP characters.
19785@end table
19786
19787If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
19788compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as defined by the default locale to
19789recognize and translate multibyte characters.
19790@end table
19791
19792@noindent
19793Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the
19794preprocessor.
19795
19796@include cppenv.texi
19797
19798@c man end
19799
19800@node Precompiled Headers
19801@section Using Precompiled Headers
19802@cindex precompiled headers
19803@cindex speed of compilation
19804
19805Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
19806source file.  The time the compiler takes to process these header files
19807over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
19808build the project.  To make builds faster, GCC allows users to
19809`precompile' a header file; then, if builds can use the precompiled
19810header file they will be much faster.
19811
19812To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
19813other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
19814treat it as a C or C++ header file.  You will probably want to use a
19815tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
19816the headers it contains change.
19817
19818A precompiled header file will be searched for when @code{#include} is
19819seen in the compilation.  As it searches for the included file
19820(@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp,The C Preprocessor}) the
19821compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
19822looks for the include file in that directory.  The name searched for is
19823the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.gch} appended.  If
19824the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
19825
19826For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
19827@file{all.h.gch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
19828precompiled header file will be used if possible, and the original
19829header will be used otherwise.
19830
19831Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
19832directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
19833before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
19834Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
19835used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
19836directory containing an @code{#error} command.
19837
19838This also works with @option{-include}.  So yet another way to use
19839precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
19840header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
19841a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
19842file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header.  If the header files
19843have guards against multiple inclusion, they will be skipped because
19844they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
19845
19846If you need to precompile the same header file for different
19847languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
19848@emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.gch}, and put each precompiled
19849header in the directory, perhaps using @option{-o}.  It doesn't matter
19850what you call the files in the directory, every precompiled header in
19851the directory will be considered.  The first precompiled header
19852encountered in the directory that is valid for this compilation will
19853be used; they're searched in no particular order.
19854
19855There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
19856good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
19857
19858A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
19859
19860@itemize
19861@item
19862Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
19863
19864@item
19865A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen.  You
19866can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you can
19867even include a precompiled header from inside another header, so long as
19868there are no C tokens before the @code{#include}.
19869
19870@item
19871The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
19872the current compilation.  You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
19873compilation.
19874
19875@item
19876The precompiled header file must have been produced by the same compiler
19877binary as the current compilation is using.
19878
19879@item
19880Any macros defined before the precompiled header is included must
19881either be defined in the same way as when the precompiled header was
19882generated, or must not affect the precompiled header, which usually
19883means that they don't appear in the precompiled header at all.
19884
19885The @option{-D} option is one way to define a macro before a
19886precompiled header is included; using a @code{#define} can also do it.
19887There are also some options that define macros implicitly, like
19888@option{-O} and @option{-Wdeprecated}; the same rule applies to macros
19889defined this way.
19890
19891@item If debugging information is output when using the precompiled
19892header, using @option{-g} or similar, the same kind of debugging information
19893must have been output when building the precompiled header.  However,
19894a precompiled header built using @option{-g} can be used in a compilation
19895when no debugging information is being output.
19896
19897@item The same @option{-m} options must generally be used when building
19898and using the precompiled header.  @xref{Submodel Options},
19899for any cases where this rule is relaxed.
19900
19901@item Each of the following options must be the same when building and using
19902the precompiled header:
19903
19904@gccoptlist{-fexceptions}
19905
19906@item
19907Some other command-line options starting with @option{-f},
19908@option{-p}, or @option{-O} must be defined in the same way as when
19909the precompiled header was generated.  At present, it's not clear
19910which options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice
19911is to use exactly the same options when generating and using the
19912precompiled header.  The following are known to be safe:
19913
19914@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=  -fpreprocessed  -fsched-interblock @gol
19915-fsched-spec  -fsched-spec-load  -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
19916-fsched-verbose=@var{number}  -fschedule-insns  -fvisibility= @gol
19917-pedantic-errors}
19918
19919@end itemize
19920
19921For all of these except the last, the compiler will automatically
19922ignore the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met.  If you
19923find an option combination that doesn't work and doesn't cause the
19924precompiled header to be ignored, please consider filing a bug report,
19925see @ref{Bugs}.
19926
19927If you do use differing options when generating and using the
19928precompiled header, the actual behavior will be a mixture of the
19929behavior for the options.  For instance, if you use @option{-g} to
19930generate the precompiled header but not when using it, you may or may
19931not get debugging information for routines in the precompiled header.
19932